]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - doc/misc/gnus.texi
; Merge from origin/emacs-25
[gnu-emacs] / doc / misc / gnus.texi
1 \input texinfo
2
3 @include gnus-overrides.texi
4
5 @setfilename ../../info/gnus.info
6 @settitle Gnus Manual
7 @include docstyle.texi
8 @syncodeindex fn cp
9 @syncodeindex vr cp
10 @syncodeindex pg cp
11
12 @copying
13 Copyright @copyright{} 1995--2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
14
15 @quotation
16 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
17 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
18 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
19 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual'',
20 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
21 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
22
23 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
24 modify this GNU manual.''
25 @end quotation
26 @end copying
27
28 @iftex
29 @iflatex
30 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
31 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
32 \usepackage{pagestyle}
33 \usepackage{epsfig}
34 \usepackage{pixidx}
35 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
36
37 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
38 \else
39 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
40 \usepackage{thumbpdf}
41 \pdfcompresslevel=9
42 \fi
43
44 \makeindex
45 \begin{document}
46
47 % Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
48 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.13}
49 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
50 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
51
52 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
53
54 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
55 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
56 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
57 \else
58 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
59 \fi
60 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
61 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
62
63 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
64 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
65
66 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
67 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
68 \newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
69 \newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
70 \newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
71 \newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
72 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
73 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
74 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
75 \newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
76 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
77 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
78 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
79 \newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
80 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
81 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
82 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
83 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
84 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
85 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
86 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
87 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
88 \newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
89 \newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
90
91 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
92 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
93 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
94 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
95 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
96 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
97 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
98 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
99 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
100 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
101 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
102 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
103 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
104
105 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
106 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
107 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
108 }
109
110 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
111
112 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
113 {\mbox{}}
114 }
115
116 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
117 \gnusdimen 0pt
118
119 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
120 \gnuscleardoublepage
121 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
122 \chapter{#2}
123 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
124 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
125 \thispagestyle{empty}
126 \hspace*{-2cm}
127 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
128 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
129 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
130 \end{picture}
131 \clearpage
132 }
133
134 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
135 \begin{figure}
136 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
137 #3
138 \end{picture}
139 \caption{#1}
140 \end{figure}
141 }
142
143 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
144 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
145 }
146
147 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
148 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
149 }
150
151 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
152 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
153 }
154
155 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
156 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
157 }
158
159 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
160
161 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
162 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
163 \section{#1}
164 }
165
166 \newenvironment{codelist}%
167 {\begin{list}{}{
168 }
169 }{\end{list}}
170
171 \newenvironment{asislist}%
172 {\begin{list}{}{
173 }
174 }{\end{list}}
175
176 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
177 {\begin{list}{}{
178 \labelwidth=0cm
179 }
180 }{\end{list}}
181
182 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
183 {\begin{list}{}{
184 }
185 }{\end{list}}
186
187 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
188 {\begin{list}{}{
189 }
190 }{\end{list}}
191
192 \newenvironment{samplist}%
193 {\begin{list}{}{
194 }
195 }{\end{list}}
196
197 \newenvironment{varlist}%
198 {\begin{list}{}{
199 }
200 }{\end{list}}
201
202 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
203 {\begin{list}{}{
204 }
205 }{\end{list}}
206
207 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
208 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
209 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
210
211 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
212 {
213 {
214 \ifodd\count0
215 {
216 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
217 }
218 \else
219 {
220 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
221 }
222 }
223 \fi
224 }
225 }
226 {
227 \ifodd\count0
228 \mbox{} \hfill
229 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
230 \else
231 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
232 \hfill \mbox{}
233 \fi
234 }
235
236 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
237 {
238 {
239 \ifodd\count0
240 {
241 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
242 }
243 \else
244 {
245 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
246 }
247 \fi
248 }
249 }
250 {
251 \ifodd\count0
252 \mbox{} \hfill
253 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
254 \else
255 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
256 \hfill \mbox{}
257 \fi
258 }
259
260 \newpagestyle{gnus}%
261 {
262 {
263 \ifodd\count0
264 {
265 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
266 }
267 \else
268 {
269 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
270 }
271 \fi
272 }
273 }
274 {
275 \ifodd\count0
276 \mbox{} \hfill
277 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
278 \else
279 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
280 \hfill \mbox{}
281 \fi
282 }
283
284 \pagenumbering{roman}
285 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
286
287 @end iflatex
288 @end iftex
289
290 @iftex
291 @iflatex
292
293 \begin{titlepage}
294 {
295
296 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
297 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
298 \parindent=0cm
299 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
300
301 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
302 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
303 \vfill
304 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
305 \vfill
306 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
307 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
308 \newpage
309 }
310
311 \mbox{}
312 \vfill
313
314 \thispagestyle{empty}
315
316 @c @insertcopying
317 \newpage
318 \end{titlepage}
319 @end iflatex
320 @end iftex
321
322 @dircategory Emacs network features
323 @direntry
324 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
325 @end direntry
326 @iftex
327 @finalout
328 @end iftex
329
330
331 @titlepage
332 @ifset WEBHACKDEVEL
333 @title Gnus Manual (DEVELOPMENT VERSION)
334 @end ifset
335 @ifclear WEBHACKDEVEL
336 @title Gnus Manual
337 @end ifclear
338
339 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
340 @page
341 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
342 @insertcopying
343 @end titlepage
344
345 @summarycontents
346 @contents
347
348 @node Top
349 @top The Gnus Newsreader
350
351 @ifinfo
352
353 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
354 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
355 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
356 luck.
357
358 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
359 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
360
361 @ifnottex
362 @insertcopying
363 @end ifnottex
364
365 @end ifinfo
366
367 @iftex
368
369 @iflatex
370 \tableofcontents
371 \gnuscleardoublepage
372 @end iflatex
373
374 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
375 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
376
377 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
378 being accused of plagiarism:
379
380 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
381 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
382 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
383 can even read news with it!
384
385 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
386 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
387 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
388 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
389 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
390 the program.
391
392 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
393 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
394
395 @heading Other related manuals
396 @itemize
397 @item Message manual: Composing messages
398 @item Emacs-MIME: Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
399 @item Sieve: Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
400 @item EasyPG: @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
401 @item SASL: @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
402 @end itemize
403
404 @end iftex
405
406 @menu
407 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
408 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
409 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
410 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
411 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
412 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
413 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
414 * Searching:: Mail and News search engines.
415 * Various:: General purpose settings.
416 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
417 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
418 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
419 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
420 * Key Index:: Key Index.
421
422 @c Doesn't work right in html.
423 @c FIXME Do this in a more standard way.
424 @ifinfo
425 Other related manuals
426
427 * Message:(message). Composing messages.
428 * Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
429 * Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
430 * EasyPG:(epa). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
431 * SASL:(sasl). @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
432 @end ifinfo
433
434 @detailmenu
435 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
436
437 Starting Gnus
438
439 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
440 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
441 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
442 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
443 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
444 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
445 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
446 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
447 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
448 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
449
450 New Groups
451
452 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
453 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
454 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
455
456 Group Buffer
457
458 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
459 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
460 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
461 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
462 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
463 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
464 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
465 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
466 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
467 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
468 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
469 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
470 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
471 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
472 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
473 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
474 * Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
475 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
476
477 Group Buffer Format
478
479 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
480 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
481 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
482
483 Group Topics
484
485 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
486 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
487 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
488 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
489 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
490
491 Misc Group Stuff
492
493 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
494 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
495 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
496 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
497 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
498
499 Summary Buffer
500
501 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
502 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
503 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
504 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
505 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
506 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
507 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
508 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
509 * Threading:: How threads are made.
510 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
511 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
512 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
513 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
514 * Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
515 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
516 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
517 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
518 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
519 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
520 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
521 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
522 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
523 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
524 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
525 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
526 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
527 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
528 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
529 or reselecting the current group.
530 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
531 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
532 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
533 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
534
535 Summary Buffer Format
536
537 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
538 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
539 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
540 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
541
542 Choosing Articles
543
544 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
545 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
546
547 Reply, Followup and Post
548
549 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
550 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
551 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
552 * Canceling and Superseding::
553
554 Marking Articles
555
556 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
557 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
558 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
559 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
560 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
561 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
562
563 Threading
564
565 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
566 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
567
568 Customizing Threading
569
570 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
571 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
572 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
573 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
574
575 Decoding Articles
576
577 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
578 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
579 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
580 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
581 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
582 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
583
584 Decoding Variables
585
586 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
587 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
588 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
589
590 Article Treatment
591
592 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
593 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
594 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
595 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
596 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
597 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
598 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
599 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
600 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys, Gravatars
601 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
602 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
603
604 Alternative Approaches
605
606 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
607 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
608
609 Various Summary Stuff
610
611 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
612 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
613 * Summary Generation Commands::
614 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
615
616 Article Buffer
617
618 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
619 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
620 * HTML:: Reading @acronym{HTML} messages.
621 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
622 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
623 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
624
625 Composing Messages
626
627 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
628 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
629 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
630 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
631 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
632 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
633 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
634 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
635 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
636
637 Select Methods
638
639 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
640 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
641 * Using IMAP:: Reading mail from @acronym{IMAP}.
642 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
643 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
644 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files.
645 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
646 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
647 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
648
649 Server Buffer
650
651 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
652 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
653 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
654 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
655 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
656 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
657 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
658
659 Getting News
660
661 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
662 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
663
664 @acronym{NNTP}
665
666 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
667 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
668 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
669
670 Getting Mail
671
672 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
673 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
674 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
675 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
676 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
677 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
678 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
679 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
680 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
681 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
682 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
683 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
684 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
685
686 Mail Sources
687
688 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
689 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
690 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
691
692 Choosing a Mail Back End
693
694 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
695 * Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
696 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
697 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
698 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
699 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
700 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
701
702 Browsing the Web
703
704 * Archiving Mail::
705 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
706 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
707
708 Other Sources
709
710 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
711 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
712 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
713 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
714 * The Empty Backend:: The backend that never has any news.
715
716 Document Groups
717
718 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
719
720 Combined Groups
721
722 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
723
724 Email Based Diary
725
726 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
727 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
728 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
729
730 The NNDiary Back End
731
732 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
733 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
734 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
735
736 The Gnus Diary Library
737
738 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
739 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
740 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
741 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
742
743 Gnus Unplugged
744
745 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
746 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
747 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
748 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
749 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
750 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
751 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
752 * Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
753 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
754 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
755 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
756 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
757 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
758 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
759
760 Agent Categories
761
762 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
763 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
764 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
765
766 Agent Commands
767
768 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
769 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
770 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
771
772 Scoring
773
774 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
775 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
776 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
777 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
778 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
779 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
780 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
781 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
782 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
783 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
784 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
785 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
786 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
787 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
788 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
789 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
790
791 Advanced Scoring
792
793 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
794 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
795 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
796
797 Searching
798
799 * nnir:: Searching with various engines.
800 * nnmairix:: Searching with Mairix.
801
802 nnir
803
804 * What is nnir?:: What does nnir do.
805 * Basic Usage:: How to perform simple searches.
806 * Setting up nnir:: How to set up nnir.
807
808 Setting up nnir
809
810 * Associating Engines:: How to associate engines.
811
812 Various
813
814 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
815 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
816 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
817 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
818 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
819 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
820 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
821 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
822 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
823 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
824 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
825 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
826 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
827 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
828 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
829 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
830 * The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
831 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
832 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
833
834 Formatting Variables
835
836 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
837 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
838 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
839 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
840 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
841 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
842 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
843 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
844
845 Image Enhancements
846
847 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
848 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
849 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were
850 meant to be shown.
851 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
852 * Gravatars:: Display the avatar of people you read.
853 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
854
855 Thwarting Email Spam
856
857 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
858 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
859 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
860 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
861
862 Spam Package
863
864 * Spam Package Introduction::
865 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
866 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
867 * Spam and Ham Processors::
868 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
869 * Spam Back Ends::
870 * Extending the Spam package::
871 * Spam Statistics Package::
872
873 Spam Statistics Package
874
875 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
876 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
877 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
878
879 Appendices
880
881 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
882 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
883 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
884 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
885 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
886 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
887 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
888 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
889 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
890
891 History
892
893 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
894 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
895 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
896 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
897 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
898 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
899 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
900 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
901
902 New Features
903
904 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
905 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
906 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
907 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
908 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
909 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
910 * No Gnus:: Very punny. Gnus 5.12/5.13
911 * Ma Gnus:: Celebrating 25 years of Gnus.
912
913 Customization
914
915 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
916 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
917 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
918 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
919
920 Gnus Reference Guide
921
922 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
923 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
924 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
925 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
926 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
927 * Group Info:: The group info format.
928 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
929 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
930 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
931
932 Back End Interface
933
934 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
935 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
936 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
937 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
938 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
939 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
940
941 Various File Formats
942
943 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
944 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
945
946 Emacs for Heathens
947
948 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
949 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
950
951 @end detailmenu
952 @end menu
953
954 @node Starting Up
955 @chapter Starting Gnus
956 @cindex starting up
957
958 If you haven't used Emacs much before using Gnus, read @ref{Emacs for
959 Heathens} first.
960
961 @kindex M-x gnus
962 @findex gnus
963 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
964 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
965 your Emacs. If not, you should customize the variable
966 @code{gnus-select-method} as described in @ref{Finding the News}. For a
967 minimal setup for posting should also customize the variables
968 @code{user-full-name} and @code{user-mail-address}.
969
970 @findex gnus-other-frame
971 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
972 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
973 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
974
975 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
976 variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
977 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
978
979 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
980 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
981
982 @menu
983 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
984 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
985 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
986 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
987 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
988 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
989 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
990 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
991 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
992 @end menu
993
994
995 @node Finding the News
996 @section Finding the News
997 @cindex finding news
998
999 First of all, you should know that there is a special buffer called
1000 @file{*Server*} that lists all the servers Gnus knows about. You can
1001 press @kbd{^} from the Group buffer to see it. In the Server buffer,
1002 you can press @kbd{RET} on a defined server to see all the groups it
1003 serves (subscribed or not!). You can also add or delete servers, edit
1004 a foreign server's definition, agentize or de-agentize a server, and
1005 do many other neat things. @xref{Server Buffer}.
1006 @xref{Foreign Groups}. @xref{Agent Basics}.
1007
1008 @vindex gnus-select-method
1009 @c @head
1010 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
1011 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
1012 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
1013 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
1014 secondary or foreign groups.
1015
1016 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
1017 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
1018
1019 @lisp
1020 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
1021 @end lisp
1022
1023 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
1024
1025 @lisp
1026 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
1027 @end lisp
1028
1029 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
1030 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
1031 server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
1032 server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
1033
1034 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
1035 @cindex NNTPSERVER
1036 @cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1037 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1038 @env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1039 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1040 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1041 If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1042 as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1043
1044 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1045 @kindex B (Group)
1046 However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1047 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1048 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1049 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1050 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1051 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1052
1053 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1054 @c @head
1055 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1056 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1057 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1058 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1059 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1060 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1061 groups are.
1062
1063 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1064 you would typically set this variable to
1065
1066 @lisp
1067 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1068 @end lisp
1069
1070
1071
1072 @node The Server is Down
1073 @section The Server is Down
1074 @cindex server errors
1075
1076 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1077 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1078 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1079
1080 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1081 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1082 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1083 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1084 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1085 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1086 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1087
1088 @findex gnus-no-server
1089 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1090 @c @head
1091 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1092 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1093 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1094 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1095 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1096 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1097 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1098
1099
1100 @node Slave Gnusae
1101 @section Slave Gnusae
1102 @cindex slave
1103
1104 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1105 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1106 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1107 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1108
1109 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1110 @file{.newsrc} file.
1111
1112 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1113 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1114 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1115 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1116 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1117 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1118 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1119
1120 @findex gnus-slave
1121 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1122 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1123 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1124 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1125 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1126 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1127 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1128 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1129
1130 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1131 information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1132
1133 If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1134 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1135 file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1136 incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1137 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1138
1139
1140
1141 @node New Groups
1142 @section New Groups
1143 @cindex new groups
1144 @cindex subscription
1145
1146 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1147 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1148 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1149 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1150 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1151 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1152 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1153 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1154 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1155
1156 @menu
1157 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1158 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1159 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1160 @end menu
1161
1162
1163 @node Checking New Groups
1164 @subsection Checking New Groups
1165
1166 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing
1167 the list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of
1168 subscribed and dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method.
1169 If @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will
1170 ask the server for new groups since the last time. This is both
1171 faster and cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list
1172 of killed groups (@pxref{Group Levels}) altogether, so you may set
1173 @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to @code{nil}, which will save time both
1174 at startup, at exit, and all over. Saves disk space, too. Why isn't
1175 this the default, then? Unfortunately, not all servers support this
1176 command.
1177
1178 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1179 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1180 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1181 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1182 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1183 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1184 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1185 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1186 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1187 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1188 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1189
1190 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1191 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1192 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1193 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1194 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1195 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1196
1197
1198 @node Subscription Methods
1199 @subsection Subscription Methods
1200
1201 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1202 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1203 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1204
1205 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1206 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1207
1208 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1209
1210 @table @code
1211
1212 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1213 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1214 Make all new groups zombies (@pxref{Group Levels}). This is the
1215 default. You can browse the zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either
1216 kill them all off properly (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them
1217 (with @kbd{u}).
1218
1219 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1220 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1221 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1222 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1223
1224 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1225 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1226 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1227
1228 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1229 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1230 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1231 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1232 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1233 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1234 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1235 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1236 up. Or something like that.
1237
1238 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1239 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1240 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1241 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1242 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1243
1244 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1245 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1246 Kill all new groups.
1247
1248 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1249 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1250 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1251 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1252 topic parameter that looks like
1253
1254 @example
1255 "nnml"
1256 @end example
1257
1258 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1259 that topic.
1260
1261 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1262 top-level topic.
1263
1264 @end table
1265
1266 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1267 A closely related variable is
1268 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1269 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1270 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1271 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1272 hierarchy or not.
1273
1274 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1275 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1276 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1277 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1278
1279
1280 @node Filtering New Groups
1281 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1282
1283 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1284 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1285 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1286
1287 @example
1288 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1289 @end example
1290
1291 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1292 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1293 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1294 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1295 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1296 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1297 subscribing these groups.
1298 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1299 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1300
1301 The ``options -n'' format is very simplistic. The syntax above is all
1302 that is supports: you can force-subscribe hierarchies, or you can
1303 deny hierarchies, and that's it.
1304
1305 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1306 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1307 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1308 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1309 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1310 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1311 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1312 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1313
1314 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1315 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1316 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1317 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1318 but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1319 more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1320 used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1321 groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1322 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, @code{nnimap}, and
1323 @code{nnmaildir}) subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this
1324 variable to @code{nil}.
1325
1326 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-categories
1327 As if that wasn't enough, @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-categories} also
1328 allows you to specify that new groups should be subscribed based on the
1329 category their select methods belong to. The default is @samp{(mail
1330 post-mail)}, meaning that all new groups from mail-like backends
1331 should be subscribed automatically.
1332
1333 New groups that match these variables are subscribed using
1334 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1335
1336
1337 @node Changing Servers
1338 @section Changing Servers
1339 @cindex changing servers
1340
1341 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1342 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1343 very flaky and you want to use another.
1344
1345 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1346 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1347
1348 @emph{Wrong!}
1349
1350 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1351 @acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1352 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1353 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1354 worthless.
1355
1356 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1357 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1358 You can use the @kbd{M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups}
1359 command to clear out all data that you have on your native groups.
1360 Use with caution.
1361
1362 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1363 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1364 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1365 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1366
1367 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1368 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1369 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1370 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1371 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1372 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1373 cache for all groups).
1374
1375
1376 @node Startup Files
1377 @section Startup Files
1378 @cindex startup files
1379 @cindex .newsrc
1380 @cindex .newsrc.el
1381 @cindex .newsrc.eld
1382
1383 Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1384 @file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1385 groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1386 read.
1387
1388 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1389 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1390 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1391 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1392 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1393 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1394 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1395
1396 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1397 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1398 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1399 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1400 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1401 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1402
1403 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1404 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1405 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1406 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1407 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1408 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1409 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1410 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1411 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1412 convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1413 want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1414 news reader.
1415
1416 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1417 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1418 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1419 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1420 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1421 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1422 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1423 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1424 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1425 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1426 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1427 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1428
1429 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1430 @vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1431 @vindex version-control
1432 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1433 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1434 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1435 If you want to keep multiple numbered backups of this file, set
1436 @code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1437 @code{version-control} variable.
1438
1439 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1440 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1441 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1442 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1443 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1444 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1445 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1446 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1447 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1448 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1449
1450 @lisp
1451 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1452 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1453
1454 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1455 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1456 @end lisp
1457
1458 @vindex gnus-init-file
1459 @vindex gnus-site-init-file
1460 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1461 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1462 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1463 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1464 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1465 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1466 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1467 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1468 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1469 the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1470 Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1471 @code{gnus-init-file}.
1472
1473
1474 @node Auto Save
1475 @section Auto Save
1476 @cindex dribble file
1477 @cindex auto-save
1478
1479 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1480 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1481 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1482 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1483 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1484 this file.
1485
1486 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1487 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1488 saved.
1489
1490 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1491 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1492 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1493
1494 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1495 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1496 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1497 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1498 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1499 file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1500
1501 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1502 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1503 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1504
1505
1506 @node The Active File
1507 @section The Active File
1508 @cindex active file
1509 @cindex ignored groups
1510
1511 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1512 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1513 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1514
1515 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1516 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1517 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1518 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1519 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1520 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1521 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1522
1523 @c This variable is
1524 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1525 @c if you set it to anything else.
1526
1527 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1528 @c @head
1529 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1530 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1531 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1532
1533 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1534 you actually subscribe to.
1535
1536 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1537 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1538 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1539 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1540
1541 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1542 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1543 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1544 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1545 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1546 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1547
1548 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1549 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1550 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1551 variable.
1552
1553 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1554 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1555 @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1556 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1557 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1558 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1559
1560 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1561 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1562
1563 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1564 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1565
1566 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1567 secondary select methods.
1568
1569
1570 @node Startup Variables
1571 @section Startup Variables
1572
1573 @table @code
1574
1575 @item gnus-load-hook
1576 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1577 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1578 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1579 times you start Gnus.
1580
1581 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1582 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1583 A hook called as the first thing when Gnus is started.
1584
1585 @item gnus-before-resume-hook
1586 @vindex gnus-before-resume-hook
1587 A hook called as the first thing when Gnus is resumed after a suspend.
1588
1589 @item gnus-startup-hook
1590 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1591 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1592
1593 @item gnus-started-hook
1594 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1595 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1596 successfully.
1597
1598 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1599 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1600 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1601 generating the group buffer.
1602
1603 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1604 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1605 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1606 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1607 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1608 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1609 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1610 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1611
1612 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1613 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1614 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1615 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1616 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1617 @file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1618
1619 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1620 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1621 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1622
1623 @item gnus-use-backend-marks
1624 @vindex gnus-use-backend-marks
1625 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will store article marks both in the
1626 @file{.newsrc.eld} file and in the backends. This will slow down
1627 group operation some.
1628
1629 @end table
1630
1631
1632 @node Group Buffer
1633 @chapter Group Buffer
1634 @cindex group buffer
1635
1636 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1637 @c
1638 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1639 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1640 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1641 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1642 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1643 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1644 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1645 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1646 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1647 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1648 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1649 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1650 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1651 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1652 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1653 @c human rights at 9...
1654
1655
1656 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1657 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1658 long as Gnus is active.
1659
1660 @iftex
1661 @iflatex
1662 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1663 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1664 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1665 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1666 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1667 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1668 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1669 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1670 }
1671 @end iflatex
1672 @end iftex
1673
1674 @menu
1675 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1676 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1677 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1678 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1679 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1680 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1681 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1682 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1683 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1684 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1685 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1686 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1687 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1688 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1689 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1690 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1691 * Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
1692 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1693 @end menu
1694
1695
1696 @node Group Buffer Format
1697 @section Group Buffer Format
1698
1699 @menu
1700 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1701 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1702 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1703 @end menu
1704
1705 You can customize the Group Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
1706 customize-apropos RET gnus-group-tool-bar}. This feature is only
1707 available in Emacs.
1708
1709 The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly depending on the
1710 cursor position. Therefore, moving around in the Group Buffer is
1711 slower. You can disable this via the variable
1712 @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}. Its default value depends on your
1713 Emacs version.
1714
1715 @node Group Line Specification
1716 @subsection Group Line Specification
1717 @cindex group buffer format
1718
1719 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1720 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1721
1722 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1723
1724 @example
1725 25: news.announce.newusers
1726 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1727 @end example
1728
1729 Quite simple, huh?
1730
1731 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1732 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1733 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1734 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1735
1736 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1737 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1738 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1739 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1740 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C@.
1741 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1742
1743 @samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1744
1745 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1746 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1747 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1748 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1749 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1750
1751 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1752 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1753 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1754
1755 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1756
1757 @table @samp
1758
1759 @item M
1760 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1761
1762 @item S
1763 Whether the group is subscribed.
1764
1765 @item L
1766 Level of subscribedness.
1767
1768 @item N
1769 Number of unread articles.
1770
1771 @item I
1772 Number of dormant articles.
1773
1774 @item T
1775 Number of ticked articles.
1776
1777 @item R
1778 Number of read articles.
1779
1780 @item U
1781 Number of unseen articles.
1782
1783 @item t
1784 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1785 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1786
1787 Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1788 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1789 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1790 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1791 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1792 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1793 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job.
1794
1795 The nnml backend (@pxref{Mail Spool}) has a feature called ``group
1796 compaction'' which circumvents this deficiency: the idea is to
1797 renumber all articles from 1, removing all gaps between numbers, hence
1798 getting a correct total count. Other backends may support this in the
1799 future. In order to keep your total article count relatively up to
1800 date, you might want to compact your groups (or even directly your
1801 server) from time to time. @xref{Misc Group Stuff}, @xref{Server Commands}.
1802
1803 @item y
1804 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1805
1806 @item i
1807 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1808
1809 @item g
1810 Full group name.
1811
1812 @item G
1813 Group name.
1814
1815 @item C
1816 Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1817 comment element in the group parameters.
1818
1819 @item D
1820 Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1821 before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1822 @code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1823 command.
1824
1825 @item o
1826 @samp{m} if moderated.
1827
1828 @item O
1829 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1830
1831 @item s
1832 Select method.
1833
1834 @item B
1835 If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1836
1837 @item n
1838 Select from where.
1839
1840 @item z
1841 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1842 used.
1843
1844 @item P
1845 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1846
1847 @item c
1848 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1849 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1850 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1851 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1852 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1853
1854 @item m
1855 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1856 @cindex %
1857 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1858 the group lately.
1859
1860 @item p
1861 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1862
1863 @item d
1864 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1865 Timestamp}).
1866
1867 @item F
1868 The disk space used by the articles fetched by both the cache and
1869 agent. The value is automatically scaled to bytes(B), kilobytes(K),
1870 megabytes(M), or gigabytes(G) to minimize the column width. A format
1871 of %7F is sufficient for a fixed-width column.
1872
1873 @item u
1874 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1875 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1876 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1877 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1878 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1879 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1880 specifier.
1881 @end table
1882
1883 @cindex *
1884 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1885 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1886 group, or a bogus native group.
1887
1888
1889 @node Group Mode Line Specification
1890 @subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1891 @cindex group mode line
1892
1893 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1894 The mode line can be changed by setting
1895 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1896 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1897
1898 @table @samp
1899 @item S
1900 The native news server.
1901 @item M
1902 The native select method.
1903 @end table
1904
1905
1906 @node Group Highlighting
1907 @subsection Group Highlighting
1908 @cindex highlighting
1909 @cindex group highlighting
1910
1911 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1912 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1913 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1914 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1915 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1916
1917 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1918 background is dark:
1919
1920 @lisp
1921 (cond (window-system
1922 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1923 (defface my-group-face-1
1924 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1925 (defface my-group-face-2
1926 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1927 "Second group face")
1928 (defface my-group-face-3
1929 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1930 (defface my-group-face-4
1931 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1932 (defface my-group-face-5
1933 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1934
1935 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1936 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1937 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1938 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1939 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1940 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1941 @end lisp
1942
1943 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1944
1945 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1946 include:
1947
1948 @table @code
1949 @item group
1950 The group name.
1951 @item unread
1952 The number of unread articles in the group.
1953 @item method
1954 The select method.
1955 @item mailp
1956 Whether the group is a mail group.
1957 @item level
1958 The level of the group.
1959 @item score
1960 The score of the group.
1961 @item ticked
1962 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1963 @item total
1964 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1965 @var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1966 @item topic
1967 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1968 topic being inserted.
1969 @end table
1970
1971 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1972 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1973 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1974
1975 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1976 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1977 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1978 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
1979
1980
1981 @node Group Maneuvering
1982 @section Group Maneuvering
1983 @cindex group movement
1984
1985 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1986 expected, hopefully.
1987
1988 @table @kbd
1989
1990 @item n
1991 @kindex n (Group)
1992 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1993 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1994 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1995
1996 @item p
1997 @itemx DEL
1998 @kindex DEL (Group)
1999 @kindex p (Group)
2000 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
2001 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
2002 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
2003
2004 @item N
2005 @kindex N (Group)
2006 @findex gnus-group-next-group
2007 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
2008
2009 @item P
2010 @kindex P (Group)
2011 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
2012 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2013
2014 @item M-n
2015 @kindex M-n (Group)
2016 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2017 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2018 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2019
2020 @item M-p
2021 @kindex M-p (Group)
2022 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2023 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2024 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2025 @end table
2026
2027 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2028
2029 @table @kbd
2030
2031 @item j
2032 @kindex j (Group)
2033 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2034 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2035 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2036 like living groups.
2037
2038 @item ,
2039 @kindex , (Group)
2040 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2041 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2042 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2043
2044 @item .
2045 @kindex . (Group)
2046 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2047 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2048 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2049 @end table
2050
2051 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2052 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2053 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2054 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2055 is @code{t}.
2056
2057 @vindex gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit
2058 If @code{gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit} is @code{t}, when a summary is
2059 exited, the point in the group buffer is moved to the next unread group.
2060 Otherwise, the point is set to the group just exited. The default is
2061 @code{t}.
2062
2063 @node Selecting a Group
2064 @section Selecting a Group
2065 @cindex group selection
2066
2067 @table @kbd
2068
2069 @item SPACE
2070 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2071 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2072 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2073 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2074 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2075 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2076 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2077 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2078 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2079 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2080
2081 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2082 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2083 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2084
2085 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2086 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2087 ones.
2088
2089 @item RET
2090 @kindex RET (Group)
2091 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2092 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2093 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2094 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2095 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2096 entry.
2097
2098 @item M-RET
2099 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2100 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2101 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2102 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2103 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2104 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2105 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2106 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2107 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2108 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2109
2110 @item M-SPACE
2111 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2112 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2113 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2114 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2115 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2116
2117 @item C-M-RET
2118 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2119 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2120 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2121 doing any processing of its contents
2122 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2123 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2124 manner will have no permanent effects.
2125
2126 @end table
2127
2128 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2129 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2130 consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2131 considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2132 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2133 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2134 articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2135 negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2136 fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2137 most recently will be fetched.
2138
2139 @vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2140 @code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2141 @code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2142 newsgroups.
2143
2144 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles
2145 In groups in some news servers, there might be a big gap between a few
2146 very old articles that will never be expired and the recent ones. In
2147 such a case, the server will return the data like @code{(1 . 30000000)}
2148 for the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, for example. Even if there
2149 are actually only the articles 1--10 and 29999900--30000000, Gnus doesn't
2150 know it at first and prepares for getting 30000000 articles. However,
2151 it will consume hundreds megabytes of memories and might make Emacs get
2152 stuck as the case may be. If you use such news servers, set the
2153 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} to a positive number.
2154 The value means that Gnus ignores articles other than this number of the
2155 latest ones in every group. For instance, the value 10000 makes Gnus
2156 get only the articles 29990001--30000000 (if the latest article number is
2157 30000000 in a group). Note that setting this variable to a number might
2158 prevent you from reading very old articles. The default value of the
2159 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} is @code{nil}, which
2160 means Gnus never ignores old articles.
2161
2162 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2163 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2164 @vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2165 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2166 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2167 Which article this is controlled by the
2168 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2169 variable are:
2170
2171 @table @code
2172
2173 @item unread
2174 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2175
2176 @item first
2177 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2178
2179 @item unseen
2180 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2181
2182 @item unseen-or-unread
2183 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2184 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2185 unread article.
2186
2187 @item best
2188 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2189
2190 @end table
2191
2192 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2193 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2194
2195 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2196 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2197 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2198 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2199 selected.
2200
2201
2202 @node Subscription Commands
2203 @section Subscription Commands
2204 @cindex subscription
2205
2206 The following commands allow for managing your subscriptions in the
2207 Group buffer. If you want to subscribe to many groups, it's probably
2208 more convenient to go to the @ref{Server Buffer}, and choose the
2209 server there using @kbd{RET} or @kbd{SPC}. Then you'll have the
2210 commands listed in @ref{Browse Foreign Server} at hand.
2211
2212 @table @kbd
2213
2214 @item S t
2215 @itemx u
2216 @kindex S t (Group)
2217 @kindex u (Group)
2218 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2219 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2220 Toggle subscription to the current group
2221 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2222
2223 @item S s
2224 @itemx U
2225 @kindex S s (Group)
2226 @kindex U (Group)
2227 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2228 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2229 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2230 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2231
2232 @item S k
2233 @itemx C-k
2234 @kindex S k (Group)
2235 @kindex C-k (Group)
2236 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2237 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2238 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2239
2240 @item S y
2241 @itemx C-y
2242 @kindex S y (Group)
2243 @kindex C-y (Group)
2244 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2245 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2246
2247 @item C-x C-t
2248 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2249 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2250 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2251 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2252 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2253
2254 @item S w
2255 @itemx C-w
2256 @kindex S w (Group)
2257 @kindex C-w (Group)
2258 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2259 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2260
2261 @item S z
2262 @kindex S z (Group)
2263 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2264 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2265
2266 @item S C-k
2267 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2268 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2269 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2270 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2271 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2272 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2273 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2274 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2275 @file{.newsrc} file.
2276
2277 @end table
2278
2279 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2280
2281
2282 @node Group Data
2283 @section Group Data
2284
2285 @table @kbd
2286
2287 @item c
2288 @kindex c (Group)
2289 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2290 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2291 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2292 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2293 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2294 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2295 the group buffer.
2296
2297 @item C
2298 @kindex C (Group)
2299 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2300 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2301 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2302
2303 @item M-c
2304 @kindex M-c (Group)
2305 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2306 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2307 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2308
2309 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2310 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2311 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2312 If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2313 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2314 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2315 caution.
2316
2317 @end table
2318
2319
2320 @node Group Levels
2321 @section Group Levels
2322 @cindex group level
2323 @cindex level
2324
2325 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2326 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2327 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2328 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2329 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2330
2331 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2332
2333 @table @kbd
2334
2335 @item S l
2336 @kindex S l (Group)
2337 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2338 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2339 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2340 prompted for a level.
2341 @end table
2342
2343 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2344 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2345 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2346 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2347 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2348 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2349 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2350 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2351 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2352 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2353 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2354 same, but zombie and killed groups store no information on what articles
2355 you have read, etc. This distinction between dead and living
2356 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2357 reasons of efficiency.
2358
2359 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2360 low levels (e.g., 1 or 2).
2361
2362 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2363 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2364 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2365 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2366 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2367 groups are hidden, in a way.
2368
2369 @cindex zombie groups
2370 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2371 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2372 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2373 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2374 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2375 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2376
2377 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2378 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2379 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2380 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2381 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2382 list of killed groups.)
2383
2384 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2385 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2386 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2387
2388 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2389 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2390 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2391 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2392 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2393 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2394 relevant valid ranges.
2395
2396 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2397 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2398 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2399 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2400 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2401 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2402 rest.
2403
2404 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2405 one with the best level.
2406
2407 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2408 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2409 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2410 by default.
2411 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function will
2412 be called and the result will be used as value.
2413
2414
2415 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2416 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2417 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2418 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2419 listed.
2420
2421 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2422 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2423 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2424 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2425
2426 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2427 Gnus will normally just activate (i.e., query the server about) groups
2428 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2429 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2430 to 5. The default is 6.
2431
2432
2433 @node Group Score
2434 @section Group Score
2435 @cindex group score
2436 @cindex group rank
2437 @cindex rank
2438
2439 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2440 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2441 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2442 reason?
2443
2444 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2445 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2446 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2447 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2448 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2449 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2450 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2451 least significant part.))
2452
2453 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2454 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2455 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2456 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2457 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2458 action after each summary exit, you can add
2459 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2460 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2461 slow things down somewhat.
2462
2463
2464 @node Marking Groups
2465 @section Marking Groups
2466 @cindex marking groups
2467
2468 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2469 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2470 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2471 bidding on those groups.
2472
2473 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2474 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2475 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2476
2477 @table @kbd
2478
2479 @item #
2480 @kindex # (Group)
2481 @itemx M m
2482 @kindex M m (Group)
2483 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2484 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2485
2486 @item M-#
2487 @kindex M-# (Group)
2488 @itemx M u
2489 @kindex M u (Group)
2490 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2491 Remove the mark from the current group
2492 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2493
2494 @item M U
2495 @kindex M U (Group)
2496 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2497 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2498
2499 @item M w
2500 @kindex M w (Group)
2501 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2502 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2503
2504 @item M b
2505 @kindex M b (Group)
2506 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2507 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2508
2509 @item M r
2510 @kindex M r (Group)
2511 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2512 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2513 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2514 @end table
2515
2516 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2517
2518 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2519 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2520 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2521 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2522 the command to be executed.
2523
2524
2525 @node Foreign Groups
2526 @section Foreign Groups
2527 @cindex foreign groups
2528
2529 If you recall how to subscribe to servers (@pxref{Finding the News})
2530 you will remember that @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} and
2531 @code{gnus-select-method} let you write a definition in Emacs Lisp of
2532 what servers you want to see when you start up. The alternate
2533 approach is to use foreign servers and groups. ``Foreign'' here means
2534 they are not coming from the select methods. All foreign server
2535 configuration and subscriptions are stored only in the
2536 @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file.
2537
2538 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2539 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2540 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2541 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2542 consulted.
2543
2544 Changes from the group editing commands are stored in
2545 @file{~/.newsrc.eld} (@code{gnus-startup-file}). An alternative is the
2546 variable @code{gnus-parameters}, @xref{Group Parameters}.
2547
2548 @table @kbd
2549
2550 @item G m
2551 @kindex G m (Group)
2552 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2553 @cindex making groups
2554 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2555 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2556 to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2557
2558 @item G M
2559 @kindex G M (Group)
2560 @findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2561 Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2562 will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2563
2564 @item G r
2565 @kindex G r (Group)
2566 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2567 @cindex renaming groups
2568 Rename the current group to something else
2569 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2570 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2571 on some back ends.
2572
2573 @item G c
2574 @kindex G c (Group)
2575 @cindex customizing
2576 @findex gnus-group-customize
2577 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2578
2579 @item G e
2580 @kindex G e (Group)
2581 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2582 @cindex renaming groups
2583 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2584 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2585
2586 @item G p
2587 @kindex G p (Group)
2588 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2589 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2590 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2591
2592 @item G E
2593 @kindex G E (Group)
2594 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2595 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2596 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2597
2598 @item G d
2599 @kindex G d (Group)
2600 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2601 @cindex nndir
2602 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2603 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2604
2605 @item G h
2606 @kindex G h (Group)
2607 @cindex help group
2608 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2609 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2610
2611 @item G D
2612 @kindex G D (Group)
2613 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2614 @cindex nneething
2615 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2616 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2617 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2618
2619 @item G f
2620 @kindex G f (Group)
2621 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2622 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2623 @cindex nndoc
2624 Make a group based on some file or other
2625 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2626 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2627 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2628 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2629 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2630 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2631 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2632 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2633 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2634
2635 @item G u
2636 @kindex G u (Group)
2637 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2638 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2639 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2640 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2641
2642 @item G w
2643 @kindex G w (Group)
2644 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2645 @cindex Google
2646 @cindex nnweb
2647 @cindex gmane
2648 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2649 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2650 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2651 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2652 include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2653 @xref{Web Searches}.
2654
2655 If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2656 to a particular group by using a match string like
2657 @samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2658
2659 @item G R
2660 @kindex G R (Group)
2661 @findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2662 Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2663 (@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL@.
2664 @xref{RSS}.
2665
2666 @item G DEL
2667 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2668 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2669 This function will delete the current group
2670 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2671 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2672 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2673 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2674 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2675
2676 @item G V
2677 @kindex G V (Group)
2678 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2679 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2680 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2681
2682 @item G v
2683 @kindex G v (Group)
2684 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2685 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2686 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2687 @end table
2688
2689 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2690 methods.
2691
2692 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2693 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2694 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2695 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2696 groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2697 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2698 newsgroups.
2699
2700
2701 The following commands create ephemeral groups. They can be called not
2702 only from the Group buffer, but in any Gnus buffer.
2703
2704 @table @code
2705 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2706 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2707 @vindex gnus-gmane-group-download-format
2708 Read an ephemeral group on Gmane.org. The articles are downloaded via
2709 HTTP using the URL specified by @code{gnus-gmane-group-download-format}.
2710 Gnus will prompt you for a group name, the start article number and an
2711 the article range.
2712
2713 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2714 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2715 This command is similar to @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group}, but
2716 the group name and the article number and range are constructed from a
2717 given @acronym{URL}. Supported @acronym{URL} formats include:
2718 @indicateurl{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12300/focus=12399},
2719 @indicateurl{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2720 @indicateurl{http://article.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2721 @indicateurl{http://permalink.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/}, and
2722 @indicateurl{http://news.gmane.org/group/gmane.foo.bar/thread=12345}.
2723
2724 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2725 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2726 Read an Emacs bug report in an ephemeral group. Gnus will prompt for a
2727 bug number. The default is the number at point. The @acronym{URL} is
2728 specified in @code{gnus-bug-group-download-format-alist}.
2729
2730 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2731 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2732 Read a Debian bug report in an ephemeral group. Analog to
2733 @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group}.
2734 @end table
2735
2736 Some of these command are also useful for article buttons, @xref{Article
2737 Buttons}.
2738
2739 Here is an example:
2740 @lisp
2741 (require 'gnus-art)
2742 (add-to-list
2743 'gnus-button-alist
2744 '("#\\([0-9]+\\)\\>" 1
2745 (string-match "\\<emacs\\>" (or gnus-newsgroup-name ""))
2746 gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group 1))
2747 @end lisp
2748
2749
2750 @node Group Parameters
2751 @section Group Parameters
2752 @cindex group parameters
2753
2754 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2755
2756 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
2757 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
2758 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
2759 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
2760 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
2761 Additionally, you can set group parameters via the
2762 @code{gnus-parameters} variable, see below.
2763
2764 Here's an example group parameter list:
2765
2766 @example
2767 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2768 (auto-expire . t))
2769 @end example
2770
2771 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2772 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2773 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2774 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2775
2776 Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2777 is an alist of regexps and values.
2778
2779 The following group parameters can be used:
2780
2781 @table @code
2782 @item to-address
2783 @cindex to-address
2784 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2785
2786 @example
2787 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2788 @end example
2789
2790 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2791 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2792 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2793 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2794 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2795
2796 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2797 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2798 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2799 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2800 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2801 list address instead.
2802
2803 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2804
2805 @item to-list
2806 @cindex to-list
2807 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2808
2809 @example
2810 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2811 @end example
2812
2813 It is totally ignored
2814 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2815 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2816
2817 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2818 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2819 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2820 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2821 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2822
2823 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2824 @cindex mail list groups
2825 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2826 entering summary buffer.
2827
2828 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2829
2830 @anchor{subscribed}
2831 @item subscribed
2832 @cindex subscribed
2833 @cindex Mail-Followup-To
2834 @findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2835 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2836 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2837 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2838 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2839 headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2840 following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2841
2842 @lisp
2843 (setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2844 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2845 @end lisp
2846
2847 @xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2848 a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2849
2850 @item visible
2851 @cindex visible
2852 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2853 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2854 of whether it has any unread articles.
2855
2856 This parameter cannot be set via @code{gnus-parameters}. See
2857 @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.
2858
2859 @item broken-reply-to
2860 @cindex broken-reply-to
2861 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2862 headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2863 if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2864 can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2865 has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2866 itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2867
2868 @item to-group
2869 @cindex to-group
2870 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2871 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2872
2873 @item newsgroup
2874 @cindex newsgroup
2875 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2876 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2877 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2878 news group.
2879
2880 @item gcc-self
2881 @cindex gcc-self
2882 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2883 composed messages will be @code{gcc}d to the current group. If
2884 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2885 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "group")} is present, this string will
2886 be inserted literally as a @code{Gcc:} header. It should be a group
2887 name. The @code{gcc-self} value may also be a list of strings and
2888 @code{t}, e.g., @code{(gcc-self "group1" "group2" t)} means to
2889 @code{gcc} the newly composed message into the groups @code{"group1"}
2890 and @code{"group2"}, and into the current group. The @code{gcc-self}
2891 parameter takes precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as
2892 described later (@pxref{Archived Messages}), with the exception for
2893 messages to resend.
2894
2895 @strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2896 @code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2897 doesn't accept articles.
2898
2899 @item auto-expire
2900 @cindex auto-expire
2901 @cindex expiring mail
2902 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2903 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2904 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2905
2906 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2907
2908 @item total-expire
2909 @cindex total-expire
2910 @cindex expiring mail
2911 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2912 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2913 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2914 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2915 expiry.
2916
2917 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2918
2919 @item expiry-wait
2920 @cindex expiry-wait
2921 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2922 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2923 @code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2924 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2925 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2926 can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2927 symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2928
2929 @item expiry-target
2930 @cindex expiry-target
2931 Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2932 @code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2933
2934 @item score-file
2935 @cindex score file group parameter
2936 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2937 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2938 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2939
2940 @item adapt-file
2941 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2942 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2943 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2944 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2945
2946 @item admin-address
2947 @cindex admin-address
2948 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2949 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2950 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2951 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2952
2953 @item display
2954 @cindex display
2955 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2956 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2957
2958 @table @code
2959 @item all
2960 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2961
2962 @item an integer
2963 Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2964 entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2965
2966 @item default
2967 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2968 ticked articles.
2969
2970 @item an array
2971 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2972
2973 Here are some examples:
2974
2975 @table @code
2976 @item [unread]
2977 Display only unread articles.
2978
2979 @item [not expire]
2980 Display everything except expirable articles.
2981
2982 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2983 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2984 responded to.
2985 @end table
2986
2987 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2988 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2989 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2990 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2991 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, and @code{unseen}.
2992
2993 @end table
2994
2995 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2996 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2997 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2998
2999 @item comment
3000 @cindex comment
3001 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
3002 arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
3003 group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
3004
3005 @item charset
3006 @cindex charset
3007 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
3008 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
3009 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
3010
3011 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
3012
3013 @item ignored-charsets
3014 @cindex ignored-charset
3015 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
3016 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
3017 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
3018
3019 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
3020
3021 @item posting-style
3022 @cindex posting-style
3023 You can store additional posting style information for this group
3024 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
3025 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
3026 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
3027 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
3028
3029 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
3030 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
3031 like this in the group parameters:
3032
3033 @example
3034 (posting-style
3035 (name "Funky Name")
3036 ("X-Message-SMTP-Method" "smtp smtp.example.org 587")
3037 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
3038 (signature "Funky Signature"))
3039 @end example
3040
3041 If you're using topics to organize your group buffer
3042 (@pxref{Group Topics}), note that posting styles can also be set in
3043 the topics parameters. Posting styles in topic parameters apply to all
3044 groups in this topic. More precisely, the posting-style settings for a
3045 group result from the hierarchical merging of all posting-style
3046 entries in the parameters of this group and all the topics it belongs
3047 to.
3048
3049
3050 @item post-method
3051 @cindex post-method
3052 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
3053 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
3054
3055 @item mail-source
3056 @cindex mail-source
3057 If it is set, and the setting of @code{mail-sources} includes a
3058 @code{group} mail source (@pxref{Mail Sources}), the value is a
3059 mail source for this group.
3060
3061 @item banner
3062 @cindex banner
3063 An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
3064 that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
3065 @var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
3066 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
3067 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
3068
3069 @item sieve
3070 @cindex sieve
3071 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
3072 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
3073 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
3074 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
3075
3076 For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
3077 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
3078 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
3079 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
3080
3081 @example
3082 if address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com" @{
3083 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3084 @}
3085 @end example
3086
3087 To generate tests for multiple email-addresses use a group parameter
3088 like @code{(sieve address "sender" ("name@@one.org" else@@two.org"))}.
3089 When generating a sieve script (@pxref{Sieve Commands}) Sieve code
3090 like the following is generated:
3091
3092 @example
3093 if address "sender" ["name@@one.org", "else@@two.org"] @{
3094 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3095 @}
3096 @end example
3097
3098 You can also use regexp expansions in the rules:
3099
3100 @example
3101 (sieve header :regex "list-id" "<c++std-\\1.accu.org>")
3102 @end example
3103
3104 See @pxref{Sieve Commands} for commands and variables that might be of
3105 interest in relation to the sieve parameter.
3106
3107 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
3108 Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
3109
3110 @item (agent parameters)
3111 If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of its parameters to
3112 control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
3113 Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
3114 agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
3115 minimize the configuration effort.
3116
3117 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
3118 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
3119 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
3120 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
3121 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
3122 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
3123 @code{eval}ed there.
3124
3125 Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer
3126 if and only if @var{variable} has been bound as a variable. Otherwise,
3127 only evaluating the form will take place. So, you may want to bind the
3128 variable in advance using @code{defvar} or other if the result of the
3129 form needs to be set to it.
3130
3131 But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
3132 message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
3133 message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
3134 question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
3135 Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
3136 parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
3137 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3138
3139 @lisp
3140 (add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
3141 @end lisp
3142
3143 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
3144 A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
3145 the subject fields of articles. E.g., if the news group
3146
3147 @example
3148 nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3149 @end example
3150
3151 has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3152 tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3153 the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3154 into the group parameters for the group.
3155
3156 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3157 hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
3158 @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group. If
3159 @code{dummy-variable} has been bound (see above), it will be set to the
3160 (meaningless) result of the @code{(ding)} form.
3161
3162 Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3163 pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3164 following is added to a group parameter
3165
3166 @lisp
3167 (gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3168 (lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3169 @end lisp
3170
3171 when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3172 expired.
3173
3174 @end table
3175
3176 @vindex gnus-parameters
3177 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3178 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect (For this
3179 case see @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.).
3180 For example:
3181
3182 @lisp
3183 (setq gnus-parameters
3184 '(("mail\\..*"
3185 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3186 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3187 (gnus-summary-line-format
3188 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3189 (gcc-self . t)
3190 (display . all))
3191
3192 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3193 (to-group . "\\1"))
3194
3195 ("mail\\.me"
3196 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3197
3198 ("list\\..*"
3199 (total-expire . t)
3200 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3201 @end lisp
3202
3203 All clauses that matches the group name will be used, but the last
3204 setting ``wins''. So if you have two clauses that both match the
3205 group name, and both set, say @code{display}, the last setting will
3206 override the first.
3207
3208 Parameters that are strings will be subjected to regexp substitution,
3209 as the @code{to-group} example shows.
3210
3211 @vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3212 By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3213 specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3214 or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3215 @code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3216 value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3217 example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3218 applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3219 group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3220 value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3221 @code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3222 always in a case-insensitive manner.
3223
3224 You can define different sorting to different groups via
3225 @code{gnus-parameters}. Here is an example to sort an @acronym{NNTP}
3226 group by reverse date to see the latest news at the top and an
3227 @acronym{RSS} group by subject. In this example, the first group is the
3228 Debian daily news group @code{gmane.linux.debian.user.news} from
3229 news.gmane.org. The @acronym{RSS} group corresponds to the Debian
3230 weekly news RSS feed
3231 @url{http://packages.debian.org/unstable/newpkg_main.en.rdf},
3232 @xref{RSS}.
3233
3234 @lisp
3235 (setq
3236 gnus-parameters
3237 '(("nntp.*gmane\\.debian\\.user\\.news"
3238 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3239 (gnus-article-sort-functions '((not gnus-article-sort-by-date)))
3240 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3241 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
3242 ("nnrss.*debian"
3243 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3244 (gnus-article-sort-functions 'gnus-article-sort-by-subject)
3245 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3246 (gnus-use-scoring t)
3247 (gnus-score-find-score-files-function 'gnus-score-find-single)
3248 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%d %I%(%[ %s %]%)\n"))))
3249 @end lisp
3250
3251
3252 @node Listing Groups
3253 @section Listing Groups
3254 @cindex group listing
3255
3256 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3257
3258 @table @kbd
3259
3260 @item l
3261 @itemx A s
3262 @kindex A s (Group)
3263 @kindex l (Group)
3264 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
3265 List all groups that have unread articles
3266 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3267 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3268 only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3269 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3270 groups).
3271
3272 @item L
3273 @itemx A u
3274 @kindex A u (Group)
3275 @kindex L (Group)
3276 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3277 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3278 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3279 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3280 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3281 unsubscribed groups).
3282
3283 @item A l
3284 @kindex A l (Group)
3285 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3286 List all unread groups on a specific level
3287 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3288 with no unread articles.
3289
3290 @item A k
3291 @kindex A k (Group)
3292 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3293 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3294 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3295 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3296 from the server.
3297
3298 @item A z
3299 @kindex A z (Group)
3300 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3301 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3302
3303 @item A m
3304 @kindex A m (Group)
3305 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3306 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3307 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3308
3309 @item A M
3310 @kindex A M (Group)
3311 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3312 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3313
3314 @item A A
3315 @kindex A A (Group)
3316 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3317 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3318 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3319 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3320 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3321 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3322 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3323 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3324
3325 @item A a
3326 @kindex A a (Group)
3327 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3328 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3329 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3330
3331 @item A d
3332 @kindex A d (Group)
3333 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3334 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3335 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3336
3337 @item A c
3338 @kindex A c (Group)
3339 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3340 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3341
3342 @item A ?
3343 @kindex A ? (Group)
3344 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3345 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3346
3347 @item A !
3348 @kindex A ! (Group)
3349 @findex gnus-group-list-ticked
3350 List all groups with ticked articles (@code{gnus-group-list-ticked}).
3351
3352 @item A /
3353 @kindex A / (Group)
3354 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3355 Further limit groups within the current selection
3356 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}). If you've first limited to groups
3357 with dormant articles with @kbd{A ?}, you can then further limit with
3358 @kbd{A / c}, which will then limit to groups with cached articles,
3359 giving you the groups that have both dormant articles and cached
3360 articles.
3361
3362 @item A f
3363 @kindex A f (Group)
3364 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3365 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3366
3367 @item A p
3368 @kindex A p (Group)
3369 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3370 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3371
3372 @end table
3373
3374 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3375 @cindex visible group parameter
3376 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3377 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3378 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3379 get the same effect.
3380
3381 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3382 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3383 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3384 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3385 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3386
3387
3388 @node Sorting Groups
3389 @section Sorting Groups
3390 @cindex sorting groups
3391
3392 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3393 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3394 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3395 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3396 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3397 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3398 include:
3399
3400 @table @code
3401
3402 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3403 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3404 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3405
3406 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3407 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3408 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3409
3410 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3411 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3412 Sort by group level.
3413
3414 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3415 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3416 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3417
3418 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3419 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3420 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3421 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3422
3423 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3424 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3425 Sort by number of unread articles.
3426
3427 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3428 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3429 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3430
3431 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3432 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3433 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3434
3435
3436 @end table
3437
3438 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3439 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3440 the last one.
3441
3442
3443 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3444 some sorting criteria:
3445
3446 @table @kbd
3447 @item G S a
3448 @kindex G S a (Group)
3449 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3450 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3451 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3452
3453 @item G S u
3454 @kindex G S u (Group)
3455 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3456 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3457 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3458
3459 @item G S l
3460 @kindex G S l (Group)
3461 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3462 Sort the group buffer by group level
3463 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3464
3465 @item G S v
3466 @kindex G S v (Group)
3467 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3468 Sort the group buffer by group score
3469 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3470
3471 @item G S r
3472 @kindex G S r (Group)
3473 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3474 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3475 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3476
3477 @item G S m
3478 @kindex G S m (Group)
3479 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3480 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3481 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3482
3483 @item G S n
3484 @kindex G S n (Group)
3485 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3486 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3487 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3488
3489 @end table
3490
3491 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3492 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3493
3494 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3495 commands will sort in reverse order.
3496
3497 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3498
3499 @table @kbd
3500 @item G P a
3501 @kindex G P a (Group)
3502 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3503 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3504 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3505
3506 @item G P u
3507 @kindex G P u (Group)
3508 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3509 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3510 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3511
3512 @item G P l
3513 @kindex G P l (Group)
3514 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3515 Sort the groups by group level
3516 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3517
3518 @item G P v
3519 @kindex G P v (Group)
3520 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3521 Sort the groups by group score
3522 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3523
3524 @item G P r
3525 @kindex G P r (Group)
3526 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3527 Sort the groups by group rank
3528 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3529
3530 @item G P m
3531 @kindex G P m (Group)
3532 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3533 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3534 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3535
3536 @item G P n
3537 @kindex G P n (Group)
3538 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3539 Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3540 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3541
3542 @item G P s
3543 @kindex G P s (Group)
3544 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3545 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3546
3547 @end table
3548
3549 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3550 move groups around.
3551
3552
3553 @node Group Maintenance
3554 @section Group Maintenance
3555 @cindex bogus groups
3556
3557 @table @kbd
3558 @item b
3559 @kindex b (Group)
3560 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3561 Find bogus groups and delete them
3562 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3563
3564 @item F
3565 @kindex F (Group)
3566 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3567 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3568 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3569 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3570 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3571 zombies.
3572
3573 @item C-c C-x
3574 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3575 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3576 @cindex expiring mail
3577 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3578 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3579 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3580 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3581
3582 @item C-c C-M-x
3583 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3584 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3585 @cindex expiring mail
3586 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3587 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3588
3589 @end table
3590
3591
3592 @node Browse Foreign Server
3593 @section Browse Foreign Server
3594 @cindex foreign servers
3595 @cindex browsing servers
3596
3597 @table @kbd
3598 @item B
3599 @kindex B (Group)
3600 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3601 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3602 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3603 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3604 @end table
3605
3606 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3607 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3608 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3609 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3610
3611 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3612
3613 @table @kbd
3614 @item n
3615 @kindex n (Browse)
3616 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3617 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3618
3619 @item p
3620 @kindex p (Browse)
3621 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3622 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3623
3624 @item SPACE
3625 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3626 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3627 Enter the current group and display the first article
3628 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3629
3630 @item RET
3631 @kindex RET (Browse)
3632 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3633 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3634
3635 @item u
3636 @kindex u (Browse)
3637 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3638 @vindex gnus-browse-subscribe-newsgroup-method
3639 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3640 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}). You
3641 can affect the way the new group is entered into the Group buffer
3642 using the variable @code{gnus-browse-subscribe-newsgroup-method}. See
3643 @pxref{Subscription Methods} for available options.
3644
3645 @item l
3646 @itemx q
3647 @kindex q (Browse)
3648 @kindex l (Browse)
3649 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3650 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3651
3652 @item d
3653 @kindex d (Browse)
3654 @findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3655 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3656
3657 @item ?
3658 @kindex ? (Browse)
3659 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3660 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3661 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3662
3663 @item DEL
3664 @kindex DEL (Browse)
3665 @findex gnus-browse-delete-group
3666 This function will delete the current group
3667 (@code{gnus-browse-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function
3668 will actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly
3669 remove the group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only
3670 if you are absolutely sure of what you are doing.
3671 @end table
3672
3673
3674 @node Exiting Gnus
3675 @section Exiting Gnus
3676 @cindex exiting Gnus
3677
3678 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3679
3680 @table @kbd
3681 @item z
3682 @kindex z (Group)
3683 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3684 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3685 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3686 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3687
3688 @item q
3689 @kindex q (Group)
3690 @findex gnus-group-exit
3691 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3692 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3693
3694 @item Q
3695 @kindex Q (Group)
3696 @findex gnus-group-quit
3697 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3698 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3699 @end table
3700
3701 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3702 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3703 @vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3704 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3705 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3706 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3707 exiting Gnus.
3708
3709 Note:
3710
3711 @quotation
3712 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3713 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3714 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3715 plastic chair.
3716 @end quotation
3717
3718
3719 @node Group Topics
3720 @section Group Topics
3721 @cindex topics
3722
3723 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3724 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3725 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3726 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3727 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3728 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3729
3730 @iftex
3731 @iflatex
3732 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3733 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3734 }
3735 @end iflatex
3736 @end iftex
3737
3738 Here's an example:
3739
3740 @example
3741 Gnus
3742 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3743 3: comp.emacs
3744 2: alt.religion.emacs
3745 Naughty Emacs
3746 452: alt.sex.emacs
3747 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3748 Misc
3749 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3750 13: comp.sources.unix
3751 @end example
3752
3753 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3754 @kindex t (Group)
3755 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3756 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3757 is a toggling command.)
3758
3759 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3760 dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3761 Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3762 under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3763 Hot and bothered?
3764
3765 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3766 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3767 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3768
3769 @lisp
3770 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3771 @end lisp
3772
3773 @menu
3774 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3775 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3776 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3777 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3778 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3779 @end menu
3780
3781
3782 @node Topic Commands
3783 @subsection Topic Commands
3784 @cindex topic commands
3785
3786 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3787 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3788 definitions slightly.
3789
3790 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3791 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3792 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3793 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3794 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3795 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3796
3797 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3798 the way you like.
3799
3800 @table @kbd
3801
3802 @item T n
3803 @kindex T n (Topic)
3804 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3805 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3806 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3807
3808 @item T TAB
3809 @itemx TAB
3810 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3811 @kindex TAB (Topic)
3812 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3813 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3814 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3815 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3816
3817 @item M-TAB
3818 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3819 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3820 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3821 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3822
3823 @end table
3824
3825 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3826 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3827 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3828 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3829
3830 @table @kbd
3831
3832 @item C-k
3833 @kindex C-k (Topic)
3834 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3835 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3836 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3837
3838 @item C-y
3839 @kindex C-y (Topic)
3840 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3841 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3842 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3843 before all groups.
3844
3845 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3846 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3847 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3848 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3849 paste. Like I said---E-Z.
3850
3851 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3852 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3853
3854 @end table
3855
3856 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3857 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3858 key.
3859
3860 @table @kbd
3861
3862 @item RET
3863 @kindex RET (Topic)
3864 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3865 @itemx SPACE
3866 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3867 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3868 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3869 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3870 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3871 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3872
3873 @end table
3874
3875 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3876
3877 @table @kbd
3878
3879 @item T m
3880 @kindex T m (Topic)
3881 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3882 Move the current group to some other topic
3883 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3884 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3885
3886 @item T j
3887 @kindex T j (Topic)
3888 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3889 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3890
3891 @item T c
3892 @kindex T c (Topic)
3893 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3894 Copy the current group to some other topic
3895 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3896 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3897
3898 @item T h
3899 @kindex T h (Topic)
3900 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3901 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3902 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3903
3904 @item T s
3905 @kindex T s (Topic)
3906 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3907 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3908 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3909
3910 @item T D
3911 @kindex T D (Topic)
3912 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3913 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3914 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3915 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3916 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3917 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3918 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3919 topic.
3920
3921 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3922 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3923
3924 @item T M
3925 @kindex T M (Topic)
3926 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3927 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3928 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3929
3930 @item T C
3931 @kindex T C (Topic)
3932 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3933 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3934 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3935
3936 @item T H
3937 @kindex T H (Topic)
3938 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3939 Toggle hiding empty topics
3940 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3941
3942 @item T #
3943 @kindex T # (Topic)
3944 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3945 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3946 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3947 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3948
3949 @item T M-#
3950 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3951 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3952 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3953 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3954 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3955
3956 @item C-c C-x
3957 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3958 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3959 @cindex expiring mail
3960 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3961 expiry process (if any)
3962 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3963
3964 @item T r
3965 @kindex T r (Topic)
3966 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3967 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3968
3969 @item T DEL
3970 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3971 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3972 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3973
3974 @item A T
3975 @kindex A T (Topic)
3976 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3977 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3978 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3979
3980 @item T M-n
3981 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3982 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3983 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3984
3985 @item T M-p
3986 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3987 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3988 Go to the previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3989
3990 @item G p
3991 @kindex G p (Topic)
3992 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3993 @cindex group parameters
3994 @cindex topic parameters
3995 @cindex parameters
3996 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3997 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3998
3999 @end table
4000
4001
4002 @node Topic Variables
4003 @subsection Topic Variables
4004 @cindex topic variables
4005
4006 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
4007 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
4008
4009 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
4010 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
4011 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4012 Valid elements are:
4013
4014 @table @samp
4015 @item i
4016 Indentation.
4017 @item n
4018 Topic name.
4019 @item v
4020 Visibility.
4021 @item l
4022 Level.
4023 @item g
4024 Number of groups in the topic.
4025 @item a
4026 Number of unread articles in the topic.
4027 @item A
4028 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
4029 @end table
4030
4031 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
4032 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
4033 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
4034 The default is 2.
4035
4036 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
4037 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
4038
4039 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
4040 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
4041 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
4042
4043
4044 @node Topic Sorting
4045 @subsection Topic Sorting
4046 @cindex topic sorting
4047
4048 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
4049 commands:
4050
4051
4052 @table @kbd
4053 @item T S a
4054 @kindex T S a (Topic)
4055 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
4056 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
4057 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
4058
4059 @item T S u
4060 @kindex T S u (Topic)
4061 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
4062 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
4063 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
4064
4065 @item T S l
4066 @kindex T S l (Topic)
4067 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
4068 Sort the current topic by group level
4069 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
4070
4071 @item T S v
4072 @kindex T S v (Topic)
4073 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
4074 Sort the current topic by group score
4075 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
4076
4077 @item T S r
4078 @kindex T S r (Topic)
4079 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
4080 Sort the current topic by group rank
4081 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
4082
4083 @item T S m
4084 @kindex T S m (Topic)
4085 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
4086 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
4087 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
4088
4089 @item T S e
4090 @kindex T S e (Topic)
4091 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
4092 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
4093 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
4094
4095 @item T S s
4096 @kindex T S s (Topic)
4097 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
4098 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
4099 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
4100 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
4101
4102 @end table
4103
4104 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
4105 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
4106 sorting.
4107
4108
4109 @node Topic Topology
4110 @subsection Topic Topology
4111 @cindex topic topology
4112 @cindex topology
4113
4114 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
4115
4116 @example
4117 @group
4118 Gnus
4119 Emacs -- I wuw it!
4120 3: comp.emacs
4121 2: alt.religion.emacs
4122 Naughty Emacs
4123 452: alt.sex.emacs
4124 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4125 Misc
4126 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4127 13: comp.sources.unix
4128 @end group
4129 @end example
4130
4131 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
4132 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
4133 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
4134 follows:
4135
4136 @lisp
4137 (("Gnus" visible)
4138 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
4139 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
4140 (("Misc" visible)))
4141 @end lisp
4142
4143 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
4144 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
4145 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
4146 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
4147 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
4148 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
4149
4150 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
4151 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
4152 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
4153
4154
4155 @node Topic Parameters
4156 @subsection Topic Parameters
4157 @cindex topic parameters
4158
4159 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
4160 (and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
4161 topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
4162 enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
4163 Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
4164
4165 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
4166 parameters:
4167
4168 @table @code
4169 @item subscribe
4170 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
4171 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
4172 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
4173 topic.
4174
4175 @item subscribe-level
4176 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
4177 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
4178 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
4179
4180 @end table
4181
4182 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
4183 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
4184 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
4185 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
4186
4187 @example
4188 @group
4189 Gnus
4190 Emacs
4191 3: comp.emacs
4192 2: alt.religion.emacs
4193 452: alt.sex.emacs
4194 Relief
4195 452: alt.sex.emacs
4196 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4197 Misc
4198 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4199 13: comp.sources.unix
4200 452: alt.sex.emacs
4201 @end group
4202 @end example
4203
4204 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4205 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4206 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4207 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4208 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4209 . "religion.SCORE")}.
4210
4211 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4212 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4213 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4214 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4215 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4216
4217 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4218 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4219 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4220 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4221 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4222 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4223 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4224 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4225
4226
4227 @node Non-ASCII Group Names
4228 @section Accessing groups of non-English names
4229 @cindex non-ascii group names
4230
4231 There are some news servers that provide groups of which the names are
4232 expressed with their native languages in the world. For instance, in a
4233 certain news server there are some newsgroups of which the names are
4234 spelled in Chinese, where people are talking in Chinese. You can, of
4235 course, subscribe to such news groups using Gnus. Currently Gnus
4236 supports non-@acronym{ASCII} group names not only with the @code{nntp}
4237 back end but also with the @code{nnml} back end and the @code{nnrss}
4238 back end.
4239
4240 Every such group name is encoded by a certain charset in the server
4241 side (in an @acronym{NNTP} server its administrator determines the
4242 charset, but for groups in the other back ends it is determined by you).
4243 Gnus has to display the decoded ones for you in the group buffer and the
4244 article buffer, and needs to use the encoded ones when communicating
4245 with servers. However, Gnus doesn't know what charset is used for each
4246 non-@acronym{ASCII} group name. The following two variables are just
4247 the ones for telling Gnus what charset should be used for each group:
4248
4249 @table @code
4250 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4251 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4252 An alist of select methods and charsets. The default value is
4253 @code{nil}. The names of groups in the server specified by that select
4254 method are all supposed to use the corresponding charset. For example:
4255
4256 @lisp
4257 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4258 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4259 @end lisp
4260
4261 Charsets specified for groups with this variable are preferred to the
4262 ones specified for the same groups with the
4263 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} variable (see below).
4264
4265 A select method can be very long, like:
4266
4267 @lisp
4268 (nntp "gmane"
4269 (nntp-address "news.gmane.org")
4270 (nntp-end-of-line "\n")
4271 (nntp-open-connection-function
4272 nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
4273 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
4274 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
4275 ("-C" "-t" "-e" "none"))
4276 (nntp-via-address @dots{}))
4277 @end lisp
4278
4279 In that case, you can truncate it into @code{(nntp "gmane")} in this
4280 variable. That is, it is enough to contain only the back end name and
4281 the server name.
4282
4283 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4284 @cindex UTF-8 group names
4285 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4286 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names.
4287 @code{((".*" . utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported,
4288 otherwise the default is @code{nil}. For example:
4289
4290 @lisp
4291 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4292 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)
4293 (".*" . utf-8)))
4294 @end lisp
4295
4296 Note that this variable is ignored if the match is made with
4297 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist}.
4298 @end table
4299
4300 Those two variables are used also to determine the charset for encoding
4301 and decoding non-@acronym{ASCII} group names that are in the back ends
4302 other than @code{nntp}. It means that it is you who determine it. If
4303 you do nothing, the charset used for group names in those back ends will
4304 all be @code{utf-8} because of the last element of
4305 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4306
4307 There is one more important variable for non-@acronym{ASCII} group
4308 names:
4309
4310 @table @code
4311 @item nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4312 @vindex nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4313 The value of this variable should be a coding system or @code{nil}. The
4314 default is @code{nil} in Emacs, or is the aliasee of the coding system
4315 named @code{file-name} (a certain coding system of which an alias is
4316 @code{file-name}) in XEmacs.
4317
4318 The @code{nnml} back end, the @code{nnrss} back end, the agent, and
4319 the cache use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names in those files and
4320 directories. This variable overrides the value of
4321 @code{file-name-coding-system} which specifies the coding system used
4322 when encoding and decoding those file names and directory names.
4323
4324 In XEmacs (with the @code{mule} feature), @code{file-name-coding-system}
4325 is the only means to specify the coding system used to encode and decode
4326 file names. On the other hand, Emacs uses the value of
4327 @code{default-file-name-coding-system} if @code{file-name-coding-system}
4328 is @code{nil} or it is bound to the value of
4329 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} which is @code{nil}.
4330
4331 Normally the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system} in Emacs or
4332 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} in XEmacs is initialized according
4333 to the locale, so you will need to do nothing if the value is suitable
4334 to encode and decode non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4335
4336 The value of this variable (or @code{default-file-name-coding-system})
4337 does not necessarily need to be the same value that is determined by
4338 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} and
4339 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4340
4341 If @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable is
4342 initialized by default to @code{iso-latin-1} for example, although you
4343 want to subscribe to the groups spelled in Chinese, that is the most
4344 typical case where you have to customize
4345 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}. The @code{utf-8} coding system is
4346 a good candidate for it. Otherwise, you may change the locale in your
4347 system so that @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable
4348 may be initialized to an appropriate value.
4349 @end table
4350
4351 Note that when you copy or move articles from a non-@acronym{ASCII}
4352 group to another group, the charset used to encode and decode group
4353 names should be the same in both groups. Otherwise the Newsgroups
4354 header will be displayed incorrectly in the article buffer.
4355
4356
4357 @node Misc Group Stuff
4358 @section Misc Group Stuff
4359
4360 @menu
4361 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4362 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4363 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4364 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4365 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
4366 @end menu
4367
4368 @table @kbd
4369
4370 @item v
4371 @kindex v (Group)
4372 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Group)
4373 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4374 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4375
4376 @lisp
4377 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map (kbd "v j d")
4378 (lambda ()
4379 (interactive)
4380 (gnus-group-jump-to-group "nndraft:drafts")))
4381 @end lisp
4382
4383 On keys reserved for users in Emacs and on keybindings in general
4384 @xref{Keymaps, Keymaps, , emacs, The Emacs Editor}.
4385
4386 @item ^
4387 @kindex ^ (Group)
4388 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4389 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4390 @xref{Server Buffer}.
4391
4392 @item a
4393 @kindex a (Group)
4394 @findex gnus-group-post-news
4395 Start composing a message (a news by default)
4396 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4397 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4398 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4399 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4400 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4401
4402 @item m
4403 @kindex m (Group)
4404 @findex gnus-group-mail
4405 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4406 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4407 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4408 @xref{Composing Messages}.
4409
4410 @item i
4411 @kindex i (Group)
4412 @findex gnus-group-news
4413 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4414 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4415 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4416
4417 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4418 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4419 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4420 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4421 for this to work though.
4422
4423 @item G z
4424 @kindex G z (Group)
4425 @findex gnus-group-compact-group
4426
4427 Compact the group under point (@code{gnus-group-compact-group}).
4428 Currently implemented only in nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes
4429 gaps between article numbers, hence getting a correct total article
4430 count.
4431
4432 @end table
4433
4434 Variables for the group buffer:
4435
4436 @table @code
4437
4438 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
4439 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4440 is called after the group buffer has been
4441 created.
4442
4443 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4444 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4445 is called after the group buffer is
4446 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4447 unnatural way.
4448
4449 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4450 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4451 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4452 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
4453
4454 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4455 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4456 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4457 whether they are empty or not.
4458
4459 @end table
4460
4461 @node Scanning New Messages
4462 @subsection Scanning New Messages
4463 @cindex new messages
4464 @cindex scanning new news
4465
4466 @table @kbd
4467
4468 @item g
4469 @kindex g (Group)
4470 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4471 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4472 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4473 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4474 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4475 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4476 back end(s).
4477
4478 @item M-g
4479 @kindex M-g (Group)
4480 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4481 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4482 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4483 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4484 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4485 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4486 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4487
4488 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4489 @cindex activating groups
4490 @item C-c M-g
4491 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4492 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4493
4494 @item R
4495 @kindex R (Group)
4496 @cindex restarting
4497 @findex gnus-group-restart
4498 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4499 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4500 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
4501
4502 @end table
4503
4504 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4505 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4506
4507 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4508 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4509 news.
4510
4511
4512 @node Group Information
4513 @subsection Group Information
4514 @cindex group information
4515 @cindex information on groups
4516
4517 @table @kbd
4518
4519
4520 @item H d
4521 @itemx C-c C-d
4522 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4523 @kindex H d (Group)
4524 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4525 @cindex describing groups
4526 @cindex group description
4527 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
4528 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4529 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4530
4531 @item M-d
4532 @kindex M-d (Group)
4533 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4534 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4535 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4536
4537 @item H v
4538 @itemx V
4539 @kindex V (Group)
4540 @kindex H v (Group)
4541 @cindex version
4542 @findex gnus-version
4543 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4544
4545 @item ?
4546 @kindex ? (Group)
4547 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4548 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4549
4550 @item C-c C-i
4551 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4552 @cindex info
4553 @cindex manual
4554 @findex gnus-info-find-node
4555 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4556 @end table
4557
4558
4559 @node Group Timestamp
4560 @subsection Group Timestamp
4561 @cindex timestamps
4562 @cindex group timestamps
4563
4564 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4565 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4566 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4567
4568 @lisp
4569 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4570 @end lisp
4571
4572 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4573
4574 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4575 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4576
4577 @lisp
4578 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4579 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4580 @end lisp
4581
4582 This will result in lines looking like:
4583
4584 @example
4585 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4586 0: custom 19961002T012713
4587 @end example
4588
4589 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4590 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4591 something like:
4592
4593 @lisp
4594 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4595 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4596 @end lisp
4597
4598 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4599 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4600 trick:
4601
4602 @lisp
4603 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4604 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4605 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4606 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4607 (if time
4608 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4609 "")))
4610 @end lisp
4611
4612 To see what variables are dynamically bound (like
4613 @code{gnus-tmp-group}), you have to look at the source code. The
4614 variable names aren't guaranteed to be stable over Gnus versions,
4615 either.
4616
4617
4618 @node File Commands
4619 @subsection File Commands
4620 @cindex file commands
4621
4622 @table @kbd
4623
4624 @item r
4625 @kindex r (Group)
4626 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4627 @vindex gnus-init-file
4628 @cindex reading init file
4629 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4630 @file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4631
4632 @item s
4633 @kindex s (Group)
4634 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4635 @cindex saving .newsrc
4636 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4637 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4638 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4639
4640 @c @item Z
4641 @c @kindex Z (Group)
4642 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4643 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4644
4645 @end table
4646
4647
4648 @node Sieve Commands
4649 @subsection Sieve Commands
4650 @cindex group sieve commands
4651
4652 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4653 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4654 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4655 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4656 script that can be transferred to the server somehow.
4657
4658 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4659 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4660 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4661 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4662 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4663 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4664 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4665 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4666 regenerate the Sieve script.
4667
4668 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4669 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4670 is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4671 placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4672 is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4673 example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4674 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4675 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4676 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4677 except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4678
4679 @example
4680 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4681 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4682 stop;
4683 @}
4684 @end example
4685
4686 @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4687
4688 @table @kbd
4689
4690 @item D g
4691 @kindex D g (Group)
4692 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
4693 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4694 @cindex generating sieve script
4695 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4696 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4697
4698 @item D u
4699 @kindex D u (Group)
4700 @findex gnus-sieve-update
4701 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4702 @cindex updating sieve script
4703 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4704 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4705 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4706
4707 @end table
4708
4709
4710 @node Summary Buffer
4711 @chapter Summary Buffer
4712 @cindex summary buffer
4713
4714 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4715 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4716
4717 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4718 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4719
4720 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4721
4722 You can customize the Summary Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
4723 customize-apropos RET gnus-summary-tool-bar}. This feature is only
4724 available in Emacs.
4725
4726 @kindex v (Summary)
4727 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Summary)
4728 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4729 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4730 @lisp
4731 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map (kbd "v -") "LrS") ;; lower subthread
4732 @end lisp
4733
4734 @menu
4735 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4736 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4737 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4738 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4739 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4740 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4741 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4742 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4743 * Threading:: How threads are made.
4744 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4745 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4746 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4747 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4748 * Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
4749 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4750 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4751 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4752 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4753 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4754 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
4755 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4756 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4757 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4758 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4759 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4760 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4761 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4762 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4763 or reselecting the current group.
4764 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4765 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4766 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4767 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4768 @end menu
4769
4770
4771 @node Summary Buffer Format
4772 @section Summary Buffer Format
4773 @cindex summary buffer format
4774
4775 @iftex
4776 @iflatex
4777 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4778 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4779 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4780 }
4781 @end iflatex
4782 @end iftex
4783
4784 @menu
4785 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4786 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4787 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4788 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4789 @end menu
4790
4791 @findex mail-extract-address-components
4792 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
4793 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4794 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4795 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4796 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4797 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4798 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4799 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4800 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4801 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
4802
4803 @lisp
4804 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
4805 'mail-extract-address-components)
4806 @end lisp
4807
4808 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4809 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4810 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4811 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4812
4813
4814 @node Summary Buffer Lines
4815 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4816
4817 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4818 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4819 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4820 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4821 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4822
4823 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4824 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4825 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4826 possible to change this. Just write a new function
4827 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4828 @xref{Positioning Point}.
4829
4830 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4831
4832 The following format specification characters and extended format
4833 specification(s) are understood:
4834
4835 @table @samp
4836 @item N
4837 Article number.
4838 @item S
4839 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4840 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4841 @item s
4842 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4843 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4844 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4845 @item F
4846 Full @code{From} header.
4847 @item n
4848 The name (from the @code{From} header).
4849 @item f
4850 The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4851 From Newsgroups}).
4852 @item a
4853 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4854 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4855 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4856 may be more thorough.
4857 @item A
4858 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4859 the @code{a} spec.
4860 @item L
4861 Number of lines in the article.
4862 @item c
4863 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4864 in some methods (like nnfolder).
4865 @item k
4866 Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4867 for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4868 @item I
4869 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4870 @item B
4871 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4872 lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
4873
4874 @example
4875 >
4876 +->
4877 | +->
4878 | | \->
4879 | | \->
4880 | \->
4881 +->
4882 \->
4883 @end example
4884
4885 You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4886 that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4887 replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4888 line-drawing glyphs.
4889 @table @code
4890 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4891 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4892 Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4893 instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4894
4895 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4896 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4897 Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4898 @code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4899
4900 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4901 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4902 Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4903 instead. The default is @samp{}.
4904
4905 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4906 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4907 Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
4908
4909 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4910 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4911 Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
4912
4913 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4914 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4915 Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
4916
4917 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4918 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4919 Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
4920
4921 @end table
4922
4923 @item T
4924 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4925 pushes everything after it off the screen).
4926 @item [
4927 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4928 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4929 @item ]
4930 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4931 for adopted articles.
4932 @item >
4933 One space for each thread level.
4934 @item <
4935 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4936 @item U
4937 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4938
4939 @item R
4940 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4941 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4942 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4943
4944 @item i
4945 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4946 @item z
4947 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4948 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4949 default level. If the difference between
4950 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4951 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4952 @item V
4953 Total thread score.
4954 @item x
4955 @code{Xref}.
4956 @item D
4957 @code{Date}.
4958 @item d
4959 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4960 @item o
4961 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4962 @item M
4963 @code{Message-ID}.
4964 @item r
4965 @code{References}.
4966 @item t
4967 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4968 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4969 @item e
4970 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4971 article has any children.
4972 @item P
4973 The line number.
4974 @item O
4975 Download mark.
4976 @item *
4977 Desired cursor position (instead of after first colon).
4978 @item &user-date;
4979 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4980 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4981 @item u
4982 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4983 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4984 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4985 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4986 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4987 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4988 @end table
4989
4990 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4991 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4992 There can only be one such area.
4993
4994 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4995 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4996 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4997 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4998 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4999 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
5000
5001 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
5002 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
5003
5004 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
5005
5006
5007 @node To From Newsgroups
5008 @subsection To From Newsgroups
5009 @cindex To
5010 @cindex Newsgroups
5011
5012 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
5013 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
5014 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
5015 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
5016 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
5017
5018 @enumerate
5019 @item
5020 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
5021 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
5022 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
5023 instance:
5024
5025 @lisp
5026 (setq gnus-extra-headers
5027 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
5028 @end lisp
5029
5030 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
5031 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
5032
5033 @item
5034 @findex gnus-extra-header
5035 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
5036 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
5037 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
5038
5039 @example
5040 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
5041 @end example
5042
5043 @item
5044 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5045 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the
5046 @samp{%f} summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader}
5047 or @code{From} header. The variable may be a regexp or a predicate
5048 function. If this matches the contents of the @code{From}
5049 header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader} headers are
5050 used instead.
5051
5052 To distinguish regular articles from those where the @code{From} field
5053 has been swapped, a string is prefixed to the @code{To} or
5054 @code{Newsgroups} header in the summary line. By default the string is
5055 @samp{-> } for @code{To} and @samp{=> } for @code{Newsgroups}, you can
5056 customize these strings with @code{gnus-summary-to-prefix} and
5057 @code{gnus-summary-newsgroup-prefix}.
5058
5059 @end enumerate
5060
5061 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
5062 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
5063 to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
5064 If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
5065 changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
5066 and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g., nnml) to cause
5067 regeneration.
5068
5069 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
5070 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
5071 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
5072 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
5073
5074 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
5075 @file{~/.gnus.el}:
5076
5077 @lisp
5078 (setq gnus-extra-headers
5079 '(To Newsgroups))
5080 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
5081 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
5082 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
5083 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5084 "Your Name Here")
5085 @end lisp
5086
5087 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
5088 to fit your needs.)
5089
5090 A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
5091 convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
5092 support:
5093
5094 The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
5095 the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
5096 nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
5097
5098 @example
5099 Newsgroups:full
5100 @end example
5101
5102 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
5103 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
5104
5105
5106 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
5107 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
5108
5109 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
5110 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
5111 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
5112 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
5113
5114 Here are the elements you can play with:
5115
5116 @table @samp
5117 @item G
5118 Group name.
5119 @item p
5120 Unprefixed group name.
5121 @item A
5122 Current article number.
5123 @item z
5124 Current article score.
5125 @item V
5126 Gnus version.
5127 @item U
5128 Number of unread articles in this group.
5129 @item e
5130 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
5131 summary buffer.
5132 @item Z
5133 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
5134 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
5135 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
5136 and no unselected ones.
5137 @item g
5138 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
5139 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
5140 @item S
5141 Subject of the current article.
5142 @item u
5143 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
5144 @item s
5145 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
5146 @item d
5147 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5148 @item t
5149 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5150 @item r
5151 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
5152 @item E
5153 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
5154 @end table
5155
5156
5157 @node Summary Highlighting
5158 @subsection Summary Highlighting
5159
5160 @table @code
5161
5162 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5163 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5164 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
5165 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
5166 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5167
5168 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
5169 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
5170 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
5171 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5172
5173 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
5174 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
5175 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
5176 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
5177
5178 @item gnus-summary-highlight
5179 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
5180 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
5181 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
5182 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
5183 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
5184 to something like
5185 @lisp
5186 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
5187 ((> score default) . bold))
5188 @end lisp
5189 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
5190 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
5191 @end table
5192
5193
5194 @node Summary Maneuvering
5195 @section Summary Maneuvering
5196 @cindex summary movement
5197
5198 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
5199 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
5200
5201 None of these commands select articles.
5202
5203 @table @kbd
5204 @item G M-n
5205 @itemx M-n
5206 @kindex M-n (Summary)
5207 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
5208 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
5209 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
5210 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
5211
5212 @item G M-p
5213 @itemx M-p
5214 @kindex M-p (Summary)
5215 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
5216 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
5217 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
5218 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
5219
5220 @item G g
5221 @kindex G g (Summary)
5222 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
5223 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
5224 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
5225 @end table
5226
5227 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
5228 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
5229 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
5230 to the group buffer.
5231
5232 Variables related to summary movement:
5233
5234 @table @code
5235
5236 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
5237 @item gnus-auto-select-next
5238 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
5239 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
5240 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
5241 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
5242 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
5243 next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
5244 is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
5245 confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
5246 will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
5247 Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
5248 command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
5249 @pxref{Group Levels}.
5250
5251 @item gnus-auto-select-same
5252 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
5253 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
5254 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
5255 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
5256 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
5257 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
5258
5259 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
5260
5261 @item gnus-summary-check-current
5262 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
5263 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
5264 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
5265 Instead, they will choose the current article.
5266
5267 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
5268 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
5269 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
5270 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
5271 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
5272 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
5273 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
5274 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
5275 threads.
5276
5277 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
5278 the given number of lines from the top.
5279
5280 @item gnus-summary-stop-at-end-of-message
5281 @vindex gnus-summary-stop-at-end-of-message
5282 If non-@code{nil}, don't go to the next article when hitting
5283 @kbd{SPC}, and you're at the end of the article.
5284
5285 @end table
5286
5287
5288 @node Choosing Articles
5289 @section Choosing Articles
5290 @cindex selecting articles
5291
5292 @menu
5293 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
5294 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
5295 @end menu
5296
5297
5298 @node Choosing Commands
5299 @subsection Choosing Commands
5300
5301 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
5302 and they all select and display an article.
5303
5304 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
5305 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
5306
5307 @table @kbd
5308 @item SPACE
5309 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5310 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5311 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
5312 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5313
5314 If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
5315 again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
5316 @kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
5317
5318 @item G n
5319 @itemx n
5320 @kindex n (Summary)
5321 @kindex G n (Summary)
5322 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
5323 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
5324 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
5325
5326 @item G p
5327 @itemx p
5328 @kindex p (Summary)
5329 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5330 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5331 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
5332
5333 @item G N
5334 @itemx N
5335 @kindex N (Summary)
5336 @kindex G N (Summary)
5337 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
5338 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
5339
5340 @item G P
5341 @itemx P
5342 @kindex P (Summary)
5343 @kindex G P (Summary)
5344 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5345 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
5346
5347 @item G C-n
5348 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
5349 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5350 Go to the next article with the same subject
5351 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
5352
5353 @item G C-p
5354 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
5355 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5356 Go to the previous article with the same subject
5357 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
5358
5359 @item G f
5360 @itemx .
5361 @kindex G f (Summary)
5362 @kindex . (Summary)
5363 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5364 Go to the first unread article
5365 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
5366
5367 @item G b
5368 @itemx ,
5369 @kindex G b (Summary)
5370 @kindex , (Summary)
5371 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5372 Go to the unread article with the highest score
5373 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5374 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
5375
5376 @item G l
5377 @itemx l
5378 @kindex l (Summary)
5379 @kindex G l (Summary)
5380 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5381 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
5382
5383 @item G o
5384 @kindex G o (Summary)
5385 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5386 @cindex history
5387 @cindex article history
5388 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5389 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5390 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5391 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5392 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5393 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
5394
5395 @item G j
5396 @itemx j
5397 @kindex j (Summary)
5398 @kindex G j (Summary)
5399 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5400 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5401 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
5402
5403 @end table
5404
5405
5406 @node Choosing Variables
5407 @subsection Choosing Variables
5408
5409 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
5410
5411 @table @code
5412 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5413 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5414 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5415 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5416 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5417 the server and display it in the article buffer.
5418
5419 @item gnus-select-article-hook
5420 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5421 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
5422 @code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
5423 you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
5424 hook will do so.
5425
5426 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
5427 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5428 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5429 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5430 @findex gnus-unread-mark
5431 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5432 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5433 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5434 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
5435 articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5436 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5437 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5438 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5439 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
5440
5441 @end table
5442
5443
5444 @node Paging the Article
5445 @section Scrolling the Article
5446 @cindex article scrolling
5447
5448 @table @kbd
5449
5450 @item SPACE
5451 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5452 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5453 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5454 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5455 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5456
5457 @vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5458 @vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5459 If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5460 the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5461 skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5462 what is considered uninteresting with
5463 @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5464 pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
5465
5466 @item DEL
5467 @kindex DEL (Summary)
5468 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5469 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
5470
5471 @item RET
5472 @kindex RET (Summary)
5473 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5474 Scroll the current article one line forward
5475 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
5476
5477 @item M-RET
5478 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
5479 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5480 Scroll the current article one line backward
5481 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
5482
5483 @item A g
5484 @itemx g
5485 @kindex A g (Summary)
5486 @kindex g (Summary)
5487 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
5488 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5489 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5490 given a prefix, show a completely ``raw'' article, just the way it
5491 came from the server. If given a prefix twice (i.e., @kbd{C-u C-u
5492 g'}), fetch the current article, but don't run any of the article
5493 treatment functions.
5494
5495 @cindex charset, view article with different charset
5496 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5497 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5498 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
5499
5500 @lisp
5501 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5502 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
5503 (2 . big5)))
5504 @end lisp
5505
5506 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
5507
5508 @item A <
5509 @itemx <
5510 @kindex < (Summary)
5511 @kindex A < (Summary)
5512 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5513 Scroll to the beginning of the article
5514 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
5515
5516 @item A >
5517 @itemx >
5518 @kindex > (Summary)
5519 @kindex A > (Summary)
5520 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5521 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
5522
5523 @item A s
5524 @itemx s
5525 @kindex A s (Summary)
5526 @kindex s (Summary)
5527 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5528 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5529 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
5530
5531 @item h
5532 @kindex h (Summary)
5533 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5534 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5535
5536 @end table
5537
5538
5539 @node Reply Followup and Post
5540 @section Reply, Followup and Post
5541
5542 @menu
5543 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5544 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5545 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5546 * Canceling and Superseding::
5547 @end menu
5548
5549
5550 @node Summary Mail Commands
5551 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
5552 @cindex mail
5553 @cindex composing mail
5554
5555 Commands for composing a mail message:
5556
5557 @table @kbd
5558
5559 @item S r
5560 @itemx r
5561 @kindex S r (Summary)
5562 @kindex r (Summary)
5563 @findex gnus-summary-reply
5564 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5565 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5566 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5567 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5568
5569 @item S R
5570 @itemx R
5571 @kindex R (Summary)
5572 @kindex S R (Summary)
5573 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5574 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5575 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5576 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5577 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5578
5579 @item S w
5580 @kindex S w (Summary)
5581 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5582 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5583 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5584 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5585 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5586 present, that's used instead.
5587
5588 @item S W
5589 @kindex S W (Summary)
5590 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5591 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5592 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5593 the process/prefix convention, but only uses the headers from the
5594 first article to determine the recipients.
5595
5596 @item S L
5597 @kindex S L (Summary)
5598 @findex gnus-summary-reply-to-list-with-original
5599 When replying to a message from a mailing list, send a reply to that
5600 message to the mailing list, and include the original message
5601 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-to-list-with-original}).
5602
5603 @item S v
5604 @kindex S v (Summary)
5605 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5606 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5607 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5608 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5609 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5610 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5611
5612 @item S V
5613 @kindex S V (Summary)
5614 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5615 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5616 original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5617 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5618
5619 @item S B r
5620 @kindex S B r (Summary)
5621 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5622 Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5623 @code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5624 If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5625 @code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5626 the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5627 correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5628
5629 @item S B R
5630 @kindex S B R (Summary)
5631 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5632 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5633 original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5634 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5635
5636 @item S o m
5637 @itemx C-c C-f
5638 @kindex S o m (Summary)
5639 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5640 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5641 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5642 Forward the current article to some other person
5643 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5644 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5645 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5646 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5647 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5648 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5649 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5650 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5651 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5652 section.
5653
5654 @item S m
5655 @itemx m
5656 @kindex m (Summary)
5657 @kindex S m (Summary)
5658 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5659 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5660 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5661 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5662 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5663
5664 @item S i
5665 @kindex S i (Summary)
5666 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5667 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5668 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5669 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5670
5671 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5672 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5673 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5674 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5675 for this to work though.
5676
5677 @item S D b
5678 @kindex S D b (Summary)
5679 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5680 @cindex bouncing mail
5681 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5682 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5683 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5684 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5685 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5686 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5687 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5688 very well fail, though.
5689
5690 @item S D r
5691 @kindex S D r (Summary)
5692 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5693 Not to be confused with the previous command,
5694 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5695 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5696 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5697 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5698 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5699 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5700 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5701
5702 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5703 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5704 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5705 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5706 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5707
5708 This command understands the process/prefix convention
5709 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5710
5711 @item S D e
5712 @kindex S D e (Summary)
5713 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5714
5715 Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5716 if it were a new message before resending.
5717
5718 @item S O m
5719 @kindex S O m (Summary)
5720 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5721 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5722 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5723 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5724
5725 @item S M-c
5726 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
5727 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5728 @cindex crossposting
5729 @cindex excessive crossposting
5730 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5731 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5732
5733 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5734 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5735 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5736 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5737 command understands the process/prefix convention
5738 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5739
5740 @end table
5741
5742 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5743 Manual}, for more information.
5744
5745
5746 @node Summary Post Commands
5747 @subsection Summary Post Commands
5748 @cindex post
5749 @cindex composing news
5750
5751 Commands for posting a news article:
5752
5753 @table @kbd
5754 @item S p
5755 @itemx a
5756 @kindex a (Summary)
5757 @kindex S p (Summary)
5758 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
5759 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5760 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5761 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5762 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5763
5764 @item S f
5765 @itemx f
5766 @kindex f (Summary)
5767 @kindex S f (Summary)
5768 @findex gnus-summary-followup
5769 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5770 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5771
5772 @item S F
5773 @itemx F
5774 @kindex S F (Summary)
5775 @kindex F (Summary)
5776 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5777 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5778 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5779 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5780 process/prefix convention.
5781
5782 @item S n
5783 @kindex S n (Summary)
5784 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5785 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5786 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5787
5788 @item S N
5789 @kindex S N (Summary)
5790 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5791 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5792 message through mail and include the original message
5793 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5794 the process/prefix convention.
5795
5796 @item S o p
5797 @kindex S o p (Summary)
5798 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5799 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5800 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5801 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5802 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5803 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5804 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5805 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5806 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5807 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5808 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5809 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
5810
5811 @item S O p
5812 @kindex S O p (Summary)
5813 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5814 @cindex digests
5815 @cindex making digests
5816 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5817 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
5818 process/prefix convention.
5819
5820 @item S u
5821 @kindex S u (Summary)
5822 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
5823 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5824 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5825 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5826 @end table
5827
5828 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5829 Manual}, for more information.
5830
5831
5832 @node Summary Message Commands
5833 @subsection Summary Message Commands
5834
5835 @table @kbd
5836 @item S y
5837 @kindex S y (Summary)
5838 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5839 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5840 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5841 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5842 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5843
5844 @end table
5845
5846
5847 @node Canceling and Superseding
5848 @subsection Canceling Articles
5849 @cindex canceling articles
5850 @cindex superseding articles
5851
5852 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5853 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5854
5855 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5856
5857 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5858 @kindex C (Summary)
5859 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5860 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5861 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5862 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5863 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5864 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5865
5866 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5867 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5868 question.
5869
5870 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5871 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5872 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5873
5874 Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5875 @code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5876 message, Message Manual}).
5877
5878 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5879 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5880 your original article.
5881
5882 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5883 @kindex S (Summary)
5884 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5885 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5886 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5887 usual way.
5888
5889 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5890 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5891 have posted almost the same article twice.
5892
5893 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5894 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5895 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5896 to the post buffer (which is called @file{*sent ...*}). There you will
5897 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5898 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5899 header by substituting one of those words for the word
5900 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5901 you would do normally. The previous article will be
5902 canceled/superseded.
5903
5904 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5905
5906 @node Delayed Articles
5907 @section Delayed Articles
5908 @cindex delayed sending
5909 @cindex send delayed
5910
5911 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5912 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5913 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5914 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5915
5916 @lisp
5917 (gnus-delay-initialize)
5918 @end lisp
5919
5920 @findex gnus-delay-article
5921 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5922 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5923 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5924 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5925
5926 @itemize @bullet
5927 @item
5928 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5929 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5930 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5931 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
5932
5933 @item
5934 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5935 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5936 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5937
5938 @item
5939 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5940 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5941 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5942 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5943 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5944 that means a time tomorrow.
5945 @end itemize
5946
5947 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5948 couple of variables:
5949
5950 @table @code
5951 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
5952 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5953 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5954 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5955
5956 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
5957 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5958 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5959 formats described above.
5960
5961 @item gnus-delay-group
5962 @vindex gnus-delay-group
5963 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5964 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5965 value is @code{"delayed"}.
5966
5967 @item gnus-delay-header
5968 @vindex gnus-delay-header
5969 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5970 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5971 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5972 @end table
5973
5974 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5975 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5976 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5977 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5978 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5979
5980 @findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5981 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5982 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5983 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5984 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5985 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5986 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5987
5988 @table @code
5989 @item gnus-delay-initialize
5990 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
5991 By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5992 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5993 argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5994 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5995 argument is ignored.
5996
5997 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5998 Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5999 Just don't forget to set that up :-)
6000 @end table
6001
6002 When delaying an article with @kbd{C-c C-j}, Message mode will
6003 automatically add a @code{"Date"} header with the current time. In
6004 many cases you probably want the @code{"Date"} header to reflect the
6005 time the message is sent instead. To do this, you have to delete
6006 @code{Date} from @code{message-draft-headers}.
6007
6008
6009 @node Marking Articles
6010 @section Marking Articles
6011 @cindex article marking
6012 @cindex article ticking
6013 @cindex marks
6014
6015 There are several marks you can set on an article.
6016
6017 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
6018 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
6019 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
6020
6021 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
6022
6023 @ifinfo
6024 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
6025 @end ifinfo
6026
6027 @menu
6028 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
6029 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
6030 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
6031 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
6032 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
6033 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
6034 @end menu
6035
6036
6037 @node Unread Articles
6038 @subsection Unread Articles
6039
6040 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
6041 other.
6042
6043 @table @samp
6044 @item !
6045 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
6046 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
6047
6048 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
6049 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
6050 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
6051 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
6052 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
6053 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
6054 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
6055
6056 @item ?
6057 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
6058 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
6059
6060 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
6061 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
6062 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
6063 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
6064 messages.
6065
6066 @item SPACE
6067 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
6068 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
6069
6070 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
6071 @end table
6072
6073
6074 @node Read Articles
6075 @subsection Read Articles
6076 @cindex expirable mark
6077
6078 All the following marks mark articles as read.
6079
6080 @table @samp
6081
6082 @item r
6083 @vindex gnus-del-mark
6084 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
6085 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
6086
6087 @item R
6088 @vindex gnus-read-mark
6089 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
6090
6091 @item O
6092 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
6093 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
6094 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
6095
6096 @item K
6097 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
6098 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
6099
6100 @item X
6101 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
6102 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
6103
6104 @item Y
6105 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
6106 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
6107
6108 @item C
6109 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
6110 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
6111
6112 @item G
6113 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
6114 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
6115
6116 @item Q
6117 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
6118 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
6119 Threading}.
6120
6121 @item M
6122 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
6123 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
6124 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
6125
6126 @end table
6127
6128 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
6129 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
6130
6131 One more special mark, though:
6132
6133 @table @samp
6134 @item E
6135 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
6136 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
6137
6138 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
6139 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
6140 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
6141 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
6142 any time.
6143 @end table
6144
6145
6146 @node Other Marks
6147 @subsection Other Marks
6148 @cindex process mark
6149 @cindex bookmarks
6150
6151 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
6152 read or not.
6153
6154 @itemize @bullet
6155
6156 @item
6157 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
6158 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
6159 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
6160 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
6161 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
6162
6163 @item
6164 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
6165 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
6166 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
6167 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
6168
6169 @item
6170 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
6171 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
6172 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
6173
6174 @item
6175 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
6176 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
6177 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6178
6179 @item
6180 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
6181 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
6182 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
6183 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
6184
6185 @item
6186 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
6187 Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
6188 with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
6189
6190 @item
6191 @vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
6192 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
6193 downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
6194 @samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
6195 (The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
6196 use.)
6197
6198 @item
6199 @vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
6200 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
6201 not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
6202 are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
6203 articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
6204 @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
6205
6206 @item
6207 @vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
6208 The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
6209 automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
6210 download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
6211 explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
6212 (The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
6213 use.)
6214
6215 @item
6216 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
6217 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
6218 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
6219 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
6220 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
6221
6222 @item
6223 @vindex gnus-process-mark
6224 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
6225 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
6226 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
6227 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
6228 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
6229
6230 @end itemize
6231
6232 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
6233 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
6234 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
6235
6236 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
6237 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
6238 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
6239
6240
6241 @node Setting Marks
6242 @subsection Setting Marks
6243 @cindex setting marks
6244
6245 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
6246
6247 @table @kbd
6248 @item M c
6249 @itemx M-u
6250 @kindex M c (Summary)
6251 @kindex M-u (Summary)
6252 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
6253 @cindex mark as unread
6254 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
6255 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
6256 article as unread.
6257
6258 @item M t
6259 @itemx !
6260 @kindex ! (Summary)
6261 @kindex M t (Summary)
6262 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
6263 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
6264 @xref{Article Caching}.
6265
6266 @item M ?
6267 @itemx ?
6268 @kindex ? (Summary)
6269 @kindex M ? (Summary)
6270 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
6271 Mark the current article as dormant
6272 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6273
6274 @item M d
6275 @itemx d
6276 @kindex M d (Summary)
6277 @kindex d (Summary)
6278 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
6279 Mark the current article as read
6280 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
6281
6282 @item D
6283 @kindex D (Summary)
6284 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
6285 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
6286 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
6287
6288 @item M k
6289 @itemx k
6290 @kindex k (Summary)
6291 @kindex M k (Summary)
6292 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
6293 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
6294 and then select the next unread article
6295 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
6296
6297 @item M K
6298 @itemx C-k
6299 @kindex M K (Summary)
6300 @kindex C-k (Summary)
6301 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
6302 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
6303 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
6304
6305 @item M C
6306 @kindex M C (Summary)
6307 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
6308 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
6309 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
6310
6311 @item M C-c
6312 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
6313 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
6314 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
6315 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
6316
6317 @item M H
6318 @kindex M H (Summary)
6319 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
6320 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
6321 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
6322
6323 @item M h
6324 @kindex M h (Summary)
6325 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
6326 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
6327 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
6328
6329 @item C-w
6330 @kindex C-w (Summary)
6331 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6332 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6333 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
6334
6335 @item M V k
6336 @kindex M V k (Summary)
6337 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6338 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6339 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
6340
6341 @item M e
6342 @itemx E
6343 @kindex M e (Summary)
6344 @kindex E (Summary)
6345 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6346 Mark the current article as expirable
6347 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
6348
6349 @item M b
6350 @kindex M b (Summary)
6351 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6352 Set a bookmark in the current article
6353 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
6354
6355 @item M B
6356 @kindex M B (Summary)
6357 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6358 Remove the bookmark from the current article
6359 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
6360
6361 @item M V c
6362 @kindex M V c (Summary)
6363 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6364 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6365 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6366
6367 @item M V u
6368 @kindex M V u (Summary)
6369 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6370 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6371 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
6372
6373 @item M V m
6374 @kindex M V m (Summary)
6375 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6376 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6377 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6378 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6379 @end table
6380
6381 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6382 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6383 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6384 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6385 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6386 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6387 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6388 The default is @code{t}.
6389
6390
6391 @node Generic Marking Commands
6392 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
6393
6394 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) to
6395 go to the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6396 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article.
6397 And even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
6398 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6399 well.
6400
6401 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6402 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6403 command should do.
6404
6405 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6406 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6407 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6408 to list in this manual.
6409
6410 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6411 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6412 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6413 article, you could say something like:
6414
6415 @lisp
6416 @group
6417 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6418 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6419 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6420 @end group
6421 @end lisp
6422
6423 @noindent
6424 or
6425
6426 @lisp
6427 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6428 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6429 @end lisp
6430
6431
6432 @node Setting Process Marks
6433 @subsection Setting Process Marks
6434 @cindex setting process marks
6435
6436 Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6437 used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6438 process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6439 articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6440 articles into the cache. For more information,
6441 @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
6442
6443 @table @kbd
6444
6445 @item M P p
6446 @itemx #
6447 @kindex # (Summary)
6448 @kindex M P p (Summary)
6449 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6450 Mark the current article with the process mark
6451 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6452 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
6453
6454 @item M P u
6455 @itemx M-#
6456 @kindex M P u (Summary)
6457 @kindex M-# (Summary)
6458 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6459 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
6460
6461 @item M P U
6462 @kindex M P U (Summary)
6463 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6464 Remove the process mark from all articles
6465 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
6466
6467 @item M P i
6468 @kindex M P i (Summary)
6469 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6470 Invert the list of process marked articles
6471 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
6472
6473 @item M P R
6474 @kindex M P R (Summary)
6475 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6476 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6477 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
6478
6479 @item M P G
6480 @kindex M P G (Summary)
6481 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6482 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6483 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
6484
6485 @item M P r
6486 @kindex M P r (Summary)
6487 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6488 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
6489
6490 @item M P g
6491 @kindex M P g (Summary)
6492 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6493 Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
6494
6495 @item M P t
6496 @kindex M P t (Summary)
6497 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6498 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6499 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6500
6501 @item M P T
6502 @kindex M P T (Summary)
6503 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6504 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6505 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6506
6507 @item M P v
6508 @kindex M P v (Summary)
6509 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6510 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6511 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
6512
6513 @item M P s
6514 @kindex M P s (Summary)
6515 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6516 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6517
6518 @item M P S
6519 @kindex M P S (Summary)
6520 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6521 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6522 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
6523
6524 @item M P a
6525 @kindex M P a (Summary)
6526 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6527 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6528
6529 @item M P b
6530 @kindex M P b (Summary)
6531 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6532 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6533 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6534
6535 @item M P k
6536 @kindex M P k (Summary)
6537 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6538 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6539 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6540
6541 @item M P y
6542 @kindex M P y (Summary)
6543 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6544 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6545 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
6546
6547 @item M P w
6548 @kindex M P w (Summary)
6549 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6550 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6551 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
6552
6553 @end table
6554
6555 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6556 set process marks based on article body contents.
6557
6558
6559 @node Limiting
6560 @section Limiting
6561 @cindex limiting
6562
6563 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6564 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6565 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6566 buffer.
6567
6568 Limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched from
6569 the servers. These commands don't query the server for additional
6570 articles.
6571
6572 @table @kbd
6573
6574 @item / /
6575 @itemx / s
6576 @kindex / / (Summary)
6577 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6578 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6579 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6580 matching articles.
6581
6582 @item / a
6583 @kindex / a (Summary)
6584 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6585 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6586 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6587 matching articles.
6588
6589 @item / R
6590 @kindex / R (Summary)
6591 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient
6592 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some recipient
6593 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient}). If given a prefix, exclude
6594 matching articles.
6595
6596 @item / A
6597 @kindex / A (Summary)
6598 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-address
6599 Limit the summary buffer to articles in which contents of From, To or Cc
6600 header match a given address (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-address}). If
6601 given a prefix, exclude matching articles.
6602
6603 @item / S
6604 @kindex / S (Summary)
6605 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons
6606 Limit the summary buffer to articles that aren't part of any displayed
6607 threads (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons}). If given a prefix,
6608 limit to articles that are part of displayed threads.
6609
6610 @item / x
6611 @kindex / x (Summary)
6612 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6613 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6614 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6615 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6616 matching articles.
6617
6618 @item / u
6619 @itemx x
6620 @kindex / u (Summary)
6621 @kindex x (Summary)
6622 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6623 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6624 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6625 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6626 dormant articles will also be excluded.
6627
6628 @item / m
6629 @kindex / m (Summary)
6630 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6631 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6632 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
6633
6634 @item / t
6635 @kindex / t (Summary)
6636 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6637 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6638 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6639 articles younger than that number of days.
6640
6641 @item / n
6642 @kindex / n (Summary)
6643 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6644 With prefix @samp{n}, limit the summary buffer to the next @samp{n}
6645 articles. If not given a prefix, use the process marked articles
6646 instead. (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}).
6647
6648 @item / w
6649 @kindex / w (Summary)
6650 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6651 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6652 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6653 the stack.
6654
6655 @item / .
6656 @kindex / . (Summary)
6657 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6658 Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6659 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
6660
6661 @item / v
6662 @kindex / v (Summary)
6663 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6664 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6665 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6666
6667 @item / p
6668 @kindex / p (Summary)
6669 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6670 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6671 group parameter predicate
6672 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6673 Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
6674
6675 @item / r
6676 @kindex / r (Summary)
6677 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-replied
6678 Limit the summary buffer to replied articles
6679 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-replied}). If given a prefix, exclude
6680 replied articles.
6681
6682 @item / E
6683 @itemx M S
6684 @kindex M S (Summary)
6685 @kindex / E (Summary)
6686 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6687 Include all expunged articles in the limit
6688 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6689
6690 @item / D
6691 @kindex / D (Summary)
6692 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6693 Include all dormant articles in the limit
6694 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6695
6696 @item / *
6697 @kindex / * (Summary)
6698 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6699 Include all cached articles in the limit
6700 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6701
6702 @item / d
6703 @kindex / d (Summary)
6704 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6705 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6706 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6707
6708 @item / M
6709 @kindex / M (Summary)
6710 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6711 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6712
6713 @item / T
6714 @kindex / T (Summary)
6715 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6716 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6717
6718 @item / c
6719 @kindex / c (Summary)
6720 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6721 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6722 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6723
6724 @item / C
6725 @kindex / C (Summary)
6726 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6727 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6728 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6729 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6730
6731 @item / b
6732 @kindex / b (Summary)
6733 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies
6734 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have bodies that match a
6735 certain regexp (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies}). If given a
6736 prefix, reverse the limit. This command is quite slow since it
6737 requires selecting each article to find the matches.
6738
6739 @item / h
6740 @kindex / h (Summary)
6741 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-headers
6742 Like the previous command, only limit to headers instead
6743 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-headers}).
6744
6745 @end table
6746
6747
6748 The following commands aren't limiting commands, but use the @kbd{/}
6749 prefix as well.
6750
6751 @table @kbd
6752 @item / N
6753 @kindex / N (Summary)
6754 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6755 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6756 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6757
6758 @item / o
6759 @kindex / o (Summary)
6760 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6761 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6762 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6763
6764 @end table
6765
6766
6767 @node Threading
6768 @section Threading
6769 @cindex threading
6770 @cindex article threading
6771
6772 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6773 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6774 hierarchical fashion.
6775
6776 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6777 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6778 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6779 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6780 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6781 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6782 @ref{Customizing Threading}.
6783
6784 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6785
6786 @table @dfn
6787 @item root
6788 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6789
6790 @item thread
6791 A tree-like article structure.
6792
6793 @item sub-thread
6794 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6795
6796 @item loose threads
6797 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6798 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6799 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6800 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6801 called loose threads.
6802
6803 @item thread gathering
6804 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6805
6806 @item sparse threads
6807 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6808 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6809
6810 @end table
6811
6812
6813 @menu
6814 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6815 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6816 @end menu
6817
6818
6819 @node Customizing Threading
6820 @subsection Customizing Threading
6821 @cindex customizing threading
6822
6823 @menu
6824 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6825 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6826 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6827 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6828 @end menu
6829
6830
6831 @node Loose Threads
6832 @subsubsection Loose Threads
6833 @cindex <
6834 @cindex >
6835 @cindex loose threads
6836
6837 @table @code
6838 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6839 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6840 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6841 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6842 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6843 read or killed the root in a previous session.
6844
6845 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6846 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6847 There are four possible values:
6848
6849 @iftex
6850 @iflatex
6851 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6852 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6853 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6854 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6855 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6856 }
6857 @end iflatex
6858 @end iftex
6859
6860 @cindex adopting articles
6861
6862 @table @code
6863
6864 @item adopt
6865 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6866 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6867 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6868 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6869
6870 @item dummy
6871 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6872 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6873 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6874 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6875 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6876 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6877 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6878 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6879 If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6880 ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
6881
6882 @item empty
6883 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6884 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6885 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6886 Buffer Format}).)
6887
6888 @item none
6889 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6890 display them after one another.
6891
6892 @item nil
6893 Don't gather loose threads.
6894 @end table
6895
6896 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6897 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6898 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6899 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6900 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6901 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6902 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6903 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6904 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6905 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6906 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6907
6908 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
6909 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6910 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6911 Matching}).
6912
6913 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6914 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6915 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6916 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6917 simplification is used.
6918
6919 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6920 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6921 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6922 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6923
6924 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6925 @lisp
6926 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6927 (concat
6928 "\\`\\[?\\("
6929 (mapconcat
6930 'identity
6931 '("looking"
6932 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6933 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6934 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6935 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6936 ;; ...
6937 )
6938 "\\|")
6939 "\\)\\s *\\("
6940 (mapconcat 'identity
6941 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6942 "\\|")
6943 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6944 @end lisp
6945
6946 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6947 subjects.
6948
6949 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6950 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6951 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6952 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6953 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6954 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6955
6956 Useful functions to put in this list include:
6957
6958 @table @code
6959 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6960 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6961 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6962
6963 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6964 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6965 Simplify fuzzily.
6966
6967 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6968 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6969 Remove excessive whitespace.
6970
6971 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6972 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6973 Remove all whitespace.
6974 @end table
6975
6976 You may also write your own functions, of course.
6977
6978
6979 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6980 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6981 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6982 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6983 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6984 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6985 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6986 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6987
6988 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6989 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6990 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6991 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6992 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6993 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6994 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6995 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6996 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6997 cholera:
6998
6999 @table @code
7000 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
7001 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
7002 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
7003 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
7004
7005 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
7006 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
7007 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
7008 @end table
7009
7010 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
7011 something like:
7012
7013 @lisp
7014 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
7015 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
7016 @end lisp
7017
7018 @end table
7019
7020
7021 @node Filling In Threads
7022 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
7023
7024 @table @code
7025 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
7026 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
7027 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
7028 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
7029 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
7030 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
7031 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
7032 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
7033 old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
7034 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
7035 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
7036 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
7037 do about that.
7038
7039 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
7040 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
7041 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
7042
7043 The server has to support @acronym{NOV} for any of this to work.
7044
7045 @cindex Gmane, gnus-fetch-old-headers
7046 This feature can seriously impact performance it ignores all locally
7047 cached header entries. Setting it to @code{t} for groups for a server
7048 that doesn't expire articles (such as news.gmane.org), leads to very
7049 slow summary generation.
7050
7051 @item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7052 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7053 Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
7054 newsgroups.
7055
7056 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
7057 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
7058 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
7059 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
7060 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
7061 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
7062 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
7063 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
7064 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
7065 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
7066 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
7067 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
7068 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
7069 @code{nil} by default.
7070
7071 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
7072 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
7073 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
7074 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
7075 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
7076 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
7077 web-based groups.
7078
7079 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
7080 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
7081 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
7082
7083 @end table
7084
7085
7086 @node More Threading
7087 @subsubsection More Threading
7088
7089 @table @code
7090 @item gnus-show-threads
7091 @vindex gnus-show-threads
7092 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
7093 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
7094 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
7095 slower and more awkward.
7096
7097 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7098 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7099 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
7100 generated.
7101
7102 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
7103 Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
7104 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
7105
7106 Here's an example:
7107
7108 @lisp
7109 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7110 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
7111 gnus-article-unseen-p))
7112 @end lisp
7113
7114 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
7115 unread, but you get my drift.)
7116
7117
7118 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
7119 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
7120 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
7121 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
7122 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
7123 threads are expunged.
7124
7125 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
7126 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
7127 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
7128 will be hidden.
7129
7130 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7131 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7132 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
7133 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
7134 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
7135 result in a new thread.
7136
7137 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
7138 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
7139 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
7140 The default is 4.
7141
7142 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7143 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7144 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
7145 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
7146 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
7147 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
7148 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
7149 Setting this variable to an alternate value
7150 (e.g., @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
7151 appropriate hook (e.g., @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
7152 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
7153
7154 @end table
7155
7156
7157 @node Low-Level Threading
7158 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
7159
7160 @table @code
7161
7162 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
7163 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
7164 Hook run before parsing any headers.
7165
7166 @item gnus-alter-header-function
7167 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
7168 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
7169 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
7170 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
7171 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
7172 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
7173 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
7174 meaningful. Here's one example:
7175
7176 @lisp
7177 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
7178
7179 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
7180 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
7181 (when (string-match
7182 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
7183 (mail-header-set-id
7184 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
7185 header))))
7186 @end lisp
7187
7188 @end table
7189
7190
7191 @node Thread Commands
7192 @subsection Thread Commands
7193 @cindex thread commands
7194
7195 @table @kbd
7196
7197 @item T k
7198 @itemx C-M-k
7199 @kindex T k (Summary)
7200 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
7201 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
7202 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
7203 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
7204 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
7205 articles instead.
7206
7207 @item T l
7208 @itemx C-M-l
7209 @kindex T l (Summary)
7210 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
7211 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
7212 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
7213 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
7214
7215 @item T i
7216 @kindex T i (Summary)
7217 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
7218 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
7219 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
7220
7221 @item T #
7222 @kindex T # (Summary)
7223 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
7224 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
7225 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
7226
7227 @item T M-#
7228 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
7229 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
7230 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
7231 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
7232
7233 @item T T
7234 @kindex T T (Summary)
7235 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
7236 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
7237
7238 @item T s
7239 @kindex T s (Summary)
7240 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
7241 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
7242 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
7243
7244 @item T h
7245 @kindex T h (Summary)
7246 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
7247 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
7248
7249 @item T S
7250 @kindex T S (Summary)
7251 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
7252 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
7253
7254 @item T H
7255 @kindex T H (Summary)
7256 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
7257 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
7258
7259 @item T t
7260 @kindex T t (Summary)
7261 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
7262 Re-thread the current article's thread
7263 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
7264 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
7265
7266 @item T ^
7267 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
7268 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
7269 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
7270 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
7271
7272 @item T M-^
7273 @kindex T M-^ (Summary)
7274 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-children
7275 Make the current article the parent of the marked articles
7276 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-children}).
7277
7278 @end table
7279
7280 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
7281 understand the numeric prefix.
7282
7283 @table @kbd
7284
7285 @item T n
7286 @kindex T n (Summary)
7287 @itemx C-M-f
7288 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
7289 @itemx M-down
7290 @kindex M-down (Summary)
7291 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
7292 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
7293
7294 @item T p
7295 @kindex T p (Summary)
7296 @itemx C-M-b
7297 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
7298 @itemx M-up
7299 @kindex M-up (Summary)
7300 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
7301 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
7302
7303 @item T d
7304 @kindex T d (Summary)
7305 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
7306 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
7307
7308 @item T u
7309 @kindex T u (Summary)
7310 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
7311 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
7312
7313 @item T o
7314 @kindex T o (Summary)
7315 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
7316 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
7317 @end table
7318
7319 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
7320 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
7321 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
7322 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
7323 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
7324 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
7325 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
7326 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
7327 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
7328 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
7329 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
7330 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
7331 Matching}).
7332
7333
7334 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
7335 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
7336
7337 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
7338 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
7339 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
7340 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7341 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
7342 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient
7343 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7344 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
7345 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
7346 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
7347 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
7348 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
7349 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
7350 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
7351 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
7352
7353 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
7354 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
7355 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient},
7356 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
7357 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date},
7358 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
7359 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
7360 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
7361 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
7362 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
7363
7364 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
7365 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
7366 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread. Exceptions
7367 to this rule are @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number} and
7368 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date}.
7369
7370 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
7371 last function in the list. You should probably always include
7372 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
7373 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
7374 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
7375 ascending article order.
7376
7377 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
7378 by number, you could do something like:
7379
7380 @lisp
7381 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7382 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7383 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7384 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
7385 @end lisp
7386
7387 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
7388 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
7389 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
7390 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
7391 which the articles arrived.
7392
7393 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
7394 say something like:
7395
7396 @lisp
7397 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7398 '((not gnus-thread-sort-by-number)
7399 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7400 @end lisp
7401
7402 By default, threads including their subthreads are sorted according to
7403 the value of @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}. By customizing
7404 @code{gnus-subthread-sort-functions} you can define a custom sorting
7405 order for subthreads. This allows for example to sort threads from
7406 high score to low score in the summary buffer, but to have subthreads
7407 still sorted chronologically from old to new without taking their
7408 score into account.
7409
7410 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7411 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7412 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7413 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7414 tickles your fancy.
7415
7416 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7417 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7418 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-date
7419 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7420 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7421 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7422 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7423 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7424 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-number
7425 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7426 other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7427 variable. It is very similar to the
7428 @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7429 different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7430 predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7431 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7432 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7433 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7434 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
7435
7436 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7437 say something like:
7438
7439 @lisp
7440 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7441 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7442 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7443 @end lisp
7444
7445 You can define group specific sorting via @code{gnus-parameters},
7446 @xref{Group Parameters}.
7447
7448
7449 @node Asynchronous Fetching
7450 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7451 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
7452 @cindex article pre-fetch
7453 @cindex pre-fetch
7454
7455 If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7456 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7457 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7458 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7459 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
7460
7461 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7462 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
7463
7464 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7465 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7466 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7467 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7468 connection is blocked.
7469
7470 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7471 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7472 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7473 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
7474
7475 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7476 the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7477 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7478 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7479 extra connection.
7480
7481 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7482 you really want to.
7483
7484 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
7485 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7486 happen automatically.
7487
7488 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7489 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7490 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7491 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7492 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7493 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7494 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7495
7496 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7497 @findex gnus-async-unread-p
7498 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7499 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7500 variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7501 function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7502 to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-unread-p}, which
7503 returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7504 article data structure as the only parameter.
7505
7506 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7507 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
7508
7509 @lisp
7510 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7511 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7512 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7513 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7514 100)))
7515
7516 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7517 @end lisp
7518
7519 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7520 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7521 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
7522
7523 @vindex gnus-async-post-fetch-function
7524 @findex gnus-html-prefetch-images
7525 After an article has been prefetched, this
7526 @code{gnus-async-post-fetch-function} will be called. The buffer will
7527 be narrowed to the region of the article that was fetched. A useful
7528 value would be @code{gnus-html-prefetch-images}, which will prefetch
7529 and store images referenced in the article, so that you don't have to
7530 wait for them to be fetched when you read the article. This is useful
7531 for @acronym{HTML} messages that have external images.
7532
7533 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7534 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7535 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7536 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
7537
7538 @table @code
7539 @item read
7540 Remove articles when they are read.
7541
7542 @item exit
7543 Remove articles when exiting the group.
7544 @end table
7545
7546 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
7547
7548 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7549 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7550 @c from the next group.
7551
7552
7553 @node Article Caching
7554 @section Article Caching
7555 @cindex article caching
7556 @cindex caching
7557
7558 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7559 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7560 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7561 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7562 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
7563
7564 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
7565
7566 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7567 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
7568 @vindex gnus-use-cache
7569 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7570 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7571 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7572 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7573 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
7574
7575 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7576 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7577 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7578 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7579 as dormant, and don't worry.
7580
7581 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
7582
7583 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7584 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7585 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7586 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7587 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7588 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7589 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7590 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7591 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7592 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
7593
7594 @findex gnus-jog-cache
7595 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7596 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7597 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7598 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7599 command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7600 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7601 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7602 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7603 not then be downloaded by this command.
7604
7605 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7606 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7607 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7608 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7609 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7610 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
7611
7612 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7613 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7614 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7615 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7616 variables, the group is not cached.
7617
7618 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7619 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7620 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7621 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7622 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7623 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7624 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7625 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7626 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7627 file.
7628
7629 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7630 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7631 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7632 where, isn't that cool?
7633
7634 @node Persistent Articles
7635 @section Persistent Articles
7636 @cindex persistent articles
7637
7638 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7639 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7640 useful in my opinion.
7641
7642 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7643 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7644 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7645 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7646 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7647 the expiry going on at the news server.
7648
7649 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7650 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7651 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
7652
7653 @table @kbd
7654
7655 @item *
7656 @kindex * (Summary)
7657 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7658 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7659
7660 @item M-*
7661 @kindex M-* (Summary)
7662 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7663 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7664 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7665 article.
7666 @end table
7667
7668 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7669
7670 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7671 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7672 interested in persistent articles:
7673
7674 @lisp
7675 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
7676 @end lisp
7677
7678 @node Sticky Articles
7679 @section Sticky Articles
7680 @cindex sticky articles
7681
7682 When you select an article the current article buffer will be reused
7683 according to the value of the variable
7684 @code{gnus-single-article-buffer}. If its value is non-@code{nil} (the
7685 default) all articles reuse the same article buffer. Else each group
7686 has its own article buffer.
7687
7688 This implies that it's not possible to have more than one article buffer
7689 in a group at a time. But sometimes you might want to display all the
7690 latest emails from your mother, your father, your aunt, your uncle and
7691 your 17 cousins to coordinate the next Christmas party.
7692
7693 That's where sticky articles come in handy. A sticky article buffer
7694 basically is a normal article buffer, but it won't be reused when you
7695 select another article. You can make an article sticky with:
7696
7697 @table @kbd
7698 @item A S
7699 @kindex A S (Summary)
7700 @findex gnus-sticky-article
7701 Make the current article sticky. If a prefix arg is given, ask for a
7702 name for this sticky article buffer.
7703 @end table
7704
7705 To close a sticky article buffer you can use these commands:
7706
7707 @table @kbd
7708 @item q
7709 @kindex q (Article)
7710 @findex bury-buffer
7711 Puts this sticky article buffer at the end of the list of all buffers.
7712
7713 @item k
7714 @kindex k (Article)
7715 @findex gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffer
7716 Kills this sticky article buffer.
7717 @end table
7718
7719 To kill all sticky article buffers you can use:
7720
7721 @defun gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffers ARG
7722 Kill all sticky article buffers.
7723 If a prefix ARG is given, ask for confirmation.
7724 @end defun
7725
7726 @node Article Backlog
7727 @section Article Backlog
7728 @cindex backlog
7729 @cindex article backlog
7730
7731 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7732 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7733 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7734 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7735 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7736 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7737 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7738 increase memory usage some.
7739
7740 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7741 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7742 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7743 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7744 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7745 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7746 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
7747
7748 The default value is 20.
7749
7750
7751 @node Saving Articles
7752 @section Saving Articles
7753 @cindex saving articles
7754
7755 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7756 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7757 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7758 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7759 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
7760
7761 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7762 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7763 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
7764
7765 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7766 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7767 unwanted headers before saving the article.
7768
7769 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
7770 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7771 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7772 deleted before saving.
7773
7774 @table @kbd
7775
7776 @item O o
7777 @itemx o
7778 @kindex O o (Summary)
7779 @kindex o (Summary)
7780 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
7781 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7782 Save the current article using the default article saver
7783 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7784
7785 @item O m
7786 @kindex O m (Summary)
7787 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7788 Save the current article in a Unix mail box (mbox) file
7789 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7790
7791 @item O r
7792 @kindex O r (Summary)
7793 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7794 Save the current article in Rmail format
7795 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}). This is mbox since Emacs 23,
7796 Babyl in older versions.
7797
7798 @item O f
7799 @kindex O f (Summary)
7800 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7801 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7802 Save the current article in plain file format
7803 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7804
7805 @item O F
7806 @kindex O F (Summary)
7807 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7808 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7809 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7810
7811 @item O b
7812 @kindex O b (Summary)
7813 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7814 Save the current article body in plain file format
7815 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7816
7817 @item O h
7818 @kindex O h (Summary)
7819 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7820 Save the current article in mh folder format
7821 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7822
7823 @item O v
7824 @kindex O v (Summary)
7825 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7826 Save the current article in a VM folder
7827 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7828
7829 @item O p
7830 @itemx |
7831 @kindex O p (Summary)
7832 @kindex | (Summary)
7833 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7834 @vindex gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command
7835 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7836 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7837 If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7838 complete headers in the piped output. The symbolic prefix @code{r} is
7839 special; it lets this command pipe a raw article including all headers.
7840 The @code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} variable can be set
7841 to a string containing the default command and options (default
7842 @code{nil}).
7843
7844 @item O P
7845 @kindex O P (Summary)
7846 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7847 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7848 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7849 external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7850 Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7851 variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7852 (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7853
7854 @end table
7855
7856 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7857 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7858 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7859 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7860 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7861 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7862 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7863 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7864 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7865 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7866 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7867 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7868 files.
7869
7870
7871 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7872 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7873 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the eight ready-made
7874 functions below, or you can create your own.
7875
7876 @table @code
7877
7878 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7879 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7880 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7881 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7882 This is the default format, that used by the Rmail package. Since Emacs
7883 23, Rmail uses standard mbox format. Before this, it used the
7884 @dfn{Babyl} format. Accordingly, this command writes mbox format since
7885 Emacs 23, unless appending to an existing Babyl file. In older versions
7886 of Emacs, it always uses Babyl format. Uses the function in the
7887 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7888 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7889
7890 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7891 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7892 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7893 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7894 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7895 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7896
7897 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7898 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7899 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
7900 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7901 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7902 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7903 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7904
7905 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7906 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7907 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7908 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7909 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7910 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7911
7912 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7913 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7914 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7915 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7916 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7917
7918 @item gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7919 @findex gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7920 Write the article body straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7921 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7922 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7923 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7924
7925 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7926 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7927 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
7928 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7929 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7930 @cindex rcvstore
7931 @cindex MH folders
7932 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7933 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7934 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7935 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7936 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7937
7938 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7939 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7940 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7941 reader to use this setting.
7942
7943 @item gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
7944 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
7945 Pipe the article to a shell command. This function takes optional two
7946 arguments COMMAND and RAW@. Valid values for COMMAND include:
7947
7948 @itemize @bullet
7949 @item a string@*
7950 The executable command name and possibly arguments.
7951 @item @code{nil}@*
7952 You will be prompted for the command in the minibuffer.
7953 @item the symbol @code{default}@*
7954 It will be replaced with the command which the variable
7955 @code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} holds or the command
7956 last used for saving.
7957 @end itemize
7958
7959 Non-@code{nil} value for RAW overrides @code{:decode} and
7960 @code{:headers} properties (see below) and the raw article including all
7961 headers will be piped.
7962 @end table
7963
7964 The symbol of each function may have the following properties:
7965
7966 @table @code
7967 @item :decode
7968 The value non-@code{nil} means save decoded articles. This is
7969 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-save-in-file},
7970 @code{gnus-summary-save-body-in-file},
7971 @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file},
7972 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}, and
7973 @code{gnus-summary-save-in-pipe}.
7974
7975 @item :function
7976 The value specifies an alternative function which appends, not
7977 overwrites, articles to a file. This implies that when saving many
7978 articles at a time, @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} is bound to
7979 @code{t} and all articles are saved in a single file. This is
7980 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file} and
7981 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
7982
7983 @item :headers
7984 The value specifies the symbol of a variable of which the value
7985 specifies headers to be saved. If it is omitted,
7986 @code{gnus-save-all-headers} and @code{gnus-saved-headers} control what
7987 headers should be saved.
7988 @end table
7989
7990 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7991 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7992 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7993 @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7994 default.
7995
7996 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7997 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7998 available functions that generate names:
7999
8000 @table @code
8001
8002 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
8003 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
8004 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
8005
8006 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
8007 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
8008 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
8009
8010 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
8011 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
8012 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
8013
8014 @item gnus-plain-save-name
8015 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
8016 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
8017
8018 @item gnus-sender-save-name
8019 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
8020 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
8021 @end table
8022
8023 @vindex gnus-split-methods
8024 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
8025 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
8026 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
8027 related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
8028 like:
8029
8030 @lisp
8031 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
8032 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
8033 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
8034 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
8035 @end lisp
8036
8037 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
8038 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
8039 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
8040 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
8041 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
8042 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
8043 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
8044 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
8045 called returns a string or a list of strings.
8046
8047 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
8048 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
8049 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
8050 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
8051
8052 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
8053 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
8054 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
8055 name.
8056
8057 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
8058 lots of mail groups called things like
8059 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
8060 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
8061 following will do just that:
8062
8063 @lisp
8064 (defun my-save-name (group)
8065 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
8066 (substring group (match-end 0))))
8067
8068 (setq gnus-split-methods
8069 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
8070 (my-save-name)))
8071 @end lisp
8072
8073
8074 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
8075 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
8076 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
8077 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
8078 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
8079 all the files in the top level directory
8080 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
8081 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
8082 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
8083 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
8084
8085 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
8086 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
8087 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
8088 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
8089 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
8090 for kill files.
8091
8092 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
8093 a spool, you could
8094
8095 @lisp
8096 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
8097 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
8098 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
8099 @end lisp
8100
8101 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
8102 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
8103 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
8104 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
8105
8106
8107 @node Decoding Articles
8108 @section Decoding Articles
8109 @cindex decoding articles
8110
8111 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
8112 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
8113
8114 @menu
8115 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
8116 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
8117 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
8118 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
8119 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
8120 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
8121 @end menu
8122
8123 @cindex series
8124 @cindex article series
8125 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
8126 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
8127 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
8128 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
8129 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
8130
8131 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
8132 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
8133 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
8134
8135 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
8136 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
8137 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
8138
8139 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
8140 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
8141 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
8142
8143
8144 @node Uuencoded Articles
8145 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
8146 @cindex uudecode
8147 @cindex uuencoded articles
8148
8149 @table @kbd
8150
8151 @item X u
8152 @kindex X u (Summary)
8153 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
8154 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
8155 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
8156
8157 @item X U
8158 @kindex X U (Summary)
8159 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
8160 Uudecodes and saves the current series
8161 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8162
8163 @item X v u
8164 @kindex X v u (Summary)
8165 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
8166 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
8167
8168 @item X v U
8169 @kindex X v U (Summary)
8170 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
8171 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
8172 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
8173
8174 @end table
8175
8176 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
8177 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
8178 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
8179 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
8180 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8181
8182 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
8183 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
8184 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
8185 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
8186 @kbd{X u}.
8187
8188 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
8189 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
8190 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
8191 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
8192 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
8193 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
8194 off.
8195
8196
8197 @node Shell Archives
8198 @subsection Shell Archives
8199 @cindex unshar
8200 @cindex shell archives
8201 @cindex shared articles
8202
8203 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
8204 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
8205 some commands to deal with these:
8206
8207 @table @kbd
8208
8209 @item X s
8210 @kindex X s (Summary)
8211 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
8212 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
8213
8214 @item X S
8215 @kindex X S (Summary)
8216 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
8217 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
8218
8219 @item X v s
8220 @kindex X v s (Summary)
8221 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
8222 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
8223
8224 @item X v S
8225 @kindex X v S (Summary)
8226 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
8227 Unshars, views and saves the current series
8228 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
8229 @end table
8230
8231
8232 @node PostScript Files
8233 @subsection PostScript Files
8234 @cindex PostScript
8235
8236 @table @kbd
8237
8238 @item X p
8239 @kindex X p (Summary)
8240 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
8241 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
8242
8243 @item X P
8244 @kindex X P (Summary)
8245 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
8246 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
8247 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
8248
8249 @item X v p
8250 @kindex X v p (Summary)
8251 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
8252 View the current PostScript series
8253 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
8254
8255 @item X v P
8256 @kindex X v P (Summary)
8257 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
8258 View and save the current PostScript series
8259 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
8260 @end table
8261
8262
8263 @node Other Files
8264 @subsection Other Files
8265
8266 @table @kbd
8267 @item X o
8268 @kindex X o (Summary)
8269 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
8270 Save the current series
8271 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
8272
8273 @item X b
8274 @kindex X b (Summary)
8275 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
8276 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
8277 doesn't really work yet.
8278
8279 @item X Y
8280 @kindex X Y (Summary)
8281 @findex gnus-uu-decode-yenc
8282 yEnc-decode the current series and save it (@code{gnus-uu-decode-yenc}).
8283 @end table
8284
8285
8286 @node Decoding Variables
8287 @subsection Decoding Variables
8288
8289 Adjective, not verb.
8290
8291 @menu
8292 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
8293 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
8294 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
8295 @end menu
8296
8297
8298 @node Rule Variables
8299 @subsubsection Rule Variables
8300 @cindex rule variables
8301
8302 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
8303 variables are of the form
8304
8305 @lisp
8306 (list '(regexp1 command2)
8307 '(regexp2 command2)
8308 ...)
8309 @end lisp
8310
8311 @table @code
8312
8313 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8314 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8315 @cindex sox
8316 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
8317 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
8318 say something like:
8319 @lisp
8320 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8321 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
8322 @end lisp
8323
8324 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8325 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8326 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
8327 user and default view rules.
8328
8329 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8330 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8331 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
8332 archives.
8333 @end table
8334
8335
8336 @node Other Decode Variables
8337 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
8338
8339 @table @code
8340 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8341
8342 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8343 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
8344 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
8345 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
8346 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
8347
8348 @table @code
8349
8350 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
8351 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
8352 View the file.
8353
8354 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
8355 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
8356 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
8357 @end table
8358
8359 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8360 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8361 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
8362 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
8363 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
8364 time.
8365
8366 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8367 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8368 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
8369
8370 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8371 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8372 Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
8373 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
8374 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
8375 kludgy.
8376
8377 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8378 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8379 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
8380
8381 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8382 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8383 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
8384 looking for files to display.
8385
8386 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
8387 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
8388 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
8389 after viewing it.
8390
8391 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8392 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8393 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
8394 rules.
8395
8396 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8397 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8398 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
8399 unpacking commands.
8400
8401 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8402 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8403 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
8404 from articles.
8405
8406 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8407 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8408 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
8409 decoded articles as unread.
8410
8411 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8412 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8413 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
8414 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
8415
8416 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8417 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8418 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
8419
8420 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8421 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8422 @cindex metamail
8423 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
8424 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
8425 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
8426 @code{metamail} for viewing.
8427
8428 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8429 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8430 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
8431 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
8432 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
8433 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
8434 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
8435 simply dropped them.
8436
8437 @end table
8438
8439
8440 @node Uuencoding and Posting
8441 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
8442
8443 @table @code
8444
8445 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8446 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8447 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
8448 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
8449 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
8450 for you when you post the article.
8451
8452 @item gnus-uu-post-length
8453 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
8454 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
8455 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
8456
8457 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
8458 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
8459 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
8460 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
8461 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
8462 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
8463 think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
8464
8465 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8466 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8467 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
8468 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
8469 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
8470 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
8471 Default is @code{t}.
8472
8473 @end table
8474
8475
8476 @node Viewing Files
8477 @subsection Viewing Files
8478 @cindex viewing files
8479 @cindex pseudo-articles
8480
8481 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
8482 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
8483 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
8484 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
8485 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
8486 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
8487 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
8488
8489 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
8490 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
8491 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
8492 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
8493
8494 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
8495 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
8496 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
8497
8498 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
8499 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
8500 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
8501 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
8502 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
8503
8504 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
8505 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
8506 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
8507 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
8508 a list of parameters to that command.
8509
8510 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
8511 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
8512 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
8513
8514 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
8515 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
8516 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
8517
8518
8519 @node Article Treatment
8520 @section Article Treatment
8521
8522 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
8523 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
8524 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
8525 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
8526 these articles easier.
8527
8528 @menu
8529 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
8530 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
8531 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
8532 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
8533 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8534 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8535 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8536 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8537 * Article Display:: Display various stuff:
8538 X-Face, Picons, Gravatars, Smileys.
8539 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8540 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8541 @end menu
8542
8543
8544 @node Article Highlighting
8545 @subsection Article Highlighting
8546 @cindex highlighting
8547
8548 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8549 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
8550
8551 @table @kbd
8552
8553 @item W H a
8554 @kindex W H a (Summary)
8555 @findex gnus-article-highlight
8556 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8557 Do much highlighting of the current article
8558 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8559 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
8560
8561 @item W H h
8562 @kindex W H h (Summary)
8563 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8564 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8565 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8566 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8567 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8568 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8569 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8570 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8571 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8572 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8573 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
8574
8575 @item W H c
8576 @kindex W H c (Summary)
8577 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8578 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
8579
8580 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
8581
8582 @table @code
8583 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8584
8585 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8586 If the article size in bytes is bigger than this variable (which is
8587 25000 by default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
8588
8589 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8590 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8591 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
8592
8593 @item gnus-cite-face-list
8594 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8595 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8596 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8597 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8598 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
8599
8600 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
8601 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8602 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
8603
8604 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8605 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8606 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
8607
8608 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8609 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8610 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8611 that it's a citation.
8612
8613 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8614 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8615 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
8616
8617 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8618 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8619 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
8620
8621 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8622 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8623 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8624 cited text belonging to the attribution.
8625
8626 @item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8627 @vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8628 If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8629 beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8630 in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8631 is @code{t}.
8632
8633 @end table
8634
8635
8636 @item W H s
8637 @kindex W H s (Summary)
8638 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
8639 @vindex gnus-signature-face
8640 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8641 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8642 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8643 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8644 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8645 default.
8646
8647 @end table
8648
8649 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
8650
8651
8652 @node Article Fontisizing
8653 @subsection Article Fontisizing
8654 @cindex emphasis
8655 @cindex article emphasis
8656
8657 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
8658 @kindex W e (Summary)
8659 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8660 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8661 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8662 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
8663
8664 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8665 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8666 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8667 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8668 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8669 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8670 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8671 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8672 highlighting.
8673
8674 @lisp
8675 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8676 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8677 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
8678 @end lisp
8679
8680 @cindex slash
8681 @cindex asterisk
8682 @cindex underline
8683 @cindex /
8684 @cindex *
8685
8686 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8687 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8688 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8689 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8690 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8691 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8692 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8693 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8694 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8695 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8696 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8697 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8698 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
8699
8700 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8701 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8702 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8703 say something like:
8704
8705 @lisp
8706 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
8707 @end lisp
8708
8709 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
8710
8711 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8712 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8713 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8714 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
8715
8716 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
8717
8718
8719 @node Article Hiding
8720 @subsection Article Hiding
8721 @cindex article hiding
8722
8723 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8724 too much cruft in most articles.
8725
8726 @table @kbd
8727
8728 @item W W a
8729 @kindex W W a (Summary)
8730 @findex gnus-article-hide
8731 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8732 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8733 headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
8734
8735 @item W W h
8736 @kindex W W h (Summary)
8737 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8738 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8739 Headers}.
8740
8741 @item W W b
8742 @kindex W W b (Summary)
8743 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8744 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8745 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
8746
8747 @item W W s
8748 @kindex W W s (Summary)
8749 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8750 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8751 Signature}.
8752
8753 @item W W l
8754 @kindex W W l (Summary)
8755 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8756 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8757 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8758 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8759 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8760 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8761 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
8762
8763 @table @code
8764
8765 @item gnus-list-identifiers
8766 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8767 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8768 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
8769
8770 @end table
8771
8772 @item W W P
8773 @kindex W W P (Summary)
8774 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8775 Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8776 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
8777
8778 @item W W B
8779 @kindex W W B (Summary)
8780 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8781 @vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8782 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8783 @cindex banner
8784 @cindex OneList
8785 @cindex stripping advertisements
8786 @cindex advertisements
8787 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8788 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8789 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8790 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8791 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8792 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8793 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8794 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8795 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8796 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8797 used.
8798
8799 For instance:
8800
8801 @lisp
8802 (setq gnus-article-banner-alist
8803 ((googleGroups .
8804 "^\n*--~--~---------\\(.+\n\\)+")))
8805 @end lisp
8806
8807 Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8808 the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8809 @code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
8810
8811 @table @code
8812
8813 @item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8814 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8815 Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8816 @code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8817 matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8818 symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8819 a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8820 address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8821 sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8822 banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8823 sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
8824
8825 @lisp
8826 ("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8827 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8828 @end lisp
8829
8830 @end table
8831
8832 @item W W c
8833 @kindex W W c (Summary)
8834 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8835 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8836 customizing the hiding:
8837
8838 @table @code
8839
8840 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8841 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8842 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8843 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8844 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8845 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8846 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8847 specs are valid:
8848
8849 @table @samp
8850 @item b
8851 Starting point of the hidden text.
8852 @item e
8853 Ending point of the hidden text.
8854 @item l
8855 Number of characters in the hidden region.
8856 @item n
8857 Number of lines of hidden text.
8858 @end table
8859
8860 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8861 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8862 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8863 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8864 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
8865
8866 @end table
8867
8868 @item W W C-c
8869 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8870 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
8871
8872 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8873 following two variables:
8874
8875 @table @code
8876 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8877 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8878 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
8879 50), hide the cited text.
8880
8881 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8882 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8883 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8884 is hidden.
8885 @end table
8886
8887 @item W W C
8888 @kindex W W C (Summary)
8889 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8890 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8891 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8892 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8893 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8894
8895 @end table
8896
8897 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8898 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8899 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8900
8901 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8902 citation customization.
8903
8904 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8905 automatically.
8906
8907
8908 @node Article Washing
8909 @subsection Article Washing
8910 @cindex washing
8911 @cindex article washing
8912
8913 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8914 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8915
8916 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8917 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8918 Cleaner, perhaps.
8919
8920 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8921 articles by default.
8922
8923 @table @kbd
8924
8925 @item C-u g
8926 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8927 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8928 the server.
8929
8930 @item g
8931 Force redisplaying of the current article
8932 (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8933 If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8934 interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8935 (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8936
8937 @item W l
8938 @kindex W l (Summary)
8939 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8940 Remove page breaks from the current article
8941 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8942 delimiters.
8943
8944 @item W r
8945 @kindex W r (Summary)
8946 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8947 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8948 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8949 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8950 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8951 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8952
8953 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8954 positions in the alphabet, e.g., @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8955 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8956 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8957
8958 @item W m
8959 @kindex W m (Summary)
8960 @findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8961 Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
8962
8963 @item W i
8964 @kindex W i (Summary)
8965 @findex gnus-summary-idna-message
8966 Decode IDNA encoded domain names in the current articles. IDNA
8967 encoded domain names looks like @samp{xn--bar}. If a string remain
8968 unencoded after running invoking this, it is likely an invalid IDNA
8969 string (@samp{xn--bar} is invalid). You must have GNU Libidn
8970 (@url{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/}) installed for this command
8971 to work.
8972
8973 @item W t
8974 @item t
8975 @kindex W t (Summary)
8976 @kindex t (Summary)
8977 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8978 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8979 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8980
8981 @item W v
8982 @kindex W v (Summary)
8983 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8984 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8985 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8986
8987 @item W o
8988 @kindex W o (Summary)
8989 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8990 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8991
8992 @item W d
8993 @kindex W d (Summary)
8994 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8995 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8996 @cindex Smartquotes
8997 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8998 @cindex Latin 1
8999 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
9000 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
9001 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
9002 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
9003 interactively.
9004
9005 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
9006 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
9007 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
9008 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
9009
9010 @item W U
9011 @kindex W U (Summary)
9012 @findex gnus-article-treat-non-ascii
9013 @cindex Unicode
9014 @cindex Non-@acronym{ASCII}
9015 Translate many non-@acronym{ASCII} characters into their
9016 @acronym{ASCII} equivalents (@code{gnus-article-treat-non-ascii}).
9017 This is mostly useful if you're on a terminal that has a limited font
9018 and doesn't show accented characters, ``advanced'' punctuation, and the
9019 like. For instance, @samp{»} is translated into @samp{>>}, and so on.
9020
9021 @item W Y f
9022 @kindex W Y f (Summary)
9023 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
9024 @cindex Outlook Express
9025 Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
9026 unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
9027 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
9028
9029 @item W Y u
9030 @kindex W Y u (Summary)
9031 @findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
9032 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
9033 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
9034 Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
9035 what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
9036 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
9037 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
9038 maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
9039 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
9040
9041 @item W Y a
9042 @kindex W Y a (Summary)
9043 @findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
9044 Repair a broken attribution line.@*
9045 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
9046
9047 @item W Y c
9048 @kindex W Y c (Summary)
9049 @findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
9050 Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
9051 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
9052
9053 @item W w
9054 @kindex W w (Summary)
9055 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
9056 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
9057
9058 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
9059 when filling.
9060
9061 @item W Q
9062 @kindex W Q (Summary)
9063 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
9064 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
9065
9066 @item W C
9067 @kindex W C (Summary)
9068 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
9069 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
9070 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
9071
9072 @item W c
9073 @kindex W c (Summary)
9074 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
9075 Translate CRLF pairs (i.e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
9076 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
9077 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
9078 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
9079
9080 @item W q
9081 @kindex W q (Summary)
9082 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
9083 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
9084 Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
9085 sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
9086 makes strings like @samp{déjà vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu},
9087 which doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually
9088 done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9089 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9090 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9091
9092 @item W 6
9093 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
9094 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
9095 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
9096 one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
9097 non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
9098 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9099 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9100 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9101
9102 @item W Z
9103 @kindex W Z (Summary)
9104 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
9105 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
9106 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
9107 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
9108
9109 @item W A
9110 @kindex W A (Summary)
9111 @findex gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences
9112 @cindex @acronym{ANSI} control sequences
9113 Translate @acronym{ANSI} SGR control sequences into overlays or
9114 extents (@code{gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences}). @acronym{ANSI}
9115 sequences are used in some Chinese hierarchies for highlighting.
9116
9117 @item W u
9118 @kindex W u (Summary)
9119 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
9120 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
9121 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
9122 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
9123 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
9124
9125 @item W h
9126 @kindex W h (Summary)
9127 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
9128 Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
9129 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9130 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
9131
9132 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for. If it is a number,
9133 the charset defined in @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist}
9134 (@pxref{Paging the Article}) will be used.
9135
9136 The default is to use the function specified by
9137 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
9138 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
9139 @acronym{HTML}. Pre-defined functions you can use include:
9140
9141 @table @code
9142 @item shr
9143 Use Gnus simple html renderer.
9144
9145 @item gnus-w3m
9146 Use Gnus rendered based on w3m.
9147
9148 @item w3m
9149 Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
9150
9151 @item w3m-standalone
9152 Use @uref{http://w3m.sourceforge.net/, w3m}.
9153
9154 @item links
9155 Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
9156
9157 @item lynx
9158 Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
9159
9160 @item html2text
9161 Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
9162
9163 @end table
9164
9165 @item W b
9166 @kindex W b (Summary)
9167 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
9168 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
9169 @xref{Article Buttons}.
9170
9171 @item W B
9172 @kindex W B (Summary)
9173 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
9174 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
9175 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
9176
9177 @item W p
9178 @kindex W p (Summary)
9179 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
9180 Verify a signed control message
9181 (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
9182 @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
9183 hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
9184 the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
9185 message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
9186 available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
9187
9188 @item W s
9189 @kindex W s (Summary)
9190 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
9191 Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
9192 @acronym{S/MIME}) message
9193 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
9194
9195 @item W a
9196 @kindex W a (Summary)
9197 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
9198 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
9199 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
9200
9201 @item W E l
9202 @kindex W E l (Summary)
9203 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
9204 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
9205 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
9206
9207 @item W E m
9208 @kindex W E m (Summary)
9209 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
9210 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
9211 lines with a single empty line.
9212 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
9213
9214 @item W E t
9215 @kindex W E t (Summary)
9216 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
9217 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
9218 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
9219
9220 @item W E a
9221 @kindex W E a (Summary)
9222 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
9223 Do all the three commands above
9224 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
9225
9226 @item W E A
9227 @kindex W E A (Summary)
9228 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
9229 Remove all blank lines
9230 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
9231
9232 @item W E s
9233 @kindex W E s (Summary)
9234 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
9235 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
9236 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
9237
9238 @item W E e
9239 @kindex W E e (Summary)
9240 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
9241 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
9242 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
9243
9244 @end table
9245
9246 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
9247
9248
9249 @node Article Header
9250 @subsection Article Header
9251
9252 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
9253
9254 @table @kbd
9255
9256 @item W G u
9257 @kindex W G u (Summary)
9258 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
9259 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
9260
9261 @item W G n
9262 @kindex W G n (Summary)
9263 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
9264 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
9265 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
9266
9267 @item W G f
9268 @kindex W G f (Summary)
9269 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
9270 Fold all the message headers
9271 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
9272
9273 @item W E w
9274 @kindex W E w (Summary)
9275 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
9276 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
9277 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
9278
9279 @end table
9280
9281
9282 @node Article Buttons
9283 @subsection Article Buttons
9284 @cindex buttons
9285
9286 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
9287 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
9288 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
9289 button on these references.
9290
9291 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9292 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
9293 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
9294 Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
9295 one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
9296
9297 @table @code
9298
9299 @item gnus-button-alist
9300 @vindex gnus-button-alist
9301 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
9302
9303 @lisp
9304 (@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9305 @end lisp
9306
9307 @table @var
9308
9309 @item regexp
9310 All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
9311 considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
9312 embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
9313 variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
9314 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
9315
9316 @item button-par
9317 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
9318 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
9319 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
9320
9321 @item use-p
9322 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
9323 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
9324 avoid false matches. Often variables named
9325 @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
9326 Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
9327
9328 @c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
9329
9330 @item function
9331 This function will be called when you click on this button.
9332
9333 @item data-par
9334 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
9335 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
9336
9337 @end table
9338
9339 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
9340
9341 @lisp
9342 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
9343 @end lisp
9344
9345 @item gnus-header-button-alist
9346 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
9347 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
9348 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
9349 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
9350
9351 @lisp
9352 (@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9353 @end lisp
9354
9355 @var{header} is a regular expression.
9356 @end table
9357
9358 @subsubsection Related variables and functions
9359
9360 @table @code
9361 @item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
9362 @xref{Article Button Levels}.
9363
9364 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
9365
9366 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
9367 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
9368 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
9369 default values of the variables above.
9370
9371 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
9372
9373 @item gnus-button-man-handler
9374 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9375 The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
9376 argument with a string naming the man page.
9377
9378 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
9379
9380 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9381 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9382 Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
9383
9384 @item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9385 @vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9386 This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
9387 @samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
9388 message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
9389 @code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
9390 a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
9391 @code{ask}, always query the user what to do. If it is a function, this
9392 function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
9393 function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
9394 @code{ask}. The default value is the function
9395 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
9396
9397 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9398 @findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9399 Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
9400 address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
9401 it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
9402 string is invalid.
9403
9404 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9405 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9406 An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
9407 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
9408
9409 @c Misc stuff
9410
9411 @item gnus-article-button-face
9412 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
9413 Face used on buttons.
9414
9415 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
9416 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
9417 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
9418
9419 @end table
9420
9421 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
9422
9423
9424 @node Article Button Levels
9425 @subsection Article button levels
9426 @cindex button levels
9427 The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
9428 the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
9429 buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
9430 already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
9431 more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
9432 you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
9433 specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
9434 variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
9435
9436 @lisp
9437 ;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
9438 (setq gnus-parameters
9439 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
9440 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
9441 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
9442 @end lisp
9443
9444 @table @code
9445
9446 @item gnus-button-browse-level
9447 @vindex gnus-button-browse-level
9448 Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
9449 news URLs. Related variables and functions include
9450 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
9451 @code{browse-url-browser-function}.
9452
9453 @item gnus-button-emacs-level
9454 @vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
9455 Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
9456 @code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
9457 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
9458 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
9459 @code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
9460 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
9461 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
9462 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
9463 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
9464 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
9465 @code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
9466
9467 @item gnus-button-man-level
9468 @vindex gnus-button-man-level
9469 Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
9470 See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
9471
9472 @item gnus-button-message-level
9473 @vindex gnus-button-message-level
9474 Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
9475 Related variables and functions include
9476 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
9477 @code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
9478 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
9479 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
9480
9481 @end table
9482
9483
9484 @node Article Date
9485 @subsection Article Date
9486
9487 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
9488 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
9489 when the article was sent.
9490
9491 @table @kbd
9492
9493 @item W T u
9494 @kindex W T u (Summary)
9495 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
9496 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
9497 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
9498
9499 @item W T i
9500 @kindex W T i (Summary)
9501 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
9502 @cindex ISO 8601
9503 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
9504 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
9505
9506 @item W T l
9507 @kindex W T l (Summary)
9508 @findex gnus-article-date-local
9509 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
9510
9511 @item W T p
9512 @kindex W T p (Summary)
9513 @findex gnus-article-date-english
9514 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
9515 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
9516
9517 @item W T s
9518 @kindex W T s (Summary)
9519 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
9520 @findex gnus-article-date-user
9521 @findex format-time-string
9522 Display the date using a user-defined format
9523 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
9524 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
9525 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
9526 for a list of possible format specs.
9527
9528 @item W T e
9529 @kindex W T e (Summary)
9530 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
9531 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
9532 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
9533 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
9534 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
9535
9536 @example
9537 Date: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
9538 @end example
9539
9540 To make this line updated continually, set the
9541 @code{gnus-article-update-date-headers} variable to the frequency in
9542 seconds (the default is @code{nil}).
9543
9544 @item W T o
9545 @kindex W T o (Summary)
9546 @findex gnus-article-date-original
9547 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9548 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9549 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9550 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9551 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
9552
9553 @end table
9554
9555 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9556 preferred format automatically.
9557
9558
9559 @node Article Display
9560 @subsection Article Display
9561 @cindex picons
9562 @cindex x-face
9563 @cindex smileys
9564 @cindex gravatars
9565
9566 These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9567 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
9568
9569 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9570 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
9571
9572 @code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9573 headers (@pxref{Face}).
9574
9575 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9576 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
9577
9578 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9579 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
9580
9581 Gravatars reside on-line and are fetched from
9582 @uref{http://www.gravatar.com/} (@pxref{Gravatars}).
9583
9584 All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9585 they'll be removed.
9586
9587 @table @kbd
9588 @item W D x
9589 @kindex W D x (Summary)
9590 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9591 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9592 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
9593
9594 @item W D d
9595 @kindex W D d (Summary)
9596 @findex gnus-article-display-face
9597 Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9598 (@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
9599
9600 @item W D s
9601 @kindex W D s (Summary)
9602 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
9603 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
9604
9605 @item W D f
9606 @kindex W D f (Summary)
9607 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9608 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
9609
9610 @item W D m
9611 @kindex W D m (Summary)
9612 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
9613 Piconify all mail headers (i.e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9614 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
9615
9616 @item W D n
9617 @kindex W D n (Summary)
9618 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
9619 Piconify all news headers (i.e., @code{Newsgroups} and
9620 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
9621
9622 @item W D g
9623 @kindex W D g (Summary)
9624 @findex gnus-treat-from-gravatar
9625 Gravatarify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-gravatar}).
9626
9627 @item W D h
9628 @kindex W D h (Summary)
9629 @findex gnus-treat-mail-gravatar
9630 Gravatarify all mail headers (i.e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9631 (@code{gnus-treat-from-gravatar}).
9632
9633 @item W D D
9634 @kindex W D D (Summary)
9635 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
9636 Remove all images from the article buffer
9637 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
9638
9639 @item W D W
9640 @kindex W D W (Summary)
9641 @findex gnus-html-show-images
9642 If you're reading an @acronym{HTML} article rendered with
9643 @code{gnus-article-html}, then you can insert any blocked images in
9644 the buffer with this command.
9645 (@code{gnus-html-show-images}).
9646
9647 @end table
9648
9649
9650
9651 @node Article Signature
9652 @subsection Article Signature
9653 @cindex signatures
9654 @cindex article signature
9655
9656 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
9657 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9658 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9659 that says what is to be considered a signature is
9660 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9661 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9662 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9663 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9664 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
9665
9666 @lisp
9667 (setq gnus-signature-separator
9668 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9669 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9670 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9671 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9672 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9673 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9674 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9675 @end lisp
9676
9677 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9678 positives.
9679
9680 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
9681 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9682 signature when displaying articles.
9683
9684 @enumerate
9685 @item
9686 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9687 that integer.
9688 @item
9689 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9690 than that number.
9691 @item
9692 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9693 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9694 @item
9695 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9696 in question is not a signature.
9697 @end enumerate
9698
9699 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9700 listed above. Here's an example:
9701
9702 @lisp
9703 (setq gnus-signature-limit
9704 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9705 @end lisp
9706
9707 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9708 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9709 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9710 signature after all.
9711
9712
9713 @node Article Miscellanea
9714 @subsection Article Miscellanea
9715
9716 @table @kbd
9717 @item A t
9718 @kindex A t (Summary)
9719 @findex gnus-article-babel
9720 Translate the article from one language to another
9721 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
9722
9723 @end table
9724
9725
9726 @node MIME Commands
9727 @section MIME Commands
9728 @cindex MIME decoding
9729 @cindex attachments
9730 @cindex viewing attachments
9731
9732 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9733 instance, @kbd{3 K v} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
9734
9735 @table @kbd
9736 @item b
9737 @itemx K v
9738 @kindex b (Summary)
9739 @kindex K v (Summary)
9740 View the @acronym{MIME} part.
9741
9742 @item K o
9743 @kindex K o (Summary)
9744 Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
9745
9746 @item K O
9747 @kindex K O (Summary)
9748 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} part and strip it
9749 from the article. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred
9750 via the message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
9751
9752 @item K r
9753 @kindex K r (Summary)
9754 Replace the @acronym{MIME} part with an external body.
9755
9756 @item K d
9757 @kindex K d (Summary)
9758 Delete the @acronym{MIME} part and add some information about the
9759 removed part.
9760
9761 @item K c
9762 @kindex K c (Summary)
9763 Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
9764
9765 @item K e
9766 @kindex K e (Summary)
9767 View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
9768
9769 @item K i
9770 @kindex K i (Summary)
9771 View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
9772
9773 @item K |
9774 @kindex K | (Summary)
9775 Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9776 @end table
9777
9778 The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9779 the same manner:
9780
9781 @table @kbd
9782 @item K H
9783 @kindex K H (Summary)
9784 @findex gnus-article-browse-html-article
9785 View @samp{text/html} parts of the current article with a WWW browser.
9786 Inline images embedded in a message using the @code{cid} scheme, as they
9787 are generally considered to be safe, will be processed properly. The
9788 message header is added to the beginning of every @acronym{HTML} part
9789 unless the prefix argument is given.
9790
9791 Warning: Spammers use links to images (using the @code{http} scheme) in
9792 @acronym{HTML} articles to verify whether you have read the message. As
9793 this command passes the @acronym{HTML} content to the browser without
9794 eliminating these ``web bugs'' you should only use it for mails from
9795 trusted senders.
9796
9797 If you always want to display @acronym{HTML} parts in the browser, set
9798 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} to @code{nil}.
9799
9800 This command creates temporary files to pass @acronym{HTML} contents
9801 including images if any to the browser, and deletes them when exiting
9802 the group (if you want).
9803
9804 @item K b
9805 @kindex K b (Summary)
9806 Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9807 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9808 parts.
9809
9810 @item W M h
9811 @kindex W M h (Summary)
9812 @findex gnus-mime-buttonize-attachments-in-header
9813 @vindex gnus-mime-display-attachment-buttons-in-header
9814 Display @acronym{MIME} part buttons in the end of the header of an
9815 article (@code{gnus-mime-buttonize-attachments-in-header}). This
9816 command toggles the display. Note that buttons to be added to the
9817 header are only the ones that aren't inlined in the body. If you want
9818 those buttons always to be displayed, set
9819 @code{gnus-mime-display-attachment-buttons-in-header} to non-@code{nil}.
9820 The default is @code{t}. To change the appearance of buttons, customize
9821 @code{gnus-header-face-alist}.
9822
9823 @item K m
9824 @kindex K m (Summary)
9825 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9826 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9827 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9828 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9829 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
9830
9831 @item X m
9832 @kindex X m (Summary)
9833 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9834 Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9835 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9836 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9837
9838 @item M-t
9839 @kindex M-t (Summary)
9840 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9841 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9842 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
9843
9844 @item W M w
9845 @kindex W M w (Summary)
9846 @findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9847 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9848 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
9849
9850 @item W M c
9851 @kindex W M c (Summary)
9852 @findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9853 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9854 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
9855
9856 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9857 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9858 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9859 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9860 include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9861 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9862
9863 @item W M v
9864 @kindex W M v (Summary)
9865 @findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9866 View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9867 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
9868
9869 @end table
9870
9871 Relevant variables:
9872
9873 @table @code
9874 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9875 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9876 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9877 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9878 @code{nil}.
9879
9880 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
9881
9882 @lisp
9883 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9884 '("text/x-vcard"))
9885 @end lisp
9886
9887 @item gnus-article-loose-mime
9888 @vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9889 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9890 before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9891 when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9892 default is @code{t}.
9893
9894 @item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9895 @vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9896 @cindex uuencode
9897 @cindex yEnc
9898 There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9899 is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9900 this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9901 see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9902 Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}. Only
9903 single-part yEnc encoded attachments can be decoded. There's no support
9904 for encoding in Gnus.
9905
9906 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9907 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9908 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9909 this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9910 displayed or this variable is overridden by
9911 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9912 @code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9913 @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
9914
9915 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9916 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9917 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9918 this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9919 displayed. This variable overrides
9920 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9921 This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9922 is @code{nil}.
9923
9924 E.g., to see security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
9925 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9926 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
9927
9928 You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
9929 display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
9930 those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
9931 (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
9932 Emacs MIME Manual}).
9933
9934 @item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9935 @vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9936 If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9937 default value is @code{nil}.
9938
9939 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9940 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9941 For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9942 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
9943 users to gather information from the article (e.g., add Vcard info to
9944 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e.g., automatically
9945 save all jpegs into some directory).
9946
9947 Here's an example function the does the latter:
9948
9949 @lisp
9950 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9951 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9952 (with-temp-buffer
9953 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9954 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9955 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9956 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9957 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
9958 @end lisp
9959
9960 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9961 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9962 Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
9963
9964 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9965 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9966 Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9967
9968 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9969 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9970 Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9971
9972 If displaying @samp{text/html} is discouraged, see
9973 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, images or other material inside a
9974 "multipart/related" part might be overlooked when this variable is
9975 @code{nil}. @ref{Display Customization, Display Customization, ,
9976 emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}.
9977
9978 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9979 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9980 Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
9981 overrides @code{nil} values of
9982 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9983 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
9984
9985 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9986 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9987 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9988 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
9989
9990 Ready-made functions include@*
9991 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9992 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9993 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9994 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9995 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9996 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9997 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9998 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9999 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
10000 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
10001 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
10002 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
10003
10004 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
10005 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
10006
10007 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
10008 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
10009 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
10010
10011 @lisp
10012 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
10013 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
10014 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
10015 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
10016 @end lisp
10017
10018 @noindent
10019 to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
10020
10021 @end table
10022
10023
10024 @node Charsets
10025 @section Charsets
10026 @cindex charsets
10027
10028 People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
10029 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
10030 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
10031 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
10032 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
10033 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
10034 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
10035
10036 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
10037 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
10038 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
10039 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
10040
10041 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
10042 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
10043 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
10044 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
10045 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
10046 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
10047 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
10048 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
10049 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
10050
10051 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
10052 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
10053 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
10054 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
10055 quoted-printable header encoding.
10056
10057 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
10058 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
10059 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
10060
10061 @table @var
10062 @item test
10063 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
10064 variable to query,
10065 @item header
10066 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
10067 means encode all charsets),
10068 @item body-list
10069 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
10070 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
10071 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
10072 @end table
10073
10074 @cindex Russian
10075 @cindex koi8-r
10076 @cindex koi8-u
10077 @cindex iso-8859-5
10078 @cindex coding system aliases
10079 @cindex preferred charset
10080
10081 @xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
10082 The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
10083 MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
10084
10085 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
10086
10087 If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
10088 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
10089
10090 @lisp
10091 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
10092 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
10093 @end lisp
10094
10095 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
10096 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
10097
10098 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
10099
10100 @lisp
10101 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
10102 @end lisp
10103
10104 This will almost do the right thing.
10105
10106 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
10107 something like
10108
10109 @lisp
10110 (codepage-setup 1251)
10111 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
10112 @end lisp
10113
10114
10115 @node Article Commands
10116 @section Article Commands
10117
10118 @table @kbd
10119
10120 @item A P
10121 @cindex PostScript
10122 @cindex printing
10123 @kindex A P (Summary)
10124 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
10125 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
10126 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
10127 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
10128 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
10129 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
10130
10131 @item A C
10132 @vindex gnus-fetch-partial-articles
10133 @findex gnus-summary-show-complete-article
10134 If @code{<backend>-fetch-partial-articles} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
10135 fetch partial articles, if the backend it fetches them from supports
10136 it. Currently only @code{nnimap} does. If you're looking at a
10137 partial article, and want to see the complete article instead, then
10138 the @kbd{A C} command (@code{gnus-summary-show-complete-article}) will
10139 do so.
10140
10141 @end table
10142
10143
10144 @node Summary Sorting
10145 @section Summary Sorting
10146 @cindex summary sorting
10147
10148 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
10149 can't really see why you'd want that.
10150
10151 @table @kbd
10152
10153 @item C-c C-s C-n
10154 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10155 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
10156 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
10157
10158 @item C-c C-s C-m C-n
10159 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10160 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number
10161 Sort by most recent article number
10162 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number}).
10163
10164 @item C-c C-s C-a
10165 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
10166 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
10167 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
10168
10169 @item C-c C-s C-t
10170 @kindex C-c C-s C-t (Summary)
10171 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient
10172 Sort by recipient (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient}).
10173
10174 @item C-c C-s C-s
10175 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
10176 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
10177 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
10178
10179 @item C-c C-s C-d
10180 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
10181 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
10182 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
10183
10184 @item C-c C-s C-m C-d
10185 @kindex C-c C-s C-m C-d (Summary)
10186 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date
10187 Sort by most recent date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date}).
10188
10189 @item C-c C-s C-l
10190 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
10191 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
10192 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
10193
10194 @item C-c C-s C-c
10195 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
10196 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
10197 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
10198
10199 @item C-c C-s C-i
10200 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
10201 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
10202 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
10203
10204 @item C-c C-s C-r
10205 @kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
10206 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
10207 Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
10208
10209 @item C-c C-s C-o
10210 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
10211 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
10212 Sort using the default sorting method
10213 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
10214 @end table
10215
10216 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
10217 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
10218 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
10219 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
10220 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
10221 Commands}).
10222
10223 If a prefix argument if given, the sort order is reversed.
10224
10225
10226 @node Finding the Parent
10227 @section Finding the Parent
10228 @cindex parent articles
10229 @cindex referring articles
10230
10231 @table @kbd
10232 @item ^
10233 @kindex ^ (Summary)
10234 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
10235 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
10236 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
10237 if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
10238 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
10239 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
10240 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
10241 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
10242 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
10243
10244 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
10245 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
10246 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
10247 grandparent and the great-grandparent of the current article. If you say
10248 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the great-grandparent of the current
10249 article.
10250
10251 @item A R (Summary)
10252 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
10253 @kindex A R (Summary)
10254 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
10255 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
10256
10257 @item A T (Summary)
10258 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
10259 @kindex A T (Summary)
10260 Display the full thread where the current article appears
10261 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
10262 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
10263 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
10264 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
10265 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
10266 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
10267
10268 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
10269 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i.e.,
10270 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
10271 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
10272 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
10273 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
10274
10275 @item M-^ (Summary)
10276 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
10277 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
10278 @cindex Message-ID
10279 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
10280 You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
10281 belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
10282 for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
10283 thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
10284 You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
10285
10286 Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
10287 been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
10288 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
10289 @end table
10290
10291 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
10292 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
10293 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
10294 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
10295 would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
10296 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
10297 necessary.
10298
10299 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
10300 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
10301 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
10302 match.
10303
10304 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
10305 then ask Google if that fails:
10306
10307 @lisp
10308 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
10309 '(current
10310 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
10311 @end lisp
10312
10313 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
10314 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
10315 @code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
10316 articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
10317 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
10318 group. @code{nnmh} does not support this at all.
10319
10320 Fortunately, the special @code{nnregistry} back end is able to locate
10321 articles in any groups, regardless of their back end (@pxref{Registry
10322 Article Refer Method, fetching by @code{Message-ID} using the
10323 registry}).
10324
10325 @node Alternative Approaches
10326 @section Alternative Approaches
10327
10328 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
10329 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
10330
10331 @menu
10332 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
10333 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
10334 @end menu
10335
10336
10337 @node Pick and Read
10338 @subsection Pick and Read
10339 @cindex pick and read
10340
10341 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
10342 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
10343 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
10344 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
10345
10346 @findex gnus-pick-mode
10347 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
10348 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
10349 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
10350 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
10351 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
10352
10353 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
10354
10355 @table @kbd
10356 @item .
10357 @kindex . (Pick)
10358 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
10359 Pick the article or thread on the current line
10360 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10361 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
10362 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
10363 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
10364 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
10365 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
10366
10367 @item SPACE
10368 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
10369 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
10370 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
10371 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
10372
10373 @item u
10374 @kindex u (Pick)
10375 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
10376 Unpick the thread or article
10377 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10378 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
10379 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
10380 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
10381 the thread or article at that line.
10382
10383 @item RET
10384 @kindex RET (Pick)
10385 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
10386 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
10387 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
10388 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
10389 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
10390 will still be visible when you are reading.
10391
10392 @end table
10393
10394 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
10395 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
10396 which is mapped to the same function
10397 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
10398
10399 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
10400
10401 @lisp
10402 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
10403 @end lisp
10404
10405 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
10406 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
10407
10408 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
10409 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
10410 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
10411
10412 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
10413 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
10414 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
10415 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
10416 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
10417 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
10418 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
10419
10420
10421 @node Binary Groups
10422 @subsection Binary Groups
10423 @cindex binary groups
10424
10425 @findex gnus-binary-mode
10426 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
10427 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
10428 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
10429 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
10430 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
10431 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
10432
10433 @kindex g (Binary)
10434 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
10435 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
10436 command, when you have turned on this mode
10437 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
10438
10439 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
10440 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
10441
10442
10443 @node Tree Display
10444 @section Tree Display
10445 @cindex trees
10446
10447 @vindex gnus-use-trees
10448 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
10449 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
10450 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
10451 in the tree buffer.
10452
10453 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
10454
10455 @table @code
10456 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
10457 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
10458 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
10459
10460 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10461 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10462 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
10463 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
10464 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
10465
10466 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
10467 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
10468 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
10469 default is @code{modeline}.
10470
10471 @item gnus-tree-line-format
10472 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
10473 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
10474 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
10475 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
10476 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
10477 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
10478
10479 Valid specs are:
10480
10481 @table @samp
10482 @item n
10483 The name of the poster.
10484 @item f
10485 The @code{From} header.
10486 @item N
10487 The number of the article.
10488 @item [
10489 The opening bracket.
10490 @item ]
10491 The closing bracket.
10492 @item s
10493 The subject.
10494 @end table
10495
10496 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
10497
10498 Variables related to the display are:
10499
10500 @table @code
10501 @item gnus-tree-brackets
10502 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
10503 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
10504 ``sparse'' articles. The format is
10505 @example
10506 ((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
10507 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
10508 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
10509 @end example
10510 and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
10511
10512 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10513 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10514 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
10515 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
10516
10517 @end table
10518
10519 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
10520 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
10521 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
10522 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
10523 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
10524 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
10525 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
10526 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
10527 other windows displayed next to it.
10528
10529 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
10530 at all times:
10531
10532 @lisp
10533 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
10534 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
10535 @end lisp
10536
10537 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
10538 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
10539 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10540 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
10541 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
10542 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
10543 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
10544
10545 @end table
10546
10547 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
10548
10549 @example
10550 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
10551 | \[Jan]
10552 | \[odd]-[Eri]
10553 | \(***)-[Eri]
10554 | \[odd]-[Paa]
10555 \[Bjo]
10556 \[Gun]
10557 \[Gun]-[Jor]
10558 @end example
10559
10560 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
10561
10562 @example
10563 @group
10564 @{***@}
10565 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
10566 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
10567 |--\-----\-----\ |
10568 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
10569 | | |--\
10570 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
10571 |
10572 [Paa]
10573 @end group
10574 @end example
10575
10576 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
10577 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
10578 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
10579
10580 @lisp
10581 (setq gnus-use-trees t
10582 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10583 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
10584 (gnus-add-configuration
10585 '(article
10586 (vertical 1.0
10587 (horizontal 0.25
10588 (summary 0.75 point)
10589 (tree 1.0))
10590 (article 1.0))))
10591 @end lisp
10592
10593 @xref{Window Layout}.
10594
10595
10596 @node Mail Group Commands
10597 @section Mail Group Commands
10598 @cindex mail group commands
10599
10600 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
10601 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
10602
10603 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
10604 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10605
10606 @table @kbd
10607
10608 @item B e
10609 @kindex B e (Summary)
10610 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
10611 @cindex expiring mail
10612 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
10613 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
10614 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
10615 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
10616
10617 @item B C-M-e
10618 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
10619 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
10620 @cindex expiring mail
10621 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
10622 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
10623 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
10624 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
10625
10626 @item B DEL
10627 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
10628 @cindex deleting mail
10629 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
10630 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
10631 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
10632 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
10633 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
10634
10635 @item B m
10636 @kindex B m (Summary)
10637 @cindex move mail
10638 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
10639 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
10640 Move the article from one mail group to another
10641 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10642 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10643
10644 @item B c
10645 @kindex B c (Summary)
10646 @cindex copy mail
10647 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
10648 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
10649 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
10650 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10651 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10652
10653 @item B B
10654 @kindex B B (Summary)
10655 @cindex crosspost mail
10656 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
10657 Crosspost the current article to some other group
10658 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
10659 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10660 be properly updated.
10661
10662 @item B i
10663 @kindex B i (Summary)
10664 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
10665 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10666 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10667 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10668
10669 @item B I
10670 @kindex B I (Summary)
10671 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
10672 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10673 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10674 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10675
10676 @item B r
10677 @kindex B r (Summary)
10678 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10679 @vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10680 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10681 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10682 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10683 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10684 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10685 (which is the default).
10686
10687 @item B w
10688 @itemx e
10689 @kindex B w (Summary)
10690 @kindex e (Summary)
10691 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10692 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10693 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10694 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10695 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10696 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10697 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
10698
10699 @item B q
10700 @kindex B q (Summary)
10701 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10702 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10703 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10704 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
10705
10706 @item B t
10707 @kindex B t (Summary)
10708 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10709 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10710 when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
10711
10712 @item B p
10713 @kindex B p (Summary)
10714 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10715 Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10716 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10717 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10718 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10719 article from your news server (or rather, from
10720 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10721 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10722 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10723 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10724 just not have arrived yet.
10725
10726 @item K E
10727 @kindex K E (Summary)
10728 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10729 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10730 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10731 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10732 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
10733
10734 @end table
10735
10736 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10737 @cindex moving articles
10738 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10739 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10740 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10741 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10742 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10743 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10744 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
10745
10746 @lisp
10747 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
10748 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10749 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10750 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
10751 @end lisp
10752
10753
10754 @node Various Summary Stuff
10755 @section Various Summary Stuff
10756
10757 @menu
10758 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10759 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10760 * Summary Generation Commands::
10761 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10762 @end menu
10763
10764 @table @code
10765 @vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10766 @item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10767 If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10768 built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10769 If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10770 lines. The default is @code{nil}.
10771
10772 @vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10773 @item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10774 If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10775 current article.
10776
10777 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10778 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10779 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
10780
10781 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10782 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10783 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10784 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10785 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10786 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10787 have been set.
10788
10789 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10790 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10791 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10792 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10793 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
10794
10795 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10796 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10797 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10798 generated.
10799
10800 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10801 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10802 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10803 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10804 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10805 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10806 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10807 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10808 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10809 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
10810
10811 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10812 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10813 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10814 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10815 list of articles to be selected.
10816
10817 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10818 the list in one particular group:
10819
10820 @lisp
10821 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10822 (if (string= group "some.group")
10823 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10824 articles))
10825 @end lisp
10826
10827 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10828 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10829 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10830 variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10831 values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10832 buffer is active.
10833
10834 Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10835 @code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10836 assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10837 that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10838 variable will be used instead.
10839
10840 These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10841 while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10842 buffers. For example:
10843
10844 @lisp
10845 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10846 '(message-use-followup-to
10847 (gnus-visible-headers .
10848 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
10849 @end lisp
10850
10851 Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
10852
10853 @end table
10854
10855
10856 @node Summary Group Information
10857 @subsection Summary Group Information
10858
10859 @table @kbd
10860
10861 @item H d
10862 @kindex H d (Summary)
10863 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10864 Give a brief description of the current group
10865 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10866 rereading the description from the server.
10867
10868 @item H h
10869 @kindex H h (Summary)
10870 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10871 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10872 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
10873
10874 @item H i
10875 @kindex H i (Summary)
10876 @findex gnus-info-find-node
10877 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
10878 @end table
10879
10880
10881 @node Searching for Articles
10882 @subsection Searching for Articles
10883
10884 @table @kbd
10885
10886 @item M-s
10887 @kindex M-s (Summary)
10888 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10889 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10890 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
10891
10892 @item M-r
10893 @kindex M-r (Summary)
10894 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10895 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10896 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
10897
10898 @item M-S
10899 @kindex M-S (Summary)
10900 @findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward
10901 Repeat the previous search forwards
10902 (@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward}).
10903
10904 @item M-R
10905 @kindex M-R (Summary)
10906 @findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward
10907 Repeat the previous search backwards
10908 (@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward}).
10909
10910 @item &
10911 @kindex & (Summary)
10912 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10913 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10914 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10915 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10916 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10917 search backward instead.
10918
10919 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10920 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
10921
10922 @item M-&
10923 @kindex M-& (Summary)
10924 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10925 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10926 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10927 @end table
10928
10929 @node Summary Generation Commands
10930 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
10931
10932 @table @kbd
10933
10934 @item Y g
10935 @kindex Y g (Summary)
10936 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
10937 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
10938
10939 @item Y c
10940 @kindex Y c (Summary)
10941 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10942 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10943 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
10944
10945 @item Y d
10946 @kindex Y d (Summary)
10947 @findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10948 Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10949 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
10950
10951 @item Y t
10952 @kindex Y t (Summary)
10953 @findex gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles
10954 Pull all ticked articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10955 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles}).
10956
10957 @end table
10958
10959
10960 @node Really Various Summary Commands
10961 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
10962
10963 @table @kbd
10964
10965 @item A D
10966 @itemx C-d
10967 @kindex C-d (Summary)
10968 @kindex A D (Summary)
10969 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10970 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10971 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10972 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10973 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10974 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10975 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10976 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10977 fashion.
10978
10979 @vindex gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit
10980 The variable @code{gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit} controls what
10981 article should be selected after exiting a digest group. Valid values
10982 include:
10983
10984 @table @code
10985 @item next
10986 Select the next article.
10987
10988 @item next-unread
10989 Select the next unread article.
10990
10991 @item next-noselect
10992 Move the cursor to the next article. This is the default.
10993
10994 @item next-unread-noselect
10995 Move the cursor to the next unread article.
10996 @end table
10997
10998 If it has any other value or there is no next (unread) article, the
10999 article selected before entering to the digest group will appear.
11000
11001 @item C-M-d
11002 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
11003 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
11004 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
11005 several documents into one biiig group
11006 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
11007 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
11008 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
11009 command understands the process/prefix convention
11010 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
11011
11012 @item C-t
11013 @kindex C-t (Summary)
11014 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
11015 Toggle truncation of summary lines
11016 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
11017 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
11018 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
11019
11020 @item =
11021 @kindex = (Summary)
11022 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
11023 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
11024 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
11025
11026 @item C-M-e
11027 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
11028 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
11029 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
11030 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
11031
11032 @item C-M-a
11033 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
11034 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
11035 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
11036 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
11037
11038 @end table
11039
11040
11041 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
11042 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
11043 @cindex summary exit
11044 @cindex exiting groups
11045
11046 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
11047 group and return you to the group buffer.
11048
11049 @table @kbd
11050
11051 @item Z Z
11052 @itemx Z Q
11053 @itemx q
11054 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
11055 @kindex Z Q (Summary)
11056 @kindex q (Summary)
11057 @findex gnus-summary-exit
11058 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
11059 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
11060 @vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
11061 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
11062 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
11063 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
11064 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
11065 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
11066 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
11067 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
11068 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
11069
11070 @item Z E
11071 @itemx Q
11072 @kindex Z E (Summary)
11073 @kindex Q (Summary)
11074 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
11075 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
11076 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
11077
11078 @item Z c
11079 @itemx c
11080 @kindex Z c (Summary)
11081 @kindex c (Summary)
11082 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
11083 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
11084 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
11085 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
11086
11087 @item Z C
11088 @kindex Z C (Summary)
11089 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
11090 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
11091 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
11092
11093 @item Z n
11094 @kindex Z n (Summary)
11095 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
11096 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
11097 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
11098
11099 @item Z p
11100 @kindex Z p (Summary)
11101 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group
11102 Mark all articles as read and go to the previous group
11103 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group}).
11104
11105 @item Z R
11106 @itemx C-x C-s
11107 @kindex Z R (Summary)
11108 @kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
11109 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
11110 Exit this group, and then enter it again
11111 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
11112 all articles, both read and unread.
11113
11114 @item Z G
11115 @itemx M-g
11116 @kindex Z G (Summary)
11117 @kindex M-g (Summary)
11118 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
11119 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
11120 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
11121 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
11122 articles, both read and unread.
11123
11124 @item Z N
11125 @kindex Z N (Summary)
11126 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
11127 Exit the group and go to the next group
11128 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
11129
11130 @item Z P
11131 @kindex Z P (Summary)
11132 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
11133 Exit the group and go to the previous group
11134 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
11135
11136 @item Z s
11137 @kindex Z s (Summary)
11138 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
11139 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
11140 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
11141 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
11142 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
11143 @end table
11144
11145 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
11146 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
11147 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
11148 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
11149
11150 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
11151 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
11152 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
11153 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
11154 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
11155 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
11156 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
11157 something like @file{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
11158 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
11159 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
11160 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
11161 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
11162
11163 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
11164
11165 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
11166 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
11167 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.)@: when you exit the
11168 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
11169 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
11170 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
11171 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
11172 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
11173 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
11174
11175
11176 @node Crosspost Handling
11177 @section Crosspost Handling
11178
11179 @cindex velveeta
11180 @cindex spamming
11181 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
11182 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
11183 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
11184 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
11185 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
11186 heinous crime.
11187
11188 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
11189 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
11190 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
11191 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
11192 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
11193
11194 @cindex cross-posting
11195 @cindex Xref
11196 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
11197 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
11198 correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
11199 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
11200 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
11201 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
11202 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
11203 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
11204 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
11205 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
11206 the cross reference mechanism.
11207
11208 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
11209 @cindex overview.fmt
11210 To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
11211 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
11212 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
11213 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
11214 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
11215 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
11216 overview files.
11217
11218 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
11219 set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
11220 considerably. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
11221
11222 C'est la vie.
11223
11224 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
11225
11226
11227 @node Duplicate Suppression
11228 @section Duplicate Suppression
11229
11230 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
11231 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
11232 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
11233 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
11234 reasons.
11235
11236 @enumerate
11237 @item
11238 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
11239 is evil and not very common.
11240
11241 @item
11242 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
11243 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
11244
11245 @item
11246 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
11247 different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
11248
11249 @item
11250 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
11251 @end enumerate
11252
11253 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
11254 well, but these four are the most common situations.
11255
11256 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
11257 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
11258 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
11259 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
11260 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
11261 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
11262 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
11263 once.
11264
11265 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
11266 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
11267 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
11268 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
11269 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
11270 saw the article in.
11271
11272 @table @code
11273 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
11274 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
11275 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
11276
11277 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
11278 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
11279 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
11280 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
11281 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
11282 session are suppressed.
11283
11284 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
11285 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
11286 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
11287 suppression list. The default is 10000.
11288
11289 @item gnus-duplicate-file
11290 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
11291 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
11292 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
11293 @end table
11294
11295 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
11296 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
11297 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
11298 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
11299 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
11300 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
11301 to you to figure out, I think.
11302
11303 @node Security
11304 @section Security
11305
11306 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
11307 The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
11308 and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
11309 things to work:
11310
11311 @enumerate
11312 @item
11313 To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
11314 install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG@. The Lisp interface
11315 to GnuPG included with Emacs is called EasyPG (@pxref{Top, ,EasyPG,
11316 epa, EasyPG Assistant user's manual}), but PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg,
11317 PGG Manual}), and Mailcrypt are also supported.
11318
11319 @item
11320 To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL@. OpenSSL 0.9.6
11321 or newer is recommended.
11322
11323 @end enumerate
11324
11325 The variables that control security functionality on reading/composing
11326 messages include:
11327
11328 @table @code
11329 @item mm-verify-option
11330 @vindex mm-verify-option
11331 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
11332 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
11333 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
11334
11335 @item mm-decrypt-option
11336 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
11337 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
11338 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
11339 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
11340
11341 @item mm-sign-option
11342 @vindex mm-sign-option
11343 Option of creating signed parts. @code{nil}, use default signing
11344 keys; @code{guided}, ask user to select signing keys from the menu.
11345
11346 @item mm-encrypt-option
11347 @vindex mm-encrypt-option
11348 Option of creating encrypted parts. @code{nil}, use the first
11349 public-key matching the @samp{From:} header as the recipient;
11350 @code{guided}, ask user to select recipient keys from the menu.
11351
11352 @item mml1991-use
11353 @vindex mml1991-use
11354 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11355 @acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but @code{pgg},
11356 and @code{mailcrypt} are also supported although
11357 deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available interface in
11358 this order.
11359
11360 @item mml2015-use
11361 @vindex mml2015-use
11362 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11363 @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but
11364 @code{pgg}, and @code{mailcrypt} are also supported
11365 although deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available
11366 interface in this order.
11367
11368 @end table
11369
11370 By default the buttons that display security information are not
11371 shown, because they clutter reading the actual e-mail. You can type
11372 @kbd{K b} manually to display the information. Use the
11373 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types} and
11374 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} variables to control this
11375 permanently. @ref{MIME Commands} for further details, and hints on
11376 how to customize these variables to always display security
11377 information.
11378
11379 @cindex snarfing keys
11380 @cindex importing PGP keys
11381 @cindex PGP key ring import
11382 Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
11383 key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
11384 rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
11385 allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
11386 through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
11387 @file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
11388 Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
11389 Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
11390 (@pxref{Using MIME}).
11391
11392 @example
11393 application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
11394 @end example
11395 @noindent
11396 This happens to also be the default action defined in
11397 @code{mailcap-mime-data}.
11398
11399 More information on how to set things for sending outgoing signed and
11400 encrypted messages up can be found in the message manual
11401 (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
11402
11403 @node Mailing List
11404 @section Mailing List
11405 @cindex mailing list
11406 @cindex RFC 2396
11407
11408 @kindex A M (summary)
11409 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
11410 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
11411 add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
11412 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
11413 summary buffer.
11414
11415 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
11416
11417 @table @kbd
11418
11419 @item C-c C-n h
11420 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
11421 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
11422 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
11423
11424 @item C-c C-n s
11425 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
11426 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
11427 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
11428
11429 @item C-c C-n u
11430 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
11431 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
11432 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
11433 field exists.
11434
11435 @item C-c C-n p
11436 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
11437 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
11438 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
11439
11440 @item C-c C-n o
11441 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
11442 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
11443 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
11444
11445 @item C-c C-n a
11446 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
11447 @findex gnus-mailing-list-archive
11448 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
11449
11450 @end table
11451
11452
11453 @node Article Buffer
11454 @chapter Article Buffer
11455 @cindex article buffer
11456
11457 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
11458 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
11459 tell Gnus otherwise.
11460
11461 @menu
11462 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
11463 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
11464 * HTML:: Reading @acronym{HTML} messages.
11465 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
11466 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
11467 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
11468 @end menu
11469
11470
11471 @node Hiding Headers
11472 @section Hiding Headers
11473 @cindex hiding headers
11474 @cindex deleting headers
11475
11476 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
11477 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
11478
11479 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
11480 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
11481 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
11482 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
11483 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
11484 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
11485 @code{References}, etc.@: ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
11486 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
11487 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
11488
11489 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
11490
11491 @table @code
11492
11493 @item gnus-visible-headers
11494 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
11495 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
11496 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
11497 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
11498
11499 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
11500 the article and the subject, you'd say:
11501
11502 @lisp
11503 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
11504 @end lisp
11505
11506 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11507 remain visible.
11508
11509 @item gnus-ignored-headers
11510 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
11511 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
11512 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
11513 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
11514 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
11515
11516 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
11517 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
11518
11519 @lisp
11520 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
11521 @end lisp
11522
11523 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11524 be removed.
11525
11526 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
11527 variable will have no effect.
11528
11529 @end table
11530
11531 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
11532 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
11533 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
11534 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
11535 the headers are to be displayed.
11536
11537 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
11538 and then the subject, you might say something like:
11539
11540 @lisp
11541 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
11542 @end lisp
11543
11544 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
11545 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
11546
11547 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
11548 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
11549 You can hide further boring headers by setting
11550 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
11551 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
11552 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
11553 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
11554 from sight.
11555
11556 These conditions are:
11557 @table @code
11558 @item empty
11559 Remove all empty headers.
11560 @item followup-to
11561 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
11562 @code{Newsgroups} header.
11563 @item reply-to
11564 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
11565 the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
11566 parameter is set.
11567 @item newsgroups
11568 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
11569 name.
11570 @item to-address
11571 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11572 the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
11573 @item to-list
11574 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11575 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11576 @item cc-list
11577 Remove the @code{Cc} header if it only contains the address identical to
11578 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11579 @item date
11580 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
11581 old.
11582 @item long-to
11583 Remove the @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} header if it is very long.
11584 @item many-to
11585 Remove all @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} headers if there are more than one.
11586 @end table
11587
11588 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
11589
11590 @lisp
11591 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
11592 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
11593 @end lisp
11594
11595 This is also the default value for this variable.
11596
11597
11598 @node Using MIME
11599 @section Using MIME
11600 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11601
11602 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
11603 while people stand around yawning.
11604
11605 @acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
11606 while all newsreaders die of fear.
11607
11608 @acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
11609 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
11610 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
11611
11612 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
11613 @findex gnus-display-mime
11614 Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
11615 to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
11616 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
11617 display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
11618
11619 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
11620 @acronym{MIME} button:
11621
11622 @table @kbd
11623 @findex gnus-article-press-button
11624 @item RET (Article)
11625 @kindex RET (Article)
11626 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
11627 Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
11628 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
11629 the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
11630 files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
11631 object is displayed inline.
11632
11633 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
11634 @item M-RET (Article)
11635 @kindex M-RET (Article)
11636 @itemx v (Article)
11637 Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11638 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
11639
11640 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
11641 @item t (Article)
11642 @kindex t (Article)
11643 View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
11644 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
11645
11646 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
11647 @item C (Article)
11648 @kindex C (Article)
11649 Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11650 charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
11651
11652 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
11653 @item o (Article)
11654 @kindex o (Article)
11655 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
11656 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
11657
11658 @findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
11659 @item C-o (Article)
11660 @kindex C-o (Article)
11661 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
11662 the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
11663 suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
11664 like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
11665 message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
11666 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
11667
11668 @findex gnus-mime-replace-part
11669 @item r (Article)
11670 @kindex r (Article)
11671 Prompt for a file name, replace the @acronym{MIME} object with an
11672 external body referring to the file via the message/external-body
11673 @acronym{MIME} type. (@code{gnus-mime-replace-part}).
11674
11675 @findex gnus-mime-delete-part
11676 @item d (Article)
11677 @kindex d (Article)
11678 Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
11679 information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
11680 (@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
11681
11682 @c FIXME: gnus-auto-select-part should be documented here
11683
11684 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
11685 @item c (Article)
11686 @kindex c (Article)
11687 Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
11688 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). If given a prefix, copy the raw contents
11689 without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual
11690 charset stuff (see @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in
11691 @ref{Paging the Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
11692 @file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
11693 @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
11694 Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11695
11696 @findex gnus-mime-print-part
11697 @item p (Article)
11698 @kindex p (Article)
11699 Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
11700 command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
11701 @file{.mailcap} file.
11702
11703 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
11704 @item i (Article)
11705 @kindex i (Article)
11706 Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
11707 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as @samp{text/plain}. If given a prefix, insert
11708 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
11709 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
11710 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
11711 Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and @file{.bz2} are
11712 automatically decompressed depending on @code{jka-compr} regardless of
11713 @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed Files,, Accessing
11714 Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11715
11716 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
11717 @item E (Article)
11718 @kindex E (Article)
11719 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
11720 viewer is available, use an external viewer
11721 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
11722
11723 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
11724 @item e (Article)
11725 @kindex e (Article)
11726 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
11727 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
11728
11729 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
11730 @item | (Article)
11731 @kindex | (Article)
11732 Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
11733
11734 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
11735 @item . (Article)
11736 @kindex . (Article)
11737 Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11738 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
11739
11740 @end table
11741
11742 Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11743 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11744 @acronym{MIME} manual.
11745
11746 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11747 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11748 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11749 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11750 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11751 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11752 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11753 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11754 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
11755
11756 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
11757
11758 Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
11759
11760
11761 @node HTML
11762 @section @acronym{HTML}
11763 @cindex @acronym{HTML}
11764
11765 Gnus can display @acronym{HTML} articles nicely formatted in the
11766 article buffer. There are many methods for doing that, but two of
11767 them are kind of default methods.
11768
11769 If your Emacs copy has been built with libxml2 support, then Gnus uses
11770 Emacs' built-in, plain elisp Simple HTML Renderer @code{shr}
11771 @footnote{@code{shr} displays colors as declared in the @acronym{HTML}
11772 article but tries to adjust them in order to be readable. If you
11773 prefer more contrast, @xref{FAQ 4-16}.} which is also used by Emacs'
11774 browser EWW (@pxref{EWW, ,EWW, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
11775
11776 If your Emacs copy lacks libxml2 support but you have @code{w3m}
11777 installed on your system, Gnus uses that to render @acronym{HTML} mail
11778 and display the results in the article buffer (@code{gnus-w3m}).
11779
11780 For a complete overview, consult @xref{Display Customization, ,Display
11781 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. This section only
11782 describes the default method.
11783
11784 @table @code
11785 @item mm-text-html-renderer
11786 @vindex mm-text-html-renderer
11787 If set to @code{shr}, Gnus uses its own simple @acronym{HTML}
11788 renderer. If set to @code{gnus-w3m}, it uses @code{w3m}.
11789
11790 @item gnus-blocked-images
11791 @vindex gnus-blocked-images
11792 External images that have @acronym{URL}s that match this regexp won't
11793 be fetched and displayed. For instance, to block all @acronym{URL}s
11794 that have the string ``ads'' in them, do the following:
11795
11796 @lisp
11797 (setq gnus-blocked-images "ads")
11798 @end lisp
11799
11800 This can also be a function to be evaluated. If so, it will be
11801 called with the group name as the parameter. The default value is
11802 @code{gnus-block-private-groups}, which will return @samp{"."} for
11803 anything that isn't a newsgroup. This means that no external images
11804 will be fetched as a result of reading mail, so that nobody can use
11805 web bugs (and the like) to track whether you've read email.
11806
11807 Also @pxref{Misc Article} for @code{gnus-inhibit-images}.
11808
11809 @item gnus-html-cache-directory
11810 @vindex gnus-html-cache-directory
11811 Gnus will download and cache images according to how
11812 @code{gnus-blocked-images} is set. These images will be stored in
11813 this directory.
11814
11815 @item gnus-html-cache-size
11816 @vindex gnus-html-cache-size
11817 When @code{gnus-html-cache-size} bytes have been used in that
11818 directory, the oldest files will be deleted. The default is 500MB.
11819
11820 @item gnus-html-frame-width
11821 @vindex gnus-html-frame-width
11822 The width to use when rendering HTML@. The default is 70.
11823
11824 @item gnus-max-image-proportion
11825 @vindex gnus-max-image-proportion
11826 How big pictures displayed are in relation to the window they're in.
11827 A value of 0.7 (the default) means that they are allowed to take up
11828 70% of the width and height of the window. If they are larger than
11829 this, and Emacs supports it, then the images will be rescaled down to
11830 fit these criteria.
11831
11832 @item gnus-article-show-cursor
11833 @vindex gnus-article-show-cursor
11834 If non-@code{nil}, display the cursor in the article buffer even when
11835 the article buffer isn't the current buffer.
11836 @end table
11837
11838 To use this, make sure that you have @code{w3m} and @code{curl}
11839 installed. If you have, then Gnus should display @acronym{HTML}
11840 automatically.
11841
11842
11843
11844 @node Customizing Articles
11845 @section Customizing Articles
11846 @cindex article customization
11847
11848 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11849 exist. You can call these functions interactively
11850 (@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11851 called automatically when you select the articles.
11852
11853 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11854 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11855 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11856 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
11857
11858 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11859 for sensible values.
11860
11861 @enumerate
11862 @item
11863 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
11864
11865 @item
11866 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
11867
11868 @item
11869 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
11870
11871 @item
11872 @code{first}: Do this treatment on the first body part.
11873
11874 @item
11875 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last body part.
11876
11877 @item
11878 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11879 than this number.
11880
11881 @item
11882 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11883 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11884 regexps in the list.
11885
11886 @item
11887 A list where the first element is not a string:
11888
11889 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11890 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11891 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
11892
11893 @lisp
11894 (or last
11895 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11896 @end lisp
11897
11898 @item
11899 A function: the function is called with no arguments and should return
11900 @code{nil} or non-@code{nil}. The current article is available in the
11901 buffer named by @code{gnus-article-buffer}.
11902
11903 @end enumerate
11904
11905 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11906 to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11907 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11908 considered to contain just a single part.
11909
11910 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11911 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11912 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11913 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11914 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11915 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11916 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
11917
11918 @ifinfo
11919 @c Avoid sort of redundant entries in the same section for the printed
11920 @c manual, but add them in info to allow 'i gnus-treat-foo-bar RET' or
11921 @c 'i foo-bar'.
11922 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize
11923 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize-head
11924 @vindex gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences
11925 @vindex gnus-treat-overstrike
11926 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-cr
11927 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body
11928 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines
11929 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines
11930 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-pem
11931 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines
11932 @vindex gnus-treat-unsplit-urls
11933 @vindex gnus-treat-wash-html
11934 @vindex gnus-treat-date
11935 @vindex gnus-treat-from-picon
11936 @vindex gnus-treat-mail-picon
11937 @vindex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
11938 @vindex gnus-treat-from-gravatar
11939 @vindex gnus-treat-mail-gravatar
11940 @vindex gnus-treat-display-smileys
11941 @vindex gnus-treat-body-boundary
11942 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11943 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
11944 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
11945 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
11946 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
11947 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
11948 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
11949 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
11950 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
11951 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
11952 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
11953 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
11954 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
11955 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
11956 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
11957 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
11958 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
11959 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
11960 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
11961 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
11962 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
11963 @end ifinfo
11964
11965 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11966 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11967 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11968 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
11969
11970 @table @code
11971 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11972 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
11973
11974 @xref{Article Buttons}.
11975
11976 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11977 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11978 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11979 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11980 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, first, integer)
11981 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11982 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11983 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11984 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11985 @item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
11986
11987 @xref{Article Washing}.
11988
11989 @item gnus-treat-date (head)
11990
11991 This will transform/add date headers according to the
11992 @code{gnus-article-date-headers} variable. This is a list of Date
11993 headers to display. The formats available are:
11994
11995 @table @code
11996 @item ut
11997 Universal time, aka GMT, aka ZULU.
11998
11999 @item local
12000 The user's local time zone.
12001
12002 @item english
12003 A semi-readable English sentence.
12004
12005 @item lapsed
12006 The time elapsed since the message was posted.
12007
12008 @item combined-lapsed
12009 Both the original date header and a (shortened) elapsed time.
12010
12011 @item original
12012 The original date header.
12013
12014 @item iso8601
12015 ISO8601 format, i.e., ``2010-11-23T22:05:21''.
12016
12017 @item user-defined
12018 A format done according to the @code{gnus-article-time-format}
12019 variable.
12020
12021 @end table
12022
12023 @xref{Article Date}.
12024
12025 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
12026 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
12027 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
12028
12029 @xref{Picons}.
12030
12031 @item gnus-treat-from-gravatar (head)
12032 @item gnus-treat-mail-gravatar (head)
12033
12034 @xref{Gravatars}.
12035
12036 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
12037
12038 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
12039
12040 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
12041 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
12042 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
12043
12044 @xref{Smileys}.
12045
12046 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
12047 @item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
12048
12049 @xref{X-Face}.
12050
12051 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
12052 @item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
12053
12054 @xref{Face}.
12055
12056 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
12057 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
12058 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
12059 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
12060 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
12061 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
12062 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
12063 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
12064 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
12065 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
12066 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
12067 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
12068 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
12069 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
12070 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
12071 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
12072 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
12073 @item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
12074 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
12075 @item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
12076
12077 @xref{Article Hiding}.
12078
12079 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
12080 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
12081 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
12082 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
12083 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
12084 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
12085
12086 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
12087
12088 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
12089 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
12090 @item gnus-treat-ansi-sequences (t)
12091 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
12092 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
12093
12094 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
12095 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
12096 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
12097 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
12098 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
12099 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
12100 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
12101 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
12102
12103 @xref{Article Header}.
12104
12105
12106 @end table
12107
12108 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
12109 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
12110 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
12111 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
12112 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
12113 everything.
12114
12115
12116 @node Article Keymap
12117 @section Article Keymap
12118
12119 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
12120 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
12121 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
12122 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
12123 buffer.
12124
12125 @kindex v (Article)
12126 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Article)
12127 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
12128 command or better use it as a prefix key.
12129
12130 A few additional keystrokes are available:
12131
12132 @table @kbd
12133
12134 @item SPACE
12135 @kindex SPACE (Article)
12136 @findex gnus-article-next-page
12137 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
12138 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
12139
12140 @item DEL
12141 @kindex DEL (Article)
12142 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
12143 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
12144 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
12145
12146 @item C-c ^
12147 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
12148 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
12149 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
12150 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
12151 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
12152
12153 @item C-c C-m
12154 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
12155 @findex gnus-article-mail
12156 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
12157 given a prefix, include the mail.
12158
12159 @item s
12160 @kindex s (Article)
12161 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
12162 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
12163 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
12164
12165 @item ?
12166 @kindex ? (Article)
12167 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
12168 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
12169 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
12170
12171 @item TAB
12172 @kindex TAB (Article)
12173 @findex gnus-article-next-button
12174 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
12175 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
12176
12177 @item M-TAB
12178 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
12179 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
12180 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
12181
12182 @item R
12183 @kindex R (Article)
12184 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
12185 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
12186 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If the region is active,
12187 only yank the text in the region.
12188
12189 @item S W
12190 @kindex S W (Article)
12191 @findex gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original
12192 Send a wide reply to the current article and yank the current article
12193 (@code{gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original}). If the region is
12194 active, only yank the text in the region.
12195
12196 @item F
12197 @kindex F (Article)
12198 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
12199 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
12200 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If the region is active,
12201 only yank the text in the region.
12202
12203
12204 @end table
12205
12206
12207 @node Misc Article
12208 @section Misc Article
12209
12210 @table @code
12211
12212 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
12213 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
12214 @cindex article buffers, several
12215 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
12216 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
12217 article buffer.
12218
12219 @item gnus-widen-article-window
12220 @cindex gnus-widen-article-window
12221 If non-@code{nil}, selecting the article buffer with the @kbd{h}
12222 command will ``widen'' the article window to take the entire frame.
12223
12224 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
12225 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
12226 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
12227 Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
12228 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
12229
12230 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
12231 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
12232 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
12233 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
12234 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
12235 the contents of the article buffer.
12236
12237 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
12238 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
12239 Hook called in article mode buffers.
12240
12241 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12242 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12243 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
12244 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
12245
12246 @vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
12247 @item gnus-article-over-scroll
12248 If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
12249 no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
12250
12251 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
12252 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
12253 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
12254 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
12255 Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
12256 with two extensions:
12257
12258 @table @samp
12259
12260 @item w
12261 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
12262 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
12263 performed. The characters and their meaning:
12264
12265 @table @samp
12266
12267 @item c
12268 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
12269
12270 @item h
12271 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
12272
12273 @item p
12274 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
12275 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
12276 security status, i.e., good or bad signature.)
12277
12278 @item s
12279 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
12280
12281 @item o
12282 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
12283
12284 @item e
12285 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasized strings in the article buffer.
12286
12287 @end table
12288
12289 @item m
12290 The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
12291
12292 @end table
12293
12294 @vindex gnus-break-pages
12295
12296 @item gnus-break-pages
12297 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
12298 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
12299 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
12300 paging will not be done.
12301
12302 @item gnus-page-delimiter
12303 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
12304 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
12305 (formfeed).
12306
12307 @cindex IDNA
12308 @cindex internationalized domain names
12309 @vindex gnus-use-idna
12310 @item gnus-use-idna
12311 This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
12312 internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
12313 @samp{Cc} headers. @xref{IDNA, ,IDNA,message, The Message Manual},
12314 for how to compose such messages. This requires
12315 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
12316 variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
12317
12318 @vindex gnus-inhibit-images
12319 @item gnus-inhibit-images
12320 If this is non-@code{nil}, inhibit displaying of images inline in the
12321 article body. It is effective to images that are in articles as
12322 @acronym{MIME} parts, and images in @acronym{HTML} articles rendered
12323 when @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization,
12324 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) is
12325 @code{shr} or @code{gnus-w3m}.
12326
12327 @end table
12328
12329
12330 @node Composing Messages
12331 @chapter Composing Messages
12332 @cindex composing messages
12333 @cindex messages
12334 @cindex mail
12335 @cindex sending mail
12336 @cindex reply
12337 @cindex followup
12338 @cindex post
12339 @cindex using gpg
12340 @cindex using s/mime
12341 @cindex using smime
12342
12343 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
12344 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
12345 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
12346 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
12347 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
12348 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
12349
12350 @menu
12351 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
12352 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
12353 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
12354 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
12355 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
12356 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
12357 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
12358 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
12359 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
12360 @end menu
12361
12362 Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
12363 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
12364
12365
12366 @node Mail
12367 @section Mail
12368
12369 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
12370
12371 @table @code
12372 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
12373 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
12374 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
12375 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
12376 @code{nil} include all headers.
12377
12378 @item gnus-add-to-list
12379 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
12380 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
12381 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
12382
12383 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12384 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12385 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
12386 about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
12387 interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
12388 receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
12389 non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
12390 matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
12391
12392 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
12393 press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
12394
12395 @item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12396 @vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12397 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
12398 @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
12399 useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
12400
12401 @end table
12402
12403
12404 @node Posting Server
12405 @section Posting Server
12406
12407 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
12408 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
12409
12410 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
12411
12412 It can be quite complicated.
12413
12414 @vindex gnus-post-method
12415 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
12416 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
12417 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
12418 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
12419 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
12420 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
12421 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
12422 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
12423 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
12424
12425 @lisp
12426 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
12427 @end lisp
12428
12429 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
12430 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
12431 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
12432 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
12433
12434 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
12435 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
12436
12437 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
12438 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
12439 for posting.
12440
12441 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
12442 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
12443
12444 @vindex message-send-mail-function
12445 When sending mail, Message invokes the function specified by the
12446 variable @code{message-send-mail-function}. Gnus tries to set it to a
12447 value suitable for your system.
12448 @xref{Mail Variables, ,Mail Variables,message,Message manual}, for more
12449 information.
12450
12451
12452 @node POP before SMTP
12453 @section POP before SMTP
12454 @cindex pop before smtp
12455 @findex mail-source-touch-pop
12456
12457 Does your @acronym{ISP} use @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
12458 authentication? This authentication method simply requires you to
12459 contact the @acronym{POP} server before sending email. To do that,
12460 put the following lines in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
12461
12462 @lisp
12463 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
12464 @end lisp
12465
12466 @noindent
12467 The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function does @acronym{POP}
12468 authentication according to the value of @code{mail-sources} without
12469 fetching mails, just before sending a mail. @xref{Mail Sources}.
12470
12471 If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
12472 @code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
12473 @code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
12474 used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
12475 is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
12476 mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
12477
12478 @lisp
12479 (setq mail-source-primary-source
12480 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12481 :password "secret"))
12482 @end lisp
12483
12484 @noindent
12485 Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
12486 @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
12487
12488 @lisp
12489 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
12490 (lambda ()
12491 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
12492 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12493 :password "secret")))
12494 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
12495 @end lisp
12496
12497
12498 @node Mail and Post
12499 @section Mail and Post
12500
12501 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
12502 posting:
12503
12504 @table @code
12505 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
12506 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
12507 @cindex mailing lists
12508
12509 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
12510 gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
12511 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
12512 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
12513 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
12514 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
12515 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
12516 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
12517 still a pain, though.
12518
12519 @item gnus-user-agent
12520 @vindex gnus-user-agent
12521 @cindex User-Agent
12522
12523 This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
12524 User-Agent header. It can be a list of symbols or a string. Valid
12525 symbols are @code{gnus} (show Gnus version) and @code{emacs} (show Emacs
12526 version). In addition to the Emacs version, you can add @code{codename}
12527 (show (S)XEmacs codename) or either @code{config} (show system
12528 configuration) or @code{type} (show system type). If you set it to a
12529 string, be sure to use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
12530
12531 @end table
12532
12533 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
12534 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
12535 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
12536
12537 @cindex ispell
12538 @findex ispell-message
12539 @lisp
12540 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
12541 @end lisp
12542
12543 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
12544 you're in, you could say something like the following:
12545
12546 @lisp
12547 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
12548 (lambda ()
12549 (cond
12550 ((string-match
12551 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
12552 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
12553 (t
12554 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
12555 @end lisp
12556
12557 Modify to suit your needs.
12558
12559 @vindex gnus-message-highlight-citation
12560 If @code{gnus-message-highlight-citation} is @code{t}, different levels of
12561 citations are highlighted like in Gnus article buffers also in message
12562 mode buffers.
12563
12564 @node Archived Messages
12565 @section Archived Messages
12566 @cindex archived messages
12567 @cindex sent messages
12568
12569 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
12570 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
12571 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
12572 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}. The
12573 default is @code{"sent.%Y-%m"}, which gives you one archive group per month.
12574
12575 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
12576 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
12577 Group Commands}).
12578
12579 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
12580 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
12581 use to store sent messages. The default is @code{"archive"}, and when
12582 actually being used it is expanded into:
12583
12584 @lisp
12585 (nnfolder "archive"
12586 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
12587 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
12588 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
12589 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
12590 @end lisp
12591
12592 @quotation
12593 @vindex gnus-update-message-archive-method
12594 Note: a server like this is saved in the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file first
12595 so that it may be used as a real method of the server which is named
12596 @code{"archive"} (that is, for the case where
12597 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} is set to @code{"archive"}) ever
12598 since. If it once has been saved, it will never be updated by default
12599 even if you change the value of @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12600 afterward. Therefore, the server @code{"archive"} doesn't necessarily
12601 mean the @code{nnfolder} server like this at all times. If you want the
12602 saved method to reflect always the value of
12603 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, set the
12604 @code{gnus-update-message-archive-method} variable to a non-@code{nil}
12605 value. The default value of this variable is @code{nil}.
12606 @end quotation
12607
12608 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
12609 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
12610 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
12611 directory chosen, you could say something like:
12612
12613 @lisp
12614 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
12615 '(nnfolder "archive"
12616 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
12617 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
12618 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
12619 @end lisp
12620
12621 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
12622 @cindex Gcc
12623 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
12624 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
12625 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
12626
12627 This variable can be used to do the following:
12628
12629 @table @asis
12630 @item a string
12631 Messages will be saved in that group.
12632
12633 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
12634 message will not be stored in the select method given by
12635 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
12636 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12637 has the default value shown above. Then setting
12638 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
12639 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
12640 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
12641 @samp{nnml:foo}.
12642
12643 @item a list of strings
12644 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
12645
12646 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
12647 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
12648
12649 @item @code{nil}
12650 No message archiving will take place.
12651 @end table
12652
12653 Let's illustrate:
12654
12655 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
12656 @lisp
12657 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
12658 @end lisp
12659
12660 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
12661 @lisp
12662 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
12663 @end lisp
12664
12665 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
12666 @lisp
12667 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12668 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
12669 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
12670 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
12671 @end lisp
12672
12673 More complex stuff:
12674 @lisp
12675 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12676 '((if (message-news-p)
12677 "misc-news"
12678 "misc-mail")))
12679 @end lisp
12680
12681 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
12682 messages in one file per month:
12683
12684 @lisp
12685 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12686 '((if (message-news-p)
12687 "misc-news"
12688 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
12689 @end lisp
12690
12691 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
12692 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
12693 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
12694 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
12695 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
12696 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
12697 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
12698 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
12699 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
12700 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
12701
12702 @table @code
12703 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12704 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12705 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
12706
12707 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12708 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12709 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
12710 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
12711 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
12712 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
12713 changed in the future.
12714
12715 @item gnus-gcc-self-resent-messages
12716 @vindex gnus-gcc-self-resent-messages
12717 Like the @code{gcc-self} group parameter, applied only for unmodified
12718 messages that @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} (@pxref{Summary Mail
12719 Commands}) resends. Non-@code{nil} value of this variable takes
12720 precedence over any existing @code{Gcc} header.
12721
12722 If this is @code{none}, no @code{Gcc} copy will be made. If this is
12723 @code{t}, messages resent will be @code{Gcc} copied to the current
12724 group. If this is a string, it specifies a group to which resent
12725 messages will be @code{Gcc} copied. If this is @code{nil}, @code{Gcc}
12726 will be done according to existing @code{Gcc} header(s), if any. If
12727 this is @code{no-gcc-self}, that is the default, resent messages will be
12728 @code{Gcc} copied to groups that existing @code{Gcc} header specifies,
12729 except for the current group.
12730
12731 @item gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook
12732 @vindex gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook
12733 @itemx gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook
12734 @vindex gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook
12735
12736 These hooks are run before/after encoding the message body of the Gcc
12737 copy of a sent message. The current buffer (when the hook is run)
12738 contains the message including the message header. Changes made to
12739 the message will only affect the Gcc copy, but not the original
12740 message. You can use these hooks to edit the copy (and influence
12741 subsequent transformations), e.g., remove MML secure tags
12742 (@pxref{Signing and encrypting}).
12743
12744 @end table
12745
12746
12747 @node Posting Styles
12748 @section Posting Styles
12749 @cindex posting styles
12750 @cindex styles
12751
12752 All them variables, they make my head swim.
12753
12754 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
12755 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
12756 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
12757 on?
12758
12759 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
12760 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
12761 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
12762 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
12763 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
12764 variable:
12765
12766 @lisp
12767 ((".*"
12768 (signature "Peace and happiness")
12769 (organization "What me?"))
12770 ("^comp"
12771 (signature "Death to everybody"))
12772 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
12773 (organization "Emacs is it")))
12774 @end lisp
12775
12776 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
12777 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
12778 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
12779 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
12780 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
12781 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
12782 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
12783 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
12784
12785 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
12786 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
12787 If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
12788 will look in the original article for a header whose name is
12789 @var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
12790 @var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
12791 replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
12792 followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
12793 @code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
12794 no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
12795 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
12796 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
12797 said to @dfn{match}.
12798
12799 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
12800 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
12801 addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
12802 form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
12803 @code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
12804 contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
12805 @var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
12806 name can be one of:
12807
12808 @itemize @bullet
12809 @item @code{signature}
12810 @item @code{signature-file}
12811 @item @code{x-face-file}
12812 @item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
12813 @item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
12814 @item @code{body}
12815 @end itemize
12816
12817 Note that the @code{signature-file} attribute honors the variable
12818 @code{message-signature-directory}.
12819
12820 The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
12821 this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
12822 the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
12823 name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
12824 is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
12825
12826 The attribute value can be a string, a function with zero arguments
12827 (the return value will be used), a variable (its value will be used)
12828 or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value will be
12829 used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
12830 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current
12831 article are available through the @code{message-reply-headers}
12832 variable, which is a vector of the following headers: number subject
12833 from date id references chars lines xref extra.
12834
12835 In the case of a string value, if the @code{match} is a regular
12836 expression, or if it takes the form @code{(header @var{match}
12837 @var{regexp})}, a @samp{gnus-match-substitute-replacement} is proceed
12838 on the value to replace the positional parameters @samp{\@var{n}} by
12839 the corresponding parenthetical matches (see @xref{Replacing Match,,
12840 Replacing the Text that Matched, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference
12841 Manual}.)
12842
12843 @vindex message-reply-headers
12844
12845 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
12846 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
12847 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
12848
12849 @findex message-mail-p
12850 @findex message-news-p
12851
12852 So here's a new example:
12853
12854 @lisp
12855 (setq gnus-posting-styles
12856 '((".*"
12857 (signature-file "~/.signature")
12858 (name "User Name")
12859 (x-face-file "~/.xface")
12860 (x-url (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
12861 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
12862 ("^rec.humor"
12863 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
12864 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
12865 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
12866 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
12867 (signature my-news-signature))
12868 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
12869 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
12870 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
12871 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
12872 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
12873 ;; @r{Reply to a message from the same subaddress the message}
12874 ;; @r{was sent to.}
12875 ((header "x-original-to" "me\\(\\+.+\\)@@example.org")
12876 (address "me\\1@@example.org"))
12877 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
12878 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
12879 (address "user@@bar.foo")
12880 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
12881 ("X-Message-SMTP-Method" "smtp smtp.example.org 587")
12882 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
12883 ("nnml:.*"
12884 (From (with-current-buffer gnus-article-buffer
12885 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
12886 ("^nn.+:"
12887 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
12888 @end lisp
12889
12890 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
12891 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
12892 if you fill many roles.
12893 You may also use @code{message-alternative-emails} instead.
12894 @xref{Message Headers, ,Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
12895
12896 Of particular interest in the ``work-mail'' style is the
12897 @samp{X-Message-SMTP-Method} header. It specifies how to send the
12898 outgoing email. You may want to sent certain emails through certain
12899 @acronym{SMTP} servers due to company policies, for instance.
12900 @xref{Mail Variables, ,Message Variables, message, Message Manual}.
12901
12902
12903 @node Drafts
12904 @section Drafts
12905 @cindex drafts
12906
12907 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
12908 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
12909 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
12910 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
12911 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
12912
12913 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
12914 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
12915 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
12916 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
12917 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
12918 group.)
12919
12920 @cindex nndraft
12921 @vindex nndraft-directory
12922 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
12923 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
12924 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
12925 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
12926 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
12927 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
12928
12929 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
12930 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
12931 unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
12932 a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
12933 behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
12934 be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
12935 simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
12936 Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
12937 correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
12938
12939 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
12940 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
12941 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
12942 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
12943 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
12944 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
12945 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
12946 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
12947 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
12948 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
12949 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
12950 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
12951 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
12952 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
12953 @c
12954 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
12955 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
12956 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
12957
12958 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
12959 @kindex D e (Draft)
12960 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
12961 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
12962 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
12963
12964 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
12965 Articles}).
12966
12967 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
12968 @kindex D s (Draft)
12969 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
12970 @kindex D S (Draft)
12971 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
12972 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
12973 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
12974 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
12975 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
12976 in the buffer.
12977
12978 @findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
12979 @kindex D t (Draft)
12980 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
12981 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
12982 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
12983
12984 Finally, if you want to delete a draft, use the normal @kbd{B DEL}
12985 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
12986
12987
12988 @node Rejected Articles
12989 @section Rejected Articles
12990 @cindex rejected articles
12991
12992 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12993 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12994 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12995 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
12996
12997 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12998 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12999 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
13000 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
13001 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
13002
13003 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
13004 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
13005 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
13006
13007 @node Signing and encrypting
13008 @section Signing and encrypting
13009 @cindex using gpg
13010 @cindex using s/mime
13011 @cindex using smime
13012
13013 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
13014 @acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
13015 decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
13016 @code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
13017
13018 @vindex gnus-message-replysign
13019 @vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
13020 @vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
13021 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
13022 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
13023 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
13024 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
13025 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
13026 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
13027 automatically encrypted messages.
13028
13029 Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
13030 @acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
13031 signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
13032
13033 @table @kbd
13034
13035 @item C-c C-m s s
13036 @kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
13037 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
13038
13039 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
13040
13041 @item C-c C-m s o
13042 @kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
13043 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
13044
13045 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
13046
13047 @item C-c C-m s p
13048 @kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
13049 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
13050
13051 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
13052
13053 @item C-c C-m c s
13054 @kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
13055 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
13056
13057 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
13058
13059 @item C-c C-m c o
13060 @kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
13061 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
13062
13063 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
13064
13065 @item C-c C-m c p
13066 @kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
13067 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
13068
13069 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
13070
13071 @item C-c C-m C-n
13072 @kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
13073 @findex mml-unsecure-message
13074 Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
13075
13076 @end table
13077
13078 @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
13079
13080 @node Select Methods
13081 @chapter Select Methods
13082 @cindex foreign groups
13083 @cindex select methods
13084
13085 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
13086 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
13087 @acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
13088 personal mail group.
13089
13090 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
13091 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
13092 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g., @code{nntp},
13093 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
13094 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
13095 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
13096
13097 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
13098 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
13099
13100 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
13101 group as.
13102
13103 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
13104 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
13105 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
13106 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
13107 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
13108
13109 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
13110
13111 @menu
13112 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
13113 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
13114 * Using IMAP:: Reading mail from @acronym{IMAP}.
13115 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
13116 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
13117 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files.
13118 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
13119 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
13120 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
13121 @end menu
13122
13123
13124 @node Server Buffer
13125 @section Server Buffer
13126
13127 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
13128 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
13129 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
13130 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
13131 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
13132 back end represents a virtual server.
13133
13134 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
13135 different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
13136 on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
13137 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
13138
13139 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
13140 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
13141 @acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
13142 hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
13143 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
13144 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
13145 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
13146
13147 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
13148 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
13149
13150 @menu
13151 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
13152 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
13153 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
13154 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
13155 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
13156 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
13157 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
13158 @end menu
13159
13160 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
13161 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
13162
13163
13164 @node Server Buffer Format
13165 @subsection Server Buffer Format
13166 @cindex server buffer format
13167
13168 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
13169 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
13170 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
13171 variable, with some simple extensions:
13172
13173 @table @samp
13174
13175 @item h
13176 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
13177
13178 @item n
13179 The name of this server.
13180
13181 @item w
13182 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
13183
13184 @item s
13185 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
13186
13187 @item a
13188 Whether this server is agentized.
13189 @end table
13190
13191 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
13192 The mode line can also be customized by using the
13193 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
13194 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
13195
13196 @table @samp
13197 @item S
13198 Server name.
13199
13200 @item M
13201 Server method.
13202 @end table
13203
13204 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
13205
13206
13207 @node Server Commands
13208 @subsection Server Commands
13209 @cindex server commands
13210
13211 @table @kbd
13212
13213 @item v
13214 @kindex v (Server)
13215 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Server)
13216 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
13217 command or better use it as a prefix key.
13218
13219 @item a
13220 @kindex a (Server)
13221 @findex gnus-server-add-server
13222 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
13223
13224 @item e
13225 @kindex e (Server)
13226 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
13227 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
13228
13229 @item S
13230 @kindex S (Server)
13231 @findex gnus-server-show-server
13232 Show the definition of a server (@code{gnus-server-show-server}).
13233
13234 @item SPACE
13235 @kindex SPACE (Server)
13236 @findex gnus-server-read-server
13237 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
13238
13239 @item q
13240 @kindex q (Server)
13241 @findex gnus-server-exit
13242 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
13243
13244 @item k
13245 @kindex k (Server)
13246 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
13247 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
13248
13249 @item y
13250 @kindex y (Server)
13251 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
13252 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
13253
13254 @item c
13255 @kindex c (Server)
13256 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
13257 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
13258
13259 @item l
13260 @kindex l (Server)
13261 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
13262 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
13263
13264 @item s
13265 @kindex s (Server)
13266 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
13267 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
13268 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
13269 servers.
13270
13271 @item g
13272 @kindex g (Server)
13273 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
13274 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
13275 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
13276 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
13277
13278 @item z
13279 @kindex z (Server)
13280 @findex gnus-server-compact-server
13281
13282 Compact all groups in the server under point
13283 (@code{gnus-server-compact-server}). Currently implemented only in
13284 nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes gaps between article numbers,
13285 hence getting a correct total article count.
13286
13287 @end table
13288
13289 Some more commands for closing, disabling, and re-opening servers are
13290 listed in @ref{Unavailable Servers}.
13291
13292
13293 @node Example Methods
13294 @subsection Example Methods
13295
13296 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
13297
13298 @lisp
13299 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
13300 @end lisp
13301
13302 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
13303
13304 @lisp
13305 (nnspool "")
13306 @end lisp
13307
13308 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
13309 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
13310 will.
13311
13312 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
13313 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
13314
13315 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
13316 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
13317 look like then:
13318
13319 @lisp
13320 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
13321 @end lisp
13322
13323 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
13324 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
13325
13326 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
13327 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
13328 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
13329 your private mail:
13330
13331 @lisp
13332 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
13333 @end lisp
13334
13335 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
13336 that.)
13337
13338 Here's the method for a public spool:
13339
13340 @lisp
13341 (nnmh "public"
13342 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
13343 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
13344 @end lisp
13345
13346 @cindex proxy
13347 @cindex firewall
13348
13349 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
13350 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
13351 on the firewall machine and connect with
13352 @uref{http://netcat.sourceforge.net/, netcat} from there to the
13353 @acronym{NNTP} server.
13354 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
13355 should probably look something like this:
13356
13357 @lisp
13358 (nntp "firewall"
13359 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)
13360 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
13361 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host"))
13362 @end lisp
13363
13364 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
13365 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
13366 configuration to the example above:
13367
13368 @lisp
13369 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13370 @end lisp
13371
13372 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}. Here's an example for
13373 an indirect connection:
13374
13375 @lisp
13376 (setq gnus-select-method
13377 '(nntp "indirect"
13378 (nntp-address "news.server.example")
13379 (nntp-via-user-name "intermediate_user_name")
13380 (nntp-via-address "intermediate.host.example")
13381 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13382 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches ("-C"))
13383 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)))
13384 @end lisp
13385
13386 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
13387 provide automatic authorization, of course.
13388
13389 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
13390 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
13391 netcat connection to the news server as follows:
13392
13393 @lisp
13394 (nntp "outside"
13395 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13396 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
13397 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13398 @end lisp
13399
13400
13401 @node Creating a Virtual Server
13402 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
13403
13404 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
13405 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
13406
13407 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
13408 would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
13409 could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
13410
13411 Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
13412
13413 You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
13414 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
13415 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
13416 will contain the following:
13417
13418 @lisp
13419 (nnml "cache")
13420 @end lisp
13421
13422 Change that to:
13423
13424 @lisp
13425 (nnml "cache"
13426 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
13427 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
13428 @end lisp
13429
13430 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
13431 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
13432 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
13433
13434
13435 @node Server Variables
13436 @subsection Server Variables
13437 @cindex server variables
13438 @cindex server parameters
13439
13440 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
13441 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
13442 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
13443 change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
13444 won't change the ``derived'' variables.
13445
13446 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
13447 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
13448 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
13449 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
13450 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
13451 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
13452 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
13453 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
13454 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
13455
13456 @lisp
13457 (nnml "public"
13458 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
13459 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
13460 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
13461 @end lisp
13462
13463 Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
13464
13465 @node Servers and Methods
13466 @subsection Servers and Methods
13467
13468 Wherever you would normally use a select method
13469 (e.g., @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
13470 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
13471 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
13472 over.
13473
13474
13475 @node Unavailable Servers
13476 @subsection Unavailable Servers
13477
13478 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
13479 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
13480 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
13481 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
13482 actually the case or not.
13483
13484 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
13485 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
13486 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
13487 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
13488 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
13489 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
13490 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
13491 it will regard that server as ``down''.
13492
13493 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
13494 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
13495
13496 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
13497 with the following commands:
13498
13499 @table @kbd
13500
13501 @item O
13502 @kindex O (Server)
13503 @findex gnus-server-open-server
13504 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
13505 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
13506
13507 @item C
13508 @kindex C (Server)
13509 @findex gnus-server-close-server
13510 Close the connection (if any) to the server
13511 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
13512
13513 @item D
13514 @kindex D (Server)
13515 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
13516 Mark the current server as unreachable
13517 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
13518
13519 @item M-o
13520 @kindex M-o (Server)
13521 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
13522 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
13523 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
13524
13525 @item M-c
13526 @kindex M-c (Server)
13527 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
13528 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
13529 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
13530
13531 @item R
13532 @kindex R (Server)
13533 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
13534 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
13535 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
13536
13537 @item c
13538 @kindex c (Server)
13539 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
13540 Copy a server and give it a new name
13541 (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}). This can be useful if you have a
13542 complex method definition, and want to use the same definition towards
13543 a different (physical) server.
13544
13545 @item L
13546 @kindex L (Server)
13547 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
13548 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
13549
13550 @end table
13551
13552
13553 @node Getting News
13554 @section Getting News
13555 @cindex reading news
13556 @cindex news back ends
13557
13558 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
13559 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
13560 or it can read from a local spool.
13561
13562 @menu
13563 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13564 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
13565 @end menu
13566
13567
13568 @node NNTP
13569 @subsection NNTP
13570 @cindex nntp
13571
13572 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
13573 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
13574 server as the, uhm, address.
13575
13576 If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
13577 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
13578 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
13579 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
13580
13581 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
13582 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
13583 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
13584
13585 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
13586 server:
13587
13588 @table @code
13589
13590 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
13591 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
13592 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
13593 @cindex authinfo
13594 @cindex authentication
13595 @cindex nntp authentication
13596 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
13597 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
13598 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
13599 commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
13600 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
13601 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
13602 present in this hook.
13603
13604 @item nntp-authinfo-function
13605 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
13606 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
13607 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
13608 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
13609 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
13610 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
13611 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
13612 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
13613 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
13614 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
13615 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
13616
13617 @enumerate
13618 @item
13619 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
13620
13621 @item
13622 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
13623
13624 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
13625 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
13626 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
13627 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
13628 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
13629 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
13630 @samp{force} is explained below.
13631
13632 @end enumerate
13633
13634 Here's an example file:
13635
13636 @example
13637 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
13638 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
13639 @end example
13640
13641 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
13642 have to be first, for instance.
13643
13644 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
13645 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
13646 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
13647 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
13648 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
13649 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
13650 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
13651
13652 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
13653 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
13654
13655 @example
13656 default force yes
13657 @end example
13658
13659 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
13660 previously mentioned.
13661
13662 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
13663
13664 @item nntp-server-action-alist
13665 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
13666 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
13667 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
13668 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
13669
13670 @lisp
13671 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
13672 '(("innd" (ding))))
13673 @end lisp
13674
13675 You probably don't want to do that, though.
13676
13677 The default value is
13678
13679 @lisp
13680 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
13681 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
13682 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
13683 @end lisp
13684
13685 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
13686 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
13687
13688 @item nntp-maximum-request
13689 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
13690 If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
13691 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
13692 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
13693 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
13694 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
13695 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
13696
13697 @item nntp-connection-timeout
13698 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
13699 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
13700 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
13701 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
13702 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
13703 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
13704 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
13705 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
13706 no timeouts are done.
13707
13708 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
13709 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
13710 If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
13711 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
13712 can be used.
13713
13714 @item nntp-xover-commands
13715 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
13716 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
13717 @cindex XOVER
13718 List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
13719 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
13720 "XOVERVIEW")}.
13721
13722 @item nntp-nov-gap
13723 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
13724 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
13725 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
13726 if you have read articles 2--5000 in the group, and only want to read
13727 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
13728 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
13729 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
13730 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
13731 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
13732 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
13733 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
13734
13735 @item nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13736 @vindex nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13737 When Gnus refers to an article having the @code{Message-ID} that a user
13738 specifies or having the @code{Message-ID} of the parent article of the
13739 current one (@pxref{Finding the Parent}), Gnus sends a @code{HEAD}
13740 command to the @acronym{NNTP} server to know where it is, and the server
13741 returns the data containing the pairs of a group and an article number
13742 in the @code{Xref} header. Gnus normally uses the article number to
13743 refer to the article if the data shows that that article is in the
13744 current group, while it uses the @code{Message-ID} otherwise. However,
13745 some news servers, e.g., ones running Diablo, run multiple engines
13746 having the same articles but article numbers are not kept synchronized
13747 between them. In that case, the article number that appears in the
13748 @code{Xref} header varies by which engine is chosen, so you cannot refer
13749 to the parent article that is in the current group, for instance. If
13750 you connect to such a server, set this variable to a non-@code{nil}
13751 value, and Gnus never uses article numbers. For example:
13752
13753 @lisp
13754 (setq gnus-select-method
13755 '(nntp "newszilla"
13756 (nntp-address "newszilla.example.com")
13757 (nntp-xref-number-is-evil t)
13758 @dots{}))
13759 @end lisp
13760
13761 The default value of this server variable is @code{nil}.
13762
13763 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
13764 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
13765 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13766
13767 @item nntp-record-commands
13768 @vindex nntp-record-commands
13769 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
13770 @acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @file{*nntp-log*}
13771 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
13772 that doesn't seem to work.
13773
13774 @item nntp-open-connection-function
13775 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
13776 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
13777 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
13778 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
13779 Seven pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped
13780 in two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
13781 indirect ones (three pre-made).
13782
13783 @item nntp-never-echoes-commands
13784 @vindex nntp-never-echoes-commands
13785 Non-@code{nil} means the nntp server never echoes commands. It is
13786 reported that some nntps server doesn't echo commands. So, you may want
13787 to set this to non-@code{nil} in the method for such a server setting
13788 @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream} for
13789 example. The default value is @code{nil}. Note that the
13790 @code{nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands} variable
13791 overrides the @code{nil} value of this variable.
13792
13793 @item nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13794 @vindex nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13795 List of functions that never echo commands. Add or set a function which
13796 you set to @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to this list if it does
13797 not echo commands. Note that a non-@code{nil} value of the
13798 @code{nntp-never-echoes-commands} variable overrides this variable. The
13799 default value is @code{(nntp-open-network-stream)}.
13800
13801 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
13802 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
13803 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
13804 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
13805 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
13806 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
13807 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
13808
13809 @lisp
13810 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
13811 @end lisp
13812
13813 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID@. This works for
13814 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
13815
13816 @item nntp-server-list-active-group
13817 If @code{nil}, then always use @samp{GROUP} instead of @samp{LIST
13818 ACTIVE}. This is usually slower, but on misconfigured servers that
13819 don't update their active files often, this can help.
13820
13821
13822 @end table
13823
13824 @menu
13825 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
13826 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
13827 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
13828 @end menu
13829
13830
13831 @node Direct Functions
13832 @subsubsection Direct Functions
13833 @cindex direct connection functions
13834
13835 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
13836 between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
13837 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
13838 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13839
13840 @table @code
13841 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
13842 @item nntp-open-network-stream
13843 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
13844 remote system. If both Emacs and the server supports it, the
13845 connection will be upgraded to an encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS}
13846 connection automatically.
13847
13848 @item network-only
13849 The same as the above, but don't do automatic @acronym{STARTTLS} upgrades.
13850
13851 @findex nntp-open-tls-stream
13852 @item nntp-open-tls-stream
13853 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13854 this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GnuTLS}
13855 installed. You then define a server as follows:
13856
13857 @lisp
13858 ;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13859 ;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
13860 ;;
13861 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13862 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
13863 (nntp-port-number 563)
13864 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13865 @end lisp
13866
13867 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
13868 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
13869 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13870 this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL}
13871 @ignore
13872 @c Defunct URL, ancient package, so don't mention it.
13873 or @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay}
13874 @end ignore
13875 installed. You then define a server as follows:
13876
13877 @lisp
13878 ;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13879 ;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
13880 ;;
13881 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13882 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
13883 (nntp-port-number 563)
13884 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13885 @end lisp
13886
13887 @findex nntp-open-netcat-stream
13888 @item nntp-open-netcat-stream
13889 Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server using the @code{netcat}
13890 program. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have
13891 the default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
13892 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
13893 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
13894 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
13895
13896 @lisp
13897 (nntp "socksified"
13898 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13899 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
13900 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13901 @end lisp
13902
13903 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
13904 session, which is not a good idea.
13905
13906 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
13907 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
13908 Like @code{nntp-open-netcat-stream}, but uses @code{telnet} rather than
13909 @code{netcat}. @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things
13910 like line-end-conversion, but sometimes netcat is simply
13911 not available. The previous example would turn into:
13912
13913 @lisp
13914 (nntp "socksified"
13915 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13916 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
13917 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
13918 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
13919 @end lisp
13920 @end table
13921
13922
13923 @node Indirect Functions
13924 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
13925 @cindex indirect connection functions
13926
13927 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
13928 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13929 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
13930 the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
13931 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
13932 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13933
13934 @table @code
13935 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13936 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13937 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then uses @code{netcat} to connect
13938 to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
13939 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
13940
13941 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat}-specific variables:
13942
13943 @table @code
13944 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13945 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13946 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13947 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13948
13949 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13950 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13951 List of strings to be used as the switches to
13952 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
13953 @samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
13954 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections.
13955 @end table
13956
13957 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13958 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13959 Does essentially the same, but uses @code{telnet} instead of @samp{netcat}
13960 to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the intermediate host.
13961 @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things like
13962 line-end-conversion, but sometimes @code{netcat} is simply not available.
13963
13964 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13965
13966 @table @code
13967 @item nntp-telnet-command
13968 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
13969 Command used to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the
13970 intermediate host. The default is @samp{telnet}.
13971
13972 @item nntp-telnet-switches
13973 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
13974 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13975 @code{nntp-telnet-command} command. The default is @code{("-8")}.
13976
13977 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13978 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13979 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13980 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13981
13982 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13983 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13984 List of strings to be used as the switches to
13985 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. If you use @samp{ssh}, you may need to set
13986 this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
13987 the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
13988 host. The default is @code{nil}.
13989 @end table
13990
13991 Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
13992 to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13993
13994 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13995 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13996 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
13997 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
13998
13999 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
14000
14001 @table @code
14002 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
14003 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
14004 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
14005 @samp{telnet}.
14006
14007 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
14008 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
14009 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
14010 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
14011
14012 @item nntp-via-user-password
14013 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
14014 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
14015
14016 @item nntp-via-envuser
14017 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
14018 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
14019 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
14020 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
14021
14022 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
14023 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
14024 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
14025 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
14026
14027 @end table
14028
14029 Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
14030 to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
14031 @end table
14032
14033
14034 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
14035 functions:
14036
14037 @table @code
14038
14039 @item nntp-via-user-name
14040 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
14041 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
14042
14043 @item nntp-via-address
14044 @vindex nntp-via-address
14045 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
14046
14047 @end table
14048
14049
14050 @node Common Variables
14051 @subsubsection Common Variables
14052
14053 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
14054 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
14055 affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
14056 default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
14057 variables individually).
14058
14059 @table @code
14060
14061 @item nntp-pre-command
14062 @vindex nntp-pre-command
14063 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
14064 connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
14065 @code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
14066 where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
14067
14068 @item nntp-address
14069 @vindex nntp-address
14070 The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
14071
14072 @item nntp-port-number
14073 @vindex nntp-port-number
14074 Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14075 @samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
14076 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
14077 than named ports (i.e., use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
14078 @samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
14079 not work with named ports.
14080
14081 @item nntp-end-of-line
14082 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
14083 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
14084 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
14085 using a non native telnet connection function.
14086
14087 @item nntp-netcat-command
14088 @vindex nntp-netcat-command
14089 Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
14090 @samp{netcat}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
14091 just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14092 @samp{nc}.
14093
14094 @item nntp-netcat-switches
14095 @vindex nntp-netcat-switches
14096 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-netcat-command}. The default
14097 is @samp{()}.
14098
14099 @end table
14100
14101 @node News Spool
14102 @subsection News Spool
14103 @cindex nnspool
14104 @cindex news spool
14105
14106 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
14107 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
14108 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
14109 instance.
14110
14111 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
14112 anything else) as the address.
14113
14114 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
14115 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
14116 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
14117 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
14118
14119 @table @code
14120
14121 @item nnspool-inews-program
14122 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
14123 Program used to post an article.
14124
14125 @item nnspool-inews-switches
14126 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
14127 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
14128
14129 @item nnspool-spool-directory
14130 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
14131 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
14132 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
14133
14134 @item nnspool-nov-directory
14135 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
14136 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
14137 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
14138
14139 @item nnspool-lib-dir
14140 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
14141 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
14142
14143 @item nnspool-active-file
14144 @vindex nnspool-active-file
14145 The name of the active file.
14146
14147 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
14148 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
14149 The name of the group descriptions file.
14150
14151 @item nnspool-history-file
14152 @vindex nnspool-history-file
14153 The name of the news history file.
14154
14155 @item nnspool-active-times-file
14156 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
14157 The name of the active date file.
14158
14159 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
14160 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
14161 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
14162 that it finds.
14163
14164 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14165 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14166 @cindex sed
14167 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
14168 relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
14169 @code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
14170 there.
14171
14172 @end table
14173
14174
14175 @node Using IMAP
14176 @section Using IMAP
14177 @cindex imap
14178
14179 The most popular mail backend is probably @code{nnimap}, which
14180 provides access to @acronym{IMAP} servers. @acronym{IMAP} servers
14181 store mail remotely, so the client doesn't store anything locally.
14182 This means that it's a convenient choice when you're reading your mail
14183 from different locations, or with different user agents.
14184
14185 @menu
14186 * Connecting to an IMAP Server:: Getting started with @acronym{IMAP}.
14187 * Customizing the IMAP Connection:: Variables for @acronym{IMAP} connection.
14188 * Client-Side IMAP Splitting:: Put mail in the correct mail box.
14189 * Support for IMAP Extensions:: Getting extensions and labels from servers.
14190 @end menu
14191
14192
14193 @node Connecting to an IMAP Server
14194 @subsection Connecting to an IMAP Server
14195
14196 Connecting to an @acronym{IMAP} can be very easy. Type @kbd{B} in the
14197 group buffer, or (if your primary interest is reading email), say
14198 something like:
14199
14200 @example
14201 (setq gnus-select-method
14202 '(nnimap "imap.gmail.com"))
14203 @end example
14204
14205 You'll be prompted for a user name and password. If you grow tired of
14206 that, then add the following to your @file{~/.authinfo} file:
14207
14208 @example
14209 machine imap.gmail.com login <username> password <password> port imap
14210 @end example
14211
14212 That should basically be it for most users.
14213
14214
14215 @node Customizing the IMAP Connection
14216 @subsection Customizing the IMAP Connection
14217
14218 Here's an example method that's more complex:
14219
14220 @example
14221 (nnimap "imap.gmail.com"
14222 (nnimap-inbox "INBOX")
14223 (nnimap-split-methods default)
14224 (nnimap-expunge t)
14225 (nnimap-stream ssl))
14226 @end example
14227
14228 @table @code
14229 @item nnimap-address
14230 The address of the server, like @samp{imap.gmail.com}.
14231
14232 @item nnimap-server-port
14233 If the server uses a non-standard port, that can be specified here. A
14234 typical port would be @code{"imap"} or @code{"imaps"}.
14235
14236 @item nnimap-stream
14237 How @code{nnimap} should connect to the server. Possible values are:
14238
14239 @table @code
14240 @item undecided
14241 This is the default, and this first tries the @code{ssl} setting, and
14242 then tries the @code{network} setting.
14243
14244 @item ssl
14245 This uses standard @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
14246
14247 @item network
14248 Non-encrypted and unsafe straight socket connection, but will upgrade
14249 to encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS} if both Emacs and the server
14250 supports it.
14251
14252 @item starttls
14253 Encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS} over the normal @acronym{IMAP} port.
14254
14255 @item shell
14256 If you need to tunnel via other systems to connect to the server, you
14257 can use this option, and customize @code{nnimap-shell-program} to be
14258 what you need.
14259
14260 @item plain
14261 Non-encrypted and unsafe straight socket connection.
14262 @acronym{STARTTLS} will not be used even if it is available.
14263
14264 @end table
14265
14266 @item nnimap-authenticator
14267 Some @acronym{IMAP} servers allow anonymous logins. In that case,
14268 this should be set to @code{anonymous}. If this variable isn't set,
14269 the normal login methods will be used. If you wish to specify a
14270 specific login method to be used, you can set this variable to either
14271 @code{login} (the traditional @acronym{IMAP} login method),
14272 @code{plain} or @code{cram-md5}.
14273
14274 @item nnimap-expunge
14275 If non-@code{nil}, expunge articles after deleting them. This is always done
14276 if the server supports UID EXPUNGE, but it's not done by default on
14277 servers that doesn't support that command.
14278
14279 @item nnimap-streaming
14280 Virtually all @acronym{IMAP} server support fast streaming of data.
14281 If you have problems connecting to the server, try setting this to
14282 @code{nil}.
14283
14284 @item nnimap-fetch-partial-articles
14285 If non-@code{nil}, fetch partial articles from the server. If set to
14286 a string, then it's interpreted as a regexp, and parts that have
14287 matching types will be fetched. For instance, @samp{"text/"} will
14288 fetch all textual parts, while leaving the rest on the server.
14289
14290 @item nnimap-record-commands
14291 If non-@code{nil}, record all @acronym{IMAP} commands in the
14292 @samp{"*imap log*"} buffer.
14293
14294 @end table
14295
14296
14297 @node Client-Side IMAP Splitting
14298 @subsection Client-Side IMAP Splitting
14299
14300 Many people prefer to do the sorting/splitting of mail into their mail
14301 boxes on the @acronym{IMAP} server. That way they don't have to
14302 download the mail they're not all that interested in.
14303
14304 If you do want to do client-side mail splitting, then the following
14305 variables are relevant:
14306
14307 @table @code
14308 @item nnimap-inbox
14309 This is the @acronym{IMAP} mail box that will be scanned for new
14310 mail. This can also be a list of mail box names.
14311
14312 @item nnimap-split-methods
14313 Uses the same syntax as @code{nnmail-split-methods} (@pxref{Splitting
14314 Mail}), except the symbol @code{default}, which means that it should
14315 use the value of the @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable.
14316
14317 @item nnimap-split-fancy
14318 Uses the same syntax as @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
14319
14320 @item nnimap-unsplittable-articles
14321 List of flag symbols to ignore when doing splitting. That is,
14322 articles that have these flags won't be considered when splitting.
14323 The default is @samp{(%Deleted %Seen)}.
14324
14325 @end table
14326
14327 Here's a complete example @code{nnimap} backend with a client-side
14328 ``fancy'' splitting method:
14329
14330 @example
14331 (nnimap "imap.example.com"
14332 (nnimap-inbox "INBOX")
14333 (nnimap-split-fancy
14334 (| ("MailScanner-SpamCheck" "spam" "spam.detected")
14335 (to "foo@@bar.com" "foo")
14336 "undecided")))
14337 @end example
14338
14339
14340 @node Support for IMAP Extensions
14341 @subsection Support for IMAP Extensions
14342
14343 @cindex Gmail
14344 @cindex X-GM-LABELS
14345 @cindex IMAP labels
14346
14347 If you're using Google's Gmail, you may want to see your Gmail labels
14348 when reading your mail. Gnus can give you this information if you ask
14349 for @samp{X-GM-LABELS} in the variable @code{gnus-extra-headers}. For
14350 example:
14351
14352 @example
14353 (setq gnus-extra-headers
14354 '(To Newsgroups X-GM-LABELS))
14355 @end example
14356
14357 This will result in Gnus storing your labels in message header
14358 structures for later use. The content is always a parenthesized
14359 (possible empty) list.
14360
14361
14362
14363 @node Getting Mail
14364 @section Getting Mail
14365 @cindex reading mail
14366 @cindex mail
14367
14368 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD@? But of
14369 course.
14370
14371 @menu
14372 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
14373 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
14374 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
14375 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
14376 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
14377 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
14378 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
14379 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
14380 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
14381 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
14382 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
14383 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
14384 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
14385 @end menu
14386
14387
14388 @node Mail in a Newsreader
14389 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
14390
14391 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
14392 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
14393 of a culture shock.
14394
14395 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
14396 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
14397
14398 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
14399 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
14400 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
14401 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
14402
14403 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
14404
14405 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
14406 deleted? How awful!
14407
14408 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
14409 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
14410 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
14411 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
14412 Mail}.
14413
14414 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
14415 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
14416 they want to treat a message.
14417
14418 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
14419 via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
14420 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
14421 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
14422 archived somewhere else.
14423
14424 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
14425 These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
14426 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
14427 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
14428 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
14429
14430 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
14431 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
14432 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
14433
14434 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
14435 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
14436 differently.
14437
14438 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
14439 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
14440 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
14441 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
14442 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
14443
14444 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
14445 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
14446 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
14447 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
14448 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
14449 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
14450 You Do.)
14451
14452
14453 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
14454 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
14455
14456 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
14457 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
14458 and things will happen automatically.
14459
14460 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
14461 mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14462
14463 @lisp
14464 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
14465 @end lisp
14466
14467 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
14468 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
14469 directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
14470 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
14471 like any other group.
14472
14473 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
14474
14475 @lisp
14476 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14477 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14478 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14479 ("other" "")))
14480 @end lisp
14481
14482 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
14483 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
14484 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
14485 last group.
14486
14487 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
14488 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
14489 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
14490
14491
14492 @node Splitting Mail
14493 @subsection Splitting Mail
14494 @cindex splitting mail
14495 @cindex mail splitting
14496 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
14497
14498 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
14499 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
14500 to be split into groups.
14501
14502 @lisp
14503 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14504 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14505 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14506 ("mail.other" "")))
14507 @end lisp
14508
14509 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
14510 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
14511 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
14512 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
14513 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
14514 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
14515 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
14516
14517 @lisp
14518 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
14519 @end lisp
14520
14521 @noindent
14522 In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
14523 the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14524
14525 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
14526 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
14527 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
14528 mail belongs in that group.
14529
14530 @cindex @samp{bogus} group
14531 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
14532 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
14533 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
14534 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
14535 to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
14536 that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
14537 will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
14538 splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
14539 see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
14540
14541 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
14542 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
14543 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
14544 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
14545 thinks should carry this mail message.
14546
14547 This variable can also be a fancy split method. For the syntax,
14548 see @ref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14549
14550 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
14551 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
14552 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
14553 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
14554
14555 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
14556 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
14557 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
14558 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
14559 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
14560
14561 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
14562 @cindex crosspost
14563 @cindex links
14564 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
14565 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
14566 links. If that's the case for you, set
14567 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
14568 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
14569
14570 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
14571 @findex nnmail-split-history
14572 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
14573 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
14574 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
14575 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
14576 Group Commands}).
14577
14578 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
14579 Header lines longer than the value of
14580 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
14581 function.
14582
14583 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
14584 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
14585 By default, splitting does not decode headers, so you can not match on
14586 non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. But it is useful if you want to match
14587 articles based on the raw header data. To enable it, set the
14588 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} variable to a non-@code{nil} value.
14589 In addition, the value of the @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset}
14590 variable is used for decoding non-@acronym{MIME} encoded string when
14591 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} is non-@code{nil}. The default
14592 value is @code{nil} which means not to decode non-@acronym{MIME} encoded
14593 string. A suitable value for you will be @code{undecided} or be the
14594 charset used normally in mails you are interested in.
14595
14596 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14597 By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
14598 specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
14599 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
14600 @emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
14601 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
14602 splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
14603 other kinds of entries.)
14604
14605 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
14606 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
14607 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
14608 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
14609 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
14610 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
14611 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
14612 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
14613 month's rent money.
14614
14615
14616 @node Mail Sources
14617 @subsection Mail Sources
14618
14619 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
14620 a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
14621 maildir, for instance.
14622
14623 @menu
14624 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
14625 * Mail Source Functions::
14626 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
14627 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
14628 @end menu
14629
14630
14631 @node Mail Source Specifiers
14632 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
14633 @cindex POP
14634 @cindex mail server
14635 @cindex procmail
14636 @cindex mail spool
14637 @cindex mail source
14638
14639 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
14640 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
14641
14642 Here's an example:
14643
14644 @lisp
14645 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
14646 @end lisp
14647
14648 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
14649 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
14650 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
14651 default values.
14652
14653 The @code{mail-sources} is global for all mail groups. You can specify
14654 an additional mail source for a particular group by including the
14655 @code{group} mail specifier in @code{mail-sources}, and setting a
14656 @code{mail-source} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) specifying
14657 a single mail source. When this is used, @code{mail-sources} is
14658 typically just @code{(group)}; the @code{mail-source} parameter for a
14659 group might look like this:
14660
14661 @lisp
14662 (mail-source . (file :path "home/user/spools/foo.spool"))
14663 @end lisp
14664
14665 This means that the group's (and only this group's) messages will be
14666 fetched from the spool file @samp{/user/spools/foo.spool}.
14667
14668 The following mail source types are available:
14669
14670 @table @code
14671 @item file
14672 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
14673
14674 Keywords:
14675
14676 @table @code
14677 @item :path
14678 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
14679 environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
14680 (usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
14681
14682 @item :prescript
14683 @itemx :postscript
14684 Script run before/after fetching mail.
14685 @end table
14686
14687 An example file mail source:
14688
14689 @lisp
14690 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
14691 @end lisp
14692
14693 Or using the default file name:
14694
14695 @lisp
14696 (file)
14697 @end lisp
14698
14699 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
14700 to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
14701 You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
14702 mail spool while moving the mail.
14703
14704 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
14705
14706 @lisp
14707 (setq mail-sources
14708 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
14709 @end lisp
14710
14711 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
14712
14713 @example
14714 #!/bin/sh
14715 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
14716 # flu@@iki.fi
14717
14718 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
14719 TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
14720 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
14721 @end example
14722
14723 Alter this script to fit the @samp{movemail} and temporary
14724 file you want to use.
14725
14726
14727 @item directory
14728 @vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
14729 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
14730 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
14731 That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
14732 directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
14733 will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
14734 to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
14735 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
14736 Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
14737 if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
14738
14739 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14740 There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
14741 that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
14742 applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
14743
14744 Keywords:
14745
14746 @table @code
14747 @item :path
14748 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
14749 value.
14750
14751 @item :suffix
14752 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
14753 @samp{.spool}.
14754
14755 @item :predicate
14756 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
14757 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
14758 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
14759 predicate are considered.
14760
14761 @item :prescript
14762 @itemx :postscript
14763 Script run before/after fetching mail.
14764
14765 @end table
14766
14767 An example directory mail source:
14768
14769 @lisp
14770 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
14771 :suffix ".prcml")
14772 @end lisp
14773
14774 @item pop
14775 Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
14776
14777 Keywords:
14778
14779 @table @code
14780 @item :server
14781 The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
14782 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
14783
14784 @item :port
14785 The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (e.g.,
14786 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (e.g., @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
14787 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
14788 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
14789 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
14790
14791 @item :user
14792 The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
14793 name.
14794
14795 @item :password
14796 The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
14797 the user is prompted.
14798
14799 @item :program
14800 The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
14801 should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
14802
14803 @example
14804 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
14805 @end example
14806
14807 The valid format specifier characters are:
14808
14809 @table @samp
14810 @item t
14811 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
14812 included in this string.
14813
14814 @item s
14815 The name of the server.
14816
14817 @item P
14818 The port number of the server.
14819
14820 @item u
14821 The user name to use.
14822
14823 @item p
14824 The password to use.
14825 @end table
14826
14827 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
14828 corresponding keywords.
14829
14830 @item :prescript
14831 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14832 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
14833
14834 One popular way to use this is to set up an SSH tunnel to access the
14835 @acronym{POP} server. Here's an example:
14836
14837 @lisp
14838 (pop :server "127.0.0.1"
14839 :port 1234
14840 :user "foo"
14841 :password "secret"
14842 :prescript
14843 "nohup ssh -f -L 1234:pop.server:110 remote.host sleep 3600 &")
14844 @end lisp
14845
14846 @item :postscript
14847 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14848 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
14849
14850 @item :function
14851 The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
14852 function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
14853 mail should be moved to.
14854
14855 @item :authentication
14856 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
14857 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
14858 @code{password}.
14859
14860 @item :leave
14861 Non-@code{nil} if the mail is to be left on the @acronym{POP} server
14862 after fetching. Only the built-in @code{pop3-movemail} program (the
14863 default) supports this keyword.
14864
14865 If this is a number, leave mails on the server for this many days since
14866 you first checked new mails. In that case, mails once fetched will
14867 never be fetched again by the @acronym{UIDL} control. If this is
14868 @code{nil} (the default), mails will be deleted on the server right
14869 after fetching. If this is neither @code{nil} nor a number, all mails
14870 will be left on the server, and you will end up getting the same mails
14871 again and again.
14872
14873 @vindex pop3-uidl-file
14874 The @code{pop3-uidl-file} variable specifies the file to which the
14875 @acronym{UIDL} data are locally stored. The default value is
14876 @file{~/.pop3-uidl}.
14877
14878 Note that @acronym{POP} servers maintain no state information between
14879 sessions, so what the client believes is there and what is actually
14880 there may not match up. If they do not, then you may get duplicate
14881 mails or the whole thing can fall apart and leave you with a corrupt
14882 mailbox.
14883
14884 @end table
14885
14886 @findex pop3-movemail
14887 @vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
14888 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
14889 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used.
14890
14891 Here are some examples for getting mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
14892
14893 Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server, using the default user
14894 name, and default fetcher:
14895
14896 @lisp
14897 (pop)
14898 @end lisp
14899
14900 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
14901
14902 @lisp
14903 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
14904 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
14905 @end lisp
14906
14907 Leave mails on the server for 14 days:
14908
14909 @lisp
14910 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
14911 :user "user-name" :password "secret"
14912 :leave 14)
14913 @end lisp
14914
14915 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
14916
14917 @lisp
14918 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
14919 @end lisp
14920
14921 @item maildir
14922 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
14923 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
14924 contains exactly one mail.
14925
14926 Keywords:
14927
14928 @table @code
14929 @item :path
14930 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
14931 taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
14932 @file{~/Maildir/}.
14933 @item :subdirs
14934 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
14935 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
14936
14937 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
14938 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
14939 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
14940 @c below.
14941
14942 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
14943 from locking problems).
14944
14945 @end table
14946
14947 Two example maildir mail sources:
14948
14949 @lisp
14950 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
14951 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
14952 @end lisp
14953
14954 @lisp
14955 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
14956 :subdirs ("new"))
14957 @end lisp
14958
14959 @item imap
14960 Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
14961 @acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (i.e.,
14962 with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
14963 to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
14964 @acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{Using IMAP}, for more information.
14965
14966 Keywords:
14967
14968 @table @code
14969 @item :server
14970 The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
14971 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
14972
14973 @item :port
14974 The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
14975 @samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
14976
14977 @item :user
14978 The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
14979 name.
14980
14981 @item :password
14982 The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
14983 prompted.
14984
14985 @item :stream
14986 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
14987 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
14988 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
14989 @samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
14990
14991 @item :authentication
14992 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
14993 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
14994 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
14995 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
14996
14997 @item :program
14998 When using the @samp{shell} :stream, the contents of this variable is
14999 mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
15000 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
15001
15002 @example
15003 ssh %s imapd
15004 @end example
15005
15006 Make sure nothing is interfering with the output of the program, e.g.,
15007 don't forget to redirect the error output to the void. The valid format
15008 specifier characters are:
15009
15010 @table @samp
15011 @item s
15012 The name of the server.
15013
15014 @item l
15015 User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
15016
15017 @item p
15018 The port number of the server.
15019 @end table
15020
15021 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
15022 corresponding keywords.
15023
15024 @item :mailbox
15025 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
15026 which normally is the mailbox which receives incoming mail. Instead of
15027 a single mailbox, this can be a list of mailboxes to fetch mail from.
15028
15029 @item :predicate
15030 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
15031 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
15032 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
15033 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
15034 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
15035 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
15036
15037 @item :fetchflag
15038 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
15039 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
15040 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
15041 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
15042
15043 @item :dontexpunge
15044 If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
15045 mailbox after finishing the fetch.
15046
15047 @end table
15048
15049 An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
15050
15051 @lisp
15052 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
15053 :stream kerberos4
15054 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
15055 @end lisp
15056
15057 @item group
15058 Get the actual mail source from the @code{mail-source} group parameter,
15059 @xref{Group Parameters}.
15060
15061 @end table
15062
15063 @table @dfn
15064 @item Common Keywords
15065 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
15066
15067 Keywords:
15068
15069 @table @code
15070 @item :plugged
15071 If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
15072 use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
15073 example:
15074
15075 @lisp
15076 (setq mail-sources
15077 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
15078 :suffix ""
15079 :plugged t)))
15080 @end lisp
15081
15082 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
15083 useful when you use local mail and news.
15084
15085 @end table
15086 @end table
15087
15088 @node Mail Source Functions
15089 @subsubsection Function Interface
15090
15091 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
15092 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
15093 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
15094 consider the following mail-source setting:
15095
15096 @lisp
15097 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
15098 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
15099 @end lisp
15100
15101 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
15102 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
15103 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
15104 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
15105 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
15106
15107 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
15108
15109
15110 @node Mail Source Customization
15111 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
15112
15113 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
15114 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
15115 variables.
15116
15117 @table @code
15118 @item mail-source-crash-box
15119 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
15120 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
15121 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
15122
15123 @cindex Incoming*
15124 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
15125 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
15126 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
15127 @code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
15128 files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
15129 (the deletion will only happen when receiving new mail). You may also
15130 set @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
15131 @code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
15132 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{10} in alpha Gnusae
15133 and @code{2} in released Gnusae. @xref{Gnus Development}.
15134
15135 @item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15136 @vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15137 If non-@code{nil}, ask for confirmation before deleting old incoming
15138 files. This variable only applies when
15139 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
15140
15141 @item mail-source-ignore-errors
15142 @vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
15143 If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
15144
15145 @item mail-source-directory
15146 @vindex mail-source-directory
15147 Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
15148 default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
15149 is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
15150 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
15151
15152 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15153 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15154 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
15155 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
15156 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
15157 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
15158 number.
15159
15160 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
15161 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
15162 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is @code{#o600}.
15163
15164 @item mail-source-movemail-program
15165 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
15166 If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
15167 @code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
15168
15169 @end table
15170
15171
15172 @node Fetching Mail
15173 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
15174
15175 @vindex mail-sources
15176 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
15177 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
15178 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
15179
15180 If this variable is @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to
15181 fetch mail by themselves.
15182
15183 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
15184 @acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
15185
15186 @lisp
15187 (setq mail-sources
15188 '((file)
15189 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15190 :password "secret")))
15191 @end lisp
15192
15193 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
15194
15195 @lisp
15196 (setq mail-sources
15197 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
15198 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15199 :user "user-name"
15200 :port "pop3"
15201 :password "secret")))
15202 @end lisp
15203
15204
15205 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
15206 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
15207 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
15208 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
15209 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
15210 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
15211
15212
15213
15214 @node Mail Back End Variables
15215 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
15216
15217 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
15218 mail back ends.
15219
15220 @table @code
15221 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15222 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15223 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
15224 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
15225
15226 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
15227 @item nnmail-split-hook
15228 @findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
15229 @cindex RFC 1522 decoding
15230 @cindex RFC 2047 decoding
15231 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
15232 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
15233 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
15234 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
15235 in the buffer will show up in any files.
15236 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
15237 to this hook.
15238
15239 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15240 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15241 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15242 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15243 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
15244 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
15245 starting to handle the new mail) and
15246 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
15247 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
15248 default file modes the new mail files get:
15249
15250 @lisp
15251 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15252 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes #o700)))
15253
15254 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15255 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes #o775)))
15256 @end lisp
15257
15258 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
15259 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
15260 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
15261 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
15262 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
15263 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
15264 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
15265
15266 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
15267 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
15268 @findex delete-file
15269 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
15270
15271 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15272 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15273 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
15274 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
15275 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
15276
15277 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15278 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15279 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
15280 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
15281 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
15282
15283 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
15284 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
15285 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
15286
15287 @end table
15288
15289
15290 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
15291 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
15292 @cindex mail splitting
15293 @cindex fancy mail splitting
15294
15295 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
15296 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
15297 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
15298 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
15299 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
15300 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
15301
15302 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
15303
15304 @lisp
15305 ;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
15306 ;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
15307 ;; @r{from real errors.}
15308 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
15309 "mail.misc"))
15310 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
15311 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
15312 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
15313 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
15314 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
15315 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
15316 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
15317 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
15318 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
15319 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
15320 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
15321 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
15322 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
15323 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
15324 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
15325 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
15326 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
15327 "misc.misc")
15328 @end lisp
15329
15330 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
15331 (possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
15332 splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
15333
15334 @table @code
15335
15336 @item group
15337 If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
15338 regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
15339
15340 @c Don't fold this line.
15341 @item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split} [@var{invert-partial}])
15342 The split can be a list containing at least three elements. If the
15343 first element @var{field} (a regexp matching a header) contains
15344 @var{value} (also a regexp) then store the message as specified by
15345 @var{split}.
15346
15347 If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp) matches some string after
15348 @var{field} and before the end of the matched @var{value}, the
15349 @var{split} is ignored. If none of the @var{restrict} clauses match,
15350 @var{split} is processed.
15351
15352 The last element @var{invert-partial} is optional. If it is
15353 non-@code{nil}, the match-partial-words behavior controlled by the
15354 variable @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} (see below) is
15355 be inverted. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15356
15357 @item (| @var{split} @dots{})
15358 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
15359 bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
15360 @var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
15361 stored in one or more groups.
15362
15363 @item (& @var{split} @dots{})
15364 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
15365 process all @var{split}s in the list.
15366
15367 @item junk
15368 If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
15369 this message. Use with extreme caution.
15370
15371 @item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
15372 If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
15373 second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
15374 arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
15375
15376 @cindex body split
15377 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
15378 body of the messages:
15379
15380 @lisp
15381 (defun split-on-body ()
15382 (save-excursion
15383 (save-restriction
15384 (widen)
15385 (goto-char (point-min))
15386 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
15387 "string.group"))))
15388 @end lisp
15389
15390 The buffer is narrowed to the header of the message in question when
15391 @var{function} is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called
15392 after @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
15393 above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
15394 not be downloaded by default. You need to set
15395 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
15396 (@pxref{Client-Side IMAP Splitting}).
15397
15398 @item (! @var{func} @var{split})
15399 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
15400 @var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
15401 function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
15402 should return a split.
15403
15404 @item nil
15405 If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
15406
15407 @end table
15408
15409 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
15410
15411 Normally, @var{value} in these splits must match a complete @emph{word}
15412 according to the fundamental mode syntax table. In other words, all
15413 @var{value}'s will be implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers,
15414 which are word delimiters. Therefore, if you use the following split,
15415 for example,
15416
15417 @example
15418 (any "joe" "joemail")
15419 @end example
15420
15421 @noindent
15422 messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will normally not be filed
15423 in @samp{joemail}. If you want to alter this behavior, you can use any
15424 of the following three ways:
15425
15426 @enumerate
15427 @item
15428 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
15429 You can set the @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} variable
15430 to non-@code{nil} in order to ignore word boundaries and instead the
15431 match becomes more like a grep. This variable controls whether partial
15432 words are matched during fancy splitting. The default value is
15433 @code{nil}.
15434
15435 Note that it influences all @var{value}'s in your split rules.
15436
15437 @item
15438 @var{value} beginning with @code{.*} ignores word boundaries in front of
15439 a word. Similarly, if @var{value} ends with @code{.*}, word boundaries
15440 in the rear of a word will be ignored. For example, the @var{value}
15441 @code{"@@example\\.com"} does not match @samp{foo@@example.com} but
15442 @code{".*@@example\\.com"} does.
15443
15444 @item
15445 You can set the @var{invert-partial} flag in your split rules of the
15446 @samp{(@var{field} @var{value} @dots{})} types, aforementioned in this
15447 section. If the flag is set, word boundaries on both sides of a word
15448 are ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15449 @code{nil}. Contrarily, if the flag is set, word boundaries are not
15450 ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15451 non-@code{nil}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15452 @end enumerate
15453
15454 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
15455 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
15456 they are expanded as specified by the variable
15457 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
15458 where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
15459 contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
15460 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
15461
15462 @table @code
15463 @item from
15464 Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
15465 @item to
15466 Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
15467 @samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
15468 @item any
15469 Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
15470 @end table
15471
15472 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
15473 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
15474 when all this splitting is performed.
15475
15476 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
15477 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
15478 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
15479
15480 @example
15481 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
15482 @end example
15483
15484 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
15485 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
15486
15487 If the string contains the element @samp{\\&}, then the previously
15488 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
15489 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
15490 groupings 1 through 9.
15491
15492 @vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
15493 Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
15494 lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
15495 Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
15496 groups when users send to an address using different case
15497 (i.e., mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
15498 is @code{t}.
15499
15500 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
15501 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
15502 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
15503 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
15504 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
15505 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
15506 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
15507 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
15508 it once per thread.
15509
15510 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
15511 and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
15512 value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
15513 using the colon feature, like so:
15514 @lisp
15515 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
15516 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
15517 nnmail-split-fancy
15518 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
15519 ;; @r{other splits go here}
15520 ))
15521 @end lisp
15522
15523 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
15524 non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
15525 in the file specified by the variable
15526 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
15527 (the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
15528 invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
15529 at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
15530 and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
15531 for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
15532 corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
15533 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
15534 recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
15535 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
15536 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
15537 300 kBytes in size.)
15538 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15539 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
15540 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
15541 messages goes into the new group.
15542
15543 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
15544 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
15545 outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
15546 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
15547 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
15548 ``outgoing'' group.
15549
15550
15551 @node Group Mail Splitting
15552 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
15553 @cindex mail splitting
15554 @cindex group mail splitting
15555
15556 @findex gnus-group-split
15557 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
15558 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
15559 You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
15560 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
15561 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
15562 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
15563 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
15564 @code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
15565
15566 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
15567 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
15568 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
15569 rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
15570
15571 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
15572 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
15573 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
15574 @code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
15575 matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
15576 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
15577 @code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
15578
15579 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
15580 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
15581 parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
15582 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
15583 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
15584 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
15585 @code{gnus-group-split}.
15586
15587 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
15588 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
15589 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
15590 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
15591 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
15592 some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
15593 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
15594 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
15595 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
15596 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
15597 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
15598 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
15599 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
15600
15601 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
15602 been defined:
15603
15604 @example
15605 nnml:mail.bar:
15606 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
15607 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
15608 nnml:mail.foo:
15609 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
15610 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
15611 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
15612 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
15613 nnml:mail.others:
15614 ((split-spec . catch-all))
15615 @end example
15616
15617 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
15618 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
15619 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
15620
15621 @lisp
15622 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
15623 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
15624 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
15625 "mail.others")
15626 @end lisp
15627
15628 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
15629 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
15630 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
15631 splits like this:
15632
15633 @lisp
15634 (: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
15635 @end lisp
15636
15637 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
15638 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
15639 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
15640 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
15641 fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
15642 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
15643 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
15644 Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
15645 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
15646
15647 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
15648 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
15649 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
15650 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
15651 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
15652 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
15653 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
15654 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
15655 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
15656
15657 @findex gnus-group-split-update
15658 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
15659 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
15660 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
15661 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
15662 you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
15663
15664 @lisp
15665 (gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
15666 @end lisp
15667
15668 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
15669 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
15670 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
15671 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
15672 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
15673 value.
15674
15675 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
15676 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
15677 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
15678 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
15679
15680 @node Incorporating Old Mail
15681 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
15682 @cindex incorporating old mail
15683 @cindex import old mail
15684
15685 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
15686 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
15687 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
15688 your mail groups.
15689
15690 Doing so can be quite easy.
15691
15692 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
15693 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
15694 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
15695 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
15696 your @code{nnml} groups.
15697
15698 Here's how:
15699
15700 @enumerate
15701 @item
15702 Go to the group buffer.
15703
15704 @item
15705 Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
15706 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
15707
15708 @item
15709 Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
15710
15711 @item
15712 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
15713 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
15714
15715 @item
15716 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
15717 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
15718 @end enumerate
15719
15720 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
15721 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
15722 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
15723 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
15724 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
15725
15726 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
15727 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
15728 using the new mail back end.
15729
15730
15731 @node Expiring Mail
15732 @subsection Expiring Mail
15733 @cindex article expiry
15734 @cindex expiring mail
15735
15736 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
15737 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
15738 different approach to mail reading.
15739
15740 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
15741 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
15742 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
15743 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
15744 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
15745 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
15746 course.
15747
15748 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
15749 articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
15750 that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
15751 will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
15752 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
15753 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
15754 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
15755 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
15756 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
15757
15758 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-marks
15759 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
15760 two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
15761 with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
15762 for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
15763 considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
15764 the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
15765 @samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} (and so on) are considered
15766 expirable. @code{gnus-auto-expirable-marks} has the full list of
15767 these marks.
15768
15769 When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
15770 who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
15771 and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
15772 (@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
15773 into its own group.)
15774
15775 Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
15776 answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
15777 advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
15778 the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
15779 between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
15780 only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
15781 total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
15782 Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
15783 scoring.
15784
15785 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15786 Groups that match the regular expression
15787 @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
15788 read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
15789 expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
15790
15791 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
15792 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
15793 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
15794 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
15795 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
15796
15797 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
15798 @lisp
15799 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
15800 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
15801 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
15802 @end lisp
15803
15804 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
15805 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
15806 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
15807 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
15808 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
15809
15810 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
15811 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
15812
15813 @lisp
15814 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15815 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
15816 @end lisp
15817
15818 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
15819 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
15820
15821 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
15822 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
15823 don't really mix very well.
15824
15825 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
15826 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
15827 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
15828 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
15829 days.
15830
15831 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
15832 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
15833 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
15834 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
15835 everywhere else:
15836
15837 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15838 @lisp
15839 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15840 (lambda (group)
15841 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
15842 31)
15843 ((string= group "mail.junk")
15844 1)
15845 ((string= group "important")
15846 'never)
15847 (t
15848 6))))
15849 @end lisp
15850
15851 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
15852 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
15853
15854 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
15855 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
15856 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
15857 @code{never}.
15858
15859 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
15860 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
15861
15862 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
15863 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
15864 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
15865 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
15866 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
15867 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
15868 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
15869 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
15870 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
15871 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
15872 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
15873 from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
15874 name or @code{delete}.
15875
15876 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
15877 @lisp
15878 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
15879 @end lisp
15880
15881 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15882 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15883 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
15884 expire mail to groups according to the variable
15885 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
15886
15887 @lisp
15888 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15889 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15890 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
15891 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
15892 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
15893 @end lisp
15894
15895 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
15896 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
15897 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
15898 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
15899 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
15900 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
15901
15902 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
15903 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
15904 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
15905 easier for procmail users.
15906
15907 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
15908 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
15909 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
15910 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
15911 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
15912 caution. Even more dangerous is the
15913 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
15914 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
15915 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
15916 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
15917 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
15918 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
15919 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
15920 with! So there!
15921
15922 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
15923
15924 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
15925 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
15926 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
15927 auto-expire turned on.
15928
15929 @vindex gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable
15930 The expirable marks of articles will be removed when copying or moving
15931 them to a group in which auto-expire is not turned on. This is for
15932 preventing articles from being expired unintentionally. On the other
15933 hand, to a group that has turned auto-expire on, the expirable marks of
15934 articles that are copied or moved will not be changed by default. I.e.,
15935 when copying or moving to such a group, articles that were expirable
15936 will be left expirable and ones that were not expirable will not be
15937 marked as expirable. So, even though in auto-expire groups, some
15938 articles will never get expired (unless you read them again). If you
15939 don't side with that behavior that unexpirable articles may be mixed
15940 into auto-expire groups, you can set
15941 @code{gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable} to a
15942 non-@code{nil} value. In that case, articles that have been read will
15943 be marked as expirable automatically when being copied or moved to a
15944 group that has auto-expire turned on. The default value is @code{nil}.
15945
15946
15947 @node Washing Mail
15948 @subsection Washing Mail
15949 @cindex mail washing
15950 @cindex list server brain damage
15951 @cindex incoming mail treatment
15952
15953 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
15954 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
15955 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
15956 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
15957 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
15958 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
15959
15960 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
15961 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
15962 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
15963 laugh.
15964
15965 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
15966 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
15967 storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
15968 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
15969
15970 @table @code
15971 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15972 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15973 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
15974 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
15975 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
15976
15977 @table @code
15978 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15979 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15980 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
15981 Emacs running on MS machines.
15982
15983 @end table
15984
15985 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15986 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15987 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
15988 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
15989
15990 @table @code
15991 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15992 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15993 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
15994 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
15995
15996 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
15997 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
15998 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
15999 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
16000 into a feature by documenting it.)
16001
16002 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
16003 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
16004 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
16005 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
16006 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
16007 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
16008 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
16009 @code{\\(..\\)}.
16010
16011 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
16012 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
16013
16014 @lisp
16015 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
16016 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
16017 @end lisp
16018
16019 This can also be done non-destructively with
16020 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
16021
16022 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
16023 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
16024 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
16025
16026 @item nnmail-ignore-broken-references
16027 @findex nnmail-ignore-broken-references
16028 @c @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
16029 @cindex Eudora
16030 @cindex Pegasus
16031 Some mail user agents (e.g., Eudora and Pegasus) produce broken
16032 @code{References} headers, but correct @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This
16033 function will get rid of the @code{References} header if the headers
16034 contain a line matching the regular expression
16035 @code{nnmail-broken-references-mailers}.
16036
16037 @end table
16038
16039 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
16040 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
16041 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
16042 include:
16043
16044 @table @code
16045 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
16046 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
16047 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
16048
16049 @end table
16050 @end table
16051
16052
16053 @node Duplicates
16054 @subsection Duplicates
16055
16056 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
16057 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
16058 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
16059 @cindex duplicate mails
16060 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
16061 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
16062 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
16063 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s:
16064 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
16065 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
16066 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
16067 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
16068 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
16069 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
16070 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
16071 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
16072 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
16073
16074 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
16075 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
16076 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
16077 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
16078
16079 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
16080 @code{nil}.
16081
16082 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
16083 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
16084 methods:
16085
16086 @lisp
16087 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
16088 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
16089 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
16090 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
16091 (any mail "mail.misc")
16092 ;; @r{Other rules.}
16093 [...] ))
16094 @end lisp
16095 @noindent
16096 Or something like:
16097 @lisp
16098 (setq nnmail-split-methods
16099 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
16100 ;; @r{Other rules.}
16101 [...]))
16102 @end lisp
16103
16104 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
16105 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
16106 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
16107 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
16108 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
16109
16110
16111 @node Not Reading Mail
16112 @subsection Not Reading Mail
16113
16114 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
16115 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
16116 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
16117
16118 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
16119 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
16120 mail, which should help.
16121
16122 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16123 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16124 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16125 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16126 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16127 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
16128 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old (pre-Emacs
16129 23) Rmail file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
16130 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
16131 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
16132 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
16133
16134 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
16135 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
16136 incoming mail.
16137
16138
16139 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
16140 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
16141
16142 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
16143 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
16144 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
16145
16146 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
16147 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
16148 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
16149 Spool}).
16150
16151 @menu
16152 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
16153 * Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
16154 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
16155 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
16156 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
16157 * nnmaildir Group Parameters::
16158 * Article Identification::
16159 * NOV Data::
16160 * Article Marks::
16161 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
16162 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
16163 @end menu
16164
16165
16166
16167 @node Unix Mail Box
16168 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
16169 @cindex nnmbox
16170 @cindex unix mail box
16171
16172 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
16173 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16174 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
16175 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
16176 which group it belongs in.
16177
16178 Virtual server settings:
16179
16180 @table @code
16181 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
16182 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16183 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
16184 @file{~/mbox}.
16185
16186 @item nnmbox-active-file
16187 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
16188 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
16189 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
16190
16191 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
16192 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16193 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
16194 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
16195 @end table
16196
16197
16198 @node Babyl
16199 @subsubsection Babyl
16200 @cindex nnbabyl
16201
16202 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16203 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16204 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box to store mail.
16205 @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each mail article to say which
16206 group it belongs in.
16207
16208 Virtual server settings:
16209
16210 @table @code
16211 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
16212 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16213 The name of the Babyl file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
16214
16215 @item nnbabyl-active-file
16216 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16217 The name of the active file for the Babyl file. The default is
16218 @file{~/.rmail-active}
16219
16220 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16221 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16222 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
16223 @code{t}
16224 @end table
16225
16226
16227 @node Mail Spool
16228 @subsubsection Mail Spool
16229 @cindex nnml
16230 @cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
16231
16232 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
16233 format. It should be used with some caution.
16234
16235 @vindex nnml-directory
16236 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
16237 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
16238 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
16239 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
16240
16241 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
16242 care of all that.
16243
16244 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
16245 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
16246 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
16247 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
16248 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
16249 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
16250 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
16251 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
16252
16253 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
16254 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
16255 @acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
16256 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
16257
16258 Virtual server settings:
16259
16260 @table @code
16261 @item nnml-directory
16262 @vindex nnml-directory
16263 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
16264 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
16265 is @file{~/Mail}).
16266
16267 @item nnml-active-file
16268 @vindex nnml-active-file
16269 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
16270 @file{~/Mail/active}.
16271
16272 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
16273 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
16274 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16275 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
16276
16277 @item nnml-get-new-mail
16278 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16279 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
16280 @code{t}.
16281
16282 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
16283 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
16284 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16285 default is @code{nil}.
16286
16287 @item nnml-nov-file-name
16288 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
16289 The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
16290
16291 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16292 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16293 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
16294
16295 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
16296 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
16297 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
16298 files. This requires @code{auto-compression-mode} to be enabled
16299 (@pxref{Compressed Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
16300 If the value of @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is a string, it is used
16301 as the file extension specifying the compression program. You can set it
16302 to @samp{.bz2} if your Emacs supports it. A value of @code{t} is
16303 equivalent to @samp{.gz}.
16304
16305 @item nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16306 @vindex nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16307 Default size threshold for compressed message files. Message files with
16308 bodies larger than that many characters will be automatically compressed
16309 if @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil}.
16310
16311 @end table
16312
16313 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
16314 If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
16315 whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
16316 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
16317 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
16318 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
16319 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
16320 Commands}).
16321
16322
16323 @node MH Spool
16324 @subsubsection MH Spool
16325 @cindex nnmh
16326 @cindex mh-e mail spool
16327
16328 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
16329 @acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
16330 file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
16331 @code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
16332 for.
16333
16334 Virtual server settings:
16335
16336 @table @code
16337 @item nnmh-directory
16338 @vindex nnmh-directory
16339 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
16340 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
16341 @file{~/Mail})
16342
16343 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
16344 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16345 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
16346 @code{t}.
16347
16348 @item nnmh-be-safe
16349 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
16350 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
16351 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
16352 they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
16353 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
16354 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
16355 have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
16356 @end table
16357
16358
16359 @node Maildir
16360 @subsubsection Maildir
16361 @cindex nnmaildir
16362 @cindex maildir
16363
16364 @code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
16365 corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
16366 @uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
16367 @uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
16368 also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
16369 within a maildir.
16370
16371 Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
16372 reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
16373 your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
16374 configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
16375 can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
16376 configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
16377 that appear as group in Gnus.
16378
16379 @code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
16380 never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
16381 corrupt its data in the filesystem.
16382
16383 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
16384 maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
16385 another, and you will keep your marks.
16386
16387 Virtual server settings:
16388
16389 @table @code
16390 @item directory
16391 For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
16392 you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
16393 it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
16394 choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
16395 will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
16396 filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
16397 in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
16398 scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
16399 the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
16400 @code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
16401
16402 The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
16403 which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
16404 the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
16405 only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
16406 server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
16407 don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
16408 optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
16409 @code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
16410 use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
16411 if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
16412 value.
16413
16414 @item target-prefix
16415 This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
16416 @code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
16417 server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
16418 closed.
16419
16420 When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
16421 created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
16422 pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
16423 So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
16424 @code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
16425 the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
16426 @file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
16427 @file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
16428 @file{../maildirs/foo}.
16429
16430 You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
16431 create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
16432 this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
16433 with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
16434 symlinks pointing to them will be).
16435
16436 As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
16437 then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
16438 @code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
16439 cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
16440 @code{force} argument.
16441
16442 @item directory-files
16443 This should be a function with the same interface as
16444 @code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
16445 used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
16446 parameter is optional; the default is
16447 @code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
16448 @code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
16449 @code{directory-files} otherwise.
16450 (@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
16451 server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
16452 scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
16453
16454 @item get-new-mail
16455 If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
16456 maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
16457 the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
16458 @code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
16459 value is @code{nil}.
16460
16461 Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
16462 an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
16463 that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
16464 different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
16465 remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
16466 @end table
16467
16468 @node nnmaildir Group Parameters
16469 @subsubsection Group parameters
16470
16471 @code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
16472 all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
16473 default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
16474 one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
16475 functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
16476 you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
16477 another back end.
16478
16479 If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
16480 is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
16481 original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
16482 evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
16483 different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
16484 back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
16485 numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
16486 @code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
16487 quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
16488
16489 @table @code
16490 @item expire-age
16491 An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
16492 before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
16493 articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
16494 @code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
16495 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
16496 @code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
16497 and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
16498 wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
16499 60 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
16500 An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
16501 modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
16502 delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
16503 article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
16504
16505 @item expire-group
16506 If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
16507 @example
16508 "backend+server.address.string:group.name"
16509 @end example
16510 and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
16511 to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
16512 before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
16513 group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
16514 was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
16515 destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
16516 the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
16517 you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
16518 article. So that form can refer to
16519 @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
16520 article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
16521 does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
16522 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
16523
16524 @item read-only
16525 If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
16526 in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
16527 from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
16528 @file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
16529 cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
16530 @file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
16531 containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
16532 maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
16533 a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
16534 have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
16535 contain extra copies of the articles.
16536
16537 @item directory-files
16538 A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
16539 used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
16540 group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
16541 server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
16542
16543 @item distrust-Lines:
16544 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
16545 article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
16546 @code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
16547
16548 @item always-marks
16549 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
16550 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16551 say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
16552 marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
16553 feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
16554 in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16555
16556 @item never-marks
16557 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
16558 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16559 say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
16560 stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
16561 @code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
16562 probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
16563 abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16564
16565 @item nov-cache-size
16566 An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
16567 speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
16568 for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
16569 worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
16570 parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
16571 the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
16572 The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
16573 and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
16574 that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
16575 that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
16576 @code{read}, plus a little extra.
16577 @end table
16578
16579 @node Article Identification
16580 @subsubsection Article identification
16581 Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
16582 Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
16583 contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
16584 @code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
16585 the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
16586 identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
16587 @file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
16588 about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
16589 available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
16590 request the article in the summary buffer.
16591
16592 @node NOV Data
16593 @subsubsection NOV data
16594 An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
16595 to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
16596 @code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
16597 @code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
16598 need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
16599 when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
16600 force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
16601 single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
16602 file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
16603 assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
16604 with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
16605
16606 @node Article Marks
16607 @subsubsection Article marks
16608 An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
16609 @code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
16610 When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16611 looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
16612 asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16613 creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
16614 rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
16615 links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
16616
16617 You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
16618 @file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
16619 your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
16620 remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
16621 this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
16622 it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
16623 type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
16624 @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
16625 pick up the changes, and might undo them.
16626
16627
16628 @node Mail Folders
16629 @subsubsection Mail Folders
16630 @cindex nnfolder
16631 @cindex mbox folders
16632 @cindex mail folders
16633
16634 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
16635 separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
16636 @code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
16637 numbers and arrival dates.
16638
16639 Virtual server settings:
16640
16641 @table @code
16642 @item nnfolder-directory
16643 @vindex nnfolder-directory
16644 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
16645 directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
16646 (whose default is @file{~/Mail})
16647
16648 @item nnfolder-active-file
16649 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
16650 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
16651
16652 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16653 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16654 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16655 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
16656
16657 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
16658 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16659 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
16660 default is @code{t}
16661
16662 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16663 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16664 @cindex backup files
16665 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
16666 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
16667 you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
16668 following in your @file{.emacs} file:
16669
16670 @lisp
16671 (defun turn-off-backup ()
16672 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
16673
16674 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
16675 @end lisp
16676
16677 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16678 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16679 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
16680 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
16681 extract some information from it before removing it.
16682
16683 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16684 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16685 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16686 default is @code{nil}.
16687
16688 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16689 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16690 The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
16691
16692 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
16693 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
16694 The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
16695 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
16696
16697 @end table
16698
16699
16700 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
16701 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
16702 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
16703 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
16704 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
16705 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
16706 though.
16707
16708 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
16709 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
16710
16711 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
16712 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
16713 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
16714 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
16715 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
16716
16717 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
16718 typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
16719 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
16720 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
16721 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
16722 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
16723 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
16724 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
16725 via NFS).
16726
16727 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
16728 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
16729 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
16730 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
16731
16732 @table @code
16733 @item nnmbox
16734
16735 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-defined
16736 format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
16737 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
16738 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
16739 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
16740 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
16741 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
16742 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
16743 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
16744 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
16745 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
16746 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
16747 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
16748 what's where.
16749
16750 @item nnbabyl
16751
16752 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
16753 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
16754 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
16755 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
16756 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
16757 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
16758 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
16759 Rmail was Emacs's first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
16760 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
16761 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
16762 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
16763 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
16764 headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
16765 course, and is still maintained within Emacs. Since Emacs 23, it
16766 uses standard mbox format rather than Babyl.
16767
16768 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
16769 file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
16770 look at your mail.
16771
16772 @item nnml
16773
16774 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
16775 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
16776 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
16777 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
16778 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
16779 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
16780 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
16781 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
16782 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
16783 @acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
16784 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
16785 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
16786 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
16787 provided by the active file and overviews.
16788
16789 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
16790 resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
16791 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
16792 tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
16793 the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
16794 wins big.
16795
16796 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
16797 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
16798 tiny files.
16799
16800 @item nnmh
16801
16802 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
16803 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
16804 individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
16805 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
16806 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
16807 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
16808 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
16809
16810 @item nnfolder
16811
16812 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
16813 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
16814 itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
16815 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
16816 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
16817 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
16818 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
16819 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
16820 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
16821
16822 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
16823 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
16824 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
16825 friendly mail back end all over.
16826
16827 @item nnmaildir
16828
16829 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
16830 incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
16831 mail back ends.
16832
16833 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
16834 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
16835 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
16836 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
16837 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}.
16838 (Use @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this
16839 slows you down or takes up very much space, a non-block-structured
16840 file system.
16841
16842 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
16843 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
16844 This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
16845 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
16846 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
16847 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
16848 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
16849 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
16850 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
16851 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
16852 undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
16853
16854 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
16855 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
16856 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
16857 else, and still have your marks.
16858
16859 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
16860 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
16861 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
16862 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
16863 parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
16864 would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
16865 removed in the future.
16866
16867 Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
16868 back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
16869 on your file system.
16870
16871 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
16872 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
16873
16874 @end table
16875
16876
16877 @node Browsing the Web
16878 @section Browsing the Web
16879 @cindex web
16880 @cindex browsing the web
16881 @cindex www
16882 @cindex http
16883
16884 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
16885 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
16886 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
16887 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
16888 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
16889 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
16890 even know what a news group is.
16891
16892 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
16893 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
16894 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
16895 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
16896 you mad in the end.
16897
16898 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
16899 to do it instead?
16900
16901 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
16902 interfaces to these sources.
16903
16904 @menu
16905 * Archiving Mail::
16906 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
16907 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
16908 @end menu
16909
16910 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
16911 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
16912 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
16913 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
16914 though, you should be ok.
16915
16916 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
16917 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
16918 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
16919 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
16920 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
16921
16922 @node Archiving Mail
16923 @subsection Archiving Mail
16924 @cindex archiving mail
16925 @cindex backup of mail
16926
16927 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
16928 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
16929 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
16930 marks is fairly simple.
16931
16932 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
16933 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
16934 though.)
16935
16936 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
16937 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
16938 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
16939 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
16940 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
16941 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
16942 might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
16943 before you restore the data.
16944
16945 @node Web Searches
16946 @subsection Web Searches
16947 @cindex nnweb
16948 @cindex Google
16949 @cindex dejanews
16950 @cindex gmane
16951 @cindex Usenet searches
16952 @cindex searching the Usenet
16953
16954 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
16955 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
16956 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
16957 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
16958 searches without having to use a browser.
16959
16960 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
16961 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
16962 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
16963 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
16964 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
16965
16966 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
16967 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
16968 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
16969 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
16970 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
16971 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
16972 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
16973 engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
16974 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
16975 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
16976 group as read.
16977
16978 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
16979 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
16980 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'être} is to
16981 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
16982 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
16983 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
16984
16985 Virtual server variables:
16986
16987 @table @code
16988 @item nnweb-type
16989 @vindex nnweb-type
16990 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
16991 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
16992 @code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
16993
16994 @item nnweb-search
16995 @vindex nnweb-search
16996 The search string to feed to the search engine.
16997
16998 @item nnweb-max-hits
16999 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
17000 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
17001 999.
17002
17003 @item nnweb-type-definition
17004 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
17005 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
17006 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
17007 present:
17008
17009 @table @code
17010 @item article
17011 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
17012 understands.
17013
17014 @item map
17015 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
17016
17017 @item search
17018 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
17019
17020 @item address
17021 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
17022 to.
17023
17024 @item id
17025 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
17026 @end table
17027
17028 @end table
17029
17030
17031 @node RSS
17032 @subsection RSS
17033 @cindex nnrss
17034 @cindex RSS
17035
17036 Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
17037 @acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
17038 sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
17039 presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
17040 changes to a wiki (e.g., @url{http://cliki.net/site/recent-changes}).
17041
17042 @acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
17043 possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
17044
17045 Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
17046 system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
17047 text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
17048 group names.
17049
17050 @kindex G R (Group)
17051 Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
17052 prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
17053 The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
17054 and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
17055
17056 An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
17057 the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
17058 subscribe to groups.
17059
17060 The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
17061 @code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
17062 names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
17063 coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
17064 variable or other. Also @xref{Non-ASCII Group Names}, for more
17065 information.
17066
17067 The @code{nnrss} back end generates @samp{multipart/alternative}
17068 @acronym{MIME} articles in which each contains a @samp{text/plain} part
17069 and a @samp{text/html} part.
17070
17071 @cindex OPML
17072 You can also use the following commands to import and export your
17073 subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
17074 Markup Language).
17075
17076 @defun nnrss-opml-import file
17077 Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
17078 file.
17079 @end defun
17080
17081 @defun nnrss-opml-export
17082 Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
17083 @acronym{OPML} format.
17084 @end defun
17085
17086 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
17087
17088 @table @code
17089 @item nnrss-directory
17090 @vindex nnrss-directory
17091 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
17092 @file{~/News/rss/}.
17093
17094 @item nnrss-file-coding-system
17095 @vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
17096 The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
17097 data files. The default is the value of
17098 @code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
17099 in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
17100
17101 @item nnrss-ignore-article-fields
17102 @vindex nnrss-ignore-article-fields
17103 Some feeds update constantly article fields during their publications,
17104 e.g., to indicate the number of comments. However, if there is
17105 a difference between the local article and the distant one, the latter
17106 is considered to be new. To avoid this and discard some fields, set this
17107 variable to the list of fields to be ignored. The default is
17108 @code{'(slash:comments)}.
17109
17110 @item nnrss-use-local
17111 @vindex nnrss-use-local
17112 @findex nnrss-generate-download-script
17113 If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
17114 the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
17115 the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
17116 download script using @command{wget}.
17117 @end table
17118
17119 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
17120 the summary buffer.
17121
17122 @lisp
17123 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
17124 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
17125
17126 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
17127 (let ((descr
17128 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
17129 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
17130 @end lisp
17131
17132 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
17133 summary buffer.
17134
17135 @lisp
17136 (require 'browse-url)
17137
17138 (defun browse-nnrss-url (arg)
17139 (interactive "p")
17140 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
17141 (mail-header-extra
17142 (gnus-data-header
17143 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
17144 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
17145 (if url
17146 (progn
17147 (browse-url (cdr url))
17148 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
17149 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
17150
17151 (with-eval-after-load "gnus"
17152 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
17153 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
17154 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
17155 @end lisp
17156
17157 Even if you have added @samp{text/html} to the
17158 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} variable (@pxref{Display
17159 Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME
17160 Manual}) since you don't want to see @acronym{HTML} parts, it might be
17161 more useful especially in @code{nnrss} groups to display
17162 @samp{text/html} parts. Here's an example of setting
17163 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} as a group parameter (@pxref{Group
17164 Parameters}) in order to display @samp{text/html} parts only in
17165 @code{nnrss} groups:
17166
17167 @lisp
17168 ;; @r{Set the default value of @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}.}
17169 (with-eval-after-load "gnus-sum"
17170 (add-to-list
17171 'gnus-newsgroup-variables
17172 '(mm-discouraged-alternatives
17173 . '("text/html" "image/.*"))))
17174
17175 ;; @r{Display @samp{text/html} parts in @code{nnrss} groups.}
17176 (add-to-list
17177 'gnus-parameters
17178 '("\\`nnrss:" (mm-discouraged-alternatives nil)))
17179 @end lisp
17180
17181
17182 @node Other Sources
17183 @section Other Sources
17184
17185 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
17186 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
17187 newsgroups.
17188
17189 @menu
17190 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
17191 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
17192 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
17193 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
17194 * The Empty Backend:: The backend that never has any news.
17195 @end menu
17196
17197
17198 @node Directory Groups
17199 @subsection Directory Groups
17200 @cindex nndir
17201 @cindex directory groups
17202
17203 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
17204 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
17205 names, of course.
17206
17207 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
17208 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
17209 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
17210 back end to read directories. Big deal.
17211
17212 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
17213 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
17214 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
17215 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
17216 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
17217
17218 @code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
17219
17220 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
17221 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
17222 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
17223 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
17224
17225
17226 @node Anything Groups
17227 @subsection Anything Groups
17228 @cindex nneething
17229
17230 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
17231 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
17232 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
17233 true.
17234
17235 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
17236 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
17237 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
17238 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
17239 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
17240 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
17241 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
17242 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g., a C source file),
17243 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
17244 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
17245 elements.
17246
17247 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
17248 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
17249 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
17250 in the article buffer, just as usual.
17251
17252 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
17253 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
17254 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
17255 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
17256
17257 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
17258 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
17259 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
17260 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
17261 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
17262 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
17263 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
17264 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
17265
17266 Some variables:
17267
17268 @table @code
17269 @item nneething-map-file-directory
17270 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
17271 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
17272 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
17273
17274 @item nneething-exclude-files
17275 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
17276 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
17277 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
17278
17279 @item nneething-include-files
17280 @vindex nneething-include-files
17281 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
17282 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
17283
17284 @item nneething-map-file
17285 @vindex nneething-map-file
17286 Name of the map files.
17287 @end table
17288
17289
17290 @node Document Groups
17291 @subsection Document Groups
17292 @cindex nndoc
17293 @cindex documentation group
17294 @cindex help group
17295
17296 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
17297 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
17298
17299 @table @code
17300 @cindex Babyl
17301 @item babyl
17302 The Babyl format.
17303
17304 @cindex mbox
17305 @cindex Unix mbox
17306 @item mbox
17307 The standard Unix mbox file.
17308
17309 @cindex MMDF mail box
17310 @item mmdf
17311 The MMDF mail box format.
17312
17313 @item news
17314 Several news articles appended into a file.
17315
17316 @cindex rnews batch files
17317 @item rnews
17318 The rnews batch transport format.
17319
17320 @item nsmail
17321 Netscape mail boxes.
17322
17323 @item mime-parts
17324 @acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
17325
17326 @item standard-digest
17327 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
17328
17329 @item mime-digest
17330 A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
17331
17332 @item lanl-gov-announce
17333 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
17334
17335 @cindex git commit messages
17336 @item git
17337 @code{git} commit messages.
17338
17339 @cindex forwarded messages
17340 @item rfc822-forward
17341 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
17342
17343 @item outlook
17344 The Outlook mail box.
17345
17346 @item oe-dbx
17347 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
17348
17349 @item exim-bounce
17350 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
17351
17352 @item forward
17353 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
17354
17355 @item rfc934
17356 An RFC934-forwarded message.
17357
17358 @item mailman
17359 A mailman digest.
17360
17361 @item clari-briefs
17362 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
17363
17364 @item slack-digest
17365 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
17366
17367 @item mail-in-mail
17368 The last resort.
17369 @end table
17370
17371 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
17372 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
17373 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
17374 file is.
17375
17376 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
17377 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
17378 group. And that's it.
17379
17380 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
17381 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
17382 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
17383 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
17384 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
17385 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
17386 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
17387 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
17388 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
17389 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
17390
17391 Virtual server variables:
17392
17393 @table @code
17394 @item nndoc-article-type
17395 @vindex nndoc-article-type
17396 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
17397 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
17398 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
17399 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
17400 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
17401
17402 @item nndoc-post-type
17403 @vindex nndoc-post-type
17404 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
17405 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
17406 and @code{news}.
17407 @end table
17408
17409 @menu
17410 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
17411 @end menu
17412
17413
17414 @node Document Server Internals
17415 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
17416
17417 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
17418 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
17419 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
17420 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
17421
17422 First, here's an example document type definition:
17423
17424 @example
17425 (mmdf
17426 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
17427 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
17428 @end example
17429
17430 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
17431 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
17432 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
17433 types can be defined with very few settings:
17434
17435 @table @code
17436 @item first-article
17437 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
17438 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
17439 totally ignored.
17440
17441 @item article-begin
17442 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
17443 says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
17444 complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
17445 use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
17446
17447 @item article-begin-function
17448 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
17449 of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
17450
17451 @item head-begin
17452 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
17453 article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
17454 simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
17455
17456 @item head-begin-function
17457 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
17458 the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
17459
17460 @item head-end
17461 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
17462 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
17463
17464 @item body-begin
17465 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
17466 to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
17467 a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
17468
17469 @item body-begin-function
17470 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
17471 of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
17472
17473 @item body-end
17474 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
17475 more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
17476 can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
17477
17478 @item body-end-function
17479 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
17480 the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
17481
17482 @item file-begin
17483 If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
17484 before this regexp will be totally ignored.
17485
17486 @item file-end
17487 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
17488 regexp will be totally ignored.
17489
17490 @end table
17491
17492 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
17493 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
17494 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
17495 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
17496 something that's palatable for Gnus:
17497
17498 @table @code
17499 @item prepare-body-function
17500 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
17501 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
17502 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
17503
17504 @item article-transform-function
17505 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
17506 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
17507 body of the article.
17508
17509 @item generate-head-function
17510 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
17511 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
17512 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
17513 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
17514
17515 @item generate-article-function
17516 If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
17517 Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
17518 parameter when requesting all articles.
17519
17520 @item dissection-function
17521 If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
17522 overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
17523 @code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
17524 @code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
17525 @code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
17526 @code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
17527
17528 @end table
17529
17530 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
17531 digests:
17532
17533 @example
17534 (standard-digest
17535 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17536 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17537 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
17538 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
17539 (head-end . "^ ?$")
17540 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
17541 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
17542 (subtype digest guess))
17543 @end example
17544
17545 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
17546 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
17547 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
17548 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
17549 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
17550
17551 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
17552 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
17553 is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
17554 where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
17555 The alist is traversed sequentially, and
17556 @code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
17557 So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
17558 @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
17559 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
17560 is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
17561 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
17562 means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
17563
17564
17565 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
17566 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17567 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
17568 @cindex gateways
17569
17570 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17571 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17572 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
17573
17574 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17575 used to post with.
17576
17577 Server variables:
17578
17579 @table @code
17580 @item nngateway-address
17581 @vindex nngateway-address
17582 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
17583
17584 @item nngateway-header-transformation
17585 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17586 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17587 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17588 transformation should be called, and defaults to
17589 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17590 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17591 gateway address.
17592
17593 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17594 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17595 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
17596
17597 @example
17598 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17599 @end example
17600
17601 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
17602
17603 @example
17604 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17605 @end example
17606
17607 The following pre-defined functions exist:
17608
17609 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17610 @table @code
17611
17612 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17613 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17614 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
17615
17616 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17617
17618 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17619 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17620 @code{nngateway-address}.
17621 @end table
17622
17623 @end table
17624
17625 Here's an example:
17626
17627 @lisp
17628 (setq gnus-post-method
17629 '(nngateway
17630 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17631 (nngateway-header-transformation
17632 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17633 @end lisp
17634
17635 So, to use this, simply say something like:
17636
17637 @lisp
17638 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17639 @end lisp
17640
17641
17642 @node The Empty Backend
17643 @subsection The Empty Backend
17644 @cindex nnnil
17645
17646 @code{nnnil} is a backend that can be used as a placeholder if you
17647 have to specify a backend somewhere, but don't really want to. The
17648 classical example is if you don't want to have a primary select
17649 methods, but want to only use secondary ones:
17650
17651 @lisp
17652 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnnil ""))
17653 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
17654 '((nnimap "foo")
17655 (nnml "")))
17656 @end lisp
17657
17658
17659 @node Combined Groups
17660 @section Combined Groups
17661
17662 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17663 groups.
17664
17665 @menu
17666 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
17667 @end menu
17668
17669
17670 @node Virtual Groups
17671 @subsection Virtual Groups
17672 @cindex nnvirtual
17673 @cindex virtual groups
17674 @cindex merging groups
17675
17676 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17677 other groups.
17678
17679 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17680 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17681 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
17682
17683 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17684 regexp to match component groups.
17685
17686 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17687 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17688 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17689 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17690 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17691 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17692 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17693 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
17694
17695 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17696 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
17697
17698 @lisp
17699 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17700 @end lisp
17701
17702 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17703 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
17704
17705 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17706 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17707 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17708 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
17709
17710 @example
17711 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17712 @end example
17713
17714 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17715 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17716 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
17717
17718 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17719 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17720 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17721 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17722 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
17723
17724 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17725 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17726 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
17727
17728 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17729 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} variable is non-@code{nil} (which
17730 is the default), @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread
17731 articles when entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil}
17732 and you read articles in a component group after the virtual group has
17733 been activated, the read articles from the component group will show up
17734 when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this effect if you
17735 have two virtual groups that have a component group in common. If
17736 that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}. Or you can
17737 just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before you enter
17738 it---it'll have much the same effect.
17739
17740 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17741 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17742 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17743 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17744 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17745 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17746 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
17747
17748 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17749 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
17750
17751 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17752 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17753 inherited.
17754
17755
17756 @node Email Based Diary
17757 @section Email Based Diary
17758 @cindex diary
17759 @cindex email based diary
17760 @cindex calendar
17761
17762 This section describes a special mail back end called @code{nndiary},
17763 and its companion library @code{gnus-diary}. It is ``special'' in the
17764 sense that it is not meant to be one of the standard alternatives for
17765 reading mail with Gnus. See @ref{Choosing a Mail Back End} for that.
17766 Instead, it is used to treat @emph{some} of your mails in a special way,
17767 namely, as event reminders.
17768
17769 Here is a typical scenario:
17770
17771 @itemize @bullet
17772 @item
17773 You've got a date with Andy Mc Dowell or Bruce Willis (select according
17774 to your sexual preference) in one month. You don't want to forget it.
17775 @item
17776 So you send a ``reminder'' message (actually, a diary one) to yourself.
17777 @item
17778 You forget all about it and keep on getting and reading new mail, as usual.
17779 @item
17780 From time to time, as you type @kbd{g} in the group buffer and as the date
17781 is getting closer, the message will pop up again to remind you of your
17782 appointment, just as if it were new and unread.
17783 @item
17784 Read your ``new'' messages, this one included, and start dreaming again
17785 of the night you're gonna have.
17786 @item
17787 Once the date is over (you actually fell asleep just after dinner), the
17788 message will be automatically deleted if it is marked as expirable.
17789 @end itemize
17790
17791 The Gnus Diary back end has the ability to handle regular appointments
17792 (that wouldn't ever be deleted) as well as punctual ones, operates as a
17793 real mail back end and is configurable in many ways. All of this is
17794 explained in the sections below.
17795
17796 @menu
17797 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
17798 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
17799 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
17800 @end menu
17801
17802
17803 @node The NNDiary Back End
17804 @subsection The NNDiary Back End
17805 @cindex nndiary
17806 @cindex the nndiary back end
17807
17808 @code{nndiary} is a back end very similar to @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
17809 Spool}). Actually, it could appear as a mix of @code{nnml} and
17810 @code{nndraft}. If you know @code{nnml}, you're already familiar with
17811 the message storing scheme of @code{nndiary}: one file per message, one
17812 directory per group.
17813
17814 Before anything, there is one requirement to be able to run
17815 @code{nndiary} properly: you @emph{must} use the group timestamp feature
17816 of Gnus. This adds a timestamp to each group's parameters. @ref{Group
17817 Timestamp} to see how it's done.
17818
17819 @menu
17820 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
17821 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
17822 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
17823 @end menu
17824
17825 @node Diary Messages
17826 @subsubsection Diary Messages
17827 @cindex nndiary messages
17828 @cindex nndiary mails
17829
17830 @code{nndiary} messages are just normal ones, except for the mandatory
17831 presence of 7 special headers. These headers are of the form
17832 @code{X-Diary-<something>}, @code{<something>} being one of
17833 @code{Minute}, @code{Hour}, @code{Dom}, @code{Month}, @code{Year},
17834 @code{Time-Zone} and @code{Dow}. @code{Dom} means ``Day of Month'', and
17835 @code{dow} means ``Day of Week''. These headers actually behave like
17836 crontab specifications and define the event date(s):
17837
17838 @itemize @bullet
17839 @item
17840 For all headers except the @code{Time-Zone} one, a header value is
17841 either a star (meaning all possible values), or a list of fields
17842 (separated by a comma).
17843 @item
17844 A field is either an integer, or a range.
17845 @item
17846 A range is two integers separated by a dash.
17847 @item
17848 Possible integer values are 0--59 for @code{Minute}, 0--23 for
17849 @code{Hour}, 1--31 for @code{Dom}, 1--12 for @code{Month}, above 1971
17850 for @code{Year} and 0--6 for @code{Dow} (0 meaning Sunday).
17851 @item
17852 As a special case, a star in either @code{Dom} or @code{Dow} doesn't
17853 mean ``all possible values'', but ``use only the other field''. Note
17854 that if both are star'ed, the use of either one gives the same result.
17855 @item
17856 The @code{Time-Zone} header is special in that it can only have one
17857 value (@code{GMT}, for instance). A star doesn't mean ``all possible
17858 values'' (because it makes no sense), but ``the current local time
17859 zone''. Most of the time, you'll be using a star here. However, for a
17860 list of available time zone values, see the variable
17861 @code{nndiary-headers}.
17862 @end itemize
17863
17864 As a concrete example, here are the diary headers to add to your message
17865 for specifying ``Each Monday and each 1st of month, at 12:00, 20:00,
17866 21:00, 22:00, 23:00 and 24:00, from 1999 to 2010'' (I'll let you find
17867 what to do then):
17868
17869 @example
17870 X-Diary-Minute: 0
17871 X-Diary-Hour: 12, 20-24
17872 X-Diary-Dom: 1
17873 X-Diary-Month: *
17874 X-Diary-Year: 1999-2010
17875 X-Diary-Dow: 1
17876 X-Diary-Time-Zone: *
17877 @end example
17878
17879 @node Running NNDiary
17880 @subsubsection Running NNDiary
17881 @cindex running nndiary
17882 @cindex nndiary operation modes
17883
17884 @code{nndiary} has two modes of operation: ``traditional'' (the default)
17885 and ``autonomous''. In traditional mode, @code{nndiary} does not get new
17886 mail by itself. You have to move (@kbd{B m}) or copy (@kbd{B c}) mails
17887 from your primary mail back end to nndiary groups in order to handle them
17888 as diary messages. In autonomous mode, @code{nndiary} retrieves its own
17889 mail and handles it independently from your primary mail back end.
17890
17891 One should note that Gnus is not inherently designed to allow several
17892 ``master'' mail back ends at the same time. However, this does make
17893 sense with @code{nndiary}: you really want to send and receive diary
17894 messages to your diary groups directly. So, @code{nndiary} supports
17895 being sort of a ``second primary mail back end'' (to my knowledge, it is
17896 the only back end offering this feature). However, there is a limitation
17897 (which I hope to fix some day): respooling doesn't work in autonomous
17898 mode.
17899
17900 In order to use @code{nndiary} in autonomous mode, you have several
17901 things to do:
17902
17903 @itemize @bullet
17904 @item
17905 Allow @code{nndiary} to retrieve new mail by itself. Put the following
17906 line in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
17907
17908 @lisp
17909 (setq nndiary-get-new-mail t)
17910 @end lisp
17911 @item
17912 You must arrange for diary messages (those containing @code{X-Diary-*}
17913 headers) to be split in a private folder @emph{before} Gnus treat them.
17914 Again, this is needed because Gnus cannot (yet ?) properly handle
17915 multiple primary mail back ends. Getting those messages from a separate
17916 source will compensate this misfeature to some extent.
17917
17918 As an example, here's my procmailrc entry to store diary files in
17919 @file{~/.nndiary} (the default @code{nndiary} mail source file):
17920
17921 @example
17922 :0 HD :
17923 * ^X-Diary
17924 .nndiary
17925 @end example
17926 @end itemize
17927
17928 Once this is done, you might want to customize the following two options
17929 that affect the diary mail retrieval and splitting processes:
17930
17931 @defvar nndiary-mail-sources
17932 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
17933 @code{mail-sources} variable. It obeys the same syntax, and defaults to
17934 @code{(file :path "~/.nndiary")}.
17935 @end defvar
17936
17937 @defvar nndiary-split-methods
17938 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
17939 @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable. It obeys the same syntax.
17940 @end defvar
17941
17942 Finally, you may add a permanent @code{nndiary} virtual server
17943 (something like @code{(nndiary "diary")} should do) to your
17944 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}.
17945
17946 Hopefully, almost everything (see the TODO section in
17947 @file{nndiary.el}) will work as expected when you restart Gnus: in
17948 autonomous mode, typing @kbd{g} and @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer, will
17949 also get your new diary mails and split them according to your
17950 diary-specific rules, @kbd{F} will find your new diary groups etc.
17951
17952 @node Customizing NNDiary
17953 @subsubsection Customizing NNDiary
17954 @cindex customizing nndiary
17955 @cindex nndiary customization
17956
17957 Now that @code{nndiary} is up and running, it's time to customize it.
17958 The custom group is called @code{nndiary} (no, really ?!). You should
17959 browse it to figure out which options you'd like to tweak. The following
17960 two variables are probably the only ones you will want to change:
17961
17962 @defvar nndiary-reminders
17963 This is the list of times when you want to be reminded of your
17964 appointments (e.g., 3 weeks before, then 2 days before, then 1 hour
17965 before and that's it). Remember that ``being reminded'' means that the
17966 diary message will pop up as brand new and unread again when you get new
17967 mail.
17968 @end defvar
17969
17970 @defvar nndiary-week-starts-on-monday
17971 Rather self-explanatory. Otherwise, Sunday is assumed (this is the
17972 default).
17973 @end defvar
17974
17975
17976 @node The Gnus Diary Library
17977 @subsection The Gnus Diary Library
17978 @cindex gnus-diary
17979 @cindex the gnus diary library
17980
17981 Using @code{nndiary} manually (I mean, writing the headers by hand and
17982 so on) would be rather boring. Fortunately, there is a library called
17983 @code{gnus-diary} written on top of @code{nndiary}, that does many
17984 useful things for you.
17985
17986 In order to use it, add the following line to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
17987
17988 @lisp
17989 (require 'gnus-diary)
17990 @end lisp
17991
17992 Also, you shouldn't use any @code{gnus-user-format-function-[d|D]}
17993 (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} provides both of these
17994 (sorry if you used them before).
17995
17996
17997 @menu
17998 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
17999 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
18000 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
18001 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
18002 @end menu
18003
18004 @node Diary Summary Line Format
18005 @subsubsection Diary Summary Line Format
18006 @cindex diary summary buffer line
18007 @cindex diary summary line format
18008
18009 Displaying diary messages in standard summary line format (usually
18010 something like @samp{From Joe: Subject}) is pretty useless. Most of
18011 the time, you're the one who wrote the message, and you mostly want to
18012 see the event's date.
18013
18014 @code{gnus-diary} provides two supplemental user formats to be used in
18015 summary line formats. @code{D} corresponds to a formatted time string
18016 for the next occurrence of the event (e.g., ``Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00''),
18017 while @code{d} corresponds to an approximate remaining time until the
18018 next occurrence of the event (e.g., ``in 6 months, 1 week'').
18019
18020 For example, here's how Joe's birthday is displayed in my
18021 @code{nndiary+diary:birthdays} summary buffer (note that the message is
18022 expirable, but will never be deleted, as it specifies a periodic event):
18023
18024 @example
18025 E Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00: Joe's birthday (in 6 months, 1 week)
18026 @end example
18027
18028 In order to get something like the above, you would normally add the
18029 following line to your diary groups'parameters:
18030
18031 @lisp
18032 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z %uD: %(%s%) (%ud)\n")
18033 @end lisp
18034
18035 However, @code{gnus-diary} does it automatically (@pxref{Diary Group
18036 Parameters}). You can however customize the provided summary line format
18037 with the following user options:
18038
18039 @defvar gnus-diary-summary-line-format
18040 Defines the summary line format used for diary groups (@pxref{Summary
18041 Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} uses it to automatically update the
18042 diary groups'parameters.
18043 @end defvar
18044
18045 @defvar gnus-diary-time-format
18046 Defines the format to display dates in diary summary buffers. This is
18047 used by the @code{D} user format. See the docstring for details.
18048 @end defvar
18049
18050 @defvar gnus-diary-delay-format-function
18051 Defines the format function to use for displaying delays (remaining
18052 times) in diary summary buffers. This is used by the @code{d} user
18053 format. There are currently built-in functions for English and French;
18054 you can also define your own. See the docstring for details.
18055 @end defvar
18056
18057 @node Diary Articles Sorting
18058 @subsubsection Diary Articles Sorting
18059 @cindex diary articles sorting
18060 @cindex diary summary lines sorting
18061 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule
18062 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule
18063 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-schedule
18064
18065 @code{gnus-diary} provides new sorting functions (@pxref{Sorting the
18066 Summary Buffer} ) called @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule},
18067 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule} and
18068 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-schedule}. These functions let you organize
18069 your diary summary buffers from the closest event to the farthest one.
18070
18071 @code{gnus-diary} automatically installs
18072 @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule} as a menu item in the summary
18073 buffer's ``sort'' menu, and the two others as the primary (hence
18074 default) sorting functions in the group parameters (@pxref{Diary Group
18075 Parameters}).
18076
18077 @node Diary Headers Generation
18078 @subsubsection Diary Headers Generation
18079 @cindex diary headers generation
18080 @findex gnus-diary-check-message
18081
18082 @code{gnus-diary} provides a function called
18083 @code{gnus-diary-check-message} to help you handle the @code{X-Diary-*}
18084 headers. This function ensures that the current message contains all the
18085 required diary headers, and prompts you for values or corrections if
18086 needed.
18087
18088 This function is hooked into the @code{nndiary} back end, so that
18089 moving or copying an article to a diary group will trigger it
18090 automatically. It is also bound to @kbd{C-c C-f d} in
18091 @code{message-mode} and @code{article-edit-mode} in order to ease the
18092 process of converting a usual mail to a diary one.
18093
18094 This function takes a prefix argument which will force prompting of
18095 all diary headers, regardless of their presence or validity. That way,
18096 you can very easily reschedule an already valid diary message, for
18097 instance.
18098
18099 @node Diary Group Parameters
18100 @subsubsection Diary Group Parameters
18101 @cindex diary group parameters
18102
18103 When you create a new diary group, or visit one, @code{gnus-diary}
18104 automatically checks your group parameters and if needed, sets the
18105 summary line format to the diary-specific value, installs the
18106 diary-specific sorting functions, and also adds the different
18107 @code{X-Diary-*} headers to the group's posting-style. It is then easier
18108 to send a diary message, because if you use @kbd{C-u a} or @kbd{C-u m}
18109 on a diary group to prepare a message, these headers will be inserted
18110 automatically (although not filled with proper values yet).
18111
18112 @node Sending or Not Sending
18113 @subsection Sending or Not Sending
18114
18115 Well, assuming you've read all of the above, here are two final notes on
18116 mail sending with @code{nndiary}:
18117
18118 @itemize @bullet
18119 @item
18120 @code{nndiary} is a @emph{real} mail back end. You really send real diary
18121 messages for real. This means for instance that you can give
18122 appointments to anybody (provided they use Gnus and @code{nndiary}) by
18123 sending the diary message to them as well.
18124 @item
18125 However, since @code{nndiary} also has a @code{request-post} method, you
18126 can also use @kbd{C-u a} instead of @kbd{C-u m} on a diary group and the
18127 message won't actually be sent; just stored locally in the group. This
18128 comes in very handy for private appointments.
18129 @end itemize
18130
18131 @node Gnus Unplugged
18132 @section Gnus Unplugged
18133 @cindex offline
18134 @cindex unplugged
18135 @cindex agent
18136 @cindex Gnus agent
18137 @cindex Gnus unplugged
18138
18139 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
18140 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
18141 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
18142 read news. Believe it or not.
18143
18144 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
18145 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
18146 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
18147 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
18148 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
18149
18150 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
18151 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
18152 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
18153 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
18154 reading news on a machine.
18155
18156 Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
18157 fact, you don't have to configure anything as the agent is now enabled
18158 by default (@pxref{Agent Variables, gnus-agent}).
18159
18160 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
18161
18162 @menu
18163 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
18164 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
18165 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
18166 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
18167 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
18168 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
18169 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
18170 * Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
18171 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
18172 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
18173 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
18174 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
18175 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
18176 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
18177 @end menu
18178
18179
18180 @node Agent Basics
18181 @subsection Agent Basics
18182
18183 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
18184
18185 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
18186 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
18187 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
18188 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
18189
18190 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
18191 connected to the net continuously.
18192
18193 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
18194 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
18195
18196 You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
18197 shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
18198 is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
18199 say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
18200 you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
18201
18202 Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
18203 that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
18204 can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
18205 servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
18206 they're kinda like plugged always).
18207
18208 So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
18209 connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
18210 servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
18211 the culprit.
18212
18213 Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
18214 reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
18215 server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
18216 server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
18217 will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
18218
18219 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
18220
18221 @itemize @bullet
18222
18223 @item
18224 @findex gnus-unplugged
18225 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
18226 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
18227 already fetched while in this mode.
18228
18229 @item
18230 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
18231 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
18232 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
18233 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
18234 Source Specifiers}).
18235
18236 @item
18237 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
18238 news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
18239 @kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
18240 all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
18241 articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
18242
18243 @item
18244 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
18245 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
18246 then you read the news offline.
18247
18248 @item
18249 And then you go to step 2.
18250 @end itemize
18251
18252 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
18253 the Agent.
18254
18255 @itemize @bullet
18256
18257 @item
18258 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
18259 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
18260 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
18261 @kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
18262 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
18263 added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
18264 no servers are agentized.
18265
18266 @item
18267 Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
18268 you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
18269 parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
18270 is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
18271
18272 Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
18273 (@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
18274 to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
18275 parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
18276 to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
18277 your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
18278 configure them.
18279
18280 @item
18281 Uhm@dots{} that's it.
18282 @end itemize
18283
18284
18285 @node Agent Categories
18286 @subsection Agent Categories
18287
18288 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
18289 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
18290 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
18291 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
18292 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
18293 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
18294 you're interested in the articles anyway.
18295
18296 One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
18297 downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
18298 groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
18299 category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
18300 buffer for creating and managing categories.
18301
18302 If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
18303 Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
18304 alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
18305 difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
18306 less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
18307 sink.
18308
18309 Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
18310 a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
18311 the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
18312 parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
18313 variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
18314 of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
18315 your settings.
18316
18317 @menu
18318 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
18319 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
18320 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
18321 @end menu
18322
18323
18324 @node Category Syntax
18325 @subsubsection Category Syntax
18326
18327 A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
18328 category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
18329 customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
18330 listed below.
18331
18332 @cindex Agent Parameters
18333 @table @code
18334 @item agent-groups
18335 The list of groups that are in this category.
18336
18337 @item agent-predicate
18338 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
18339 are eligible for downloading; and
18340
18341 @item agent-score
18342 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
18343 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
18344 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
18345
18346 @item agent-enable-expiration
18347 a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
18348 this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
18349 fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
18350 only groups that should not be expired.
18351
18352 @item agent-days-until-old
18353 an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
18354 before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
18355
18356 @item agent-low-score
18357 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
18358
18359 @item agent-high-score
18360 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
18361
18362 @item agent-short-article
18363 an integer that overrides the value of
18364 @code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
18365
18366 @item agent-long-article
18367 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
18368
18369 @item agent-enable-undownloaded-faces
18370 a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
18371 undownloaded articles using the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face}
18372 faces. Any symbol other than @code{nil} will enable the use of
18373 undownloaded faces.
18374 @end table
18375
18376 The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
18377 created.
18378
18379 Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
18380 that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
18381 group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
18382 category.
18383
18384 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
18385 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
18386 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
18387 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
18388
18389 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
18390 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
18391 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
18392
18393 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
18394 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
18395 operators sprinkled in between.
18396
18397 Perhaps some examples are in order.
18398
18399 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
18400 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
18401
18402 @lisp
18403 short
18404 @end lisp
18405
18406 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
18407 short (for some value of ``short'').
18408
18409 Here's a more complex predicate:
18410
18411 @lisp
18412 (or high
18413 (and
18414 (not low)
18415 (not long)))
18416 @end lisp
18417
18418 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
18419 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
18420 drift.
18421
18422 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
18423 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
18424 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
18425
18426 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
18427 you want to do, you can write your own.
18428
18429 When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
18430 bound to the value determined by calling
18431 @code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
18432 example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
18433 @code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
18434 means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
18435 predicate to individual groups.
18436
18437 @table @code
18438 @item short
18439 True if the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
18440 lines; default 100.
18441
18442 @item long
18443 True if the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
18444 lines; default 200.
18445
18446 @item low
18447 True if the article has a download score less than
18448 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
18449
18450 @item high
18451 True if the article has a download score greater than
18452 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
18453
18454 @item spam
18455 True if the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
18456 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
18457 checksum and sees whether articles match.
18458
18459 @item true
18460 Always true.
18461
18462 @item false
18463 Always false.
18464 @end table
18465
18466 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
18467 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
18468 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
18469 useful values.
18470
18471 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
18472 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g., posted
18473 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
18474 something along the lines of the following:
18475
18476 @lisp
18477 (defun my-article-old-p ()
18478 "Say whether an article is old."
18479 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
18480 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
18481 @end lisp
18482
18483 with the predicate then defined as:
18484
18485 @lisp
18486 (not my-article-old-p)
18487 @end lisp
18488
18489 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
18490 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
18491 wherever.
18492
18493 @lisp
18494 (require 'gnus-agent)
18495 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
18496 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
18497 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
18498 @end lisp
18499
18500 and simply specify your predicate as:
18501
18502 @lisp
18503 (not old)
18504 @end lisp
18505
18506 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
18507 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
18508 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
18509 just don't give a damn.
18510
18511 The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
18512 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
18513 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
18514 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
18515 parameters like so:
18516
18517 @lisp
18518 (agent-predicate . short)
18519 @end lisp
18520
18521 This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
18522 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
18523 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
18524
18525 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
18526
18527 @lisp
18528 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
18529 @end lisp
18530
18531 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
18532 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
18533 predicate is assumed to be a list.
18534
18535
18536 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
18537 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
18538 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
18539 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
18540 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
18541 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
18542
18543 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
18544 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
18545 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
18546 if it's to be specific to that group.
18547
18548 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
18549 three forms:
18550
18551 @enumerate
18552 @item
18553 Score rule
18554
18555 This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
18556 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
18557
18558 example:
18559
18560 @itemize @bullet
18561 @item
18562 Category specification
18563
18564 @lisp
18565 (("from"
18566 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18567 ("lines"
18568 (500 -100 nil <)))
18569 @end lisp
18570
18571 @item
18572 Group/Topic Parameter specification
18573
18574 @lisp
18575 (agent-score ("from"
18576 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18577 ("lines"
18578 (500 -100 nil <)))
18579 @end lisp
18580
18581 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
18582 @end itemize
18583
18584 @item
18585 Agent score file
18586
18587 These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
18588 keywords stated above.
18589
18590 example:
18591
18592 @itemize @bullet
18593 @item
18594 Category specification
18595
18596 @lisp
18597 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
18598 @end lisp
18599
18600 or perhaps
18601
18602 @lisp
18603 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
18604 @end lisp
18605
18606 @item
18607 Group Parameter specification
18608
18609 @lisp
18610 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
18611 @end lisp
18612
18613 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
18614 about parenthesis?
18615 @end itemize
18616
18617 @item
18618 Use @code{normal} score files
18619
18620 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
18621 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
18622 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
18623 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
18624
18625 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
18626 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
18627 files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
18628 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
18629
18630 @itemize @bullet
18631 @item
18632 Category Specification
18633
18634 @lisp
18635 file
18636 @end lisp
18637
18638 @item
18639 Group Parameter specification
18640
18641 @lisp
18642 (agent-score . file)
18643 @end lisp
18644 @end itemize
18645 @end enumerate
18646
18647 @node Category Buffer
18648 @subsubsection Category Buffer
18649
18650 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
18651 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
18652 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
18653
18654 The following commands are available in this buffer:
18655
18656 @table @kbd
18657 @item q
18658 @kindex q (Category)
18659 @findex gnus-category-exit
18660 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
18661
18662 @item e
18663 @kindex e (Category)
18664 @findex gnus-category-customize-category
18665 Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
18666 parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
18667
18668 @item k
18669 @kindex k (Category)
18670 @findex gnus-category-kill
18671 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
18672
18673 @item c
18674 @kindex c (Category)
18675 @findex gnus-category-copy
18676 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
18677
18678 @item a
18679 @kindex a (Category)
18680 @findex gnus-category-add
18681 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
18682
18683 @item p
18684 @kindex p (Category)
18685 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
18686 Edit the predicate of the current category
18687 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
18688
18689 @item g
18690 @kindex g (Category)
18691 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18692 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18693 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
18694
18695 @item s
18696 @kindex s (Category)
18697 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
18698 Edit the download score rule of the current category
18699 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
18700
18701 @item l
18702 @kindex l (Category)
18703 @findex gnus-category-list
18704 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18705 @end table
18706
18707
18708 @node Category Variables
18709 @subsubsection Category Variables
18710
18711 @table @code
18712 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
18713 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18714 Hook run in category buffers.
18715
18716 @item gnus-category-line-format
18717 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
18718 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18719 Variables}). Valid elements are:
18720
18721 @table @samp
18722 @item c
18723 The name of the category.
18724
18725 @item g
18726 The number of groups in the category.
18727 @end table
18728
18729 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18730 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18731 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
18732
18733 @item gnus-agent-short-article
18734 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18735 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
18736
18737 @item gnus-agent-long-article
18738 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18739 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
18740
18741 @item gnus-agent-low-score
18742 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18743 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
18744 0.
18745
18746 @item gnus-agent-high-score
18747 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18748 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
18749 0.
18750
18751 @item gnus-agent-expire-days
18752 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18753 The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18754 local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18755 the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18756 just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18757 important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18758 article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18759 read.
18760 Default 7.
18761
18762 @item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18763 @vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18764 Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18765 retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18766 you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18767 you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18768 have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18769
18770 @end table
18771
18772
18773 @node Agent Commands
18774 @subsection Agent Commands
18775 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18776 @kindex J j (Agent)
18777
18778 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18779 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
18780 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
18781
18782
18783 @menu
18784 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
18785 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
18786 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
18787 @end menu
18788
18789
18790
18791
18792 @node Group Agent Commands
18793 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
18794
18795 @table @kbd
18796 @item J u
18797 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
18798 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
18799 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
18800 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
18801
18802 @item J c
18803 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
18804 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
18805 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
18806
18807 @item J s
18808 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
18809 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
18810 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
18811 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
18812
18813 @item J S
18814 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
18815 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
18816 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
18817 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
18818
18819 @item J a
18820 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
18821 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
18822 Add the current group to an Agent category
18823 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
18824 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18825
18826 @item J r
18827 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
18828 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
18829 Remove the current group from its category, if any
18830 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
18831 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18832
18833 @item J Y
18834 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
18835 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18836 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
18837
18838
18839 @end table
18840
18841
18842 @node Summary Agent Commands
18843 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
18844
18845 @table @kbd
18846 @item J #
18847 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
18848 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
18849 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
18850
18851 @item J M-#
18852 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
18853 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
18854 Remove the downloading mark from the article
18855 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
18856
18857 @cindex %
18858 @item @@
18859 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
18860 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
18861 Toggle whether to download the article
18862 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
18863 default.
18864
18865 @item J c
18866 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
18867 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
18868 Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
18869
18870 @item J S
18871 @kindex J S (Agent Summary)
18872 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
18873 Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
18874 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
18875
18876 @item J s
18877 @kindex J s (Agent Summary)
18878 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series
18879 Download all processable articles in this group.
18880 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series}).
18881
18882 @item J u
18883 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
18884 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
18885 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
18886 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
18887
18888 @end table
18889
18890
18891 @node Server Agent Commands
18892 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
18893
18894 @table @kbd
18895 @item J a
18896 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
18897 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
18898 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
18899 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
18900
18901 @item J r
18902 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
18903 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
18904 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
18905 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
18906
18907 @end table
18908
18909
18910 @node Agent Visuals
18911 @subsection Agent Visuals
18912
18913 If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
18914 active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
18915 stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
18916 something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
18917 placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
18918 there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
18919 When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
18920 placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
18921 You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
18922 placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
18923
18924 While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
18925 available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
18926 fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
18927 way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
18928 less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
18929 adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
18930 the download status of each article so that you always know which
18931 articles will be available when unplugged.
18932
18933 The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
18934 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
18935 a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
18936 Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
18937 will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
18938 other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
18939 @samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
18940 (@samp{ }) will be displayed.
18941
18942 The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
18943 are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
18944 result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
18945 that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
18946 face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
18947 tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
18948 conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
18949 that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
18950 to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
18951
18952 If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
18953 each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
18954 undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
18955 being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
18956 downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear. For those
18957 users using the agent to improve online performance by caching the NOV
18958 database (most users since 5.10.2), the undownloaded faces may appear
18959 to be an absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since none
18960 of their articles have been fetched into the Agent, all of the
18961 normal faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces.
18962
18963 If you would like to use the undownloaded faces, you must enable the
18964 undownloaded faces by setting the @code{agent-enable-undownloaded-faces}
18965 group parameter to @code{t}. This parameter, like all other agent
18966 parameters, may be set on an Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}),
18967 a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic Parameters}), or an individual group
18968 (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
18969
18970 The one problem common to all users using the agent is how quickly it
18971 can consume disk space. If you using the agent on many groups, it is
18972 even more difficult to effectively recover disk space. One solution
18973 is the @samp{%F} format available in @code{gnus-group-line-format}.
18974 This format will display the actual disk space used by articles
18975 fetched into both the agent and cache. By knowing which groups use
18976 the most space, users know where to focus their efforts when ``agent
18977 expiring'' articles.
18978
18979 @node Agent as Cache
18980 @subsection Agent as Cache
18981
18982 When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
18983 articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
18984 Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
18985 in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
18986 buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
18987 are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
18988 consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
18989 article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
18990 server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
18991
18992 If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
18993 @pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
18994 plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
18995 synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
18996 sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
18997
18998 @node Agent Expiry
18999 @subsection Agent Expiry
19000
19001 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
19002 @findex gnus-agent-expire
19003 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
19004 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
19005 @findex gnus-agent-expire-group
19006 @cindex agent expiry
19007 @cindex Gnus agent expiry
19008 @cindex expiry, in Gnus agent
19009
19010 The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
19011 least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
19012 special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
19013 commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
19014 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
19015 that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
19016 efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
19017 @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
19018
19019 Note that other functions might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you
19020 to keep the agent synchronized with the group.
19021
19022 The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
19023 prevent expiration in selected groups.
19024
19025 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
19026 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
19027 expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
19028 and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
19029 are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
19030 be kept indefinitely.
19031
19032 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
19033 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
19034 commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
19035 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
19036
19037 @node Agent Regeneration
19038 @subsection Agent Regeneration
19039
19040 @cindex agent regeneration
19041 @cindex Gnus agent regeneration
19042 @cindex regeneration
19043
19044 The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
19045 due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
19046 @code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
19047 to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
19048 internal inconsistencies.
19049
19050 For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
19051 downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
19052 know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
19053 failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
19054 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
19055 such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
19056
19057 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
19058 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
19059 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
19060 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
19061 you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
19062 recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
19063
19064 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
19065 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
19066 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
19067 of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
19068 then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
19069 are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
19070 agent as unread.
19071
19072 @node Agent and flags
19073 @subsection Agent and flags
19074
19075 The Agent works with any Gnus back end including those, such as
19076 nnimap, that store flags (read, ticked, etc.)@: on the server. Sadly,
19077 the Agent does not actually know which backends keep their flags in
19078 the backend server rather than in @file{.newsrc}. This means that the
19079 Agent, while unplugged or disconnected, will always record all changes
19080 to the flags in its own files.
19081
19082 When you plug back in, Gnus will then check to see if you have any
19083 changed any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the
19084 server. This behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
19085
19086 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19087 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19088 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19089 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19090 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19091 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
19092
19093 If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
19094 re-connect, you can do it manually with the
19095 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
19096 in the group buffer.
19097
19098 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
19099 all local flags to the server, but rather by incrementally updated the
19100 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
19101 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group then
19102 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
19103 removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
19104 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
19105 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
19106
19107 @node Agent and IMAP
19108 @subsection Agent and IMAP
19109
19110 The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
19111 since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
19112 @acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
19113 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
19114
19115 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
19116 expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
19117
19118 @itemize @bullet
19119
19120 @item
19121 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
19122
19123 @item
19124 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
19125
19126 @end itemize
19127
19128 @node Outgoing Messages
19129 @subsection Outgoing Messages
19130
19131 By default, when Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail
19132 and news) are stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}).
19133 You can view them there after posting, and edit them at will.
19134
19135 You can control the circumstances under which outgoing mail is queued
19136 (see @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail}, @pxref{Agent Variables}). Outgoing
19137 news is always queued when Gnus is unplugged, and never otherwise.
19138
19139 You can send the messages either from the draft group with the special
19140 commands available there, or you can use the @kbd{J S} command in the
19141 group buffer to send all the sendable messages in the draft group.
19142 Posting news will only work when Gnus is plugged, but you can send
19143 mail at any time.
19144
19145 If sending mail while unplugged does not work for you and you worry
19146 about hitting @kbd{J S} by accident when unplugged, you can have Gnus
19147 ask you to confirm your action (see
19148 @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue}, @pxref{Agent Variables}).
19149
19150 @node Agent Variables
19151 @subsection Agent Variables
19152
19153 @table @code
19154 @item gnus-agent
19155 @vindex gnus-agent
19156 Is the agent enabled? The default is @code{t}. When first enabled,
19157 the agent will use @code{gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods} to
19158 automatically mark some back ends as agentized. You may change which
19159 back ends are agentized using the agent commands in the server buffer.
19160
19161 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
19162 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
19163
19164
19165 @item gnus-agent-directory
19166 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
19167 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
19168 @file{~/News/agent/}.
19169
19170 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
19171 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
19172 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
19173 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
19174 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
19175 by default.
19176
19177 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19178 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19179 Hook run when connecting to the network.
19180
19181 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19182 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19183 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
19184
19185 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19186 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19187 Hook run when finished fetching articles.
19188
19189 @item gnus-agent-cache
19190 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
19191 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
19192 articles when plugged, e.g., essentially using the Agent as a cache.
19193 The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
19194
19195 @item gnus-agent-go-online
19196 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
19197 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
19198 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
19199 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
19200 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
19201 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
19202 online status.
19203
19204 @item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19205 @vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19206 If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
19207 mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
19208 thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
19209 read. The default is @code{t}.
19210
19211 @item gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19212 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19213 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19214 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19215 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19216 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19217 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
19218
19219 @item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19220 @vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19221 If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
19222 agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
19223 downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
19224 the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
19225 are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
19226 into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
19227 the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
19228 over and over again.
19229
19230 @item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19231 @vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19232 The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
19233 them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
19234 the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
19235 have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
19236 limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
19237 performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
19238 connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
19239 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
19240 However, all articles parsed prior to losing the connection will be
19241 available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
19242 see any cycling.
19243
19244 @item gnus-server-unopen-status
19245 @vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
19246 Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
19247 variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
19248 Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
19249 whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
19250 Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
19251 for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
19252 is only valid if the Agent is used.
19253
19254 @item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19255 @vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19256 Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
19257 that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
19258 buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
19259 agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
19260
19261 The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
19262 @code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
19263 have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
19264 ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
19265 (maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
19266
19267 @item gnus-agent-queue-mail
19268 @vindex gnus-agent-queue-mail
19269 When @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail} is @code{always}, Gnus will always
19270 queue mail rather than sending it straight away. When @code{t}, Gnus
19271 will queue mail when unplugged only. When @code{nil}, never queue
19272 mail. The default is @code{t}.
19273
19274 @item gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
19275 @vindex gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
19276 When @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue} is non-@code{nil} Gnus will
19277 prompt you to confirm that you really wish to proceed if you hit
19278 @kbd{J S} while unplugged. The default is @code{nil}.
19279
19280 @item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19281 @vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19282 If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
19283 @file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
19284 automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
19285 which back ends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
19286 to agentize remote back ends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
19287 as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
19288 If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
19289 removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
19290 start Gnus. The default is @samp{nil}.
19291
19292 @end table
19293
19294
19295 @node Example Setup
19296 @subsection Example Setup
19297
19298 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
19299 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
19300 @file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
19301
19302 @lisp
19303 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
19304 ;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
19305 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
19306
19307 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
19308 ;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
19309 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
19310
19311 ;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
19312 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
19313
19314 ;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
19315 ;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
19316 ;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
19317 @end lisp
19318
19319 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
19320 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
19321 gnus}.
19322
19323 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
19324 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
19325 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
19326 @acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
19327 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
19328 once.
19329
19330 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
19331 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
19332 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
19333 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
19334 back all the killed groups.)
19335
19336 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
19337 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
19338 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
19339
19340
19341 @node Batching Agents
19342 @subsection Batching Agents
19343 @findex gnus-agent-batch
19344
19345 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
19346 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
19347 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
19348
19349 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
19350 following incantation:
19351
19352 @example
19353 #!/bin/sh
19354 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
19355 @end example
19356
19357
19358 @node Agent Caveats
19359 @subsection Agent Caveats
19360
19361 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
19362 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
19363 may ask:
19364
19365 @table @dfn
19366 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
19367
19368 @strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
19369 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
19370 @code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
19371
19372 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
19373 the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
19374
19375 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
19376
19377 @end table
19378
19379 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
19380 articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
19381 locally stored articles.
19382
19383
19384 @node Scoring
19385 @chapter Scoring
19386 @cindex scoring
19387
19388 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
19389 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
19390 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
19391 attention!
19392
19393 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
19394 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
19395 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
19396 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
19397 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
19398
19399 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
19400 before generating the summary buffer.
19401
19402 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
19403 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
19404 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
19405
19406 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
19407 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
19408 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
19409 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
19410
19411 @menu
19412 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
19413 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
19414 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
19415 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
19416 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
19417 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
19418 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
19419 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
19420 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
19421 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
19422 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
19423 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
19424 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
19425 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
19426 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
19427 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
19428 @end menu
19429
19430
19431 @node Summary Score Commands
19432 @section Summary Score Commands
19433 @cindex score commands
19434
19435 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
19436 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
19437 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
19438 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
19439 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
19440
19441 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
19442 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
19443 some other score file (e.g., @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
19444 score file the current one.
19445
19446 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
19447
19448 @table @kbd
19449
19450 @item V s
19451 @kindex V s (Summary)
19452 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
19453 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
19454
19455 @item V S
19456 @kindex V S (Summary)
19457 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
19458 Display the score of the current article
19459 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
19460
19461 @item V t
19462 @kindex V t (Summary)
19463 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
19464 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
19465 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @file{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
19466 may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
19467 current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
19468 score file and edit it.
19469
19470 @item V w
19471 @kindex V w (Summary)
19472 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
19473 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
19474
19475 @item V R
19476 @kindex V R (Summary)
19477 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
19478 Run the current summary through the scoring process
19479 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
19480 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
19481 effect you're having.
19482
19483 @item V c
19484 @kindex V c (Summary)
19485 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
19486 Make a different score file the current
19487 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
19488
19489 @item V e
19490 @kindex V e (Summary)
19491 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
19492 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
19493 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
19494 File Editing}).
19495
19496 @item V f
19497 @kindex V f (Summary)
19498 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
19499 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
19500 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
19501
19502 @item V F
19503 @kindex V F (Summary)
19504 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19505 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
19506 after editing score files.
19507
19508 @item V C
19509 @kindex V C (Summary)
19510 @findex gnus-score-customize
19511 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
19512 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
19513
19514 @end table
19515
19516 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
19517
19518 @table @kbd
19519
19520 @item V m
19521 @kindex V m (Summary)
19522 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
19523 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
19524 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
19525
19526 @item V x
19527 @kindex V x (Summary)
19528 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
19529 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
19530 expunge all articles below this score
19531 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
19532 @end table
19533
19534 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
19535 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
19536 them.)
19537
19538 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
19539 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
19540
19541 @enumerate
19542 @item
19543 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
19544 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
19545 @item
19546 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
19547 keys are available:
19548 @table @kbd
19549
19550 @item a
19551 Score on the author name.
19552
19553 @item s
19554 Score on the subject line.
19555
19556 @item x
19557 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
19558
19559 @item r
19560 Score on the @code{References} line.
19561
19562 @item d
19563 Score on the date.
19564
19565 @item l
19566 Score on the number of lines.
19567
19568 @item i
19569 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
19570
19571 @item e
19572 Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
19573 if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
19574
19575 @item f
19576 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
19577 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
19578 @file{ADAPT} files.)
19579
19580 @item b
19581 Score on the body.
19582
19583 @item h
19584 Score on the head.
19585
19586 @item t
19587 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
19588 files.)
19589
19590 @end table
19591
19592 @item
19593 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
19594 what headers you are scoring on.
19595
19596 @table @code
19597
19598 @item strings
19599
19600 @table @kbd
19601
19602 @item e
19603 Exact matching.
19604
19605 @item s
19606 Substring matching.
19607
19608 @item f
19609 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
19610
19611 @item r
19612 Regexp matching
19613 @end table
19614
19615 @item date
19616 @table @kbd
19617
19618 @item b
19619 Before date.
19620
19621 @item a
19622 After date.
19623
19624 @item n
19625 This date.
19626 @end table
19627
19628 @item number
19629 @table @kbd
19630
19631 @item <
19632 Less than number.
19633
19634 @item =
19635 Equal to number.
19636
19637 @item >
19638 Greater than number.
19639 @end table
19640 @end table
19641
19642 @item
19643 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
19644 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
19645 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
19646 file.
19647 @table @kbd
19648
19649 @item t
19650 Temporary score entry.
19651
19652 @item p
19653 Permanent score entry.
19654
19655 @item i
19656 Immediately scoring.
19657 @end table
19658
19659 @item
19660 If you are scoring on @samp{e} (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
19661 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
19662 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
19663
19664 @end enumerate
19665
19666 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
19667 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
19668 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
19669 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
19670
19671 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
19672 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
19673 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
19674 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
19675 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
19676
19677 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
19678 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
19679 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
19680 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
19681 current score file.
19682
19683 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
19684 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
19685 pretend they are keymaps or not.
19686
19687
19688 @node Group Score Commands
19689 @section Group Score Commands
19690 @cindex group score commands
19691
19692 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
19693
19694 @table @kbd
19695
19696 @item W e
19697 @kindex W e (Group)
19698 @findex gnus-score-edit-all-score
19699 Edit the apply-to-all-groups all.SCORE file. You will be popped into
19700 a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score File Editing}).
19701
19702 @item W f
19703 @kindex W f (Group)
19704 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19705 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
19706 all the time. This command will flush the cache
19707 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
19708
19709 @end table
19710
19711 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
19712
19713 @findex gnus-batch-score
19714 @cindex batch scoring
19715 @example
19716 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
19717 @end example
19718
19719
19720 @node Score Variables
19721 @section Score Variables
19722 @cindex score variables
19723
19724 @table @code
19725
19726 @item gnus-use-scoring
19727 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
19728 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
19729 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
19730
19731 @item gnus-kill-killed
19732 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
19733 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
19734 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
19735 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
19736 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
19737 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
19738 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
19739
19740 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
19741 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19742 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19743 initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19744 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
19745
19746 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
19747 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19748 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19749 (@file{SCORE} by default.)
19750
19751 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19752 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19753 @cindex score cache
19754 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19755 score files. However, this might make your Emacs grow big and
19756 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19757 to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19758 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19759 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19760 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19761 be cached.
19762
19763 @item gnus-save-score
19764 @vindex gnus-save-score
19765 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19766 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19767 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
19768
19769 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19770 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19771 across group visits.
19772
19773 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19774 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19775 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19776 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19777 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19778 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19779 manually entered data.
19780
19781 @item gnus-summary-default-score
19782 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19783 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
19784
19785 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19786 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19787 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19788 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19789 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19790 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
19791
19792 @item gnus-score-over-mark
19793 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19794 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19795 default. Default is @samp{+}.
19796
19797 @item gnus-score-below-mark
19798 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19799 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19800 default. Default is @samp{-}.
19801
19802 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19803 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19804 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19805 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
19806
19807 Predefined functions available are:
19808 @table @code
19809
19810 @item gnus-score-find-single
19811 @findex gnus-score-find-single
19812 Only apply the group's own score file.
19813
19814 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
19815 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19816 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19817 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19818 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19819 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19820 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19821 then a regexp match is done.
19822
19823 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19824 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
19825
19826 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19827 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19828 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19829 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
19830
19831 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19832 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19833 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
19834 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
19835 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
19836 server.
19837
19838 @end table
19839 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
19840 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
19841 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
19842 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
19843 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
19844 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
19845 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
19846 Phu.
19847
19848 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
19849 overall score file, you could use the value
19850 @example
19851 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
19852 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
19853 @end example
19854
19855 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
19856 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
19857 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
19858 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
19859 are expired. It's 7 by default.
19860
19861 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19862 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19863 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
19864 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
19865 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
19866 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
19867 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
19868 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
19869
19870 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19871 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19872 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
19873
19874 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
19875 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
19876 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
19877 simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
19878 threading---according to the current value of
19879 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
19880 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
19881 simplified in this manner.
19882
19883 @end table
19884
19885
19886 @node Score File Format
19887 @section Score File Format
19888 @cindex score file format
19889
19890 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
19891 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
19892 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
19893
19894 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
19895
19896 @lisp
19897 (("from"
19898 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
19899 ("Per Abrahamsen")
19900 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
19901 ("subject"
19902 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
19903 ("xref"
19904 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
19905 ("lines"
19906 (2 -100 nil <))
19907 (mark 0)
19908 (expunge -1000)
19909 (mark-and-expunge -10)
19910 (read-only nil)
19911 (orphan -10)
19912 (adapt t)
19913 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
19914 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
19915 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
19916 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
19917 (eval (ding)))
19918 @end lisp
19919
19920 This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
19921 Scoring}, for a different approach.
19922
19923 Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
19924 @code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
19925 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
19926
19927 Six keys are supported by this alist:
19928
19929 @table @code
19930
19931 @item STRING
19932 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
19933 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
19934 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
19935 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
19936 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
19937 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
19938 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
19939 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
19940 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
19941 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
19942 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
19943 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
19944 to articles that matches these score entries.
19945
19946 Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
19947 score entry has one to four elements.
19948 @enumerate
19949
19950 @item
19951 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
19952 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
19953 integer.
19954
19955 @item
19956 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
19957 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
19958 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
19959 is successful. If this element is not present, the
19960 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
19961 instead. This is 1000 by default.
19962
19963 @item
19964 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
19965 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
19966 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
19967 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
19968 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
19969
19970 @item
19971 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
19972 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
19973 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
19974 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
19975 @table @dfn
19976
19977 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
19978 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
19979 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
19980 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
19981 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
19982 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
19983 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
19984 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
19985 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
19986 instead, if you feel like.
19987
19988 @item Extra
19989 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
19990 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
19991 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
19992 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
19993 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
19994 host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
19995 overviews:
19996
19997 @lisp
19998 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
19999 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
20000 @end lisp
20001
20002 @item Lines, Chars
20003 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
20004 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
20005
20006 These predicates are true if
20007
20008 @example
20009 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
20010 @end example
20011
20012 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
20013 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
20014 following form:
20015
20016 @lisp
20017 (< header-value 4)
20018 @end lisp
20019
20020 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
20021 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
20022 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
20023 it's not. I think.)
20024
20025 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
20026 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
20027 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
20028 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
20029
20030 @item Date
20031 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
20032 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
20033 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
20034 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
20035 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
20036 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
20037 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
20038
20039 @cindex ISO8601
20040 @cindex date
20041 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
20042 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
20043 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
20044 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
20045 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
20046 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
20047 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
20048 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
20049 whole family, eh?)
20050
20051 @item Head, Body, All
20052 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc.)@:
20053 header uses.
20054
20055 @item Followup
20056 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
20057 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
20058 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
20059 you to increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
20060 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
20061 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
20062 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
20063 files.)
20064
20065 @item Thread
20066 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
20067 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
20068 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
20069 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
20070 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
20071 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
20072 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
20073 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
20074 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
20075 nondeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
20076 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
20077 @end table
20078 @end enumerate
20079
20080 @cindex score file atoms
20081 @item mark
20082 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20083 lower than this number will be marked as read.
20084
20085 @item expunge
20086 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20087 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
20088
20089 @item mark-and-expunge
20090 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20091 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
20092 summary buffer.
20093
20094 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
20095 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
20096 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
20097 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
20098 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
20099
20100 @item files
20101 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
20102 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
20103 this one was.
20104
20105 @item exclude-files
20106 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
20107 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
20108 other.
20109
20110 @item eval
20111 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}ed. This element will be
20112 ignored when handling global score files.
20113
20114 @item read-only
20115 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
20116 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
20117 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
20118 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
20119
20120 @item orphan
20121 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
20122 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
20123 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
20124 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
20125
20126 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
20127
20128 @example
20129 (orphan -500)
20130 (mark-and-expunge -100)
20131 @end example
20132
20133 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
20134 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
20135 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{c y}) the
20136 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
20137 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
20138
20139 I.e., the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
20140 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
20141 scoring rules exist.
20142
20143 @item adapt
20144 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
20145 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
20146 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
20147 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
20148 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
20149 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
20150 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20151 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
20152 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
20153 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
20154 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
20155 it.
20156
20157 @item adapt-file
20158 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
20159 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
20160 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
20161 file for a number of groups.
20162
20163 @item local
20164 @cindex local variables
20165 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
20166 @var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
20167 current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
20168 convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
20169 groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
20170 be evaluated.
20171 @end table
20172
20173
20174 @node Score File Editing
20175 @section Score File Editing
20176
20177 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
20178 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
20179 with a mode for that.
20180
20181 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
20182 additional commands:
20183
20184 @table @kbd
20185
20186 @item C-c C-c
20187 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
20188 @findex gnus-score-edit-exit
20189 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
20190 (@code{gnus-score-edit-exit}).
20191
20192 @item C-c C-d
20193 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
20194 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
20195 Insert the current date in numerical format
20196 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
20197 you were wondering.
20198
20199 @item C-c C-p
20200 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
20201 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
20202 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
20203 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
20204 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
20205 you.
20206
20207 @end table
20208
20209 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
20210
20211 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
20212 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
20213
20214 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
20215 @kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
20216
20217
20218 @node Adaptive Scoring
20219 @section Adaptive Scoring
20220 @cindex adaptive scoring
20221
20222 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
20223 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
20224 stupidity, to be precise.
20225
20226 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
20227 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
20228 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
20229 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
20230 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20231 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
20232 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
20233 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
20234 variable to @code{(word line)}.
20235
20236 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20237 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
20238 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
20239 might look something like this:
20240
20241 @lisp
20242 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20243 '((gnus-unread-mark)
20244 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
20245 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
20246 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
20247 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
20248 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
20249 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
20250 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
20251 (gnus-ancient-mark)
20252 (gnus-low-score-mark)
20253 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
20254 @end lisp
20255
20256 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
20257 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
20258 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
20259 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
20260 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
20261 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
20262 entries.
20263
20264 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
20265 will be applied to each article.
20266
20267 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
20268 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
20269 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
20270 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
20271
20272 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
20273 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
20274 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
20275 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
20276
20277 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
20278 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
20279 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
20280 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
20281
20282 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
20283 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
20284 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
20285 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
20286 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
20287 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
20288
20289 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
20290 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
20291 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
20292
20293 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
20294 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
20295 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
20296
20297 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
20298 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
20299 let you use different rules in different groups.
20300
20301 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
20302 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
20303 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
20304 is @file{ADAPT}.
20305
20306 @vindex gnus-adaptive-pretty-print
20307 Adaptive score files can get huge and are not meant to be edited by
20308 human hands. If @code{gnus-adaptive-pretty-print} is @code{nil} (the
20309 default) those files will not be written in a human readable way.
20310
20311 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
20312 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
20313 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
20314 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
20315 the length of the match is less than
20316 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
20317 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
20318 this problem.
20319
20320 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20321 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
20322 headers. If you adapt on words, the
20323 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
20324 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
20325
20326 @lisp
20327 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20328 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
20329 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
20330 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
20331 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
20332 @end lisp
20333
20334 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
20335 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
20336 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
20337 score with 30 points.
20338
20339 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
20340 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
20341 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
20342 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
20343 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
20344
20345 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
20346 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
20347 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
20348 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
20349 variable defaults to @code{nil}.
20350
20351 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
20352 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
20353 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
20354 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
20355
20356 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
20357 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
20358 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
20359 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
20360
20361 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
20362 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
20363 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
20364 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
20365 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
20366
20367 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
20368 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
20369 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
20370
20371 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
20372 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
20373 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
20374 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
20375
20376
20377 @node Home Score File
20378 @section Home Score File
20379
20380 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
20381 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
20382 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
20383 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
20384
20385 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
20386 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
20387 could perhaps use the same home score file.
20388
20389 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
20390 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
20391 be:
20392
20393 @enumerate
20394 @item
20395 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
20396 groups.
20397
20398 @item
20399 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
20400 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
20401 parameter.
20402
20403 @item
20404 A list. The elements in this list can be:
20405
20406 @enumerate
20407 @item
20408 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
20409 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
20410
20411 @item
20412 A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
20413 be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
20414 name of the group as the parameter.
20415
20416 @item
20417 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
20418 @end enumerate
20419
20420 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
20421 for matches.
20422
20423 @end enumerate
20424
20425 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
20426
20427 @lisp
20428 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20429 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
20430 @end lisp
20431
20432 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
20433 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
20434
20435 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
20436 @lisp
20437 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20438 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
20439 @end lisp
20440
20441 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
20442 Other functions include
20443
20444 @table @code
20445 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
20446 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
20447 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
20448 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
20449
20450 @end table
20451
20452 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
20453 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
20454 their own home score files:
20455
20456 @lisp
20457 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20458 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
20459 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
20460 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
20461 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
20462 @end lisp
20463
20464 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
20465 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
20466 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
20467 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
20468 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
20469
20470 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
20471 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
20472 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
20473 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
20474 precedence over this variable.
20475
20476
20477 @node Followups To Yourself
20478 @section Followups To Yourself
20479
20480 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
20481 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
20482 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
20483 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
20484 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
20485 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
20486
20487 @table @code
20488
20489 @item gnus-score-followup-article
20490 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
20491 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
20492 article.
20493
20494 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
20495 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
20496 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
20497 your own article.
20498 @end table
20499
20500 @vindex message-sent-hook
20501 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
20502 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
20503 @lisp
20504 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
20505 @end lisp
20506
20507
20508 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
20509 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
20510 mine:
20511
20512 @example
20513 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20514 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20515 @end example
20516
20517 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
20518 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
20519 myself:
20520
20521 @lisp
20522 ("references"
20523 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
20524 1000 nil r))
20525 @end lisp
20526
20527 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
20528 is system-dependent.
20529
20530
20531 @node Scoring On Other Headers
20532 @section Scoring On Other Headers
20533 @cindex scoring on other headers
20534
20535 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
20536 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
20537 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
20538 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
20539 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
20540
20541 @vindex gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring
20542 You can inhibit this slow scoring on headers or body by setting the
20543 variable @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring}. If
20544 @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring} is regexp, slow scoring is inhibited if
20545 the group matches the regexp. If it is @code{t}, slow scoring on it is
20546 inhibited for all groups.
20547
20548 Now, there's not much you can do about the slowness for news groups, but for
20549 mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
20550 it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
20551 a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
20552 @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
20553
20554 Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
20555
20556 @lisp
20557 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
20558 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
20559 @end lisp
20560
20561 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
20562 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
20563 time if you have much mail.
20564
20565 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
20566 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
20567
20568 See? Simple.
20569
20570
20571 @node Scoring Tips
20572 @section Scoring Tips
20573 @cindex scoring tips
20574
20575 @table @dfn
20576
20577 @item Crossposts
20578 @cindex crossposts
20579 @cindex scoring crossposts
20580 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
20581 the @code{Xref} header.
20582 @lisp
20583 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
20584 @end lisp
20585
20586 @item Multiple crossposts
20587 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
20588 more than, say, 3 groups:
20589 @lisp
20590 ("xref"
20591 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
20592 -1000 nil r))
20593 @end lisp
20594
20595 @item Matching on the body
20596 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
20597 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
20598 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
20599 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
20600 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
20601 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
20602 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
20603 the matches.
20604
20605 @item Marking as read
20606 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
20607 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
20608 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
20609 @lisp
20610 ((mark -100))
20611 @end lisp
20612 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
20613
20614 @item Negated character classes
20615 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
20616 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
20617 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
20618 @end table
20619
20620
20621 @node Reverse Scoring
20622 @section Reverse Scoring
20623 @cindex reverse scoring
20624
20625 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
20626 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
20627 like this in your score file:
20628
20629 @lisp
20630 (("subject"
20631 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
20632 (mark 1)
20633 (expunge 1))
20634 @end lisp
20635
20636 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
20637 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
20638
20639
20640 @node Global Score Files
20641 @section Global Score Files
20642 @cindex global score files
20643
20644 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
20645 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
20646 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
20647
20648 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
20649 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
20650 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
20651
20652 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
20653 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
20654 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
20655 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
20656 files are applicable to which group.
20657
20658 To use the score file
20659 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
20660 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
20661 say this:
20662
20663 @lisp
20664 (setq gnus-global-score-files
20665 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
20666 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
20667 @end lisp
20668
20669 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
20670 @noindent
20671 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
20672 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
20673 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
20674 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
20675
20676 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
20677 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
20678
20679 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
20680 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
20681 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
20682 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
20683 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
20684 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
20685
20686 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
20687 head:
20688
20689 @itemize @bullet
20690
20691 @item
20692 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
20693 @item
20694 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
20695 @item
20696 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
20697 @item
20698 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
20699 lowered out of existence.
20700 @item
20701 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
20702 articles completely.
20703
20704 @item
20705 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
20706 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
20707 old articles for a long time.
20708 @end itemize
20709
20710 @dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
20711 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
20712 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
20713 holding our breath yet?
20714
20715
20716 @node Kill Files
20717 @section Kill Files
20718 @cindex kill files
20719
20720 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
20721 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
20722 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
20723
20724 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
20725 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
20726 files into score files.
20727
20728 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
20729 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
20730 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
20731 that isn't a very good idea.
20732
20733 Normal kill files look like this:
20734
20735 @lisp
20736 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20737 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
20738 (gnus-expunge "X")
20739 @end lisp
20740
20741 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
20742 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
20743
20744 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
20745 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
20746 interpreting it.
20747
20748 Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
20749
20750 @table @kbd
20751
20752 @item M-k
20753 @kindex M-k (Summary)
20754 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20755 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
20756
20757 @item M-K
20758 @kindex M-K (Summary)
20759 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20760 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20761 @end table
20762
20763 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
20764
20765 @table @kbd
20766
20767 @item M-k
20768 @kindex M-k (Group)
20769 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20770 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
20771
20772 @item M-K
20773 @kindex M-K (Group)
20774 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20775 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
20776 @end table
20777
20778 Kill file variables:
20779
20780 @table @code
20781 @item gnus-kill-file-name
20782 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20783 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20784 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20785 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20786 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20787 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
20788
20789 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20790 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20791 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20792 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20793 kills.
20794
20795 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20796 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20797 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20798 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20799 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20800 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20801 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20802 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20803 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
20804
20805 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20806 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20807 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
20808
20809 @end table
20810
20811
20812 @node Converting Kill Files
20813 @section Converting Kill Files
20814 @cindex kill files
20815 @cindex converting kill files
20816
20817 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20818 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20819 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20820 by hand.
20821
20822 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Emacs by default.
20823 You can fetch it from the contrib directory of the Gnus distribution or
20824 from
20825 @uref{http://heim.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
20826
20827 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20828 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20829 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20830 before.
20831
20832
20833 @node Advanced Scoring
20834 @section Advanced Scoring
20835
20836 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
20837 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
20838 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
20839 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
20840 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
20841
20842 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
20843 scoring patterns.
20844
20845 @menu
20846 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
20847 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
20848 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
20849 @end menu
20850
20851
20852 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
20853 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
20854
20855 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
20856 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
20857 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
20858 non-@code{nil} value.
20859
20860 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
20861 operator, and various match operators.
20862
20863 Logical operators:
20864
20865 @table @code
20866 @item &
20867 @itemx and
20868 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20869 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
20870 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
20871 @code{true}.
20872
20873 @item |
20874 @itemx or
20875 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20876 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
20877 then this operator will return @code{false}.
20878
20879 @item !
20880 @itemx not
20881 @itemx ¬
20882 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
20883 logical negation of the value of its argument.
20884
20885 @end table
20886
20887 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
20888 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
20889 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
20890 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
20891 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
20892 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
20893 the ancestry you want to go.
20894
20895 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
20896 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
20897 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
20898 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
20899 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
20900
20901
20902 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
20903 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
20904
20905 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
20906 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
20907 of parentheses.
20908
20909 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
20910 when he's talking about Gnus:
20911
20912 @example
20913 @group
20914 ((&
20915 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20916 ("subject" "Gnus"))
20917 1000)
20918 @end group
20919 @end example
20920
20921 Quite simple, huh?
20922
20923 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
20924
20925 @example
20926 ((&
20927 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20928 (|
20929 ("subject" "Gnus")
20930 ("lines" 100 >)))
20931 1000)
20932 @end example
20933
20934 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
20935 really don't want to read what he's written:
20936
20937 @example
20938 ((&
20939 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20940 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigil Logge")))
20941 -100000)
20942 @end example
20943
20944 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
20945 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
20946 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
20947 very interesting:
20948
20949 @example
20950 ((&
20951 (1-
20952 (&
20953 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
20954 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
20955 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
20956 ("body" "white.*socks"))
20957 1000)
20958 @end example
20959
20960 Suppose you're reading a high volume group and you're only interested
20961 in replies. The plan is to score down all articles that don't have
20962 subject that begin with "Re:", "Fw:" or "Fwd:" and then score up all
20963 parents of articles that have subjects that begin with reply marks.
20964
20965 @example
20966 ((! ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20967 -200)
20968 ((1- ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20969 200)
20970 @end example
20971
20972 The possibilities are endless.
20973
20974 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
20975 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
20976
20977 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
20978 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
20979 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
20980 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
20981 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
20982 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
20983 @samp{subject}) first.
20984
20985 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
20986 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
20987 something like:
20988
20989 @example
20990 ...
20991 (1-
20992 (1-
20993 ("from" "lars")))
20994 ...
20995 @end example
20996
20997 Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
20998 current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
20999
21000 @example
21001 (1-
21002 (&
21003 ("from" "Lars")
21004 ("subject" "Gnus")))
21005 @end example
21006
21007 than it is to say:
21008
21009 @example
21010 (&
21011 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
21012 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
21013 @end example
21014
21015
21016 @node Score Decays
21017 @section Score Decays
21018 @cindex score decays
21019 @cindex decays
21020
21021 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
21022 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
21023 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
21024 use them in any sensible way.
21025
21026 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
21027 @findex gnus-decay-score
21028 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
21029 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
21030 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
21031 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
21032 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
21033 If @code{gnus-decay-scores} is a regexp, only score files matching this
21034 regexp are treated. E.g., you may set it to @samp{\\.ADAPT\\'} if only
21035 @emph{adaptive} score files should be decayed. The decay itself if
21036 performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function} function, which is
21037 @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the definition of that
21038 function:
21039
21040 @lisp
21041 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
21042 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
21043 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
21044 (let ((n (- score
21045 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
21046 (min (abs score)
21047 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
21048 (* (abs score)
21049 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
21050 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
21051 ;; XEmacs's floor can handle only the floating point
21052 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
21053 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
21054 (string-to-number
21055 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
21056 (floor n))))
21057 @end lisp
21058
21059 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
21060 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
21061 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
21062 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
21063
21064 @enumerate
21065 @item
21066 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
21067
21068 @item
21069 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
21070
21071 @item
21072 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
21073 score.
21074 @end enumerate
21075
21076 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
21077 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
21078 the new score, which should be an integer.
21079
21080 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
21081 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
21082
21083 @node Searching
21084 @chapter Searching
21085 @cindex searching
21086
21087 FIXME: Add a brief overview of Gnus search capabilities. A brief
21088 comparison of nnir, nnmairix, contrib/gnus-namazu would be nice
21089 as well.
21090
21091 This chapter describes tools for searching groups and servers for
21092 articles matching a query and then retrieving those articles. Gnus
21093 provides a simpler mechanism for searching through articles in a summary buffer
21094 to find those matching a pattern. @xref{Searching for Articles}.
21095
21096 @menu
21097 * nnir:: Searching with various engines.
21098 * nnmairix:: Searching with Mairix.
21099 @end menu
21100
21101 @node nnir
21102 @section nnir
21103 @cindex nnir
21104
21105 This section describes how to use @code{nnir} to search for articles
21106 within gnus.
21107
21108 @menu
21109 * What is nnir?:: What does @code{nnir} do?
21110 * Basic Usage:: How to perform simple searches.
21111 * Setting up nnir:: How to set up @code{nnir}.
21112 @end menu
21113
21114 @node What is nnir?
21115 @subsection What is nnir?
21116
21117 @code{nnir} is a Gnus interface to a number of tools for searching
21118 through mail and news repositories. Different backends (like
21119 @code{nnimap} and @code{nntp}) work with different tools (called
21120 @dfn{engines} in @code{nnir} lingo), but all use the same basic search
21121 interface.
21122
21123 The @code{nnimap} and @code{gmane} search engines should work with no
21124 configuration. Other engines require a local index that needs to be
21125 created and maintained outside of Gnus.
21126
21127
21128 @node Basic Usage
21129 @subsection Basic Usage
21130
21131 In the group buffer typing @kbd{G G} will search the group on the
21132 current line by calling @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group}. This prompts
21133 for a query string, creates an ephemeral @code{nnir} group containing
21134 the articles that match this query, and takes you to a summary buffer
21135 showing these articles. Articles may then be read, moved and deleted
21136 using the usual commands.
21137
21138 The @code{nnir} group made in this way is an @code{ephemeral} group,
21139 and some changes are not permanent: aside from reading, moving, and
21140 deleting, you can't act on the original article. But there is an
21141 alternative: you can @emph{warp} (i.e., jump) to the original group
21142 for the article on the current line with @kbd{A W}, aka
21143 @code{gnus-warp-to-article}. Even better, the function
21144 @code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}, bound by default in summary buffers
21145 to @kbd{A T}, will first warp to the original group before it works
21146 its magic and includes all the articles in the thread. From here you
21147 can read, move and delete articles, but also copy them, alter article
21148 marks, whatever. Go nuts.
21149
21150 You say you want to search more than just the group on the current line?
21151 No problem: just process-mark the groups you want to search. You want
21152 even more? Calling for an nnir search with the cursor on a topic heading
21153 will search all the groups under that heading.
21154
21155 Still not enough? OK, in the server buffer
21156 @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group} (now bound to @kbd{G}) will search all
21157 groups from the server on the current line. Too much? Want to ignore
21158 certain groups when searching, like spam groups? Just customize
21159 @code{nnir-ignored-newsgroups}.
21160
21161 One more thing: individual search engines may have special search
21162 features. You can access these special features by giving a prefix-arg
21163 to @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group}. If you are searching multiple
21164 groups with different search engines you will be prompted for the
21165 special search features for each engine separately.
21166
21167
21168 @node Setting up nnir
21169 @subsection Setting up nnir
21170
21171 To set up nnir you may need to do some prep work. Firstly, you may need
21172 to configure the search engines you plan to use. Some of them, like
21173 @code{imap} and @code{gmane}, need no special configuration. Others,
21174 like @code{namazu} and @code{swish}, require configuration as described
21175 below. Secondly, you need to associate a search engine with a server or
21176 a backend.
21177
21178 If you just want to use the @code{imap} engine to search @code{nnimap}
21179 servers, and the @code{gmane} engine to search @code{gmane} then you
21180 don't have to do anything. But you might want to read the details of the
21181 query language anyway.
21182
21183 @menu
21184 * Associating Engines:: How to associate engines.
21185 * The imap Engine:: Imap configuration and usage.
21186 * The gmane Engine:: Gmane configuration and usage.
21187 * The swish++ Engine:: Swish++ configuration and usage.
21188 * The swish-e Engine:: Swish-e configuration and usage.
21189 * The namazu Engine:: Namazu configuration and usage.
21190 * The notmuch Engine:: Notmuch configuration and usage.
21191 * The hyrex Engine:: Hyrex configuration and usage.
21192 * Customizations:: User customizable settings.
21193 @end menu
21194
21195 @node Associating Engines
21196 @subsubsection Associating Engines
21197
21198
21199 When searching a group, @code{nnir} needs to know which search engine to
21200 use. You can configure a given server to use a particular engine by
21201 setting the server variable @code{nnir-search-engine} to the engine
21202 name. For example to use the @code{namazu} engine to search the server
21203 named @code{home} you can use
21204
21205 @lisp
21206 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
21207 '((nnml "home"
21208 (nnimap-address "localhost")
21209 (nnir-search-engine namazu))))
21210 @end lisp
21211
21212 Alternatively you might want to use a particular engine for all servers
21213 with a given backend. For example, you might want to use the @code{imap}
21214 engine for all servers using the @code{nnimap} backend. In this case you
21215 can customize the variable @code{nnir-method-default-engines}. This is
21216 an alist of pairs of the form @code{(backend . engine)}. By default this
21217 variable is set to use the @code{imap} engine for all servers using the
21218 @code{nnimap} backend, and the @code{gmane} backend for @code{nntp}
21219 servers. (Don't worry, the @code{gmane} search engine won't actually try
21220 to search non-gmane @code{nntp} servers.) But if you wanted to use
21221 @code{namazu} for all your servers with an @code{nnimap} backend you
21222 could change this to
21223
21224 @lisp
21225 '((nnimap . namazu)
21226 (nntp . gmane))
21227 @end lisp
21228
21229 @node The imap Engine
21230 @subsubsection The imap Engine
21231
21232 The @code{imap} engine requires no configuration.
21233
21234 Queries using the @code{imap} engine follow a simple query language.
21235 The search is always case-insensitive and supports the following
21236 features (inspired by the Google search input language):
21237
21238 @table @samp
21239
21240 @item Boolean query operators
21241 AND, OR, and NOT are supported, and parentheses can be used to control
21242 operator precedence, e.g., (emacs OR xemacs) AND linux. Note that
21243 operators must be written with all capital letters to be
21244 recognized. Also preceding a term with a @minus{} sign is equivalent
21245 to NOT term.
21246
21247 @item Automatic AND queries
21248 If you specify multiple words then they will be treated as an AND
21249 expression intended to match all components.
21250
21251 @item Phrase searches
21252 If you wrap your query in double-quotes then it will be treated as a
21253 literal string.
21254
21255 @end table
21256
21257 By default the whole message will be searched. The query can be limited
21258 to a specific part of a message by using a prefix-arg. After inputting
21259 the query this will prompt (with completion) for a message part.
21260 Choices include ``Whole message'', ``Subject'', ``From'', and
21261 ``To''. Any unrecognized input is interpreted as a header name. For
21262 example, typing @kbd{Message-ID} in response to this prompt will limit
21263 the query to the Message-ID header.
21264
21265 Finally selecting ``Imap'' will interpret the query as a raw
21266 @acronym{IMAP} search query. The format of such queries can be found in
21267 RFC3501.
21268
21269 If you don't like the default of searching whole messages you can
21270 customize @code{nnir-imap-default-search-key}. For example to use
21271 @acronym{IMAP} queries by default
21272
21273 @lisp
21274 (setq nnir-imap-default-search-key "Imap")
21275 @end lisp
21276
21277 @node The gmane Engine
21278 @subsubsection The gmane Engine
21279
21280 The @code{gmane} engine requires no configuration.
21281
21282 Gmane queries follow a simple query language:
21283
21284 @table @samp
21285 @item Boolean query operators
21286 AND, OR, NOT (or AND NOT), and XOR are supported, and brackets can be
21287 used to control operator precedence, e.g., (emacs OR xemacs) AND linux.
21288 Note that operators must be written with all capital letters to be
21289 recognized.
21290
21291 @item Required and excluded terms
21292 + and @minus{} can be used to require or exclude terms, e.g., football
21293 @minus{}american
21294
21295 @item Unicode handling
21296 The search engine converts all text to utf-8, so searching should work
21297 in any language.
21298
21299 @item Stopwords
21300 Common English words (like 'the' and 'a') are ignored by default. You
21301 can override this by prefixing such words with a + (e.g., +the) or
21302 enclosing the word in quotes (e.g., "the").
21303
21304 @end table
21305
21306 The query can be limited to articles by a specific author using a
21307 prefix-arg. After inputting the query this will prompt for an author
21308 name (or part of a name) to match.
21309
21310 @node The swish++ Engine
21311 @subsubsection The swish++ Engine
21312
21313 FIXME: Say something more here.
21314
21315 Documentation for swish++ may be found at the swish++ sourceforge page:
21316 @uref{http://swishplusplus.sourceforge.net}
21317
21318 @table @code
21319
21320 @item nnir-swish++-program
21321 The name of the swish++ executable. Defaults to @code{search}
21322
21323 @item nnir-swish++-additional-switches
21324 A list of strings to be given as additional arguments to
21325 swish++. @code{nil} by default.
21326
21327 @item nnir-swish++-remove-prefix
21328 The prefix to remove from each file name returned by swish++ in order
21329 to get a group name. By default this is @code{$HOME/Mail}.
21330
21331 @end table
21332
21333 @node The swish-e Engine
21334 @subsubsection The swish-e Engine
21335
21336 FIXME: Say something more here.
21337
21338 Documentation for swish-e may be found at the swish-e homepage
21339 @uref{http://swish-e.org}
21340
21341 @table @code
21342
21343 @item nnir-swish-e-program
21344 The name of the swish-e search program. Defaults to @code{swish-e}.
21345
21346 @item nnir-swish-e-additional-switches
21347 A list of strings to be given as additional arguments to
21348 swish-e. @code{nil} by default.
21349
21350 @item nnir-swish-e-remove-prefix
21351 The prefix to remove from each file name returned by swish-e in order
21352 to get a group name. By default this is @code{$HOME/Mail}.
21353
21354 @end table
21355
21356 @node The namazu Engine
21357 @subsubsection The namazu Engine
21358
21359 Using the namazu engine requires creating and maintaining index files.
21360 One directory should contain all the index files, and nnir must be told
21361 where to find them by setting the @code{nnir-namazu-index-directory}
21362 variable.
21363
21364 To work correctly the @code{nnir-namazu-remove-prefix} variable must
21365 also be correct. This is the prefix to remove from each file name
21366 returned by Namazu in order to get a proper group name (albeit with @samp{/}
21367 instead of @samp{.}).
21368
21369 For example, suppose that Namazu returns file names such as
21370 @samp{/home/john/Mail/mail/misc/42}. For this example, use the
21371 following setting: @code{(setq nnir-namazu-remove-prefix
21372 "/home/john/Mail/")} Note the trailing slash. Removing this prefix from
21373 the directory gives @samp{mail/misc/42}. @code{nnir} knows to remove
21374 the @samp{/42} and to replace @samp{/} with @samp{.} to arrive at the
21375 correct group name @samp{mail.misc}.
21376
21377 Extra switches may be passed to the namazu search command by setting the
21378 variable @code{nnir-namazu-additional-switches}. It is particularly
21379 important not to pass any any switches to namazu that will change the
21380 output format. Good switches to use include @option{--sort},
21381 @option{--ascending}, @option{--early} and @option{--late}.
21382 Refer to the Namazu documentation for further
21383 information on valid switches.
21384
21385 Mail must first be indexed with the @command{mknmz} program. Read the
21386 documentation for namazu to create a configuration file. Here is an
21387 example:
21388
21389 @cartouche
21390 @example
21391 package conf; # Don't remove this line!
21392
21393 # Paths which will not be indexed. Don't use '^' or '$' anchors.
21394 $EXCLUDE_PATH = "spam|sent";
21395
21396 # Header fields which should be searchable. case-insensitive
21397 $REMAIN_HEADER = "from|date|message-id|subject";
21398
21399 # Searchable fields. case-insensitive
21400 $SEARCH_FIELD = "from|date|message-id|subject";
21401
21402 # The max length of a word.
21403 $WORD_LENG_MAX = 128;
21404
21405 # The max length of a field.
21406 $MAX_FIELD_LENGTH = 256;
21407 @end example
21408 @end cartouche
21409
21410 For this example, mail is stored in the directories @samp{~/Mail/mail/},
21411 @samp{~/Mail/lists/} and @samp{~/Mail/archive/}, so to index them go to
21412 the index directory set in @code{nnir-namazu-index-directory} and issue
21413 the following command:
21414
21415 @example
21416 mknmz --mailnews ~/Mail/archive/ ~/Mail/mail/ ~/Mail/lists/
21417 @end example
21418
21419 For maximum searching efficiency you might want to have a cron job run
21420 this command periodically, say every four hours.
21421
21422
21423 @node The notmuch Engine
21424 @subsubsection The notmuch Engine
21425
21426 @table @code
21427 @item nnir-notmuch-program
21428 The name of the notmuch search executable. Defaults to
21429 @samp{notmuch}.
21430
21431 @item nnir-notmuch-additional-switches
21432 A list of strings, to be given as additional arguments to notmuch.
21433
21434 @item nnir-notmuch-remove-prefix
21435 The prefix to remove from each file name returned by notmuch in order
21436 to get a group name (albeit with @samp{/} instead of @samp{.}). This
21437 is a regular expression.
21438
21439 @end table
21440
21441
21442 @node The hyrex Engine
21443 @subsubsection The hyrex Engine
21444 This engine is obsolete.
21445
21446 @node Customizations
21447 @subsubsection Customizations
21448
21449 @table @code
21450
21451 @item nnir-method-default-engines
21452 Alist of pairs of server backends and search engines. The default
21453 associations are
21454 @example
21455 (nnimap . imap)
21456 (nntp . gmane)
21457 @end example
21458
21459 @item nnir-ignored-newsgroups
21460 A regexp to match newsgroups in the active file that should be skipped
21461 when searching all groups on a server.
21462
21463 @item nnir-summary-line-format
21464 The format specification to be used for lines in an nnir summary buffer.
21465 All the items from @code{gnus-summary-line-format} are available, along with
21466 three items unique to nnir summary buffers:
21467
21468 @example
21469 %Z Search retrieval score value (integer)
21470 %G Article original full group name (string)
21471 %g Article original short group name (string)
21472 @end example
21473
21474 If @code{nil} (the default) this will use @code{gnus-summary-line-format}.
21475
21476 @item nnir-retrieve-headers-override-function
21477 If non-@code{nil}, a function that retrieves article headers rather than using
21478 the gnus built-in function. This function takes an article list and
21479 group as arguments and populates the @code{nntp-server-buffer} with the
21480 retrieved headers. It should then return either 'nov or 'headers
21481 indicating the retrieved header format. Failure to retrieve headers
21482 should return @code{nil}.
21483
21484 If this variable is @code{nil}, or if the provided function returns
21485 @code{nil} for a search result, @code{gnus-retrieve-headers} will be
21486 called instead."
21487
21488
21489 @end table
21490
21491
21492 @node nnmairix
21493 @section nnmairix
21494
21495 @cindex mairix
21496 @cindex nnmairix
21497 This paragraph describes how to set up mairix and the back end
21498 @code{nnmairix} for indexing and searching your mail from within
21499 Gnus. Additionally, you can create permanent ``smart'' groups which are
21500 bound to mairix searches and are automatically updated.
21501
21502 @menu
21503 * About mairix:: About the mairix mail search engine
21504 * nnmairix requirements:: What you will need for using nnmairix
21505 * What nnmairix does:: What does nnmairix actually do?
21506 * Setting up mairix:: Set up your mairix installation
21507 * Configuring nnmairix:: Set up the nnmairix back end
21508 * nnmairix keyboard shortcuts:: List of available keyboard shortcuts
21509 * Propagating marks:: How to propagate marks from nnmairix groups
21510 * nnmairix tips and tricks:: Some tips, tricks and examples
21511 * nnmairix caveats:: Some more stuff you might want to know
21512 @end menu
21513
21514 @c FIXME: The markup in this section might need improvement.
21515 @c E.g., adding @samp, @var, @file, @command, etc.
21516 @c Cf. (info "(texinfo)Indicating")
21517
21518 @node About mairix
21519 @subsection About mairix
21520
21521 Mairix is a tool for indexing and searching words in locally stored
21522 mail. It was written by Richard Curnow and is licensed under the
21523 GPL@. Mairix comes with most popular GNU/Linux distributions, but it also
21524 runs under Windows (with cygwin), Mac OS X and Solaris. The homepage can
21525 be found at
21526 @uref{http://www.rpcurnow.force9.co.uk/mairix/index.html}
21527
21528 Though mairix might not be as flexible as other search tools like
21529 swish++ or namazu, which you can use via the @code{nnir} back end, it
21530 has the prime advantage of being incredibly fast. On current systems, it
21531 can easily search through headers and message bodies of thousands and
21532 thousands of mails in well under a second. Building the database
21533 necessary for searching might take a minute or two, but only has to be
21534 done once fully. Afterwards, the updates are done incrementally and
21535 therefore are really fast, too. Additionally, mairix is very easy to set
21536 up.
21537
21538 For maximum speed though, mairix should be used with mails stored in
21539 @code{Maildir} or @code{MH} format (this includes the @code{nnml} back
21540 end), although it also works with mbox. Mairix presents the search
21541 results by populating a @emph{virtual} maildir/MH folder with symlinks
21542 which point to the ``real'' message files (if mbox is used, copies are
21543 made). Since mairix already presents search results in such a virtual
21544 mail folder, it is very well suited for using it as an external program
21545 for creating @emph{smart} mail folders, which represent certain mail
21546 searches.
21547
21548 @node nnmairix requirements
21549 @subsection nnmairix requirements
21550
21551 Mairix searches local mail---that means, mairix absolutely must have
21552 direct access to your mail folders. If your mail resides on another
21553 server (e.g., an @acronym{IMAP} server) and you happen to have shell
21554 access, @code{nnmairix} supports running mairix remotely, e.g., via ssh.
21555
21556 Additionally, @code{nnmairix} only supports the following Gnus back
21557 ends: @code{nnml}, @code{nnmaildir}, and @code{nnimap}. You must use
21558 one of these back ends for using @code{nnmairix}. Other back ends, like
21559 @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnfolder} or @code{nnmh}, won't work.
21560
21561 If you absolutely must use mbox and still want to use @code{nnmairix},
21562 you can set up a local @acronym{IMAP} server, which you then access via
21563 @code{nnimap}. This is a rather massive setup for accessing some mbox
21564 files, so just change to MH or Maildir already... However, if you're
21565 really, really passionate about using mbox, you might want to look into
21566 the package @file{mairix.el}, which comes with Emacs 23.
21567
21568 @node What nnmairix does
21569 @subsection What nnmairix does
21570
21571 The back end @code{nnmairix} enables you to call mairix from within Gnus,
21572 either to query mairix with a search term or to update the
21573 database. While visiting a message in the summary buffer, you can use
21574 several pre-defined shortcuts for calling mairix, e.g., to quickly
21575 search for all mails from the sender of the current message or to
21576 display the whole thread associated with the message, even if the
21577 mails are in different folders.
21578
21579 Additionally, you can create permanent @code{nnmairix} groups which are bound
21580 to certain mairix searches. This way, you can easily create a group
21581 containing mails from a certain sender, with a certain subject line or
21582 even for one specific thread based on the Message-ID@. If you check for
21583 new mail in these folders (e.g., by pressing @kbd{g} or @kbd{M-g}), they
21584 automatically update themselves by calling mairix.
21585
21586 You might ask why you need @code{nnmairix} at all, since mairix already
21587 creates the group, populates it with links to the mails so that you can
21588 then access it with Gnus, right? Well, this @emph{might} work, but often
21589 does not---at least not without problems. Most probably you will get
21590 strange article counts, and sometimes you might see mails which Gnus
21591 claims have already been canceled and are inaccessible. This is due to
21592 the fact that Gnus isn't really amused when things are happening behind
21593 its back. Another problem can be the mail back end itself, e.g., if you
21594 use mairix with an @acronym{IMAP} server (I had Dovecot complaining
21595 about corrupt index files when mairix changed the contents of the search
21596 group). Using @code{nnmairix} should circumvent these problems.
21597
21598 @code{nnmairix} is not really a mail back end---it's actually more like
21599 a wrapper, sitting between a ``real'' mail back end where mairix stores
21600 the searches and the Gnus front end. You can choose between three
21601 different mail back ends for the mairix folders: @code{nnml},
21602 @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnimap}. @code{nnmairix} will call the mairix
21603 binary so that the search results are stored in folders named
21604 @code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>} on this mail back end, but it will
21605 present these folders in the Gnus front end only with @code{<NAME>}.
21606 You can use an existing mail back end where you already store your mail,
21607 but if you're uncomfortable with @code{nnmairix} creating new mail
21608 groups alongside your other mail, you can also create, e.g., a new
21609 @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml} server exclusively for mairix, but then
21610 make sure those servers do not accidentally receive your new mail
21611 (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). A special case exists if you want to use
21612 mairix remotely on an IMAP server with @code{nnimap}---here the mairix
21613 folders and your other mail must be on the same @code{nnimap} back end.
21614
21615 @node Setting up mairix
21616 @subsection Setting up mairix
21617
21618 First: create a backup of your mail folders (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}).
21619
21620 Setting up mairix is easy: simply create a @file{.mairixrc} file with
21621 (at least) the following entries:
21622
21623 @example
21624 # Your Maildir/MH base folder
21625 base=~/Maildir
21626 @end example
21627
21628 This is the base folder for your mails. All the following directories
21629 are relative to this base folder. If you want to use @code{nnmairix}
21630 with @code{nnimap}, this base directory has to point to the mail
21631 directory where the @acronym{IMAP} server stores the mail folders!
21632
21633 @example
21634 maildir= ... your maildir folders which should be indexed ...
21635 mh= ... your nnml/mh folders which should be indexed ...
21636 mbox = ... your mbox files which should be indexed ...
21637 @end example
21638
21639 This specifies all your mail folders and mbox files (relative to the
21640 base directory!) you want to index with mairix. Note that the
21641 @code{nnml} back end saves mails in MH format, so you have to put those
21642 directories in the @code{mh} line. See the example at the end of this
21643 section and mairixrc's man-page for further details.
21644
21645 @example
21646 omit=zz_mairix-*
21647 @end example
21648
21649 @vindex nnmairix-group-prefix
21650 This should make sure that you don't accidentally index the mairix
21651 search results. You can change the prefix of these folders with the
21652 variable @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
21653
21654 @example
21655 mformat= ... 'maildir' or 'mh' ...
21656 database= ... location of database file ...
21657 @end example
21658
21659 The @code{format} setting specifies the output format for the mairix
21660 search folder. Set this to @code{mh} if you want to access search results
21661 with @code{nnml}. Otherwise choose @code{maildir}.
21662
21663 To summarize, here is my shortened @file{.mairixrc} file as an example:
21664
21665 @example
21666 base=~/Maildir
21667 maildir=.personal:.work:.logcheck:.sent
21668 mh=../Mail/nnml/*...
21669 mbox=../mboxmail/mailarchive_year*
21670 mformat=maildir
21671 omit=zz_mairix-*
21672 database=~/.mairixdatabase
21673 @end example
21674
21675 In this case, the base directory is @file{~/Maildir}, where all my Maildir
21676 folders are stored. As you can see, the folders are separated by
21677 colons. If you wonder why every folder begins with a dot: this is
21678 because I use Dovecot as @acronym{IMAP} server, which again uses
21679 @code{Maildir++} folders. For testing nnmairix, I also have some
21680 @code{nnml} mail, which is saved in @file{~/Mail/nnml}. Since this has
21681 to be specified relative to the @code{base} directory, the @code{../Mail}
21682 notation is needed. Note that the line ends in @code{*...}, which means
21683 to recursively scan all files under this directory. Without the three
21684 dots, the wildcard @code{*} will not work recursively. I also have some
21685 old mbox files with archived mail lying around in @file{~/mboxmail}.
21686 The other lines should be obvious.
21687
21688 See the man page for @code{mairixrc} for details and further options,
21689 especially regarding wildcard usage, which may be a little different
21690 than you are used to.
21691
21692 Now simply call @code{mairix} to create the index for the first time.
21693 Note that this may take a few minutes, but every following index will do
21694 the updates incrementally and hence is very fast.
21695
21696 @node Configuring nnmairix
21697 @subsection Configuring nnmairix
21698
21699 In group mode, type @kbd{G b c}
21700 (@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). This will ask you for all
21701 necessary information and create a @code{nnmairix} server as a foreign
21702 server. You will have to specify the following:
21703
21704 @itemize @bullet
21705
21706 @item
21707 The @strong{name} of the @code{nnmairix} server---choose whatever you
21708 want.
21709
21710 @item
21711 The name of the @strong{back end server} where mairix should store its
21712 searches. This must be a full server name, like @code{nnml:mymail}.
21713 Just hit @kbd{TAB} to see the available servers. Currently, servers
21714 which are accessed through @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnimap} and
21715 @code{nnml} are supported. As explained above, for locally stored
21716 mails, this can be an existing server where you store your mails.
21717 However, you can also create, e.g., a new @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml}
21718 server exclusively for @code{nnmairix} in your secondary select methods
21719 (@pxref{Finding the News}). If you use a secondary @code{nnml} server
21720 just for mairix, make sure that you explicitly set the server variable
21721 @code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}, or you might lose mail
21722 (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). If you want to use mairix remotely on an
21723 @acronym{IMAP} server, you have to choose the corresponding
21724 @code{nnimap} server here.
21725
21726 @item
21727 @vindex nnmairix-mairix-search-options
21728 The @strong{command} to call the mairix binary. This will usually just
21729 be @code{mairix}, but you can also choose something like @code{ssh
21730 SERVER mairix} if you want to call mairix remotely, e.g., on your
21731 @acronym{IMAP} server. If you want to add some default options to
21732 mairix, you could do this here, but better use the variable
21733 @code{nnmairix-mairix-search-options} instead.
21734
21735 @item
21736 The name of the @strong{default search group}. This will be the group
21737 where all temporary mairix searches are stored, i.e., all searches which
21738 are not bound to permanent @code{nnmairix} groups. Choose whatever you
21739 like.
21740
21741 @item
21742 If the mail back end is @code{nnimap} or @code{nnmaildir}, you will be
21743 asked if you work with @strong{Maildir++}, i.e., with hidden maildir
21744 folders (=beginning with a dot). For example, you have to answer
21745 @samp{yes} here if you work with the Dovecot @acronym{IMAP}
21746 server. Otherwise, you should answer @samp{no} here.
21747
21748 @end itemize
21749
21750 @node nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
21751 @subsection nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
21752
21753 In group mode:
21754
21755 @table @kbd
21756
21757 @item G b c
21758 @kindex G b c (Group)
21759 @findex nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group
21760 Creates @code{nnmairix} server and default search group for this server
21761 (@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). You should have done
21762 this by now (@pxref{Configuring nnmairix}).
21763
21764 @item G b s
21765 @kindex G b s (Group)
21766 @findex nnmairix-search
21767 Prompts for query which is then sent to the mairix binary. Search
21768 results are put into the default search group which is automatically
21769 displayed (@code{nnmairix-search}).
21770
21771 @item G b m
21772 @kindex G b m (Group)
21773 @findex nnmairix-widget-search
21774 Allows you to create a mairix search or a permanent group more
21775 comfortably using graphical widgets, similar to a customization
21776 group. Just try it to see how it works (@code{nnmairix-widget-search}).
21777
21778 @item G b i
21779 @kindex G b i (Group)
21780 @findex nnmairix-search-interactive
21781 Another command for creating a mairix query more comfortably, but uses
21782 only the minibuffer (@code{nnmairix-search-interactive}).
21783
21784 @item G b g
21785 @kindex G b g (Group)
21786 @findex nnmairix-create-search-group
21787 Creates a permanent group which is associated with a search query
21788 (@code{nnmairix-create-search-group}). The @code{nnmairix} back end
21789 automatically calls mairix when you update this group with @kbd{g} or
21790 @kbd{M-g}.
21791
21792 @item G b q
21793 @kindex G b q (Group)
21794 @findex nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group
21795 Changes the search query for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor
21796 (@code{nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group}).
21797
21798 @item G b t
21799 @kindex G b t (Group)
21800 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group
21801 Toggles the 'threads' parameter for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor,
21802 i.e., if you want see the whole threads of the found messages
21803 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group}).
21804
21805 @item G b u
21806 @kindex G b u (Group)
21807 @findex nnmairix-update-database
21808 @vindex nnmairix-mairix-update-options
21809 Calls mairix binary for updating the database
21810 (@code{nnmairix-update-database}). The default parameters are @code{-F}
21811 and @code{-Q} for making this as fast as possible (see variable
21812 @code{nnmairix-mairix-update-options} for defining these default
21813 options).
21814
21815 @item G b r
21816 @kindex G b r (Group)
21817 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group
21818 Keep articles in this @code{nnmairix} group always read or unread, or leave the
21819 marks unchanged (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group}).
21820
21821 @item G b d
21822 @kindex G b d (Group)
21823 @findex nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group
21824 Recreate @code{nnmairix} group on the ``real'' mail back end
21825 (@code{nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group}). You can do this if
21826 you always get wrong article counts with a @code{nnmairix} group.
21827
21828 @item G b a
21829 @kindex G b a (Group)
21830 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group
21831 Toggles the @code{allow-fast} parameters for group under cursor
21832 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group}). The default
21833 behavior of @code{nnmairix} is to do a mairix search every time you
21834 update or enter the group. With the @code{allow-fast} parameter set,
21835 mairix will only be called when you explicitly update the group, but not
21836 upon entering. This makes entering the group faster, but it may also
21837 lead to dangling symlinks if something changed between updating and
21838 entering the group which is not yet in the mairix database.
21839
21840 @item G b p
21841 @kindex G b p (Group)
21842 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group
21843 Toggle marks propagation for this group
21844 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group}). (@pxref{Propagating
21845 marks}).
21846
21847 @item G b o
21848 @kindex G b o (Group)
21849 @findex nnmairix-propagate-marks
21850 Manually propagate marks (@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks}); needed only when
21851 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} is set to @code{nil}.
21852
21853 @end table
21854
21855 In summary mode:
21856
21857 @table @kbd
21858
21859 @item $ m
21860 @kindex $ m (Summary)
21861 @findex nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article
21862 Allows you to create a mairix query or group based on the current
21863 message using graphical widgets (same as @code{nnmairix-widget-search})
21864 (@code{nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article}).
21865
21866 @item $ g
21867 @kindex $ g (Summary)
21868 @findex nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message
21869 Interactively creates a new search group with query based on the current
21870 message, but uses the minibuffer instead of graphical widgets
21871 (@code{nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message}).
21872
21873 @item $ t
21874 @kindex $ t (Summary)
21875 @findex nnmairix-search-thread-this-article
21876 Searches thread for the current article
21877 (@code{nnmairix-search-thread-this-article}). This is effectively a
21878 shortcut for calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{m:msgid} of the
21879 current article and enabled threads.
21880
21881 @item $ f
21882 @kindex $ f (Summary)
21883 @findex nnmairix-search-from-this-article
21884 Searches all messages from sender of the current article
21885 (@code{nnmairix-search-from-this-article}). This is a shortcut for
21886 calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{f:From}.
21887
21888 @item $ o
21889 @kindex $ o (Summary)
21890 @findex nnmairix-goto-original-article
21891 (Only in @code{nnmairix} groups!) Tries determine the group this article
21892 originally came from and displays the article in this group, so that,
21893 e.g., replying to this article the correct posting styles/group
21894 parameters are applied (@code{nnmairix-goto-original-article}). This
21895 function will use the registry if available, but can also parse the
21896 article file name as a fallback method.
21897
21898 @item $ u
21899 @kindex $ u (Summary)
21900 @findex nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article
21901 Remove possibly existing tick mark from original article
21902 (@code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article}). (@pxref{nnmairix
21903 tips and tricks}).
21904
21905 @end table
21906
21907 @node Propagating marks
21908 @subsection Propagating marks
21909
21910 First of: you really need a patched mairix binary for using the marks
21911 propagation feature efficiently. Otherwise, you would have to update
21912 the mairix database all the time. You can get the patch at
21913
21914 @uref{http://www.randomsample.de/mairix-maildir-patch.tar}
21915
21916 You need the mairix v0.21 source code for this patch; everything else
21917 is explained in the accompanied readme file. If you don't want to use
21918 marks propagation, you don't have to apply these patches, but they also
21919 fix some annoyances regarding changing maildir flags, so it might still
21920 be useful to you.
21921
21922 With the patched mairix binary, you can use @code{nnmairix} as an
21923 alternative to mail splitting (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}). For
21924 example, instead of splitting all mails from @samp{david@@foobar.com}
21925 into a group, you can simply create a search group with the query
21926 @samp{f:david@@foobar.com}. This is actually what ``smart folders'' are
21927 all about: simply put everything in one mail folder and dynamically
21928 create searches instead of splitting. This is more flexible, since you
21929 can dynamically change your folders any time you want to. This also
21930 implies that you will usually read your mails in the @code{nnmairix}
21931 groups instead of your ``real'' mail groups.
21932
21933 There is one problem, though: say you got a new mail from
21934 @samp{david@@foobar.com}; it will now show up in two groups, the
21935 ``real'' group (your INBOX, for example) and in the @code{nnmairix}
21936 search group (provided you have updated the mairix database). Now you
21937 enter the @code{nnmairix} group and read the mail. The mail will be
21938 marked as read, but only in the @code{nnmairix} group---in the ``real''
21939 mail group it will be still shown as unread.
21940
21941 You could now catch up the mail group (@pxref{Group Data}), but this is
21942 tedious and error prone, since you may overlook mails you don't have
21943 created @code{nnmairix} groups for. Of course, you could first use
21944 @code{nnmairix-goto-original-article} (@pxref{nnmairix keyboard
21945 shortcuts}) and then read the mail in the original group, but that's
21946 even more cumbersome.
21947
21948 Clearly, the easiest way would be if marks could somehow be
21949 automatically set for the original article. This is exactly what
21950 @emph{marks propagation} is about.
21951
21952 Marks propagation is inactive by default. You can activate it for a
21953 certain @code{nnmairix} group with
21954 @code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group} (bound to @kbd{G b
21955 p}). This function will warn you if you try to use it with your default
21956 search group; the reason is that the default search group is used for
21957 temporary searches, and it's easy to accidentally propagate marks from
21958 this group. However, you can ignore this warning if you really want to.
21959
21960 With marks propagation enabled, all the marks you set in a @code{nnmairix}
21961 group should now be propagated to the original article. For example,
21962 you can now tick an article (by default with @kbd{!}) and this mark should
21963 magically be set for the original article, too.
21964
21965 A few more remarks which you may or may not want to know:
21966
21967 @vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close
21968 Marks will not be set immediately, but only upon closing a group. This
21969 not only makes marks propagation faster, it also avoids problems with
21970 dangling symlinks when dealing with maildir files (since changing flags
21971 will change the file name). You can also control when to propagate marks
21972 via @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} (see the doc-string for
21973 details).
21974
21975 Obviously, @code{nnmairix} will have to look up the original group for every
21976 article you want to set marks for. If available, @code{nnmairix} will first
21977 use the registry for determining the original group. The registry is very
21978 fast, hence you should really, really enable the registry when using
21979 marks propagation. If you don't have to worry about RAM and disc space,
21980 set @code{gnus-registry-max-entries} to a large enough value; to be on
21981 the safe side, choose roughly the amount of mails you index with mairix.
21982
21983 @vindex nnmairix-only-use-registry
21984 If you don't want to use the registry or the registry hasn't seen the
21985 original article yet, @code{nnmairix} will use an additional mairix
21986 search for determining the file name of the article. This, of course, is
21987 way slower than the registry---if you set hundreds or even thousands of
21988 marks this way, it might take some time. You can avoid this situation by
21989 setting @code{nnmairix-only-use-registry} to @code{t}.
21990
21991 Maybe you also want to propagate marks the other way round, i.e., if you
21992 tick an article in a "real" mail group, you'd like to have the same
21993 article in a @code{nnmairix} group ticked, too. For several good
21994 reasons, this can only be done efficiently if you use maildir. To
21995 immediately contradict myself, let me mention that it WON'T work with
21996 @code{nnmaildir}, since @code{nnmaildir} stores the marks externally and
21997 not in the file name. Therefore, propagating marks to @code{nnmairix}
21998 groups will usually only work if you use an IMAP server which uses
21999 maildir as its file format.
22000
22001 @vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups
22002 If you work with this setup, just set
22003 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t} and see what
22004 happens. If you don't like what you see, just set it to @code{nil} again.
22005 One problem might be that you get a wrong number of unread articles; this
22006 usually happens when you delete or expire articles in the original
22007 groups. When this happens, you can recreate the @code{nnmairix} group on
22008 the back end using @kbd{G b d}.
22009
22010 @node nnmairix tips and tricks
22011 @subsection nnmairix tips and tricks
22012
22013 @itemize
22014 @item
22015 Checking Mail
22016
22017 @findex nnmairix-update-groups
22018 I put all my important mail groups at group level 1. The mairix groups
22019 have group level 5, so they do not get checked at start up (@pxref{Group
22020 Levels}).
22021
22022 I use the following to check for mails:
22023
22024 @lisp
22025 (defun my-check-mail-mairix-update (level)
22026 (interactive "P")
22027 ;; if no prefix given, set level=1
22028 (gnus-group-get-new-news (or level 1))
22029 (nnmairix-update-groups "mairixsearch" t t)
22030 (gnus-group-list-groups))
22031
22032 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map "g" 'my-check-mail-mairix-update)
22033 @end lisp
22034
22035 Instead of @samp{"mairixsearch"} use the name of your @code{nnmairix}
22036 server. See the doc string for @code{nnmairix-update-groups} for
22037 details.
22038
22039 @item
22040 Example: search group for ticked articles
22041
22042 For example, you can create a group for all ticked articles, where the
22043 articles always stay unread:
22044
22045 Hit @kbd{G b g}, enter group name (e.g., @samp{important}), use
22046 @samp{F:f} as query and do not include threads.
22047
22048 Now activate marks propagation for this group by using @kbd{G b p}. Then
22049 activate the always-unread feature by using @kbd{G b r} twice.
22050
22051 So far so good---but how do you remove the tick marks in the @code{nnmairix}
22052 group? There are two options: You may simply use
22053 @code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article} (bound to @kbd{$ u}) to remove
22054 tick marks from the original article. The other possibility is to set
22055 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t}, but see the above
22056 comments about this option. If it works for you, the tick marks should
22057 also exist in the @code{nnmairix} group and you can remove them as usual,
22058 e.g., by marking an article as read.
22059
22060 When you have removed a tick mark from the original article, this
22061 article should vanish from the @code{nnmairix} group after you have updated the
22062 mairix database and updated the group. Fortunately, there is a function
22063 for doing exactly that: @code{nnmairix-update-groups}. See the previous code
22064 snippet and the doc string for details.
22065
22066 @item
22067 Dealing with auto-subscription of mail groups
22068
22069 As described before, all @code{nnmairix} groups are in fact stored on
22070 the mail back end in the form @samp{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can
22071 see them when you enter the back end server in the server buffer. You
22072 should not subscribe these groups! Unfortunately, these groups will
22073 usually get @emph{auto-subscribed} when you use @code{nnmaildir} or
22074 @code{nnml}, i.e., you will suddenly see groups of the form
22075 @samp{zz_mairix*} pop up in your group buffer. If this happens to you,
22076 simply kill these groups with C-k. For avoiding this, turn off
22077 auto-subscription completely by setting the variable
22078 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups} to @code{nil} (@pxref{Filtering New
22079 Groups}), or if you like to keep this feature use the following kludge
22080 for turning it off for all groups beginning with @samp{zz_}:
22081
22082 @lisp
22083 (setq gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
22084 "^\\(nnml\\|nnfolder\\|nnmbox\\|nnmh\\|nnbabyl\\|nnmaildir\\).*:\\([^z]\\|z$\\|\\z[^z]\\|zz$\\|zz[^_]\\|zz_$\\).*")
22085 @end lisp
22086
22087 @end itemize
22088
22089 @node nnmairix caveats
22090 @subsection nnmairix caveats
22091
22092 @itemize
22093 @item
22094 You can create a secondary @code{nnml} server just for nnmairix, but then
22095 you have to explicitly set the corresponding server variable
22096 @code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}. Otherwise, new mail might get
22097 put into this secondary server (and would never show up again). Here's
22098 an example server definition:
22099
22100 @lisp
22101 (nnml "mairix" (nnml-directory "mairix") (nnml-get-new-mail nil))
22102 @end lisp
22103
22104 (The @code{nnmaildir} back end also has a server variable
22105 @code{get-new-mail}, but its default value is @code{nil}, so you don't
22106 have to explicitly set it if you use a @code{nnmaildir} server just for
22107 mairix.)
22108
22109 @item
22110 If you use the Gnus registry: don't use the registry with
22111 @code{nnmairix} groups (put them in
22112 @code{gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups}; this is the default). Be
22113 @emph{extra careful} if you use
22114 @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}; mails which are split
22115 into @code{nnmairix} groups are usually gone for good as soon as you
22116 check the group for new mail (yes, it has happened to me...).
22117
22118 @item
22119 Therefore: @emph{Never ever} put ``real'' mails into @code{nnmairix}
22120 groups (you shouldn't be able to, anyway).
22121
22122 @item
22123 If you use the Gnus agent (@pxref{Gnus Unplugged}): don't agentize
22124 @code{nnmairix} groups (though I have no idea what happens if you do).
22125
22126 @item
22127 mairix does only support us-ascii characters.
22128
22129 @item
22130 @code{nnmairix} uses a rather brute force method to force Gnus to
22131 completely reread the group on the mail back end after mairix was
22132 called---it simply deletes and re-creates the group on the mail
22133 back end. So far, this has worked for me without any problems, and I
22134 don't see how @code{nnmairix} could delete other mail groups than its
22135 own, but anyway: you really should have a backup of your mail
22136 folders.
22137
22138 @item
22139 All necessary information is stored in the group parameters
22140 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). This has the advantage that no active file
22141 is needed, but also implies that when you kill a @code{nnmairix} group,
22142 it is gone for good.
22143
22144 @item
22145 @findex nnmairix-purge-old-groups
22146 If you create and kill a lot of @code{nnmairix} groups, the
22147 ``zz_mairix-*'' groups will accumulate on the mail back end server. To
22148 delete old groups which are no longer needed, call
22149 @code{nnmairix-purge-old-groups}. Note that this assumes that you don't
22150 save any ``real'' mail in folders of the form
22151 @code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can change the prefix of
22152 @code{nnmairix} groups by changing the variable
22153 @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
22154
22155 @item
22156 The following only applies if you @emph{don't} use the mentioned patch
22157 for mairix (@pxref{Propagating marks}):
22158
22159 A problem can occur when using @code{nnmairix} with maildir folders and
22160 comes with the fact that maildir stores mail flags like @samp{Seen} or
22161 @samp{Replied} by appending chars @samp{S} and @samp{R} to the message
22162 file name, respectively. This implies that currently you would have to
22163 update the mairix database not only when new mail arrives, but also when
22164 mail flags are changing. The same applies to new mails which are indexed
22165 while they are still in the @samp{new} folder but then get moved to
22166 @samp{cur} when Gnus has seen the mail. If you don't update the database
22167 after this has happened, a mairix query can lead to symlinks pointing to
22168 non-existing files. In Gnus, these messages will usually appear with
22169 ``(none)'' entries in the header and can't be accessed. If this happens
22170 to you, using @kbd{G b u} and updating the group will usually fix this.
22171
22172 @end itemize
22173
22174 @iftex
22175 @iflatex
22176 @chapter Message
22177 @include message.texi
22178 @chapter Emacs MIME
22179 @include emacs-mime.texi
22180 @chapter Sieve
22181 @include sieve.texi
22182 @chapter EasyPG
22183 @include epa.texi
22184 @chapter SASL
22185 @include sasl.texi
22186 @end iflatex
22187 @end iftex
22188
22189 @node Various
22190 @chapter Various
22191
22192 @menu
22193 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
22194 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
22195 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
22196 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
22197 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
22198 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
22199 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
22200 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
22201 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
22202 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
22203 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
22204 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
22205 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
22206 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
22207 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
22208 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
22209 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
22210 * The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
22211 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
22212 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
22213 @end menu
22214
22215
22216 @node Process/Prefix
22217 @section Process/Prefix
22218 @cindex process/prefix convention
22219
22220 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
22221 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
22222
22223 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
22224 command to be performed on.
22225
22226 It goes like this:
22227
22228 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
22229 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
22230 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
22231 with the current one.
22232
22233 @vindex transient-mark-mode
22234 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
22235 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
22236
22237 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
22238 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
22239 the process mark.
22240
22241 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
22242 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
22243
22244 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
22245 are avoided.
22246
22247 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
22248 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
22249 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
22250 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
22251
22252 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
22253 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
22254 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
22255 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
22256 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
22257 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
22258 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
22259 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
22260
22261 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
22262 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
22263 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
22264 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
22265 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
22266
22267
22268 @node Interactive
22269 @section Interactive
22270 @cindex interaction
22271
22272 @table @code
22273
22274 @item gnus-novice-user
22275 @vindex gnus-novice-user
22276 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
22277 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
22278 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
22279 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
22280 default.
22281
22282 @item gnus-expert-user
22283 @vindex gnus-expert-user
22284 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
22285 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing,
22286 no matter how strange. For example, quitting Gnus, exiting a group
22287 without an update, catching up with a group, deleting expired
22288 articles, and replying by mail to a news message will not require
22289 confirmation.
22290
22291 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
22292 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
22293 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
22294 is @code{t} by default.
22295
22296 @item gnus-interactive-exit
22297 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
22298 If non-@code{nil}, require a confirmation when exiting Gnus. If
22299 @code{quiet}, update any active summary buffers automatically without
22300 querying. The default value is @code{t}.
22301 @end table
22302
22303
22304 @node Symbolic Prefixes
22305 @section Symbolic Prefixes
22306 @cindex symbolic prefixes
22307
22308 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
22309 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
22310 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
22311 rule of 900 to the current article.
22312
22313 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
22314 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
22315 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
22316 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
22317 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
22318 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
22319 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
22320
22321 @kindex M-i (Summary)
22322 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
22323 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
22324 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
22325 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
22326 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
22327 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
22328 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
22329 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
22330
22331 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
22332 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
22333 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
22334
22335 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
22336 Interactive}.
22337
22338
22339 @node Formatting Variables
22340 @section Formatting Variables
22341 @cindex formatting variables
22342
22343 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
22344 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
22345 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
22346 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
22347 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
22348 be annoyed by.
22349
22350 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
22351 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
22352 lots of percentages everywhere.
22353
22354 @menu
22355 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
22356 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
22357 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
22358 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
22359 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
22360 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
22361 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
22362 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
22363 @end menu
22364
22365 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
22366 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
22367 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
22368 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
22369 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
22370 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
22371 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
22372 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
22373
22374 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
22375 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
22376
22377 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
22378 @findex gnus-update-format
22379 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
22380 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
22381 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
22382 examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
22383
22384
22385
22386 @node Formatting Basics
22387 @subsection Formatting Basics
22388
22389 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
22390 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
22391 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
22392
22393 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
22394 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
22395 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
22396 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
22397 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
22398 the right instead.
22399
22400 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
22401 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
22402 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
22403 less than 4 characters wide.
22404
22405 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
22406 @samp{%&user-date;}.
22407
22408
22409 @node Mode Line Formatting
22410 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
22411
22412 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
22413 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
22414 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
22415 with the following two differences:
22416
22417 @enumerate
22418
22419 @item
22420 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
22421
22422 @item
22423 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
22424 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
22425 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
22426 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
22427 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
22428 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
22429 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
22430
22431 @end enumerate
22432
22433
22434 @node Advanced Formatting
22435 @subsection Advanced Formatting
22436
22437 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
22438 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
22439 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
22440 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
22441
22442 These are the valid modifiers:
22443
22444 @table @code
22445 @item pad
22446 @itemx pad-left
22447 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
22448 length.
22449
22450 @item pad-right
22451 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
22452 length.
22453
22454 @item max
22455 @itemx max-left
22456 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
22457
22458 @item max-right
22459 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
22460 length.
22461
22462 @item cut
22463 @itemx cut-left
22464 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
22465
22466 @item cut-right
22467 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
22468
22469 @item ignore
22470 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
22471
22472 @item form
22473 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
22474 used.
22475
22476 Here's an example:
22477
22478 @lisp
22479 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
22480 @end lisp
22481
22482 @end table
22483
22484 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
22485 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
22486 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
22487 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
22488 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
22489 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
22490 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
22491
22492 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
22493 last operation, padding.
22494
22495
22496 @node User-Defined Specs
22497 @subsection User-Defined Specs
22498
22499 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
22500 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
22501 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
22502 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
22503 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
22504 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
22505 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
22506 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
22507 should protect against that.
22508
22509 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
22510 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
22511
22512 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
22513 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
22514 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
22515 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
22516 inserted.
22517
22518
22519 @node Formatting Fonts
22520 @subsection Formatting Fonts
22521
22522 @cindex %(, %)
22523 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
22524 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
22525 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
22526 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
22527 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
22528 over it.
22529
22530 @cindex %@{, %@}
22531 @vindex gnus-face-0
22532 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
22533 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
22534 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
22535 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
22536 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
22537 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
22538
22539 @cindex %<<, %>>, guillemets
22540 @c @cindex %<<, %>>, %«, %», guillemets
22541 @vindex gnus-balloon-face-0
22542 Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
22543 special @code{balloon-help} property set to
22544 @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
22545 @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
22546 variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
22547 return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
22548 set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
22549 refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
22550 (in Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
22551 XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
22552 guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
22553 paragraph.)
22554
22555 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
22556
22557 @lisp
22558 ;; @r{Create three face types.}
22559 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
22560 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
22561
22562 ;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
22563 ;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
22564 ;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
22565 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
22566 ;; @r{Set the color.}
22567 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
22568 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
22569
22570 ;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
22571 (setq gnus-group-line-format
22572 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
22573 @end lisp
22574
22575 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
22576 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
22577
22578 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
22579 mode-line variables.
22580
22581 @node Positioning Point
22582 @subsection Positioning Point
22583
22584 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
22585 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
22586 line. You can customize this behavior in three different ways.
22587
22588 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
22589
22590 @findex gnus-goto-colon
22591 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
22592 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
22593
22594 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
22595 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
22596 put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
22597 place point there.
22598
22599
22600 @node Tabulation
22601 @subsection Tabulation
22602
22603 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
22604 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
22605 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
22606 about lining up the following text afterwards.
22607
22608 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
22609 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
22610
22611 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
22612 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
22613 This is the soft tabulator.
22614
22615 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
22616 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
22617 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
22618
22619
22620 @node Wide Characters
22621 @subsection Wide Characters
22622
22623 Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
22624 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
22625 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
22626
22627 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
22628 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
22629 these countries, that's not true.
22630
22631 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
22632 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
22633 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
22634 prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
22635 for Emacs.
22636
22637
22638 @node Window Layout
22639 @section Window Layout
22640 @cindex window layout
22641
22642 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
22643
22644 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
22645 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
22646 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
22647 @code{t} by default.
22648
22649 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
22650 glitches. Use at your own peril.
22651
22652 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
22653 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
22654 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
22655
22656 @lisp
22657 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)))
22658 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
22659 (article 1.0))))
22660 @end lisp
22661
22662 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
22663 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
22664 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
22665 possible names is listed below.
22666
22667 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
22668 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example:
22669
22670 @lisp
22671 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
22672 (article 1.0)))
22673 @end lisp
22674
22675 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
22676 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
22677 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
22678 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
22679 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
22680 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
22681 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
22682 size spec per split.
22683
22684 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
22685 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
22686 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e., is the third or
22687 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
22688 present) gets focus.
22689
22690 Here's a more complicated example:
22691
22692 @lisp
22693 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
22694 (summary 0.25 point)
22695 (article 1.0)))
22696 @end lisp
22697
22698 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
22699 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
22700 occupy, not a percentage.
22701
22702 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
22703 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
22704 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
22705 be used as a split.
22706
22707 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
22708
22709 @lisp
22710 (article (horizontal 1.0
22711 (vertical 0.5
22712 (group 1.0))
22713 (vertical 1.0
22714 (summary 0.25 point)
22715 (article 1.0))))
22716 @end lisp
22717
22718 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
22719 @code{horizontal} thingie?
22720
22721 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
22722 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
22723 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
22724 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
22725 the screen is to be given to this strip.
22726
22727 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
22728 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
22729 lines from the splits.
22730
22731 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
22732 may look like:
22733
22734 @example
22735 @group
22736 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
22737 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
22738 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
22739 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
22740 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
22741 size = number | frame-params
22742 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
22743 @end group
22744 @end example
22745
22746 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
22747 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
22748 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
22749 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
22750
22751 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
22752 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
22753 @cindex window height
22754 @cindex window width
22755 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
22756 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
22757 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
22758 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
22759 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
22760 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
22761
22762 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
22763 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
22764 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
22765 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
22766
22767 @findex gnus-configure-frame
22768 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
22769 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
22770 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
22771 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
22772 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
22773 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
22774 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
22775 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
22776 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
22777 configuration list.
22778
22779 @lisp
22780 (gnus-configure-frame
22781 '(horizontal 1.0
22782 (vertical 10
22783 (group 1.0)
22784 (article 0.3 point))
22785 (vertical 1.0
22786 (article 1.0)
22787 (horizontal 4
22788 (group 1.0)
22789 (article 10)))))
22790 @end lisp
22791
22792 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
22793 @code{frame} split:
22794
22795 @lisp
22796 (gnus-configure-frame
22797 '(frame 1.0
22798 (vertical 1.0
22799 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
22800 (article 1.0))
22801 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
22802 (user-position . t)
22803 (left . -1) (top . 1))
22804 (picon 1.0))))
22805
22806 @end lisp
22807
22808 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
22809 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
22810 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
22811 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
22812 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
22813 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
22814 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
22815 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
22816 is such a plist.
22817 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
22818 be found in its default value.
22819
22820 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
22821 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
22822 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
22823 might be used:
22824
22825 @lisp
22826 (message (horizontal 1.0
22827 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
22828 (vertical 0.24
22829 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
22830 '(summary 0.5))
22831 (group 1.0))))
22832 @end lisp
22833
22834 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
22835 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
22836 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
22837
22838 @lisp
22839 (message
22840 (frame 1.0
22841 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
22842 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
22843 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
22844 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
22845 (name . "Message"))
22846 (message 1.0 point))))
22847 @end lisp
22848
22849 @findex gnus-add-configuration
22850 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
22851 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
22852 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
22853 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
22854
22855 @lisp
22856 (gnus-add-configuration
22857 '(article (vertical 1.0
22858 (group 4)
22859 (summary .25 point)
22860 (article 1.0))))
22861 @end lisp
22862
22863 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
22864 @file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
22865 Gnus has been loaded.
22866
22867 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
22868 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
22869 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
22870 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
22871 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
22872
22873 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
22874 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
22875 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
22876 windows resized.
22877
22878 @subsection Window Configuration Names
22879
22880 Here's a list of most of the currently known window configurations,
22881 and when they're used:
22882
22883 @table @code
22884 @item group
22885 The group buffer.
22886
22887 @item summary
22888 Entering a group and showing only the summary.
22889
22890 @item article
22891 Selecting an article.
22892
22893 @item server
22894 The server buffer.
22895
22896 @item browse
22897 Browsing groups from the server buffer.
22898
22899 @item message
22900 Composing a (new) message.
22901
22902 @item only-article
22903 Showing only the article buffer.
22904
22905 @item edit-article
22906 Editing an article.
22907
22908 @item edit-form
22909 Editing group parameters and the like.
22910
22911 @item edit-score
22912 Editing a server definition.
22913
22914 @item post
22915 Composing a news message.
22916
22917 @item reply
22918 Replying or following up an article without yanking the text.
22919
22920 @item forward
22921 Forwarding a message.
22922
22923 @item reply-yank
22924 Replying or following up an article with yanking the text.
22925
22926 @item mail-bound
22927 Bouncing a message.
22928
22929 @item pipe
22930 Sending an article to an external process.
22931
22932 @item bug
22933 Sending a bug report.
22934
22935 @item score-trace
22936 Displaying the score trace.
22937
22938 @item score-words
22939 Displaying the score words.
22940
22941 @item split-trace
22942 Displaying the split trace.
22943
22944 @item compose-bounce
22945 Composing a bounce message.
22946
22947 @item mml-preview
22948 Previewing a @acronym{MIME} part.
22949
22950 @end table
22951
22952
22953 @subsection Example Window Configurations
22954
22955 @itemize @bullet
22956 @item
22957 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
22958 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
22959
22960 @ifinfo
22961 @example
22962 +---+---------+
22963 | G | Summary |
22964 | r +---------+
22965 | o | |
22966 | u | Article |
22967 | p | |
22968 +---+---------+
22969 @end example
22970 @end ifinfo
22971
22972 @lisp
22973 (gnus-add-configuration
22974 '(article
22975 (horizontal 1.0
22976 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22977 (vertical 1.0
22978 (summary 0.16 point)
22979 (article 1.0)))))
22980
22981 (gnus-add-configuration
22982 '(summary
22983 (horizontal 1.0
22984 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22985 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
22986 @end lisp
22987
22988 @end itemize
22989
22990
22991 @node Faces and Fonts
22992 @section Faces and Fonts
22993 @cindex faces
22994 @cindex fonts
22995 @cindex colors
22996
22997 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
22998 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
22999 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
23000 interface.
23001
23002
23003 @node Mode Lines
23004 @section Mode Lines
23005 @cindex mode lines
23006
23007 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
23008 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
23009 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
23010 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
23011 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
23012 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
23013 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
23014 quicker.
23015
23016 @cindex display-time
23017
23018 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
23019 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
23020 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
23021 to display (e.g., the subject of the article) is often longer than the
23022 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
23023 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
23024 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
23025 additional elements on the mode line (e.g., a clock), you should modify
23026 this variable:
23027
23028 @c Hook written by Francesco Potortì <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
23029 @lisp
23030 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
23031 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
23032 (+ 21
23033 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
23034 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
23035 (length display-time-string)))))
23036 @end lisp
23037
23038 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
23039 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
23040 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
23041 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
23042 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
23043
23044
23045 @node Highlighting and Menus
23046 @section Highlighting and Menus
23047 @cindex visual
23048 @cindex highlighting
23049 @cindex menus
23050
23051 @vindex gnus-visual
23052 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
23053 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
23054 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
23055 file.
23056
23057 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
23058 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
23059
23060 @table @code
23061 @item group-highlight
23062 Do highlights in the group buffer.
23063 @item summary-highlight
23064 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
23065 @item article-highlight
23066 Do highlights in the article buffer.
23067 @item highlight
23068 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
23069 @item group-menu
23070 Create menus in the group buffer.
23071 @item summary-menu
23072 Create menus in the summary buffers.
23073 @item article-menu
23074 Create menus in the article buffer.
23075 @item browse-menu
23076 Create menus in the browse buffer.
23077 @item server-menu
23078 Create menus in the server buffer.
23079 @item score-menu
23080 Create menus in the score buffers.
23081 @item menu
23082 Create menus in all buffers.
23083 @end table
23084
23085 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
23086 buffers, you could say something like:
23087
23088 @lisp
23089 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
23090 @end lisp
23091
23092 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
23093
23094 @lisp
23095 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
23096 @end lisp
23097
23098 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
23099 in all Gnus buffers.
23100
23101 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
23102
23103 @table @code
23104 @item gnus-mouse-face
23105 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
23106 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
23107 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
23108
23109 @end table
23110
23111 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
23112
23113 @table @code
23114
23115 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
23116 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
23117 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
23118
23119 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
23120 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
23121 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
23122
23123 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
23124 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
23125 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
23126
23127 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
23128 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
23129 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
23130
23131 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
23132 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
23133 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
23134
23135 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
23136 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
23137 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
23138
23139 @end table
23140
23141
23142 @node Daemons
23143 @section Daemons
23144 @cindex demons
23145 @cindex daemons
23146
23147 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
23148 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
23149 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
23150 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
23151 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
23152
23153 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
23154 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
23155 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
23156
23157 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
23158 been idle for thirty minutes:
23159
23160 @lisp
23161 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
23162 @end lisp
23163
23164 Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
23165 Emacs is idle:
23166
23167 @lisp
23168 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
23169 @end lisp
23170
23171 This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
23172 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
23173 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23174
23175 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
23176 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
23177 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
23178 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23179
23180 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
23181 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
23182 @var{idle} minutes.
23183
23184 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
23185 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
23186 minutes.
23187
23188 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
23189 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
23190 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
23191
23192 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
23193 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
23194 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
23195 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
23196
23197 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
23198 your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23199
23200 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
23201 @lisp
23202 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
23203 @end lisp
23204
23205 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
23206 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
23207 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
23208 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
23209 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
23210 @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
23211 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
23212 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
23213 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
23214 @file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
23215
23216 @findex gnus-demon-init
23217 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
23218 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
23219 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
23220 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
23221 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
23222
23223 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
23224 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
23225 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
23226 behave.
23227
23228
23229 @node Undo
23230 @section Undo
23231 @cindex undo
23232
23233 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
23234 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
23235 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
23236
23237 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
23238 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
23239 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
23240 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
23241 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
23242 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
23243 @code{undo} function.
23244
23245 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
23246 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
23247 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
23248 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
23249 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
23250 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
23251 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
23252 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
23253 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
23254 never be totally undoable.
23255
23256 @findex gnus-undo-mode
23257 @vindex gnus-use-undo
23258 @findex gnus-undo
23259 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
23260 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
23261 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
23262 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
23263 command.
23264
23265
23266 @node Predicate Specifiers
23267 @section Predicate Specifiers
23268 @cindex predicate specifiers
23269
23270 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
23271 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
23272 to type all that much.
23273
23274 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
23275
23276 Here's an example:
23277
23278 @lisp
23279 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
23280 gnus-article-unread-p)
23281 @end lisp
23282
23283 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
23284 functions all take one parameter.
23285
23286 @findex gnus-make-predicate
23287 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
23288 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
23289 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
23290 specifier.
23291
23292
23293 @node Moderation
23294 @section Moderation
23295 @cindex moderation
23296
23297 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
23298 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
23299 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
23300 get a copy.
23301
23302 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
23303 buffers. Put
23304
23305 @lisp
23306 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
23307 @end lisp
23308
23309 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
23310
23311 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
23312 supposed to work:
23313
23314 @enumerate
23315 @item
23316 You split your incoming mail by matching on
23317 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
23318 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
23319
23320 @item
23321 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
23322 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
23323
23324 @item
23325 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
23326 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
23327 @kbd{c} command.
23328 @end enumerate
23329
23330 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
23331
23332 @lisp
23333 (setq gnus-moderated-list
23334 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
23335 @end lisp
23336
23337
23338 @node Fetching a Group
23339 @section Fetching a Group
23340 @cindex fetching a group
23341
23342 @findex gnus-fetch-group
23343 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
23344 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
23345 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
23346 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
23347 It takes the group name as a parameter.
23348
23349
23350 @node Image Enhancements
23351 @section Image Enhancements
23352
23353 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
23354 support images, Emacs 22 does.} and up, are able to display pictures and
23355 stuff, so Gnus has taken advantage of that.
23356
23357 @menu
23358 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
23359 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
23360 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
23361 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
23362 * Gravatars:: Display the avatar of people you read.
23363 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
23364 @end menu
23365
23366
23367 @node X-Face
23368 @subsection X-Face
23369 @cindex x-face
23370
23371 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
23372 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
23373 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
23374 readers.
23375
23376 @cindex x-face
23377 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
23378 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
23379 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
23380 @iftex
23381 @iflatex
23382 \include{xface}
23383 @end iflatex
23384 @end iftex
23385 @c @anchor{X-Face}
23386
23387 Viewing an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
23388 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions have), or that you
23389 have suitable conversion or display programs installed. If your Emacs
23390 has image support the default action is to display the face before the
23391 @code{From} header. If there's no native @code{X-Face} support, Gnus
23392 will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using external programs
23393 from the @code{pbmplus} package and friends, see below. For XEmacs it's
23394 faster if XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support. The
23395 default action under Emacs without image support is to fork off the
23396 @code{display} program.
23397
23398 On a GNU/Linux system, the @code{display} program is included in the
23399 ImageMagick package. For external conversion programs look for packages
23400 with names like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.
23401 On Windows, you may use the packages @code{netpbm} and @code{compface}
23402 from @url{http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net}. You need to add the
23403 @code{bin} directory to your @code{PATH} environment variable.
23404 @c In fact only the following DLLs and binaries seem to be required:
23405 @c compface1.dll uncompface.exe libnetpbm10.dll icontopbm.exe
23406
23407 The variable @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} controls which programs
23408 are used to display the @code{X-Face} header. If this variable is a
23409 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
23410 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
23411 If @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches the
23412 @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
23413
23414 (Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
23415 @code{xface}).
23416
23417 @noindent
23418 Face and variable:
23419
23420 @table @code
23421 @item gnus-x-face
23422 @vindex gnus-x-face
23423 Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
23424 foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
23425 default colors are black and white.
23426
23427 @item gnus-face-properties-alist
23428 @vindex gnus-face-properties-alist
23429 Alist of image types and properties applied to Face (@pxref{Face}) and
23430 X-Face images. The default value is @code{((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face))
23431 (png . nil))} for Emacs or @code{((xface . (:face gnus-x-face)))} for
23432 XEmacs. Here are examples:
23433
23434 @lisp
23435 ;; Specify the altitude of Face and X-Face images in the From header.
23436 (setq gnus-face-properties-alist
23437 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :ascent 80))
23438 (png . (:ascent 80))))
23439
23440 ;; Show Face and X-Face images as pressed buttons.
23441 (setq gnus-face-properties-alist
23442 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :relief -2))
23443 (png . (:relief -2))))
23444 @end lisp
23445
23446 @pxref{Image Descriptors, ,Image Descriptors, elisp, The Emacs Lisp
23447 Reference Manual} for the valid properties for various image types.
23448 Currently, @code{pbm} is used for X-Face images and @code{png} is used
23449 for Face images in Emacs. Only the @code{:face} property is effective
23450 on the @code{xface} image type in XEmacs if it is built with the
23451 @samp{libcompface} library.
23452 @end table
23453
23454 If you use posting styles, you can use an @code{x-face-file} entry in
23455 @code{gnus-posting-styles}, @xref{Posting Styles}. If you don't, Gnus
23456 provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow easier
23457 insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages. You also need the
23458 above mentioned ImageMagick, netpbm or other image conversion packages
23459 (depending the values of the variables below) for these functions.
23460
23461 @findex gnus-random-x-face
23462 @vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
23463 @vindex gnus-x-face-directory
23464 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
23465 @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
23466 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
23467 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
23468 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
23469 header data as a string.
23470
23471 @findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
23472 @code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
23473 @code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
23474 randomly generated data.
23475
23476 @findex gnus-x-face-from-file
23477 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
23478 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
23479 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
23480 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
23481
23482 Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
23483 like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23484
23485 @lisp
23486 (setq message-required-news-headers
23487 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23488 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
23489 @end lisp
23490
23491 Using the last function would be something like this:
23492
23493 @lisp
23494 (setq message-required-news-headers
23495 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23496 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
23497 (gnus-x-face-from-file
23498 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
23499 @end lisp
23500
23501
23502 @node Face
23503 @subsection Face
23504 @cindex face
23505
23506 @c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces' implementations should really be harmonized.
23507
23508 @code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
23509 ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
23510 represent the author of the message.
23511
23512 @cindex face
23513 @findex gnus-article-display-face
23514 The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
23515 See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
23516 specifications.
23517
23518 The @code{gnus-face-properties-alist} variable affects the appearance of
23519 displayed Face images. @xref{X-Face}.
23520
23521 Viewing a @code{Face} header requires an Emacs that is able to display
23522 PNG images.
23523 @c Maybe add this:
23524 @c (if (featurep 'xemacs)
23525 @c (featurep 'png)
23526 @c (image-type-available-p 'png))
23527
23528 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
23529 easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
23530
23531 @findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
23532 @code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
23533 726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
23534
23535 @findex gnus-face-from-file
23536 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
23537 @code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
23538 converts the file to Face format by using the
23539 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
23540
23541 Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
23542 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23543
23544 @lisp
23545 (setq message-required-news-headers
23546 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23547 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
23548 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
23549 @end lisp
23550
23551
23552 @node Smileys
23553 @subsection Smileys
23554 @cindex smileys
23555
23556 @iftex
23557 @iflatex
23558 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
23559 \input{smiley}
23560 @end iflatex
23561 @end iftex
23562
23563 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
23564 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
23565
23566 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
23567 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23568
23569 @lisp
23570 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
23571 @end lisp
23572
23573 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
23574 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
23575 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
23576 text and maps that to file names.
23577
23578 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
23579 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
23580 variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
23581 the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
23582 the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
23583 displayed.
23584
23585 The following variables customize the appearance of the smileys:
23586
23587 @table @code
23588
23589 @item smiley-style
23590 @vindex smiley-style
23591 Specifies the smiley style. Predefined smiley styles include
23592 @code{low-color} (small 13x14 pixel, three-color images), @code{medium}
23593 (more colorful images, 16x16 pixel), and @code{grayscale} (grayscale
23594 images, 14x14 pixel). The default depends on the height of the default
23595 face.
23596
23597 @item smiley-data-directory
23598 @vindex smiley-data-directory
23599 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files. You shouldn't set this
23600 variable anymore. Customize @code{smiley-style} instead.
23601
23602 @item gnus-smiley-file-types
23603 @vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
23604 List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
23605
23606 @end table
23607
23608
23609 @node Picons
23610 @subsection Picons
23611
23612 @iftex
23613 @iflatex
23614 \include{picons}
23615 @end iflatex
23616 @end iftex
23617
23618 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
23619 good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
23620 over your shoulder as you read news.
23621
23622 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
23623
23624 @iftex
23625 @iflatex
23626 \margindex{}
23627 @end iflatex
23628 @end iftex
23629
23630 @quotation
23631 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
23632 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
23633 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
23634 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
23635 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
23636 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
23637 @code{GIF} formats.
23638 @end quotation
23639
23640 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
23641 For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
23642 point your Web browser at
23643 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
23644
23645 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
23646 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
23647
23648 To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
23649 @code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
23650 Picons databases.
23651
23652 @vindex gnus-picon-style
23653 The variable @code{gnus-picon-style} controls how picons are displayed.
23654 If @code{inline}, the textual representation is replaced. If
23655 @code{right}, picons are added right to the textual representation.
23656
23657 @vindex gnus-picon-properties
23658 The value of the variable @code{gnus-picon-properties} is a list of
23659 properties applied to picons.
23660
23661 The following variables offer control over where things are located.
23662
23663 @table @code
23664
23665 @item gnus-picon-databases
23666 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
23667 The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
23668 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
23669 subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
23670 "/usr/local/faces")}.
23671
23672 @item gnus-picon-news-directories
23673 @vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
23674 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23675 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
23676
23677 @item gnus-picon-user-directories
23678 @vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
23679 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
23680 faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
23681
23682 @item gnus-picon-domain-directories
23683 @vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
23684 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23685 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
23686 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
23687
23688 @item gnus-picon-file-types
23689 @vindex gnus-picon-file-types
23690 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
23691 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
23692
23693 @item gnus-picon-inhibit-top-level-domains
23694 @vindex gnus-picon-inhibit-top-level-domains
23695 If non-@code{nil} (which is the default), don't display picons for
23696 things like @samp{.net} and @samp{.de}, which aren't usually very
23697 interesting.
23698
23699 @end table
23700
23701 @node Gravatars
23702 @subsection Gravatars
23703
23704 @iftex
23705 @iflatex
23706 \include{gravatars}
23707 @end iflatex
23708 @end iftex
23709
23710 A gravatar is an image registered to an e-mail address.
23711
23712 You can submit yours on-line at @uref{http://www.gravatar.com}.
23713
23714 The following variables offer control over how things are displayed.
23715
23716 @table @code
23717
23718 @item gnus-gravatar-size
23719 @vindex gnus-gravatar-size
23720 The size in pixels of gravatars. Gravatars are always square, so one
23721 number for the size is enough.
23722
23723 @item gnus-gravatar-properties
23724 @vindex gnus-gravatar-properties
23725 List of image properties applied to Gravatar images.
23726
23727 @item gnus-gravatar-too-ugly
23728 @vindex gnus-gravatar-too-ugly
23729 Regexp that matches mail addresses or names of people of which avatars
23730 should not be displayed, or @code{nil}. It default to the value of
23731 @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (@pxref{X-Face}).
23732
23733 @end table
23734
23735 If you want to see them in the From field, set:
23736 @lisp
23737 (setq gnus-treat-from-gravatar 'head)
23738 @end lisp
23739
23740 If you want to see them in the Cc and To fields, set:
23741
23742 @lisp
23743 (setq gnus-treat-mail-gravatar 'head)
23744 @end lisp
23745
23746
23747 @node XVarious
23748 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
23749
23750 @table @code
23751 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23752 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23753 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
23754 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
23755 unusual directory structure.
23756
23757 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23758 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23759 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
23760 default.
23761
23762 @end table
23763
23764 @subsubsection Toolbar
23765
23766 @table @code
23767
23768 @item gnus-use-toolbar
23769 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
23770 This variable specifies the position to display the toolbar. If
23771 @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If it is non-@code{nil}, it should
23772 be one of the symbols @code{default}, @code{top}, @code{bottom},
23773 @code{right}, and @code{left}. @code{default} means to use the default
23774 toolbar, the rest mean to display the toolbar on the place which those
23775 names show. The default is @code{default}.
23776
23777 @item gnus-toolbar-thickness
23778 @vindex gnus-toolbar-thickness
23779 Cons of the height and the width specifying the thickness of a toolbar.
23780 The height is used for the toolbar displayed on the top or the bottom,
23781 the width is used for the toolbar displayed on the right or the left.
23782 The default is that of the default toolbar.
23783
23784 @item gnus-group-toolbar
23785 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
23786 The toolbar in the group buffer.
23787
23788 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
23789 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
23790 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
23791
23792 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23793 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23794 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
23795
23796 @end table
23797
23798 @iftex
23799 @iflatex
23800 \margindex{}
23801 @end iflatex
23802 @end iftex
23803
23804
23805 @node Fuzzy Matching
23806 @section Fuzzy Matching
23807 @cindex fuzzy matching
23808
23809 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
23810 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
23811
23812 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
23813 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
23814 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
23815
23816 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
23817 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
23818 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
23819 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
23820 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
23821
23822
23823 @node Thwarting Email Spam
23824 @section Thwarting Email Spam
23825 @cindex email spam
23826 @cindex spam
23827 @cindex UCE
23828 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23829
23830 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
23831 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
23832 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
23833 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
23834 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
23835 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
23836 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
23837 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
23838 in the end.
23839
23840 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
23841 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
23842 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
23843 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
23844 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
23845 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
23846
23847 This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
23848
23849 @menu
23850 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
23851 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
23852 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
23853 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
23854 @end menu
23855
23856 @node The problem of spam
23857 @subsection The problem of spam
23858 @cindex email spam
23859 @cindex spam filtering approaches
23860 @cindex filtering approaches, spam
23861 @cindex UCE
23862 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23863
23864 First, some background on spam.
23865
23866 If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
23867 termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
23868 exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
23869 so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
23870 make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
23871 common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
23872 further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
23873 but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
23874 @emph{morons} are in common use as well.
23875
23876 Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
23877 dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
23878 example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
23879 unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
23880 their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
23881 of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
23882 be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
23883 through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
23884 requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
23885 and processing.
23886
23887 The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
23888 server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
23889 messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
23890 @samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
23891 discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
23892 lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
23893 from Bulgarian IPs.
23894
23895 This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
23896 risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
23897 etc.)@: or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.)@: from contacting
23898 you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
23899
23900 In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
23901 been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
23902 words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
23903 cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
23904
23905 Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
23906 processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
23907 @var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
23908 Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
23909 @var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
23910 database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
23911 of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
23912 of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
23913 spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
23914
23915 Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
23916 a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
23917 fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
23918 spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
23919 well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
23920 sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
23921 down for some time because of the incident.
23922
23923 The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
23924 based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
23925 the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
23926 words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
23927 analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
23928 classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
23929 run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
23930 to store the database of spam analysis. Statistical analysis on the
23931 server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
23932 user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
23933 the server that it has misclassified mail.
23934
23935 Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
23936 magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
23937 Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
23938 because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
23939 are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
23940 idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
23941 a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
23942 spam plague.
23943
23944 @node Anti-Spam Basics
23945 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
23946 @cindex email spam
23947 @cindex spam
23948 @cindex UCE
23949 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23950
23951 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
23952 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
23953
23954 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
23955 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
23956 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
23957 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
23958 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
23959 part of the mail address.)
23960
23961 @lisp
23962 (setq message-default-news-headers
23963 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
23964 @end lisp
23965
23966 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
23967 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
23968
23969 @lisp
23970 (...
23971 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
23972 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
23973 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
23974 "spam"))
23975 ...)
23976 @end lisp
23977
23978 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
23979 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
23980 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
23981 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
23982
23983 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
23984 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
23985 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
23986 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
23987 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
23988 your fancy split rule in this way:
23989
23990 @lisp
23991 (
23992 ...
23993 (to "larsi" "misc")
23994 "spam")
23995 @end lisp
23996
23997 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
23998 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
23999 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
24000 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
24001 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
24002
24003 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
24004 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
24005 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
24006 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
24007
24008 Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
24009
24010
24011 @node SpamAssassin
24012 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
24013 @cindex SpamAssassin
24014 @cindex Vipul's Razor
24015 @cindex DCC
24016
24017 The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
24018 avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
24019 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
24020 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
24021 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
24022 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
24023 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
24024
24025 Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
24026 which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
24027 the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
24028 recipes.
24029
24030 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
24031 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
24032 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
24033 Specifiers}) follow.
24034
24035 @lisp
24036 (setq mail-sources
24037 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
24038 (pop :user "jrl"
24039 :server "pophost"
24040 :postscript
24041 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
24042 @end lisp
24043
24044 Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
24045 the mail contain, e.g., a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
24046 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
24047
24048 @lisp
24049 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
24050 ...))
24051 @end lisp
24052
24053 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
24054
24055 @lisp
24056 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
24057 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
24058 ...))
24059 @end lisp
24060
24061 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
24062 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
24063 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
24064 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
24065
24066 @lisp
24067 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
24068 ...))
24069 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
24070 (save-excursion
24071 (save-restriction
24072 (widen)
24073 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
24074 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
24075 "spam"))))
24076 @end lisp
24077
24078 Note that with the nnimap back end, message bodies will not be
24079 downloaded by default. You need to set
24080 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
24081 (@pxref{Client-Side IMAP Splitting}).
24082
24083 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
24084 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
24085 spam. And here is the nifty function:
24086
24087 @lisp
24088 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
24089 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
24090 (interactive)
24091 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d" t)
24092 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
24093 @end lisp
24094
24095 @node Hashcash
24096 @subsection Hashcash
24097 @cindex hashcash
24098
24099 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
24100 costly and demonstrably unique for each message they send. This has
24101 the obvious drawback that you cannot rely on everyone in the world
24102 using this technique, since it is not part of the Internet standards,
24103 but it may be useful in smaller communities.
24104
24105 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
24106 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
24107 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
24108 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
24109 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
24110 instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
24111 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
24112 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
24113 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
24114 one of them separately.
24115
24116 @cindex X-Hashcash
24117 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
24118 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
24119 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:} header.
24120 For more details, and for the external application @code{hashcash} you
24121 need to install to use this feature, see
24122 @uref{http://www.hashcash.org/}. Even more information can be found
24123 at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
24124
24125 If you wish to generate hashcash for each message you send, you can
24126 customize @code{message-generate-hashcash} (@pxref{Mail Headers, ,Mail
24127 Headers,message, The Message Manual}), as in:
24128
24129 @lisp
24130 (setq message-generate-hashcash t)
24131 @end lisp
24132
24133 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
24134
24135 @table @code
24136
24137 @item hashcash-default-payment
24138 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
24139 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
24140 should consist of. By default this is 20. Suggested useful values
24141 include 17 to 29.
24142
24143 @item hashcash-payment-alist
24144 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
24145 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
24146 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
24147 @var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
24148 or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
24149 that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
24150 @var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
24151 (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
24152
24153 @item hashcash-path
24154 @vindex hashcash-path
24155 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed. This variable should
24156 be automatically set by @code{executable-find}, but if it's @code{nil}
24157 (usually because the @code{hashcash} binary is not in your path)
24158 you'll get a warning when you check hashcash payments and an error
24159 when you generate hashcash payments.
24160
24161 @end table
24162
24163 Gnus can verify hashcash cookies, although this can also be done by
24164 hand customized mail filtering scripts. To verify a hashcash cookie
24165 in a message, use the @code{mail-check-payment} function in the
24166 @code{hashcash.el} library. You can also use the @code{spam.el}
24167 package with the @code{spam-use-hashcash} back end to validate hashcash
24168 cookies in incoming mail and filter mail accordingly (@pxref{Anti-spam
24169 Hashcash Payments}).
24170
24171 @node Spam Package
24172 @section Spam Package
24173 @cindex spam filtering
24174 @cindex spam
24175
24176 The Spam package provides Gnus with a centralized mechanism for
24177 detecting and filtering spam. It filters new mail, and processes
24178 messages according to whether they are spam or ham. (@dfn{Ham} is the
24179 name used throughout this manual to indicate non-spam messages.)
24180
24181 @menu
24182 * Spam Package Introduction::
24183 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
24184 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
24185 * Spam and Ham Processors::
24186 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
24187 * Spam Back Ends::
24188 * Extending the Spam package::
24189 * Spam Statistics Package::
24190 @end menu
24191
24192 @node Spam Package Introduction
24193 @subsection Spam Package Introduction
24194 @cindex spam filtering
24195 @cindex spam filtering sequence of events
24196 @cindex spam
24197
24198 You must read this section to understand how the Spam package works.
24199 Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
24200
24201 Make sure you read the section on the @code{spam.el} sequence of
24202 events. See @xref{Extending the Spam package}.
24203
24204 @cindex spam-initialize
24205 @vindex spam-use-stat
24206 To use the Spam package, you @strong{must} first run the function
24207 @code{spam-initialize}:
24208
24209 @example
24210 (spam-initialize)
24211 @end example
24212
24213 This autoloads @code{spam.el} and installs the various hooks necessary
24214 to let the Spam package do its job. In order to make use of the Spam
24215 package, you have to set up certain group parameters and variables,
24216 which we will describe below. All of the variables controlling the
24217 Spam package can be found in the @samp{spam} customization group.
24218
24219 There are two ``contact points'' between the Spam package and the rest
24220 of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and leaving a group.
24221
24222 Checking new mail for spam is done in one of two ways: while splitting
24223 incoming mail, or when you enter a group.
24224
24225 The first way, checking for spam while splitting incoming mail, is
24226 suited to mail back ends such as @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap}, where
24227 new mail appears in a single spool file. The Spam package processes
24228 incoming mail, and sends mail considered to be spam to a designated
24229 ``spam'' group. @xref{Filtering Incoming Mail}.
24230
24231 The second way is suited to back ends such as @code{nntp}, which have
24232 no incoming mail spool, or back ends where the server is in charge of
24233 splitting incoming mail. In this case, when you enter a Gnus group,
24234 the unseen or unread messages in that group are checked for spam.
24235 Detected spam messages are marked as spam. @xref{Detecting Spam in
24236 Groups}.
24237
24238 @cindex spam back ends
24239 In either case, you have to tell the Spam package what method to use
24240 to detect spam messages. There are several methods, or @dfn{spam back
24241 ends} (not to be confused with Gnus back ends!) to choose from: spam
24242 ``blacklists'' and ``whitelists'', dictionary-based filters, and so
24243 forth. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24244
24245 In the Gnus summary buffer, messages that have been identified as spam
24246 always appear with a @samp{$} symbol.
24247
24248 The Spam package divides Gnus groups into three categories: ham
24249 groups, spam groups, and unclassified groups. You should mark each of
24250 the groups you subscribe to as either a ham group or a spam group,
24251 using the @code{spam-contents} group parameter (@pxref{Group
24252 Parameters}). Spam groups have a special property: when you enter a
24253 spam group, all unseen articles are marked as spam. Thus, mail split
24254 into a spam group is automatically marked as spam.
24255
24256 Identifying spam messages is only half of the Spam package's job. The
24257 second half comes into play whenever you exit a group buffer. At this
24258 point, the Spam package does several things:
24259
24260 First, it calls @dfn{spam and ham processors} to process the articles
24261 according to whether they are spam or ham. There is a pair of spam
24262 and ham processors associated with each spam back end, and what the
24263 processors do depends on the back end. At present, the main role of
24264 spam and ham processors is for dictionary-based spam filters: they add
24265 the contents of the messages in the group to the filter's dictionary,
24266 to improve its ability to detect future spam. The @code{spam-process}
24267 group parameter specifies what spam processors to use. @xref{Spam and
24268 Ham Processors}.
24269
24270 If the spam filter failed to mark a spam message, you can mark it
24271 yourself, so that the message is processed as spam when you exit the
24272 group:
24273
24274 @table @kbd
24275 @item $
24276 @itemx M-d
24277 @itemx M s x
24278 @itemx S x
24279 @kindex $ (Summary)
24280 @kindex M-d (Summary)
24281 @kindex S x (Summary)
24282 @kindex M s x (Summary)
24283 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24284 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24285 Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark
24286 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}).
24287 @end table
24288
24289 @noindent
24290 Similarly, you can unmark an article if it has been erroneously marked
24291 as spam. @xref{Setting Marks}.
24292
24293 Normally, a ham message found in a non-ham group is not processed as
24294 ham---the rationale is that it should be moved into a ham group for
24295 further processing (see below). However, you can force these articles
24296 to be processed as ham by setting
24297 @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
24298 @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups}.
24299
24300 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
24301 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
24302 The second thing that the Spam package does when you exit a group is
24303 to move ham articles out of spam groups, and spam articles out of ham
24304 groups. Ham in a spam group is moved to the group specified by the
24305 variable @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}, or the group parameter
24306 @code{ham-process-destination}. Spam in a ham group is moved to the
24307 group specified by the variable @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations},
24308 or the group parameter @code{spam-process-destination}. If these
24309 variables are not set, the articles are left in their current group.
24310 If an article cannot be moved (e.g., with a read-only backend such
24311 as @acronym{NNTP}), it is copied.
24312
24313 If an article is moved to another group, it is processed again when
24314 you visit the new group. Normally, this is not a problem, but if you
24315 want each article to be processed only once, load the
24316 @code{gnus-registry.el} package and set the variable
24317 @code{spam-log-to-registry} to @code{t}. @xref{Spam Package
24318 Configuration Examples}.
24319
24320 Normally, spam groups ignore @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations}.
24321 However, if you set @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only} to
24322 @code{nil}, spam will also be moved out of spam groups, depending on
24323 the @code{spam-process-destination} parameter.
24324
24325 The final thing the Spam package does is to mark spam articles as
24326 expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
24327
24328 If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
24329 as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
24330 50 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
24331
24332 @node Filtering Incoming Mail
24333 @subsection Filtering Incoming Mail
24334 @cindex spam filtering
24335 @cindex spam filtering incoming mail
24336 @cindex spam
24337
24338 To use the Spam package to filter incoming mail, you must first set up
24339 fancy mail splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}. The Spam package
24340 defines a special splitting function that you can add to your fancy
24341 split variable (either @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
24342 @code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on your mail back end):
24343
24344 @example
24345 (: spam-split)
24346 @end example
24347
24348 @vindex spam-split-group
24349 @noindent
24350 The @code{spam-split} function scans incoming mail according to your
24351 chosen spam back end(s), and sends messages identified as spam to a
24352 spam group. By default, the spam group is a group named @samp{spam},
24353 but you can change this by customizing @code{spam-split-group}. Make
24354 sure the contents of @code{spam-split-group} are an unqualified group
24355 name. For instance, in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server},
24356 the value @samp{spam} means @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The value
24357 @samp{nnimap+server:spam} is therefore wrong---it gives the group
24358 @samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam}.
24359
24360 @code{spam-split} does not modify the contents of messages in any way.
24361
24362 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
24363 Note for IMAP users: if you use the @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
24364 @code{spam-check-ifile}, and @code{spam-check-stat} spam back ends,
24365 you should also set the variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to
24366 @code{t}. These spam back ends are most useful when they can ``scan''
24367 the full message body. By default, the nnimap back end only retrieves
24368 the message headers; @code{nnimap-split-download-body} tells it to
24369 retrieve the message bodies as well. We don't set this by default
24370 because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and that is not an
24371 appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user. @xref{Client-Side
24372 IMAP Splitting}.
24373
24374 You have to specify one or more spam back ends for @code{spam-split}
24375 to use, by setting the @code{spam-use-*} variables. @xref{Spam Back
24376 Ends}. Normally, @code{spam-split} simply uses all the spam back ends
24377 you enabled in this way. However, you can tell @code{spam-split} to
24378 use only some of them. Why this is useful? Suppose you are using the
24379 @code{spam-use-regex-headers} and @code{spam-use-blackholes} spam back
24380 ends, and the following split rule:
24381
24382 @example
24383 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
24384 (any "ding" "ding")
24385 (: spam-split)
24386 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24387 "mail")
24388 @end example
24389
24390 @noindent
24391 The problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the ding
24392 folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam detected by
24393 SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through, when it's
24394 sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to the ding
24395 list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the invocation
24396 of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
24397
24398 The solution is to let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, and
24399 perform the other @code{spam-split} rules (including a second
24400 invocation of the regex-headers check) after the ding rule. This is
24401 done by passing a parameter to @code{spam-split}:
24402
24403 @example
24404 nnimap-split-fancy
24405 '(|
24406 ;; @r{spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
24407 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
24408 (any "ding" "ding")
24409 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
24410 (: spam-split)
24411 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24412 "mail")
24413 @end example
24414
24415 @noindent
24416 This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
24417 your particular needs, and target the results of those checks to a
24418 particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
24419 spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
24420 mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
24421 blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
24422 spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
24423
24424 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24425 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24426 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
24427 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24428
24429 @c @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
24430 @c statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
24431 @c don't.}
24432
24433 @node Detecting Spam in Groups
24434 @subsection Detecting Spam in Groups
24435
24436 To detect spam when visiting a group, set the group's
24437 @code{spam-autodetect} and @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group
24438 parameters. These are accessible with @kbd{G c} or @kbd{G p}, as
24439 usual (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
24440
24441 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24442 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24443 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
24444 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set.
24445
24446 By default, only unseen articles are processed for spam. You can
24447 force Gnus to recheck all messages in the group by setting the
24448 variable @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages} to @code{t}.
24449
24450 If you use the @code{spam-autodetect} method of checking for spam, you
24451 can specify different spam detection methods for different groups.
24452 For instance, the @samp{ding} group may have @code{spam-use-BBDB} as
24453 the autodetection method, while the @samp{suspect} group may have the
24454 @code{spam-use-blacklist} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods
24455 enabled. Unlike with @code{spam-split}, you don't have any control
24456 over the @emph{sequence} of checks, but this is probably unimportant.
24457
24458 @node Spam and Ham Processors
24459 @subsection Spam and Ham Processors
24460 @cindex spam filtering
24461 @cindex spam filtering variables
24462 @cindex spam variables
24463 @cindex spam
24464
24465 @vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
24466 Spam and ham processors specify special actions to take when you exit
24467 a group buffer. Spam processors act on spam messages, and ham
24468 processors on ham messages. At present, the main role of these
24469 processors is to update the dictionaries of dictionary-based spam back
24470 ends such as Bogofilter (@pxref{Bogofilter}) and the Spam Statistics
24471 package (@pxref{Spam Statistics Filtering}).
24472
24473 The spam and ham processors that apply to each group are determined by
24474 the group's@code{spam-process} group parameter. If this group
24475 parameter is not defined, they are determined by the variable
24476 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups}.
24477
24478 @vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
24479 Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
24480 one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
24481 @code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
24482 groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
24483 @code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
24484 by customizing the corresponding variable
24485 @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
24486 parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
24487 also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
24488 classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
24489 groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
24490 @code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
24491 considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
24492 default.
24493
24494 @vindex gnus-spam-mark
24495 @cindex $
24496 In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
24497 they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
24498 group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
24499 unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
24500 thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
24501 will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
24502 @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
24503 should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
24504 buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
24505 @samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
24506 @kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
24507 group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
24508 processor which will study them as spam samples.
24509
24510 Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
24511 @code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
24512 and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
24513 @samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
24514 low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
24515 are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
24516 use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
24517 should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
24518
24519 @defvar ham-marks
24520 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
24521 marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
24522 deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
24523 that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
24524 useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
24525 recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
24526 indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
24527 happy for you.
24528 @end defvar
24529
24530 @defvar spam-marks
24531 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
24532 marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
24533 the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
24534 you really want to.
24535 @end defvar
24536
24537 When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
24538 @code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
24539 to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
24540 explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
24541 @samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
24542 spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
24543 and nothing else.
24544
24545 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
24546 When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
24547 marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
24548 not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
24549 @strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
24550 determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
24551 parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
24552 variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
24553 names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
24554 customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
24555 group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
24556 the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
24557 parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
24558 @code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
24559 set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
24560
24561 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
24562 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
24563
24564 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
24565 expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
24566 group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
24567
24568 When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
24569 a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
24570
24571 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
24572 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
24573 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
24574 to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
24575 to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
24576
24577 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
24578 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
24579 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
24580 or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
24581 you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
24582 it there.
24583
24584 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
24585 When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
24586 @strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
24587 the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
24588 @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
24589 regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
24590 customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
24591 gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
24592 Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
24593 @code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
24594 articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
24595 that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
24596 group buffer then you need it here as well.
24597
24598 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
24599 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
24600
24601 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
24602 expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
24603 training} groups.
24604
24605 @vindex spam-log-to-registry
24606 The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
24607 this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
24608 variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
24609 what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
24610 multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
24611 entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
24612
24613 @vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
24614 Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
24615 be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
24616 @code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
24617
24618 @vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
24619 Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
24620 out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
24621 like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
24622 in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
24623 from the mail server.
24624
24625 @vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
24626 When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
24627 only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
24628 spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
24629
24630 @node Spam Package Configuration Examples
24631 @subsection Spam Package Configuration Examples
24632 @cindex spam filtering
24633 @cindex spam filtering configuration examples
24634 @cindex spam configuration examples
24635 @cindex spam
24636
24637 @subsubheading Ted's setup
24638
24639 From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
24640 @example
24641 ;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
24642 ;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
24643 (gnus-registry-initialize)
24644 (spam-initialize)
24645
24646 (setq
24647 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
24648 spam-use-BBDB t
24649 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
24650 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
24651 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
24652 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24653 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
24654 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
24655 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
24656 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
24657 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
24658 ;; @r{for nnimap you'll probably want to set nnimap-split-methods, see the manual}
24659 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
24660 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
24661 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
24662 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
24663 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
24664 (any "ding" "ding")
24665 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
24666 (: spam-split)
24667 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24668 "mail"))
24669
24670 ;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
24671
24672 ;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
24673 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
24674 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
24675 ;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
24676
24677 ((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
24678
24679 ;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
24680 ;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
24681 ((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
24682 ;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
24683 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
24684
24685 ;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
24686 ((spam-autodetect . t))
24687
24688 ;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
24689
24690 ;; @r{this is a spam group}
24691 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
24692
24693 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
24694 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
24695 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
24696
24697 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
24698
24699 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
24700 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
24701
24702 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
24703 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
24704 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
24705 (ham-marks
24706 (gnus-ticked-mark))
24707 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
24708 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
24709 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
24710
24711 ;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
24712 ;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
24713 ;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
24714
24715 @end example
24716
24717 @subsubheading Using @code{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
24718 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24719
24720 My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
24721 the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
24722 @samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
24723 i.e., to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
24724 positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
24725 @samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
24726 the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
24727 options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
24728 @samp{training.spam} folders.
24729
24730 With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
24731 does most of the job for me:
24732
24733 @lisp
24734 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
24735 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
24736 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
24737 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24738 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
24739 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
24740 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
24741 @end lisp
24742
24743 @itemize
24744
24745 @item @b{The Spam folder:}
24746
24747 In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
24748 (i.e., legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
24749 bogofilter or DCC).
24750
24751 Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
24752 messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
24753 positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark
24754 (@code{ham-marks}, @ref{Spam and Ham Processors}). On group exit,
24755 those messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want
24756 to have the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter)
24757 and deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
24758
24759 The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
24760 false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
24761 have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e., chars) makes finding
24762 other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
24763 (@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
24764 an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
24765
24766 @item @b{Ham folders:}
24767
24768 In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
24769 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
24770 mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
24771 @samp{training.spam}.
24772 @end itemize
24773
24774 @subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
24775
24776 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24777
24778 With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
24779 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
24780 groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
24781
24782 @lisp
24783 ("^gmane\\."
24784 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
24785 @end lisp
24786
24787 Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
24788 because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
24789 through my local news server (leafnode). I.e., the article numbers are
24790 not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
24791 the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
24792
24793 @node Spam Back Ends
24794 @subsection Spam Back Ends
24795 @cindex spam back ends
24796
24797 The spam package offers a variety of back ends for detecting spam.
24798 Each back end defines a set of methods for detecting spam
24799 (@pxref{Filtering Incoming Mail}, @pxref{Detecting Spam in Groups}),
24800 and a pair of spam and ham processors (@pxref{Spam and Ham
24801 Processors}).
24802
24803 @menu
24804 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
24805 * BBDB Whitelists::
24806 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
24807 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
24808 * Blackholes::
24809 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
24810 * Bogofilter::
24811 * SpamAssassin back end::
24812 * ifile spam filtering::
24813 * Spam Statistics Filtering::
24814 * SpamOracle::
24815 @end menu
24816
24817 @node Blacklists and Whitelists
24818 @subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
24819 @cindex spam filtering
24820 @cindex whitelists, spam filtering
24821 @cindex blacklists, spam filtering
24822 @cindex spam
24823
24824 @defvar spam-use-blacklist
24825
24826 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
24827 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
24828 will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
24829 filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
24830 be spammers.
24831
24832 @end defvar
24833
24834 @defvar spam-use-whitelist
24835
24836 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
24837 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
24838 whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24839 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
24840 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24841
24842 @end defvar
24843
24844 @defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
24845
24846 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
24847 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24848 unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
24849
24850 @end defvar
24851
24852 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
24853
24854 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24855 customizing the group parameters or the
24856 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24857 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24858 spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
24859
24860 @emph{WARNING}
24861
24862 Instead of the obsolete
24863 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
24864 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
24865 the same way, we promise.
24866
24867 @end defvar
24868
24869 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
24870
24871 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24872 customizing the group parameters or the
24873 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24874 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24875 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24876 whitelist.
24877
24878 @emph{WARNING}
24879
24880 Instead of the obsolete
24881 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
24882 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
24883 the same way, we promise.
24884
24885 @end defvar
24886
24887 Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
24888 consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
24889 sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
24890 blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
24891 use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
24892
24893 Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
24894 legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
24895 non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
24896 Emacs regular expression syntax.
24897
24898 The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
24899 @code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
24900 the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
24901 directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
24902 @code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
24903 @file{blacklist} respectively.
24904
24905 @node BBDB Whitelists
24906 @subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
24907 @cindex spam filtering
24908 @cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
24909 @cindex BBDB, spam filtering
24910 @cindex spam
24911
24912 @defvar spam-use-BBDB
24913
24914 Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24915 Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
24916 addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
24917 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
24918 not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24919 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
24920 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24921
24922 @end defvar
24923
24924 @defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
24925
24926 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
24927 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24928 unless the sender is in the BBDB@. Use with care. Only sender
24929 addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
24930 classified as spammers.
24931
24932 While @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} @emph{can} be used as an alias
24933 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} as far as @code{spam.el} is concerned, it is
24934 @emph{not} a separate back end. If you set
24935 @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} to @code{t}, @emph{all} your BBDB splitting
24936 will be exclusive.
24937
24938 @end defvar
24939
24940 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
24941
24942 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24943 customizing the group parameters or the
24944 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24945 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24946 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24947 BBDB.
24948
24949 @emph{WARNING}
24950
24951 Instead of the obsolete
24952 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
24953 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
24954 the same way, we promise.
24955
24956 @end defvar
24957
24958 @node Gmane Spam Reporting
24959 @subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
24960 @cindex spam reporting
24961 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24962 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24963 @cindex spam
24964
24965 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
24966
24967 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24968 customizing the group parameters or the
24969 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24970 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
24971 articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
24972 HTTP request.
24973
24974 Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
24975
24976 @emph{WARNING}
24977
24978 Instead of the obsolete
24979 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
24980 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
24981 same way, we promise.
24982
24983 @end defvar
24984
24985 @defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
24986
24987 This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
24988 running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
24989 numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
24990 @code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
24991 @code{spam-report.el} will fetch the number from the article headers.
24992
24993 @end defvar
24994
24995 @defvar spam-report-user-mail-address
24996
24997 Mail address exposed in the User-Agent spam reports to Gmane. It allows
24998 the Gmane administrators to contact you in case of misreports. The
24999 default is @code{user-mail-address}.
25000
25001 @end defvar
25002
25003 @node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
25004 @subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
25005 @cindex spam filtering
25006 @cindex hashcash, spam filtering
25007 @cindex spam
25008
25009 @defvar spam-use-hashcash
25010
25011 Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
25012 Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
25013 instead of the sender address. Messages without a hashcash payment
25014 token will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an explicit
25015 filter, meaning that unless a hashcash token is found, the messages
25016 are not assumed to be spam or ham.
25017
25018 @end defvar
25019
25020 @node Blackholes
25021 @subsubsection Blackholes
25022 @cindex spam filtering
25023 @cindex blackholes, spam filtering
25024 @cindex spam
25025
25026 @defvar spam-use-blackholes
25027
25028 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
25029 blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
25030 when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
25031 holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
25032 list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
25033 contains outdated servers.
25034
25035 The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
25036 @code{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
25037 you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
25038 this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
25039 possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
25040 use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
25041
25042 @end defvar
25043
25044 @defvar spam-blackhole-servers
25045
25046 The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
25047
25048 @end defvar
25049
25050 @defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
25051
25052 A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
25053 blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
25054
25055 @end defvar
25056
25057 @defvar spam-use-dig
25058
25059 Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
25060 The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
25061
25062 @end defvar
25063
25064 Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
25065 ham processor for blackholes.
25066
25067 @node Regular Expressions Header Matching
25068 @subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
25069 @cindex spam filtering
25070 @cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
25071 @cindex spam
25072
25073 @defvar spam-use-regex-headers
25074
25075 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
25076 message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
25077 option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
25078 @code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
25079 Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
25080 message is spam or ham, respectively.
25081
25082 @end defvar
25083
25084 @defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
25085
25086 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
25087 the message, positively identify it as spam.
25088
25089 @end defvar
25090
25091 @defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
25092
25093 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
25094 the message, positively identify it as ham.
25095
25096 @end defvar
25097
25098 Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
25099 There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
25100
25101 @node Bogofilter
25102 @subsubsection Bogofilter
25103 @cindex spam filtering
25104 @cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
25105 @cindex spam
25106
25107 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter
25108
25109 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
25110 speedy Bogofilter.
25111
25112 With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
25113 articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
25114 should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
25115 category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
25116 for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
25117 the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
25118
25119 Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
25120 threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
25121 documentation.
25122
25123 If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
25124 processing will be turned off.
25125
25126 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
25127
25128 @end defvar
25129
25130 @table @kbd
25131 @item M s t
25132 @itemx S t
25133 @kindex M s t
25134 @kindex S t
25135 @findex spam-bogofilter-score
25136 Get the Bogofilter spamicity score (@code{spam-bogofilter-score}).
25137 @end table
25138
25139 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
25140
25141 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
25142 speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
25143 similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
25144 must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
25145 procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
25146 installation documents for details.
25147
25148 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
25149
25150 @end defvar
25151
25152 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
25153 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25154 customizing the group parameters or the
25155 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25156 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
25157 will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
25158
25159 @emph{WARNING}
25160
25161 Instead of the obsolete
25162 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
25163 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
25164 the same way, we promise.
25165 @end defvar
25166
25167 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
25168 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25169 customizing the group parameters or the
25170 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25171 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25172 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
25173 of non-spam messages.
25174
25175 @emph{WARNING}
25176
25177 Instead of the obsolete
25178 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
25179 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
25180 the same way, we promise.
25181 @end defvar
25182
25183 @defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
25184
25185 This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
25186 is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
25187 database directory.
25188
25189 @end defvar
25190
25191 The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
25192 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25193 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
25194 variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
25195 used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
25196 Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
25197
25198 @node SpamAssassin back end
25199 @subsubsection SpamAssassin back end
25200 @cindex spam filtering
25201 @cindex spamassassin, spam filtering
25202 @cindex spam
25203
25204 @defvar spam-use-spamassassin
25205
25206 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use SpamAssassin.
25207
25208 SpamAssassin assigns a score to each article based on a set of rules
25209 and tests, including a Bayesian filter. The Bayesian filter can be
25210 trained by associating the @samp{$} mark for spam articles. The
25211 spam score can be viewed by using the command @kbd{S t} in summary
25212 mode.
25213
25214 If you set this variable, each article will be processed by
25215 SpamAssassin when @code{spam-split} is called. If your mail is
25216 preprocessed by SpamAssassin, and you want to just use the
25217 SpamAssassin headers, set @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}
25218 instead.
25219
25220 You should not enable this if you use
25221 @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}.
25222
25223 @end defvar
25224
25225 @defvar spam-use-spamassassin-headers
25226
25227 Set this variable if your mail is preprocessed by SpamAssassin and
25228 want @code{spam-split} to split based on the SpamAssassin headers.
25229
25230 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-spamassassin}.
25231
25232 @end defvar
25233
25234 @defvar spam-spamassassin-program
25235
25236 This variable points to the SpamAssassin executable. If you have
25237 @code{spamd} running, you can set this variable to the @code{spamc}
25238 executable for faster processing. See the SpamAssassin documentation
25239 for more information on @code{spamd}/@code{spamc}.
25240
25241 @end defvar
25242
25243 SpamAssassin is a powerful and flexible spam filter that uses a wide
25244 variety of tests to identify spam. A ham and a spam processors are
25245 provided, plus the @code{spam-use-spamassassin} and
25246 @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers} variables to indicate to
25247 spam-split that SpamAssassin should be either used, or has already
25248 been used on the article. The 2.63 version of SpamAssassin was used
25249 to test this functionality.
25250
25251 @node ifile spam filtering
25252 @subsubsection ifile spam filtering
25253 @cindex spam filtering
25254 @cindex ifile, spam filtering
25255 @cindex spam
25256
25257 @defvar spam-use-ifile
25258
25259 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
25260 statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
25261
25262 @end defvar
25263
25264 @defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
25265
25266 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
25267 the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
25268 sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
25269
25270 @end defvar
25271
25272 @defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
25273
25274 This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
25275 The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
25276 the default value of @samp{spam}.
25277 @end defvar
25278
25279 @defvar spam-ifile-database
25280
25281 This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
25282 default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
25283
25284 @end defvar
25285
25286 The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
25287 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25288 @code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
25289 should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
25290 functionality.
25291
25292 @node Spam Statistics Filtering
25293 @subsubsection Spam Statistics Filtering
25294 @cindex spam filtering
25295 @cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
25296 @cindex spam-stat
25297 @cindex spam
25298
25299 This back end uses the Spam Statistics Emacs Lisp package to perform
25300 statistics-based filtering (@pxref{Spam Statistics Package}). Before
25301 using this, you may want to perform some additional steps to
25302 initialize your Spam Statistics dictionary. @xref{Creating a
25303 spam-stat dictionary}.
25304
25305 @defvar spam-use-stat
25306
25307 @end defvar
25308
25309 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
25310 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25311 customizing the group parameters or the
25312 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25313 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
25314 articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
25315
25316 @emph{WARNING}
25317
25318 Instead of the obsolete
25319 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
25320 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
25321 the same way, we promise.
25322 @end defvar
25323
25324 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
25325 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25326 customizing the group parameters or the
25327 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25328 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25329 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
25330 of non-spam messages.
25331
25332 @emph{WARNING}
25333
25334 Instead of the obsolete
25335 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
25336 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
25337 the same way, we promise.
25338 @end defvar
25339
25340 This enables @code{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
25341 @file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
25342 which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
25343 A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
25344 @code{spam-split} are provided.
25345
25346 @node SpamOracle
25347 @subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
25348 @cindex spam filtering
25349 @cindex SpamOracle
25350 @cindex spam
25351
25352 An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
25353 statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
25354 installed separately.
25355
25356 There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
25357 mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
25358 then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
25359 mail as a spam mail or not.
25360
25361 One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
25362 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
25363 the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
25364
25365 The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Spam Package})
25366 call SpamOracle.
25367
25368 @vindex spam-use-spamoracle
25369 To enable SpamOracle usage by @code{spam.el}, set the variable
25370 @code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
25371 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}. @xref{Spam
25372 Package}. In this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is
25373 filtered using SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be
25374 moved to @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham
25375 messages stay in @samp{INBOX}:
25376
25377 @example
25378 (setq spam-use-spamoracle t
25379 spam-split-group "Junk"
25380 ;; @r{for nnimap you'll probably want to set nnimap-split-methods, see the manual}
25381 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
25382 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
25383 @end example
25384
25385 @defvar spam-use-spamoracle
25386 Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
25387 SpamOracle.
25388 @end defvar
25389
25390 @defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
25391 Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
25392 user's PATH@. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
25393 can be customized.
25394 @end defvar
25395
25396 @defvar spam-spamoracle-database
25397 By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
25398 store its analysis. This is controlled by the variable
25399 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
25400 the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
25401 database to live somewhere special, set
25402 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
25403 @end defvar
25404
25405 SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
25406 message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
25407 false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns
25408 the characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
25409 (training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
25410 SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary
25411 buffer and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using
25412 @file{spam.el}'s spam- and ham-processors, which is much more
25413 convenient. For a detailed description of spam- and ham-processors,
25414 @xref{Spam Package}.
25415
25416 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
25417 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25418 customizing the group parameter or the
25419 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25420 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
25421 sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
25422
25423 @emph{WARNING}
25424
25425 Instead of the obsolete
25426 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
25427 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
25428 the same way, we promise.
25429 @end defvar
25430
25431 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
25432 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25433 customizing the group parameter or the
25434 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25435 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
25436 @emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
25437 messages.
25438
25439 @emph{WARNING}
25440
25441 Instead of the obsolete
25442 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
25443 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
25444 the same way, we promise.
25445 @end defvar
25446
25447 @emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
25448 classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
25449 messages.
25450 @example
25451 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
25452 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
25453 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
25454 @end example
25455 For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
25456 ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
25457 (e.g., because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
25458 the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
25459 processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
25460 SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
25461
25462 @node Extending the Spam package
25463 @subsection Extending the Spam package
25464 @cindex spam filtering
25465 @cindex spam elisp package, extending
25466 @cindex extending the spam elisp package
25467
25468 Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
25469 incoming mail, provide the following:
25470
25471 @enumerate
25472
25473 @item
25474 Code
25475
25476 @lisp
25477 (defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
25478 "True if blackbox should be used.")
25479 @end lisp
25480
25481 Write @code{spam-check-blackbox} if Blackbox can check incoming mail.
25482
25483 Write @code{spam-blackbox-register-routine} and
25484 @code{spam-blackbox-unregister-routine} using the bogofilter
25485 register/unregister routines as a start, or other register/unregister
25486 routines more appropriate to Blackbox, if Blackbox can
25487 register/unregister spam and ham.
25488
25489 @item
25490 Functionality
25491
25492 The @code{spam-check-blackbox} function should return @samp{nil} or
25493 @code{spam-split-group}, observing the other conventions. See the
25494 existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for examples of what you can
25495 do, and stick to the template unless you fully understand the reasons
25496 why you aren't.
25497
25498 @end enumerate
25499
25500 For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
25501
25502 @enumerate
25503
25504 @item
25505 Code
25506
25507 Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
25508 provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
25509
25510 Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
25511 variables. Instead the form @code{(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
25512 @code{(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
25513 processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
25514
25515 @lisp
25516 (defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
25517 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
25518 Only applicable to spam groups.")
25519
25520 (defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
25521 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
25522 Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
25523
25524 @end lisp
25525
25526 @item
25527 Gnus parameters
25528
25529 Add
25530 @lisp
25531 (const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
25532 (const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
25533 @end lisp
25534 to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
25535 sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
25536 variable customization.
25537
25538 Add
25539 @lisp
25540 (variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
25541 @end lisp
25542 to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
25543 @code{gnus.el} if Blackbox can check incoming mail for spam contents.
25544
25545 Finally, use the appropriate @code{spam-install-*-backend} function in
25546 @code{spam.el}. Here are the available functions.
25547
25548
25549 @enumerate
25550
25551 @item
25552 @code{spam-install-backend-alias}
25553
25554 This function will simply install an alias for a back end that does
25555 everything like the original back end. It is currently only used to
25556 make @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} act like @code{spam-use-BBDB}.
25557
25558 @item
25559 @code{spam-install-nocheck-backend}
25560
25561 This function installs a back end that has no check function, but can
25562 register/unregister ham or spam. The @code{spam-use-gmane} back end is
25563 such a back end.
25564
25565 @item
25566 @code{spam-install-checkonly-backend}
25567
25568 This function will install a back end that can only check incoming mail
25569 for spam contents. It can't register or unregister messages.
25570 @code{spam-use-blackholes} and @code{spam-use-hashcash} are such
25571 back ends.
25572
25573 @item
25574 @code{spam-install-statistical-checkonly-backend}
25575
25576 This function installs a statistical back end (one which requires the
25577 full body of a message to check it) that can only check incoming mail
25578 for contents. @code{spam-use-regex-body} is such a filter.
25579
25580 @item
25581 @code{spam-install-statistical-backend}
25582
25583 This function install a statistical back end with incoming checks and
25584 registration/unregistration routines. @code{spam-use-bogofilter} is
25585 set up this way.
25586
25587 @item
25588 @code{spam-install-backend}
25589
25590 This is the most normal back end installation, where a back end that can
25591 check and register/unregister messages is set up without statistical
25592 abilities. The @code{spam-use-BBDB} is such a back end.
25593
25594 @item
25595 @code{spam-install-mover-backend}
25596
25597 Mover back ends are internal to @code{spam.el} and specifically move
25598 articles around when the summary is exited. You will very probably
25599 never install such a back end.
25600 @end enumerate
25601
25602 @end enumerate
25603
25604 @node Spam Statistics Package
25605 @subsection Spam Statistics Package
25606 @cindex Paul Graham
25607 @cindex Graham, Paul
25608 @cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
25609 @cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
25610 @cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
25611
25612 Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
25613 statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
25614 Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
25615 filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
25616 the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
25617 always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
25618 on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
25619 this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
25620 that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
25621 or not.
25622
25623 The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
25624 with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
25625 either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
25626 collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
25627 word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
25628 non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
25629 probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
25630 than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
25631
25632 The Spam Statistics package adds support to Gnus for this kind of
25633 filtering. It can be used as one of the back ends of the Spam package
25634 (@pxref{Spam Package}), or by itself.
25635
25636 Before using the Spam Statistics package, you need to set it up.
25637 First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
25638 non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
25639 collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
25640 this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
25641
25642 @menu
25643 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
25644 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
25645 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
25646 @end menu
25647
25648 @node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
25649 @subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
25650
25651 Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
25652 create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
25653 one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
25654 for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
25655 need several hundred emails in both collections.
25656
25657 Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
25658 creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
25659 per mail. Use the following:
25660
25661 @defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
25662 Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
25663 is treated as one spam mail.
25664 @end defun
25665
25666 @defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
25667 Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
25668 file is treated as one non-spam mail.
25669 @end defun
25670
25671 Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
25672 directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds to
25673 the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
25674 @code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
25675 @file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds to the group
25676 @samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
25677
25678 When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
25679 locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
25680 to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
25681 @file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
25682 @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
25683
25684 @defvar spam-stat
25685 This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
25686 dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
25687 collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
25688 word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
25689 @end defvar
25690
25691 If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
25692 reset the dictionary.
25693
25694 @defun spam-stat-reset
25695 Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
25696 @end defun
25697
25698 When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
25699 be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
25700 (instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
25701 can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
25702 not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
25703 only non-spam mails.
25704
25705 @defun spam-stat-reduce-size
25706 Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
25707 to update the dictionary incrementally.
25708 @end defun
25709
25710 @defun spam-stat-save
25711 Save the dictionary.
25712 @end defun
25713
25714 @defvar spam-stat-file
25715 The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
25716 @file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
25717 @end defvar
25718
25719 @node Splitting mail using spam-stat
25720 @subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
25721
25722 This section describes how to use the Spam statistics
25723 @emph{independently} of the @xref{Spam Package}.
25724
25725 First, add the following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25726
25727 @lisp
25728 (require 'spam-stat)
25729 (spam-stat-load)
25730 @end lisp
25731
25732 This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
25733 created.
25734
25735 Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
25736 determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
25737 the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
25738 use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
25739
25740 In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
25741 @samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
25742 spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
25743 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
25744
25745 @lisp
25746 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25747 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25748 "mail.misc"))
25749 @end lisp
25750
25751 @defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
25752 The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
25753 @end defvar
25754
25755 If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
25756 the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
25757 expression are considered potential spam.
25758
25759 @lisp
25760 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25761 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25762 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25763 "mail.misc"))
25764 @end lisp
25765
25766 If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
25767 creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
25768 consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
25769 non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
25770 mails, when creating the dictionary!
25771
25772 @lisp
25773 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25774 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25775 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25776 "mail.misc"))
25777 @end lisp
25778
25779 You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
25780 HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
25781 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
25782 @samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
25783 nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
25784 dictionary!
25785
25786 @lisp
25787 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25788 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
25789 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25790 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25791 "mail.misc"))
25792 @end lisp
25793
25794
25795 @node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25796 @subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25797
25798 The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
25799
25800 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
25801 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
25802 Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25803 @end defun
25804
25805 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
25806 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
25807 mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25808 @end defun
25809
25810 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
25811 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
25812 mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
25813 already been processed as non-spam.
25814 @end defun
25815
25816 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
25817 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
25818 normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
25819 been processed as spam.
25820 @end defun
25821
25822 @defun spam-stat-save
25823 Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
25824 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25825 @end defun
25826
25827 @defun spam-stat-load
25828 Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
25829 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25830 @end defun
25831
25832 @defun spam-stat-score-word
25833 Return the spam score for a word.
25834 @end defun
25835
25836 @defun spam-stat-score-buffer
25837 Return the spam score for a buffer.
25838 @end defun
25839
25840 @defun spam-stat-split-fancy
25841 Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
25842 spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
25843 @end defun
25844
25845 Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
25846 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25847
25848 @lisp
25849 (require 'spam-stat)
25850 (spam-stat-load)
25851 @end lisp
25852
25853 Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
25854
25855 @smallexample
25856 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25857 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25858 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25859 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25860 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25861 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25862 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25863 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25864 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25865 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25866 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25867 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25868 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25869 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25870 @end smallexample
25871
25872 Here is how you would create your dictionary:
25873
25874 @smallexample
25875 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25876 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25877 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25878 Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
25879 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25880 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25881 @end smallexample
25882
25883 @node The Gnus Registry
25884 @section The Gnus Registry
25885 @cindex registry
25886 @cindex split
25887 @cindex track
25888
25889 The Gnus registry is a package that tracks messages by their
25890 Message-ID across all backends. This allows Gnus users to do several
25891 cool things, be the envy of the locals, get free haircuts, and be
25892 experts on world issues. Well, maybe not all of those, but the
25893 features are pretty cool.
25894
25895 Although they will be explained in detail shortly, here's a quick list
25896 of said features in case your attention span is... never mind.
25897
25898 @enumerate
25899 @item
25900 Split messages to their parent
25901
25902 This keeps discussions in the same group. You can use the subject and
25903 the sender in addition to the Message-ID@. Several strategies are
25904 available.
25905
25906 @item
25907 Refer to messages by ID
25908
25909 Commands like @code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article} can take
25910 advantage of the registry to jump to the referred article, regardless
25911 of the group the message is in.
25912
25913 @item
25914 Store custom flags and keywords
25915
25916 The registry can store custom flags and keywords for a message. For
25917 instance, you can mark a message ``To-Do'' this way and the flag will
25918 persist whether the message is in the nnimap, nnml, nnmaildir,
25919 etc.@: backends.
25920
25921 @item
25922 Store arbitrary data
25923
25924 Through a simple ELisp API, the registry can remember any data for a
25925 message. A built-in inverse map, when activated, allows quick lookups
25926 of all messages matching a particular set of criteria.
25927 @end enumerate
25928
25929 @menu
25930 * Gnus Registry Setup::
25931 * Registry Article Refer Method::
25932 * Fancy splitting to parent::
25933 * Store custom flags and keywords::
25934 * Store arbitrary data::
25935 @end menu
25936
25937 @node Gnus Registry Setup
25938 @subsection Gnus Registry Setup
25939
25940 Fortunately, setting up the Gnus registry is pretty easy:
25941
25942 @lisp
25943 (setq gnus-registry-max-entries 2500)
25944
25945 (gnus-registry-initialize)
25946 @end lisp
25947
25948 This adds registry saves to Gnus newsrc saves (which happen on exit
25949 and when you press @kbd{s} from the @file{*Group*} buffer. It also
25950 adds registry calls to article actions in Gnus (copy, move, etc.)@: so
25951 it's not easy to undo the initialization. See
25952 @code{gnus-registry-initialize} for the gory details.
25953
25954 Here are other settings used by the author of the registry (understand
25955 what they do before you copy them blindly).
25956
25957 @lisp
25958 (setq
25959 gnus-registry-split-strategy 'majority
25960 gnus-registry-ignored-groups '(("nntp" t)
25961 ("nnrss" t)
25962 ("spam" t)
25963 ("train" t))
25964 gnus-registry-max-entries 500000
25965 ;; this is the default
25966 gnus-registry-track-extra '(sender subject))
25967 @end lisp
25968
25969 They say: keep a lot of messages around, track messages by sender and
25970 subject (not just parent Message-ID), and when the registry splits
25971 incoming mail, use a majority rule to decide where messages should go
25972 if there's more than one possibility. In addition, the registry
25973 should ignore messages in groups that match ``nntp'', ``nnrss'',
25974 ``spam'', or ``train.''
25975
25976 You are doubtless impressed by all this, but you ask: ``I am a Gnus
25977 user, I customize to live. Give me more.'' Here you go, these are
25978 the general settings.
25979
25980 @defvar gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups
25981 The groups that will not be followed by
25982 @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}. They will still be
25983 remembered by the registry. This is a list of regular expressions.
25984 By default any group name that ends with ``delayed'', ``drafts'',
25985 ``queue'', or ``INBOX'', belongs to the nnmairix backend, or contains
25986 the word ``archive'' is not followed.
25987 @end defvar
25988
25989 @defvar gnus-registry-max-entries
25990 The number (an integer or @code{nil} for unlimited) of entries the
25991 registry will keep. If the registry has reached or exceeded this
25992 size, it will reject insertion of new entries.
25993 @end defvar
25994
25995 @defvar gnus-registry-prune-factor
25996 This option (a float between 0 and 1) controls how much the registry
25997 is cut back during pruning. In order to prevent constant pruning, the
25998 registry will be pruned back to less than
25999 @code{gnus-registry-max-entries}. This option controls exactly how
26000 much less: the target is calculated as the maximum number of entries
26001 minus the maximum number times this factor. The default is 0.1:
26002 i.e., if your registry is limited to 50000 entries, pruning will try to
26003 cut back to 45000 entries. Entries with keys marked as precious will
26004 not be pruned.
26005 @end defvar
26006
26007 @defvar gnus-registry-default-sort-function
26008 This option specifies how registry entries are sorted during pruning.
26009 If a function is given, it should sort least valuable entries first,
26010 as pruning starts from the beginning of the list. The default value
26011 is @code{gnus-registry-sort-by-creation-time}, which proposes the
26012 oldest entries for pruning. Set to nil to perform no sorting, which
26013 will speed up the pruning process.
26014 @end defvar
26015
26016 @defvar gnus-registry-cache-file
26017 The file where the registry will be stored between Gnus sessions. By
26018 default the file name is @code{.gnus.registry.eieio} in the same
26019 directory as your @code{.newsrc.eld}.
26020 @end defvar
26021
26022 @node Registry Article Refer Method
26023 @subsection Fetching by @code{Message-ID} Using the Registry
26024
26025 The registry knows how to map each @code{Message-ID} to the group it's
26026 in. This can be leveraged to enhance the ``article refer method'',
26027 the thing that tells Gnus how to look up an article given its
26028 Message-ID (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
26029
26030 @vindex nnregistry
26031 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
26032
26033 The @code{nnregistry} refer method does exactly that. It has the
26034 advantage that an article may be found regardless of the group it's
26035 in---provided its @code{Message-ID} is known to the registry. It can
26036 be enabled by augmenting the start-up file with something along these
26037 lines:
26038
26039 @example
26040 ;; Keep enough entries to have a good hit rate when referring to an
26041 ;; article using the registry. Use long group names so that Gnus
26042 ;; knows where the article is.
26043 (setq gnus-registry-max-entries 2500)
26044
26045 (gnus-registry-initialize)
26046
26047 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
26048 '(current
26049 (nnregistry)
26050 (nnweb "gmane" (nnweb-type gmane))))
26051 @end example
26052
26053 The example above instructs Gnus to first look up the article in the
26054 current group, or, alternatively, using the registry, and finally, if
26055 all else fails, using Gmane.
26056
26057 @node Fancy splitting to parent
26058 @subsection Fancy splitting to parent
26059
26060 Simply put, this lets you put followup e-mail where it belongs.
26061
26062 Every message has a Message-ID, which is unique, and the registry
26063 remembers it. When the message is moved or copied, the registry will
26064 notice this and offer the new group as a choice to the splitting
26065 strategy.
26066
26067 When a followup is made, usually it mentions the original message's
26068 Message-ID in the headers. The registry knows this and uses that
26069 mention to find the group where the original message lives. You only
26070 have to put a rule like this:
26071
26072 @lisp
26073 (setq nnimap-my-split-fancy '(|
26074
26075 ;; split to parent: you need this
26076 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
26077
26078 ;; other rules, as an example
26079 (: spam-split)
26080 ;; default mailbox
26081 "mail")
26082 @end lisp
26083
26084 in your fancy split setup. In addition, you may want to customize the
26085 following variables.
26086
26087 @defvar gnus-registry-track-extra
26088 This is a list of symbols, so it's best to change it from the
26089 Customize interface. By default it's @code{(subject sender recipient)},
26090 which may work for you. It can be annoying if your mail flow is large
26091 and people don't stick to the same groups.
26092
26093 When you decide to stop tracking any of those extra data, you can use
26094 the command @code{gnus-registry-remove-extra-data} to purge it from
26095 the existing registry entries.
26096 @end defvar
26097
26098 @defvar gnus-registry-split-strategy
26099 This is a symbol, so it's best to change it from the Customize
26100 interface. By default it's @code{nil}, but you may want to set it to
26101 @code{majority} or @code{first} to split by sender or subject based on
26102 the majority of matches or on the first found. I find @code{majority}
26103 works best.
26104 @end defvar
26105
26106 @node Store custom flags and keywords
26107 @subsection Store custom flags and keywords
26108
26109 The registry lets you set custom flags and keywords per message. You
26110 can use the Gnus->Registry Marks menu or the @kbd{M M x} keyboard
26111 shortcuts, where @code{x} is the first letter of the mark's name.
26112
26113 @defvar gnus-registry-marks
26114 The custom marks that the registry can use. You can modify the
26115 default list, if you like. If you do, you'll have to exit Emacs
26116 before they take effect (you can also unload the registry and reload
26117 it or evaluate the specific macros you'll need, but you probably don't
26118 want to bother). Use the Customize interface to modify the list.
26119
26120 By default this list has the @code{Important}, @code{Work},
26121 @code{Personal}, @code{To-Do}, and @code{Later} marks. They all have
26122 keyboard shortcuts like @kbd{M M i} for Important, using the first
26123 letter.
26124 @end defvar
26125
26126 @defun gnus-registry-mark-article
26127 Call this function to mark an article with a custom registry mark. It
26128 will offer the available marks for completion.
26129 @end defun
26130
26131 You can use @code{defalias} to install a summary line formatting
26132 function that will show the registry marks. There are two flavors of
26133 this function, either showing the marks as single characters, using
26134 their @code{:char} property, or showing the marks as full strings.
26135
26136 @lisp
26137 ;; show the marks as single characters (see the :char property in
26138 ;; 'gnus-registry-marks'):
26139 ;; (defalias 'gnus-user-format-function-M 'gnus-registry-article-marks-to-chars)
26140
26141 ;; show the marks by name (see 'gnus-registry-marks'):
26142 ;; (defalias 'gnus-user-format-function-M 'gnus-registry-article-marks-to-names)
26143 @end lisp
26144
26145
26146 @node Store arbitrary data
26147 @subsection Store arbitrary data
26148
26149 The registry has a simple API that uses a Message-ID as the key to
26150 store arbitrary data (as long as it can be converted to a list for
26151 storage).
26152
26153 @defun gnus-registry-set-id-key (id key value)
26154 Store @code{value} under @code{key} for message @code{id}.
26155 @end defun
26156
26157 @defun gnus-registry-get-id-key (id key)
26158 Get the data under @code{key} for message @code{id}.
26159 @end defun
26160
26161 @defvar gnus-registry-extra-entries-precious
26162 If any extra entries are precious, their presence will make the
26163 registry keep the whole entry forever, even if there are no groups for
26164 the Message-ID and if the size limit of the registry is reached. By
26165 default this is just @code{(marks)} so the custom registry marks are
26166 precious.
26167 @end defvar
26168
26169 @node Other modes
26170 @section Interaction with other modes
26171
26172 @subsection Dired
26173 @cindex dired
26174
26175 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provides some useful functions for dired
26176 buffers. It is enabled with
26177 @lisp
26178 (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
26179 @end lisp
26180
26181 @table @kbd
26182 @item C-c C-m C-a
26183 @findex gnus-dired-attach
26184 @cindex attachments, selection via dired
26185 Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
26186 You will be prompted for a message buffer.
26187
26188 @item C-c C-m C-l
26189 @findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
26190 Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
26191 (@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
26192 buffer.
26193
26194 @item C-c C-m C-p
26195 @findex gnus-dired-print
26196 Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
26197 there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
26198 @end table
26199
26200 @node Various Various
26201 @section Various Various
26202 @cindex mode lines
26203 @cindex highlights
26204
26205 @table @code
26206
26207 @item gnus-home-directory
26208 @vindex gnus-home-directory
26209 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
26210 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
26211
26212 @item gnus-directory
26213 @vindex gnus-directory
26214 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
26215 this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
26216 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
26217
26218 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
26219 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
26220 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
26221 @file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
26222
26223 @item gnus-default-directory
26224 @vindex gnus-default-directory
26225 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
26226 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
26227 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
26228 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
26229 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
26230 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
26231
26232 @item gnus-verbose
26233 @vindex gnus-verbose
26234 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
26235 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
26236 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
26237 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
26238 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
26239
26240 @item gnus-verbose-backends
26241 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
26242 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
26243 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
26244
26245 @item gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26246 @vindex gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26247 This variable controls whether to add timestamps to messages that are
26248 controlled by @code{gnus-verbose} and @code{gnus-verbose-backends} and
26249 are issued. The default value is @code{nil} which means never to add
26250 timestamp. If it is @code{log}, add timestamps to only the messages
26251 that go into the @file{*Messages*} buffer (in XEmacs, it is the
26252 @w{@file{ *Message-Log*}} buffer). If it is neither @code{nil} nor
26253 @code{log}, add timestamps not only to log messages but also to the ones
26254 displayed in the echo area.
26255
26256 @item nnheader-max-head-length
26257 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
26258 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
26259 as little as possible. This variable (default 8192) specifies
26260 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
26261 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
26262 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
26263 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
26264 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
26265 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
26266
26267 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
26268 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
26269 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
26270 read when doing the operation described above.
26271
26272 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26273 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26274 @cindex file names
26275 @cindex invalid characters in file names
26276 @cindex characters in file names
26277 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
26278 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
26279 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
26280
26281 @lisp
26282 @group
26283 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26284 '((?: . ?_)))
26285 @end group
26286 @end lisp
26287
26288 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
26289 Windows (phooey) systems.
26290
26291 @item gnus-hidden-properties
26292 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
26293 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
26294 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
26295 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
26296
26297 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
26298 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
26299 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
26300 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
26301 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
26302
26303 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
26304 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
26305 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
26306
26307 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26308 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26309
26310 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
26311 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
26312 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
26313 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
26314 group).
26315
26316 @acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
26317
26318 @item gnus-safe-html-newsgroups
26319 @vindex gnus-safe-html-newsgroups
26320 Groups in which links in html articles are considered all safe. The
26321 value may be a regexp matching those groups, a list of group names, or
26322 @code{nil}. This overrides @code{mm-w3m-safe-url-regexp}. The default
26323 value is @code{"\\`nnrss[+:]"}. This is effective only when emacs-w3m
26324 renders html articles, i.e., in the case @code{mm-text-html-renderer} is
26325 set to @code{w3m}. @xref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization,
26326 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}.
26327
26328 @end table
26329
26330 @node The End
26331 @chapter The End
26332
26333 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
26334 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
26335
26336 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
26337
26338 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
26339
26340 @quotation
26341 @strong{Te Deum}
26342
26343 @sp 1
26344 Not because of victories @*
26345 I sing,@*
26346 having none,@*
26347 but for the common sunshine,@*
26348 the breeze,@*
26349 the largess of the spring.
26350
26351 @sp 1
26352 Not for victory@*
26353 but for the day's work done@*
26354 as well as I was able;@*
26355 not for a seat upon the dais@*
26356 but at the common table.@*
26357 @end quotation
26358
26359
26360 @node Appendices
26361 @chapter Appendices
26362
26363 @menu
26364 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
26365 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
26366 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
26367 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
26368 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
26369 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
26370 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
26371 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
26372 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
26373 @end menu
26374
26375
26376 @node XEmacs
26377 @section XEmacs
26378 @cindex XEmacs
26379 @cindex installing under XEmacs
26380
26381 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
26382 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
26383 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
26384 @samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
26385 @samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print},
26386 @samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
26387
26388
26389 @node History
26390 @section History
26391
26392 @cindex history
26393 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
26394 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
26395
26396 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
26397 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
26398 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
26399 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
26400 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
26401
26402 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
26403 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
26404 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
26405 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
26406 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
26407 appropriate name, don't you think?)
26408
26409 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
26410 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
26411 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
26412 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
26413
26414 @menu
26415 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
26416 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
26417 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
26418 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
26419 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
26420 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
26421 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
26422 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
26423 @end menu
26424
26425
26426 @node Gnus Versions
26427 @subsection Gnus Versions
26428 @cindex ding Gnus
26429 @cindex September Gnus
26430 @cindex Red Gnus
26431 @cindex Quassia Gnus
26432 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
26433 @cindex Oort Gnus
26434 @cindex No Gnus
26435 @cindex Ma Gnus
26436 @cindex Gnus versions
26437
26438 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
26439 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
26440 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
26441
26442 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
26443 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
26444
26445 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
26446 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
26447
26448 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
26449 It was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
26450
26451 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
26452 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
26453 1999.
26454
26455 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun and was released as
26456 Gnus 5.10 on May 1st 2003 (24 releases).
26457
26458 On the January 4th 2004, No Gnus was begun.
26459
26460 On April 19, 2010 Gnus development was moved to Git. See
26461 http://git.gnus.org for details (http://www.gnus.org will be updated
26462 with the information when possible).
26463
26464 On the January 31th 2012, Ma Gnus was begun.
26465
26466 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name---``(ding)
26467 Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
26468 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'', ``No Gnus'', ``Ma Gnus''---don't
26469 panic. Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly.
26470 Whatever you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of
26471 its reach. Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up to
26472 that instead.
26473
26474
26475 @node Why?
26476 @subsection Why?
26477
26478 What's the point of Gnus?
26479
26480 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
26481 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
26482 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
26483 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
26484 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
26485 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
26486 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
26487 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
26488 keep track of millions of people who post?
26489
26490 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
26491 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
26492 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
26493 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
26494 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
26495 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
26496 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
26497 every one of you to explore and invent.
26498
26499 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
26500 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
26501
26502
26503 @node Compatibility
26504 @subsection Compatibility
26505
26506 @cindex compatibility
26507 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
26508 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
26509 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
26510
26511 Our motto is:
26512 @quotation
26513 @cartouche
26514 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
26515 @end cartouche
26516 @end quotation
26517
26518 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
26519 their names.
26520
26521 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
26522 Articles}.
26523
26524 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
26525 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
26526 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
26527 important variables have their values copied into their global
26528 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
26529 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
26530
26531 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
26532 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
26533 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
26534 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
26535 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
26536 peculiar results.
26537
26538 @cindex hilit19
26539 @cindex highlighting
26540 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
26541 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
26542 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
26543 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
26544 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
26545 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
26546 Away!
26547
26548 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
26549 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
26550 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
26551 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
26552
26553 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
26554 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
26555 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
26556 to stop doing it the old way.
26557
26558 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
26559
26560 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
26561 @findex gnus-bug
26562 @cindex reporting bugs
26563 @cindex bugs
26564 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
26565 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
26566 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
26567
26568 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
26569 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
26570 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
26571 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
26572 up at you.
26573
26574
26575 @node Conformity
26576 @subsection Conformity
26577
26578 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
26579 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
26580 with, of course.
26581
26582 @table @strong
26583
26584 @item RFC (2)822
26585 @cindex RFC 822
26586 @cindex RFC 2822
26587 There are no known breaches of this standard.
26588
26589 @item RFC 1036
26590 @cindex RFC 1036
26591 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
26592
26593 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
26594 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
26595 We do have some breaches to this one.
26596
26597 @table @emph
26598
26599 @item X-Newsreader
26600 @itemx User-Agent
26601 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
26602 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
26603 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
26604 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
26605 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
26606 @end table
26607
26608 @item USEFOR
26609 @cindex USEFOR
26610 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
26611 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
26612 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
26613 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
26614
26615 @item MIME---RFC 2045--2049 etc
26616 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
26617 All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
26618
26619 @item Disposition Notifications---RFC 2298
26620 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
26621
26622 @item PGP---RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
26623 @cindex RFC 1991
26624 @cindex RFC 2440
26625 RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
26626 published as an informational RFC@. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
26627 called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
26628 non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
26629 encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
26630 decryption).
26631
26632 @item PGP/MIME---RFC 2015/3156
26633 RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
26634 1991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RFC 1991/2440 format.
26635 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
26636
26637 @item S/MIME---RFC 2633
26638 RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
26639
26640 @item IMAP---RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
26641 RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
26642 (@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
26643 authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
26644 lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
26645 protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
26646 integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
26647 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
26648
26649 @end table
26650
26651 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
26652 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
26653 know.
26654
26655
26656 @node Emacsen
26657 @subsection Emacsen
26658 @cindex Emacsen
26659 @cindex XEmacs
26660 @cindex Mule
26661 @cindex Emacs
26662
26663 This version of Gnus should work on:
26664
26665 @itemize @bullet
26666
26667 @item
26668 Emacs 23.1 and up.
26669
26670 @item
26671 XEmacs 21.4 and up.
26672
26673 @end itemize
26674
26675 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
26676 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
26677 Emacs versions. Particularly, Gnus 5.10.8 should also work on Emacs
26678 20.7 and XEmacs 21.1.
26679
26680 @c No-merge comment: The paragraph added in v5-10 here must not be
26681 @c synced here!
26682
26683 @node Gnus Development
26684 @subsection Gnus Development
26685
26686 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
26687 discussion on the development mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}, where people
26688 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
26689 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
26690 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
26691 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
26692 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
26693 have names like ``Oort Gnus'' and ``No Gnus''. @xref{Gnus Versions}.
26694
26695 After futzing around for 10--100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
26696 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
26697 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.10.1'' instead. Normal people are
26698 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
26699 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup. This newgroup is mirrored to the
26700 mailing list @samp{info-gnus-english@@gnu.org} which is carried on Gmane
26701 as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.user}. These releases are finally integrated
26702 in Emacs.
26703
26704 @cindex Incoming*
26705 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
26706 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26707 in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
26708 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
26709 @xref{Mail Source Customization}.
26710
26711 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
26712 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
26713 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
26714 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
26715 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
26716 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
26717 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
26718 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
26719 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
26720 can't be assumed to do so.
26721
26722 So if you have problems with or questions about the alpha versions,
26723 direct those to the ding mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}. This list
26724 is also available on Gmane as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.general}.
26725
26726 @cindex Incoming*
26727 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
26728 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26729 in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
26730 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
26731 @xref{Mail Source Customization}.
26732
26733 @node Contributors
26734 @subsection Contributors
26735 @cindex contributors
26736
26737 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
26738 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
26739 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
26740 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
26741 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
26742 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
26743 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
26744 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
26745 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
26746 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
26747
26748 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
26749 wrong show.
26750
26751 @itemize @bullet
26752
26753 @item
26754 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
26755
26756 @item
26757 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el,
26758 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
26759 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
26760 functionality and stuff.
26761
26762 @item
26763 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
26764 well as numerous other things).
26765
26766 @item
26767 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
26768
26769 @item
26770 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
26771
26772 @item
26773 Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
26774
26775 @item
26776 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
26777
26778 @item
26779 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
26780 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
26781
26782 @item
26783 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
26784
26785 @item
26786 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section.
26787
26788 @item
26789 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
26790
26791 @item
26792 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
26793
26794 @item
26795 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bug detection and fixes.
26796
26797 @item
26798 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
26799
26800 @item
26801 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
26802 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
26803
26804 @item
26805 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
26806
26807 @item
26808 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
26809
26810 @item
26811 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
26812
26813 @item
26814 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
26815 .newsrc files.
26816
26817 @item
26818 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
26819
26820 @item
26821 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
26822
26823 @item
26824 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
26825
26826 @item
26827 François Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
26828 well as autoconf support.
26829
26830 @end itemize
26831
26832 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
26833 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
26834
26835 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
26836
26837 Christopher Davis,
26838 Andrew Eskilsson,
26839 Kai Grossjohann,
26840 Kevin Greiner,
26841 Jesper Harder,
26842 Paul Jarc,
26843 Simon Josefsson,
26844 David K@aa{}gedal,
26845 Richard Pieri,
26846 Fabrice Popineau,
26847 Daniel Quinlan,
26848 Michael Shields,
26849 Reiner Steib,
26850 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
26851 Jack Vinson,
26852 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
26853 and
26854 Teodor Zlatanov.
26855
26856 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
26857
26858 Jari Aalto,
26859 Adrian Aichner,
26860 Vladimir Alexiev,
26861 Russ Allbery,
26862 Peter Arius,
26863 Matt Armstrong,
26864 Marc Auslander,
26865 Miles Bader,
26866 Alexei V. Barantsev,
26867 Frank Bennett,
26868 Robert Bihlmeyer,
26869 Chris Bone,
26870 Mark Borges,
26871 Mark Boyns,
26872 Lance A. Brown,
26873 Rob Browning,
26874 Kees de Bruin,
26875 Martin Buchholz,
26876 Joe Buehler,
26877 Kevin Buhr,
26878 Alastair Burt,
26879 Joao Cachopo,
26880 Zlatko Calusic,
26881 Massimo Campostrini,
26882 Castor,
26883 David Charlap,
26884 Dan Christensen,
26885 Kevin Christian,
26886 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
26887 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
26888 Laura Conrad,
26889 Michael R. Cook,
26890 Glenn Coombs,
26891 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
26892 Neil Crellin,
26893 Frank D. Cringle,
26894 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
26895 Andre Deparade,
26896 Ulrik Dickow,
26897 Dave Disser,
26898 Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
26899 Joev Dubach,
26900 Michael Welsh Duggan,
26901 Dave Edmondson,
26902 Paul Eggert,
26903 Mark W. Eichin,
26904 Karl Eichwalder,
26905 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
26906 Michael Ernst,
26907 Luc Van Eycken,
26908 Sam Falkner,
26909 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
26910 Sigbjorn Finne,
26911 Sven Fischer,
26912 Paul Fisher,
26913 Decklin Foster,
26914 Gary D. Foster,
26915 Paul Franklin,
26916 Guy Geens,
26917 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
26918 David S. Goldberg,
26919 Michelangelo Grigni,
26920 Dale Hagglund,
26921 D. Hall,
26922 Magnus Hammerin,
26923 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
26924 Raja R. Harinath,
26925 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
26926 P. E. Jareth Hein,
26927 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
26928 Scott Hofmann,
26929 Tassilo Horn,
26930 Marc Horowitz,
26931 Gunnar Horrigmo,
26932 Richard Hoskins,
26933 Brad Howes,
26934 Miguel de Icaza,
26935 François Felix Ingrand,
26936 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
26937 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
26938 Lee Iverson,
26939 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
26940 Rajappa Iyer,
26941 Andreas Jaeger,
26942 Adam P. Jenkins,
26943 Randell Jesup,
26944 Fred Johansen,
26945 Gareth Jones,
26946 Greg Klanderman,
26947 Karl Kleinpaste,
26948 Michael Klingbeil,
26949 Peter Skov Knudsen,
26950 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
26951 Petr Konecny,
26952 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
26953 Thor Kristoffersen,
26954 Jens Lautenbacher,
26955 Martin Larose,
26956 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
26957 Joerg Lenneis,
26958 Carsten Leonhardt,
26959 James LewisMoss,
26960 Christian Limpach,
26961 Markus Linnala,
26962 Dave Love,
26963 Mike McEwan,
26964 Tonny Madsen,
26965 Shlomo Mahlab,
26966 Nat Makarevitch,
26967 Istvan Marko,
26968 David Martin,
26969 Jason R. Mastaler,
26970 Gordon Matzigkeit,
26971 Timo Metzemakers,
26972 Richard Mlynarik,
26973 Lantz Moore,
26974 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
26975 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
26976 Hrvoje Niksic,
26977 Andy Norman,
26978 Fred Oberhauser,
26979 C. R. Oldham,
26980 Alexandre Oliva,
26981 Ken Olstad,
26982 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
26983 Hideki Ono, @c Ono
26984 Ettore Perazzoli,
26985 William Perry,
26986 Stephen Peters,
26987 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
26988 Ulrich Pfeifer,
26989 Matt Pharr,
26990 Andy Piper,
26991 John McClary Prevost,
26992 Bill Pringlemeir,
26993 Mike Pullen,
26994 Jim Radford,
26995 Colin Rafferty,
26996 Lasse Rasinen,
26997 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
26998 Joe Reiss,
26999 Renaud Rioboo,
27000 Roland B. Roberts,
27001 Bart Robinson,
27002 Christian von Roques,
27003 Markus Rost,
27004 Jason Rumney,
27005 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
27006 Jay Sachs,
27007 Dewey M. Sasser,
27008 Conrad Sauerwald,
27009 Loren Schall,
27010 Dan Schmidt,
27011 Ralph Schleicher,
27012 Philippe Schnoebelen,
27013 Andreas Schwab,
27014 Randal L. Schwartz,
27015 Danny Siu,
27016 Matt Simmons,
27017 Paul D. Smith,
27018 Jeff Sparkes,
27019 Toby Speight,
27020 Michael Sperber,
27021 Darren Stalder,
27022 Richard Stallman,
27023 Greg Stark,
27024 Sam Steingold,
27025 Paul Stevenson,
27026 Jonas Steverud,
27027 Paul Stodghill,
27028 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
27029 Kurt Swanson,
27030 Samuel Tardieu,
27031 Teddy,
27032 Chuck Thompson,
27033 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
27034 Philippe Troin,
27035 James Troup,
27036 Trung Tran-Duc,
27037 Jack Twilley,
27038 Aaron M. Ucko,
27039 Aki Vehtari,
27040 Didier Verna,
27041 Vladimir Volovich,
27042 Jan Vroonhof,
27043 Stefan Waldherr,
27044 Pete Ware,
27045 Barry A. Warsaw,
27046 Christoph Wedler,
27047 Joe Wells,
27048 Lee Willis,
27049 and
27050 Lloyd Zusman.
27051
27052
27053 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
27054 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
27055 (550kB and counting).
27056
27057 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
27058 sure.
27059
27060 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
27061 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
27062
27063
27064 @node New Features
27065 @subsection New Features
27066 @cindex new features
27067
27068 @menu
27069 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
27070 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
27071 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
27072 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
27073 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
27074 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
27075 * No Gnus:: Very punny. Gnus 5.12/5.13.
27076 * Ma Gnus:: Celebrating 25 years of Gnus.
27077 @end menu
27078
27079 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
27080 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
27081 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
27082
27083 @node ding Gnus
27084 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
27085
27086 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
27087
27088 @itemize @bullet
27089
27090 @item
27091 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
27092 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
27093
27094 @item
27095 Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
27096 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
27097
27098 @item
27099 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
27100
27101 @item
27102 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
27103 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
27104 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
27105
27106 @item
27107 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
27108 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
27109 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
27110 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
27111
27112 @item
27113 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
27114 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27115
27116 @item
27117 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
27118 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
27119 (@pxref{The Active File}).
27120
27121 @item
27122 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
27123 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
27124
27125 @item
27126 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
27127 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
27128 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
27129
27130 @item
27131 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
27132 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
27133 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
27134
27135 @item
27136 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
27137 cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
27138
27139 @item
27140 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
27141 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
27142
27143 @item
27144 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
27145 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27146
27147 @item
27148 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
27149 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
27150
27151 @item
27152 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
27153 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27154
27155 @item
27156 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
27157
27158 @item
27159 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
27160 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
27161
27162 @item
27163 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
27164 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
27165
27166 @item
27167 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
27168 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
27169
27170 @item
27171 Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
27172
27173 @item
27174 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
27175 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
27176
27177 @item
27178 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
27179 Articles}).
27180
27181 @item
27182 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
27183 Buttons}).
27184
27185 @item
27186 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
27187 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
27188
27189 @end itemize
27190
27191
27192 @node September Gnus
27193 @subsubsection September Gnus
27194
27195 @iftex
27196 @iflatex
27197 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
27198 @end iflatex
27199 @end iftex
27200
27201 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
27202
27203 @itemize @bullet
27204
27205 @item
27206 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
27207 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
27208 now obsolete.
27209
27210 @item
27211 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
27212 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
27213 Threading}).
27214
27215 @lisp
27216 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
27217 @end lisp
27218
27219 @item
27220 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
27221 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
27222
27223 @item
27224 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
27225 referred.
27226
27227 @item
27228 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions.
27229
27230 @item
27231 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
27232
27233 @item
27234 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
27235
27236 @lisp
27237 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
27238 @end lisp
27239
27240 @item
27241 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
27242 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
27243
27244 @lisp
27245 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
27246 @end lisp
27247
27248 @item
27249 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
27250 Groups}).
27251
27252 @item
27253 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
27254 Topics}).
27255
27256 @lisp
27257 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
27258 @end lisp
27259
27260 @item
27261 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
27262
27263 @item
27264 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
27265 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
27266
27267 @lisp
27268 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
27269 @end lisp
27270
27271 @item
27272 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
27273 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
27274
27275 @item
27276 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
27277
27278 @item
27279 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
27280 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
27281 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
27282
27283 @item
27284 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets.
27285
27286 @item
27287 The Gnus cache is much faster.
27288
27289 @item
27290 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
27291 Groups}).
27292
27293 @item
27294 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
27295 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
27296
27297 @item
27298 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
27299 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
27300
27301 @item
27302 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
27303 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
27304
27305 @item
27306 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
27307 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
27308 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
27309
27310 @item
27311 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
27312 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
27313
27314 @item
27315 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
27316
27317 @item
27318 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
27319
27320 @item
27321 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
27322
27323 @item
27324 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
27325
27326 @item
27327 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
27328 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
27329
27330 @item
27331 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
27332 Layout}).
27333
27334 @item
27335 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
27336 @iftex
27337 @iflatex
27338 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
27339 @end iflatex
27340 @end iftex
27341
27342 @item
27343 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27344
27345 @lisp
27346 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
27347 @end lisp
27348
27349 @item
27350 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
27351
27352 @item
27353 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
27354
27355 @item
27356 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
27357 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
27358
27359 @lisp
27360 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
27361 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
27362 @end lisp
27363
27364 @item
27365 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
27366 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
27367
27368 @lisp
27369 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
27370 @end lisp
27371
27372 @item
27373 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
27374 buffer to allow easier treatment.
27375
27376 @item
27377 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
27378
27379 @item
27380 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
27381 Articles}).
27382
27383 @lisp
27384 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
27385 @end lisp
27386
27387 @item
27388 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
27389 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
27390
27391 @lisp
27392 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
27393 @end lisp
27394
27395 @item
27396 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
27397 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
27398
27399 @item
27400 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
27401 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27402
27403 @lisp
27404 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
27405 @end lisp
27406
27407 @item
27408 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27409
27410 @item
27411 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
27412
27413 @item
27414 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
27415
27416 @end itemize
27417
27418
27419 @node Red Gnus
27420 @subsubsection Red Gnus
27421
27422 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
27423
27424 @iftex
27425 @iflatex
27426 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
27427 @end iflatex
27428 @end iftex
27429
27430 @itemize @bullet
27431
27432 @item
27433 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
27434
27435 @item
27436 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
27437 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27438
27439 @item
27440 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
27441 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
27442 Scoring}).
27443
27444 @item
27445 Article washing status can be displayed in the
27446 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
27447
27448 @item
27449 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
27450
27451 @item
27452 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
27453 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
27454
27455 @lisp
27456 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
27457 @end lisp
27458
27459 @item
27460 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
27461 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
27462 been added.
27463
27464 @item
27465 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extensible (@pxref{Document
27466 Server Internals}).
27467
27468 @item
27469 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
27470 Parameters}).
27471
27472 @item
27473 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
27474
27475 @item
27476 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
27477 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
27478
27479 @item
27480 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
27481 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
27482 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
27483
27484 @item
27485 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
27486 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27487
27488 @item
27489 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
27490 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
27491
27492 @item
27493 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
27494 (@pxref{Undo}).
27495
27496 @item
27497 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
27498 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27499
27500 @item
27501 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
27502 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
27503
27504 @lisp
27505 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
27506 @end lisp
27507
27508 @item
27509 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
27510
27511 @lisp
27512 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
27513 @end lisp
27514
27515 @item
27516 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
27517 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27518
27519 @item
27520 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
27521 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27522
27523 @item
27524 A new command for reading collections of documents
27525 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
27526 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
27527
27528 @item
27529 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
27530 Marks}).
27531
27532 @item
27533 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
27534 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
27535
27536 @item
27537 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
27538 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
27539 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
27540
27541 @item
27542 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
27543 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
27544 Sorting}).
27545
27546 @item
27547 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
27548 Groups}).
27549
27550 @item
27551 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
27552 Commands}).
27553 @iftex
27554 @iflatex
27555 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
27556 @end iflatex
27557 @end iftex
27558
27559 @item
27560 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
27561 Variables}).
27562
27563 @item
27564 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
27565 Mail}).
27566
27567 @item
27568 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
27569 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
27570
27571 @item
27572 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
27573
27574 @end itemize
27575
27576
27577 @node Quassia Gnus
27578 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
27579
27580 New features in Gnus 5.6:
27581
27582 @itemize @bullet
27583
27584 @item
27585 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
27586 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
27587 @xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
27588
27589 @item
27590 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
27591 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
27592 group, which is created automatically.
27593
27594 @item
27595 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
27596 values.
27597
27598 @item
27599 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-IDs.
27600
27601 @item
27602 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
27603 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
27604
27605 @item
27606 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
27607 @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
27608
27609 @item
27610 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
27611
27612 @item
27613 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
27614 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
27615
27616 @item
27617 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
27618
27619 @item
27620 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
27621 details.
27622
27623 @item
27624 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
27625 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
27626
27627 @item
27628 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
27629 control over simplification.
27630
27631 @item
27632 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
27633
27634 @item
27635 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
27636 limit.
27637
27638 @item
27639 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
27640
27641 @item
27642 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
27643
27644 @item
27645 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
27646 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
27647 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
27648
27649 @item
27650 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
27651 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
27652
27653 @item
27654 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
27655 text---@kbd{W d}.
27656
27657 @item
27658 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
27659 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
27660
27661 @item
27662 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
27663 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
27664
27665 @item
27666 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
27667 has been added.
27668
27669 @item
27670 A history of where mails have been split is available.
27671
27672 @item
27673 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
27674
27675 @item
27676 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
27677 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
27678
27679 @item
27680 A new function for citing in Message has been
27681 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
27682
27683 @item
27684 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
27685
27686 @item
27687 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
27688 been added.
27689
27690 @item
27691 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
27692 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
27693
27694 @item
27695 The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
27696 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
27697
27698 @item
27699 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
27700
27701 @item
27702 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
27703
27704 @end itemize
27705
27706 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
27707 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
27708
27709 New features in Gnus 5.8:
27710
27711 @itemize @bullet
27712
27713 @item
27714 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
27715 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
27716
27717 If you used procmail like in
27718
27719 @lisp
27720 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
27721 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
27722 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
27723 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
27724 @end lisp
27725
27726 this now has changed to
27727
27728 @lisp
27729 (setq mail-sources
27730 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
27731 :suffix ".in")))
27732 @end lisp
27733
27734 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
27735
27736 @item
27737 Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
27738 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
27739
27740 @item
27741 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
27742 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
27743
27744 @item
27745 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
27746 called to position point.
27747
27748 @item
27749 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
27750 summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
27751
27752 @item
27753 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
27754 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
27755
27756 @item
27757 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
27758 subtly different manner.
27759
27760 @item
27761 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
27762 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
27763 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
27764
27765 @item
27766 Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
27767
27768 @end itemize
27769
27770 @node Oort Gnus
27771 @subsubsection Oort Gnus
27772 @cindex Oort Gnus
27773
27774 New features in Gnus 5.10:
27775
27776 @itemize @bullet
27777
27778 @item Installation changes
27779 @c ***********************
27780
27781 @itemize @bullet
27782 @item
27783 Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
27784
27785 If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
27786 release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
27787 this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
27788 @file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
27789 read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
27790 @file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
27791 later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
27792 isn't save in general.
27793
27794 @item
27795 Lisp files are now installed in @file{.../site-lisp/gnus/} by default.
27796 It defaulted to @file{.../site-lisp/} formerly. In addition to this,
27797 the new installer issues a warning if other Gnus installations which
27798 will shadow the latest one are detected. You can then remove those
27799 shadows manually or remove them using @code{make
27800 remove-installed-shadows}.
27801
27802 @item
27803 New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
27804
27805 Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
27806 first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
27807 @file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, if you want
27808 to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
27809 the second parameter.
27810
27811 @file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
27812 automatic recognition of XEmacs and Emacs, generates
27813 @file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
27814 generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
27815 process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
27816 back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
27817 install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
27818 complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
27819 cycle used under Unix systems.
27820
27821 The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} and @file{xemacs.mak}
27822 superfluous, so they have been removed.
27823
27824 @item
27825 @file{~/News/overview/} not used.
27826
27827 As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
27828 directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
27829 hierarchy.
27830
27831 @c FIXME: 'gnus-load' is mentioned in README, which is not included in
27832 @c the repository. We should find a better place for this item.
27833 @item
27834 @code{(require 'gnus-load)}
27835
27836 If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
27837 @code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
27838 lisp directory into load-path.
27839
27840 File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
27841 some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
27842
27843 @end itemize
27844
27845 @item New packages and libraries within Gnus
27846 @c *****************************************
27847
27848 @itemize @bullet
27849
27850 @item
27851 The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
27852 @xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
27853
27854 @item
27855 @acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
27856
27857 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
27858 @acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GnuTLS.
27859
27860 @item
27861 Improved anti-spam features.
27862
27863 Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
27864 using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
27865 methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
27866 for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
27867 are also new. @ref{Thwarting Email Spam} and @ref{Spam Package}.
27868 @c FIXME: @xref{Spam Package}?. Should this be under Misc?
27869
27870 @item
27871 Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
27872
27873 Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
27874 complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
27875 buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
27876 generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
27877 manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
27878
27879 @end itemize
27880
27881 @item Changes in group mode
27882 @c ************************
27883
27884 @itemize @bullet
27885
27886 @item
27887 @code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
27888 using @kbd{G M}.
27889
27890 @item
27891 Retrieval of charters and control messages
27892
27893 There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
27894 control messages (@kbd{H C}).
27895
27896 @item
27897 The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
27898
27899 Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
27900 the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
27901 enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
27902 variable in @file{~/.gnus.el} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
27903 variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
27904 parameters, a'la:
27905 @lisp
27906 (setq gnus-parameters
27907 '(("mail\\..*"
27908 (gnus-show-threads nil)
27909 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
27910 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
27911 (to-group . "\\1"))))
27912 @end lisp
27913
27914 @item
27915 Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
27916
27917 The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
27918 be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
27919 @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
27920 @code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
27921 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} (called after getting new
27922 mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
27923 want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
27924 you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
27925 when getting new mail, remove the function.
27926
27927 @item
27928 Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
27929
27930 This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
27931 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
27932 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
27933
27934 @item
27935 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
27936 @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
27937
27938 The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
27939 instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
27940 variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
27941 @lisp
27942 ("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
27943 @end lisp
27944
27945 @item
27946 Old intermediate incoming mail files (@file{Incoming*}) are deleted
27947 after a couple of days, not immediately. @xref{Mail Source
27948 Customization}. (New in Gnus 5.10.10 / Emacs 22.2)
27949
27950 @end itemize
27951
27952 @item Changes in summary and article mode
27953 @c **************************************
27954
27955 @itemize @bullet
27956
27957 @item
27958 @kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
27959 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
27960 region if the region is active.
27961
27962 @item
27963 In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
27964 Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
27965
27966 @item
27967 Article Buttons
27968
27969 More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
27970 pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
27971 variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
27972 appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
27973
27974 @item
27975 Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
27976
27977 @item
27978 Picons
27979
27980 The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
27981 the previous options have been removed or renamed.
27982
27983 Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
27984 newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
27985 @xref{Picons}.
27986
27987 @item
27988 If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
27989 boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
27990
27991 @item
27992 Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
27993
27994 @item
27995 The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
27996 article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
27997
27998 @item
27999 Warn about email replies to news
28000
28001 Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
28002 the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
28003 you.
28004
28005 @item
28006 If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
28007 non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
28008 built.
28009
28010 @item
28011 Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
28012 related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
28013
28014 @item
28015 The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
28016 in English. @xref{Article Date}.
28017
28018 @item
28019 diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
28020 @code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
28021
28022 @item
28023 Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
28024
28025 Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
28026 mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
28027 though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
28028 @code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
28029 citations.
28030
28031 The new command @kbd{W Y f}
28032 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}) allows deuglifying broken
28033 Outlook (Express) articles.
28034
28035 @item
28036 @code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
28037
28038 If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
28039 not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
28040 which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
28041 what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
28042
28043 This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
28044 consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
28045 message cited below.
28046
28047 @item
28048 Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc.)@: are now displayed graphically in
28049 Emacs too.
28050
28051 Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.gnus.el} to
28052 disable it.
28053
28054 @item
28055 Face headers handling. @xref{Face}.
28056
28057 @item
28058 In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
28059 and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
28060
28061 @item
28062 Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
28063
28064 @item
28065 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}
28066
28067 The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
28068 %s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
28069 @code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
28070 changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
28071 recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
28072 groups.
28073
28074 @item
28075 Deleting of attachments.
28076
28077 The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
28078 on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
28079 external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
28080 @acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
28081 that support editing.
28082
28083 @item
28084 @code{gnus-default-charset}
28085
28086 The default value is determined from the
28087 @code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
28088 @code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
28089 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
28090
28091 @item
28092 Printing capabilities are enhanced.
28093
28094 Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
28095 Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
28096 printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
28097
28098 @item
28099 Extended format specs.
28100
28101 Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
28102 @code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
28103 format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
28104 @samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
28105 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
28106 escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
28107
28108 @item
28109 @kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
28110 @c FIXME: Was this a user-visible change?
28111
28112 It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
28113 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
28114 out other articles.
28115
28116 @item
28117 Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
28118
28119 If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
28120 s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
28121 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
28122 result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
28123
28124 @item
28125 Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
28126
28127 @end itemize
28128
28129 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
28130 @c ****************************************************
28131
28132 @itemize @bullet
28133
28134 @item
28135 Delayed articles
28136
28137 You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
28138 buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
28139 for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
28140
28141 @item
28142 If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
28143 the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
28144
28145 @item
28146 The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
28147 Gcc articles as read.
28148
28149 @item
28150 Externalizing of attachments
28151
28152 If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
28153 @code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
28154 local files as external parts.
28155
28156 @item
28157 The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
28158 @xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
28159
28160 @item
28161 Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
28162
28163 Earlier it was generated when the user configurable email address was
28164 different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
28165 algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
28166 only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
28167 cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
28168 see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
28169 default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
28170 @code{message-required-news-headers}, and
28171 @code{message-required-mail-headers}.
28172
28173 @item
28174 Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
28175
28176 Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
28177 subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
28178 M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
28179 @kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
28180 appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
28181 followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
28182
28183 @item
28184 References and X-Draft-From headers are no longer generated when you
28185 start composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
28186 @code{nil}.
28187
28188 @item
28189 Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers. @xref{X-Face}.
28190
28191 @item
28192 Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
28193
28194 To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
28195 are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
28196 variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
28197 contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
28198 you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
28199 into two groups) you must change it to return the list
28200 @code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
28201 incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
28202 was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
28203 was inserted directly.
28204
28205 @item
28206 @code{message-insinuate-rmail}
28207
28208 @c FIXME should that not be 'message-user-agent?
28209 Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
28210 mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
28211 compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
28212 enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
28213
28214 @item
28215 @code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
28216
28217 The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
28218 @lisp
28219 (define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
28220 'bbdb-complete-name)
28221 @end lisp
28222
28223 @item
28224 @code{gnus-posting-styles}
28225
28226 Add a new format of match like
28227 @lisp
28228 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
28229 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28230 @end lisp
28231 The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
28232 @lisp
28233 (header "to" "larsi.*org"
28234 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28235 @end lisp
28236
28237 @item
28238 @code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
28239
28240 @samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
28241 added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
28242 need add those two headers too.
28243
28244 @item
28245 Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
28246 composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
28247 Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
28248 versions.
28249
28250 @item
28251 The option @code{mm-fill-flowed} can be used to disable treatment of
28252 ``format=flowed'' messages. Also, flowed text is disabled when sending
28253 inline PGP signed messages. @xref{Flowed text, , Flowed text,
28254 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
28255 @c This entry is also present in the node "No Gnus".
28256
28257 @item
28258 Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
28259
28260 This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
28261
28262 @item
28263 Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
28264
28265 In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
28266 the valid values.
28267
28268 @item
28269 Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
28270
28271 This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
28272 used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
28273 superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
28274 you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
28275 system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
28276 security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
28277 will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
28278 The behavior can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
28279
28280 @item
28281 Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
28282 2015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630--2633).
28283
28284 It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
28285 additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
28286 Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
28287 messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
28288
28289 @item
28290 @acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
28291 C-m}.
28292
28293 This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
28294 @code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
28295
28296 @item
28297 The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to the symbol
28298 @code{best}.
28299
28300 The behavior for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
28301 convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
28302 used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
28303 invalidate the digital signature.
28304
28305 @item
28306 If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
28307 decompressed when activated.
28308 @c FIXME: Does this affect article or message mode?
28309
28310 @item
28311 Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
28312
28313 Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
28314 Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
28315 send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
28316 Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
28317 and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
28318 controls this.
28319
28320 @item You can now drag and drop attachments to the Message buffer.
28321 See @code{mml-dnd-protocol-alist} and @code{mml-dnd-attach-options}.
28322 @xref{MIME, ,MIME, message, Message Manual}.
28323 @c New in 5.10.9 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.1)
28324
28325 @item @code{auto-fill-mode} is enabled by default in Message mode.
28326 See @code{message-fill-column}. @xref{Various Message Variables, ,
28327 Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
28328 @c New in Gnus 5.10.12 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.3)
28329
28330 @end itemize
28331
28332 @item Changes in back ends
28333 @c ***********************
28334
28335 @itemize @bullet
28336 @item
28337 Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
28338
28339 @item
28340 The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
28341
28342 @item
28343 Gnus supports Maildir groups.
28344
28345 Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
28346
28347 @item
28348 The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
28349
28350 This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
28351 separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
28352 makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
28353 sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within, e.g., a department. It
28354 works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
28355 file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
28356 nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
28357 another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
28358 @file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
28359 The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
28360 @code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
28361
28362 @end itemize
28363
28364 @item Appearance
28365 @c *************
28366
28367 @itemize @bullet
28368
28369 @item
28370 The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
28371 been renamed to ``Gnus''.
28372
28373 @item
28374 The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
28375 renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
28376 related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
28377 message, Message Manual}).
28378
28379 @item
28380 The tool bars have been updated to use GNOME icons in Group, Summary and
28381 Message mode. You can also customize the tool bars: @kbd{M-x
28382 customize-apropos RET -tool-bar$} should get you started. This is a new
28383 feature in Gnus 5.10.10. (Only for Emacs, not in XEmacs.)
28384
28385 @item The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly
28386 in the group buffer, see the variable @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}.
28387 Its default value depends on your Emacs version. This is a new feature
28388 in Gnus 5.10.9.
28389 @end itemize
28390
28391
28392 @item Miscellaneous changes
28393 @c ************************
28394
28395 @itemize @bullet
28396
28397 @item
28398 @code{gnus-agent}
28399
28400 The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
28401 and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
28402 @code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
28403 only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
28404 default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
28405 enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
28406 of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
28407 unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
28408 @kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
28409 the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
28410 @kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
28411 behavior of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
28412 nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
28413 is not needed any more.
28414
28415 @item
28416 Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
28417
28418 If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
28419 in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
28420 gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
28421
28422 @item
28423 Dired integration
28424
28425 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
28426 bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
28427 using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
28428 entry.
28429
28430 @item
28431 The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
28432
28433 @item
28434 @code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
28435
28436 A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
28437
28438 @end itemize
28439
28440 @end itemize
28441
28442 @node No Gnus
28443 @subsubsection No Gnus
28444 @cindex No Gnus
28445
28446 New features in No Gnus:
28447 @c FIXME: Gnus 5.12?
28448
28449 @include gnus-news.texi
28450
28451 @node Ma Gnus
28452 @subsubsection Ma Gnus
28453 @cindex Ma Gnus
28454
28455 I'm sure there will be lots of text here. It's really spelled 真
28456 Gnus.
28457
28458 New features in Ma Gnus:
28459
28460 @itemize @bullet
28461
28462 @item Changes in summary and article mode
28463 @c **************************************
28464
28465 @itemize @bullet
28466
28467 @item
28468 By default, @acronym{MIME} part buttons for attachments (if any) will
28469 appear in the end of the article header in addition to the bottom of the
28470 article body, so you can easily find them without scrolling the article
28471 again and again. @xref{MIME Commands}.
28472
28473 @end itemize
28474
28475 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
28476 @c ****************************************************
28477
28478 @itemize @bullet
28479
28480 @item
28481 The new hooks @code{gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook} and
28482 @code{gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook} are run before/after encoding
28483 the message body of the Gcc copy of a sent message. See
28484 @xref{Archived Messages}.
28485
28486 @end itemize
28487
28488 @end itemize
28489
28490 @iftex
28491
28492 @page
28493 @node The Manual
28494 @section The Manual
28495 @cindex colophon
28496 @cindex manual
28497
28498 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
28499 either @code{texi2dvi}
28500 @iflatex
28501 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
28502 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
28503 @end iflatex
28504 to get what you hold in your hands now.
28505
28506 The following conventions have been used:
28507
28508 @enumerate
28509
28510 @item
28511 This is a @samp{string}
28512
28513 @item
28514 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
28515
28516 @item
28517 This is a @file{file}
28518
28519 @item
28520 This is a @code{symbol}
28521
28522 @end enumerate
28523
28524 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
28525 mean:
28526
28527 @lisp
28528 (setq flargnoze "yes")
28529 @end lisp
28530
28531 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
28532
28533 @lisp
28534 (setq flumphel 'yes)
28535 @end lisp
28536
28537 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
28538 ever get them confused.
28539
28540 @iflatex
28541 @c @head
28542 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
28543 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
28544 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
28545 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
28546 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
28547 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
28548 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
28549 @end iflatex
28550
28551 @end iftex
28552
28553
28554 @node On Writing Manuals
28555 @section On Writing Manuals
28556
28557 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
28558 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
28559 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
28560 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
28561 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
28562 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code go hand
28563 in hand.
28564
28565 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
28566 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
28567 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
28568 started with Gnus.
28569
28570 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
28571 reference manual as source material. It would look quite different.
28572
28573
28574 @page
28575 @node Terminology
28576 @section Terminology
28577
28578 @cindex terminology
28579 @table @dfn
28580
28581 @item news
28582 @cindex news
28583 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
28584 News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
28585 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
28586 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
28587 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
28588
28589 @item mail
28590 @cindex mail
28591 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
28592 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
28593 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
28594 not posting, and replying is not following up.
28595
28596 @item reply
28597 @cindex reply
28598 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
28599
28600 @item follow up
28601 @cindex follow up
28602 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
28603 are reading.
28604
28605 @item back end
28606 @cindex back end
28607 Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
28608 difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
28609 commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
28610 messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
28611 architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
28612 ``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
28613 @key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
28614 Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
28615 ``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
28616 number 4711''.
28617
28618 So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
28619 end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
28620 accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
28621 layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
28622 ``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
28623 file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
28624
28625 Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
28626 done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
28627 access the articles.
28628
28629 However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
28630 would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
28631 method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
28632 confusing.
28633
28634 @item native
28635 @cindex native
28636 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
28637 default, way of getting news. Groups from the native select method
28638 have names like @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}.
28639
28640 @item foreign
28641 @cindex foreign
28642 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same
28643 time. These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends
28644 for getting news. Foreign groups have names like
28645 @samp{nntp+news.gmane.org:gmane.emacs.gnus.devel}.
28646
28647 @item secondary
28648 @cindex secondary
28649 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and
28650 being foreign, but they mostly act like they are native, but they, too
28651 have names like @samp{nntp+news.gmane.org:gmane.emacs.gnus.devel}.
28652
28653 @item article
28654 @cindex article
28655 A message that has been posted as news.
28656
28657 @item mail message
28658 @cindex mail message
28659 A message that has been mailed.
28660
28661 @item message
28662 @cindex message
28663 A mail message or news article
28664
28665 @item head
28666 @cindex head
28667 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.)@: is
28668 put.
28669
28670 @item body
28671 @cindex body
28672 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
28673 body.
28674
28675 @item header
28676 @cindex header
28677 A line from the head of an article.
28678
28679 @item headers
28680 @cindex headers
28681 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
28682 collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
28683
28684 @item @acronym{NOV}
28685 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
28686 @acronym{NOV} stands for News OverView, which is a type of news server
28687 header which provide datas containing the condensed header information
28688 of articles. They are produced by the server itself; in the @code{nntp}
28689 back end Gnus uses the ones that the @acronym{NNTP} server makes, but
28690 Gnus makes them by itself for some backends (in particular, @code{nnml}).
28691
28692 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
28693 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
28694 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
28695 normal @sc{head} format.
28696
28697 The @acronym{NOV} data consist of one or more text lines (@pxref{Text
28698 Lines, ,Motion by Text Lines, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual})
28699 where each line has the header information of one article. The header
28700 information is a tab-separated series of the header's contents including
28701 an article number, a subject, an author, a date, a message-id,
28702 references, etc.
28703
28704 Those data enable Gnus to generate summary lines quickly. However, if
28705 the server does not support @acronym{NOV} or you disable it purposely or
28706 for some reason, Gnus will try to generate the header information by
28707 parsing each article's headers one by one. It will take time.
28708 Therefore, it is not usually a good idea to set nn*-nov-is-evil
28709 (@pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}) to a non-@code{nil} value unless you
28710 know that the server makes wrong @acronym{NOV} data.
28711
28712 @item level
28713 @cindex levels
28714 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1--9). The ones
28715 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
28716 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1--5 are considered
28717 @dfn{subscribed}; 6--7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
28718 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
28719 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
28720
28721 @item killed groups
28722 @cindex killed groups
28723 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
28724 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
28725
28726 @item zombie groups
28727 @cindex zombie groups
28728 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
28729
28730 @item active file
28731 @cindex active file
28732 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
28733 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
28734 is rather large, as you might surmise.
28735
28736 @item bogus groups
28737 @cindex bogus groups
28738 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
28739 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
28740 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
28741
28742 @item activating
28743 @cindex activating groups
28744 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
28745 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
28746 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
28747
28748 @item spool
28749 @cindex spool
28750 News servers store their articles locally in one fashion or other.
28751 One old-fashioned storage method is to have just one file per
28752 article. That's called a ``traditional spool''.
28753
28754 @item server
28755 @cindex server
28756 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
28757
28758 @item select method
28759 @cindex select method
28760 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
28761 server settings.
28762
28763 @item virtual server
28764 @cindex virtual server
28765 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
28766 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
28767 whole is a virtual server.
28768
28769 @item washing
28770 @cindex washing
28771 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
28772 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
28773 original.
28774
28775 @item ephemeral groups
28776 @cindex ephemeral groups
28777 @cindex temporary groups
28778 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
28779 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
28780 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
28781
28782 @item solid groups
28783 @cindex solid groups
28784 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
28785 group buffer are solid groups.
28786
28787 @item sparse articles
28788 @cindex sparse articles
28789 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
28790 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
28791
28792 @item threading
28793 @cindex threading
28794 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
28795 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
28796
28797 @item root
28798 @cindex root
28799 @cindex thread root
28800 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
28801 articles in the thread.
28802
28803 @item parent
28804 @cindex parent
28805 An article that has responses.
28806
28807 @item child
28808 @cindex child
28809 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
28810
28811 @item digest
28812 @cindex digest
28813 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
28814 specified by RFC 1153.
28815
28816 @item splitting
28817 @cindex splitting, terminology
28818 @cindex mail sorting
28819 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
28820 The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
28821 incorrectly called mail filtering.
28822
28823 @end table
28824
28825
28826 @page
28827 @node Customization
28828 @section Customization
28829 @cindex general customization
28830
28831 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
28832 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
28833 for some quite common situations.
28834
28835 @menu
28836 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
28837 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
28838 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
28839 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
28840 @end menu
28841
28842
28843 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
28844 @subsection Slow/Expensive Connection
28845
28846 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
28847 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
28848 Gnus has to get from the server.
28849
28850 @table @code
28851
28852 @item gnus-read-active-file
28853 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
28854 entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
28855 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
28856 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
28857 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
28858
28859 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
28860 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
28861 Usually this one must @emph{always} be @code{nil} (which is the
28862 default). If, for example, you wish to not use @acronym{NOV}
28863 (@pxref{Terminology}) with the @code{nntp} back end (@pxref{Crosspost
28864 Handling}), set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to a non-@code{nil} value
28865 instead of setting this. But you normally do not need to set
28866 @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} since Gnus by itself will detect whether the
28867 @acronym{NNTP} server supports @acronym{NOV}. Anyway, grabbing article
28868 headers from the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast if you tell
28869 Gnus not to use @acronym{NOV}.
28870
28871 As the variables for the other back ends, there are
28872 @code{nndiary-nov-is-evil}, @code{nndir-nov-is-evil},
28873 @code{nnfolder-nov-is-evil}, @code{nnimap-nov-is-evil},
28874 @code{nnml-nov-is-evil}, and @code{nnspool-nov-is-evil}. Note that a
28875 non-@code{nil} value for @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} overrides all those
28876 variables.
28877 @end table
28878
28879
28880 @node Slow Terminal Connection
28881 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
28882
28883 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
28884 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
28885 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
28886
28887 @table @code
28888
28889 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
28890 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
28891 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
28892 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
28893 horizontal and vertical recentering.
28894
28895 @item gnus-visible-headers
28896 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
28897 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
28898 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
28899 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
28900
28901 Use the following to enable all the available hiding features:
28902 @lisp
28903 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
28904 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
28905 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
28906 @end lisp
28907
28908 @item gnus-use-full-window
28909 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
28910 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
28911 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
28912 want to read them anyway.
28913
28914 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
28915 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
28916 hidden initially.
28917
28918
28919 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
28920 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
28921 lines, which might save some time.
28922 @end table
28923
28924
28925 @node Little Disk Space
28926 @subsection Little Disk Space
28927 @cindex disk space
28928
28929 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
28930 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
28931
28932 @table @code
28933
28934 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
28935 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
28936 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
28937 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
28938 default.
28939
28940 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
28941 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
28942 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
28943 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
28944 default.
28945
28946 @item gnus-save-killed-list
28947 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
28948 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
28949 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
28950 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
28951
28952 @end table
28953
28954
28955 @node Slow Machine
28956 @subsection Slow Machine
28957 @cindex slow machine
28958
28959 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
28960 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
28961
28962 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
28963 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
28964
28965 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
28966 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
28967 summary buffer faster. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
28968
28969
28970 @page
28971 @node Troubleshooting
28972 @section Troubleshooting
28973 @cindex troubleshooting
28974
28975 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
28976 problems, really.
28977
28978 Ahem.
28979
28980 @enumerate
28981
28982 @item
28983 Make sure your computer is switched on.
28984
28985 @item
28986 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
28987 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
28988 Gnus will work.
28989
28990 @item
28991 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
28992 like @c
28993 @samp{Gnus v5.13} @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change this line!
28994 @c
28995 you have the right files loaded. Otherwise you have some old @file{.el}
28996 files lying around. Delete these.
28997
28998 @item
28999 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
29000 @acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
29001
29002 @item
29003 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
29004 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
29005 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
29006 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
29007 something like that.
29008 @end enumerate
29009
29010 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
29011
29012 @cindex bugs
29013 @cindex reporting bugs
29014
29015 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
29016 @findex gnus-bug
29017 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
29018 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
29019 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
29020 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
29021
29022 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
29023 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
29024 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
29025 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
29026 time.
29027
29028 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
29029 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
29030 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
29031 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
29032 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
29033 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
29034
29035 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
29036 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
29037 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
29038 the bug report.
29039
29040 @cindex patches
29041 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
29042 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
29043
29044 @cindex edebug
29045 If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
29046 in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
29047 edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
29048 (@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
29049 Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
29050 you discover some weird behavior when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
29051 step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
29052 the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
29053 then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
29054 return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
29055 placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
29056 evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
29057 @kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
29058 @kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
29059
29060 @cindex elp
29061 @cindex profile
29062 @cindex slow
29063 Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
29064 manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
29065 can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
29066 slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
29067 helps isolating the real problem areas).
29068
29069 A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP@. The profiler is
29070 (or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
29071 there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
29072 part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g., @kbd{M-x
29073 elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
29074 RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
29075 @kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
29076 time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
29077 longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
29078 output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
29079 profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
29080 elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
29081 complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
29082 work perfectly.
29083
29084 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
29085 @cindex ding mailing list
29086 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
29087 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
29088 @email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
29089 @email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
29090
29091
29092 @page
29093 @node Gnus Reference Guide
29094 @section Gnus Reference Guide
29095
29096 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
29097 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
29098 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
29099 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
29100 it.
29101
29102 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
29103 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
29104 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
29105 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
29106 and general methods of operation.
29107
29108 @menu
29109 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
29110 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
29111 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
29112 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
29113 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
29114 * Group Info:: The group info format.
29115 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
29116 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
29117 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
29118 @end menu
29119
29120
29121 @node Gnus Utility Functions
29122 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
29123 @cindex Gnus utility functions
29124 @cindex utility functions
29125 @cindex functions
29126 @cindex internal variables
29127
29128 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
29129 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
29130 Below is a list of the most common ones.
29131
29132 @table @code
29133
29134 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
29135 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
29136 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
29137
29138 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
29139 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
29140 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
29141
29142 @item gnus-group-real-name
29143 @findex gnus-group-real-name
29144 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
29145 name.
29146
29147 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
29148 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
29149 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
29150 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
29151
29152 @item gnus-get-info
29153 @findex gnus-get-info
29154 Returns the group info list for @var{group} (@pxref{Group Info}).
29155
29156 @item gnus-group-unread
29157 @findex gnus-group-unread
29158 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
29159 unknown.
29160
29161 @item gnus-active
29162 @findex gnus-active
29163 The active entry (i.e., a cons cell containing the lowest and highest
29164 article numbers) for @var{group}.
29165
29166 @item gnus-set-active
29167 @findex gnus-set-active
29168 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
29169
29170 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29171 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29172 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
29173 exit.
29174
29175 @item gnus-continuum-version
29176 @findex gnus-continuum-version
29177 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
29178 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
29179 versions.
29180
29181 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
29182 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
29183 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
29184
29185 @item gnus-news-group-p
29186 @findex gnus-news-group-p
29187 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
29188
29189 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29190 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29191 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
29192
29193 @item gnus-server-to-method
29194 @findex gnus-server-to-method
29195 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
29196
29197 @item gnus-server-equal
29198 @findex gnus-server-equal
29199 Says whether two virtual servers are essentially equal. For instance,
29200 two virtual servers may have server parameters in different order, but
29201 this function will consider them equal.
29202
29203 @item gnus-group-native-p
29204 @findex gnus-group-native-p
29205 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
29206
29207 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
29208 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
29209 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
29210
29211 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
29212 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
29213 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
29214
29215 @item gnus-group-find-parameter
29216 @findex gnus-group-find-parameter
29217 Returns the parameter list of @var{group} (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
29218 If given a second parameter, returns the value of that parameter for
29219 @var{group}.
29220
29221 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
29222 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
29223 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
29224
29225 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
29226 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
29227 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
29228
29229 @item gnus-check-backend-function
29230 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
29231 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
29232 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
29233
29234 @lisp
29235 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
29236 @result{} t
29237 @end lisp
29238
29239 @item gnus-read-method
29240 @findex gnus-read-method
29241 Prompts the user for a select method.
29242
29243 @end table
29244
29245
29246 @node Back End Interface
29247 @subsection Back End Interface
29248
29249 Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
29250 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
29251 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
29252 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
29253 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
29254 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
29255
29256 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
29257 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
29258 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
29259 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
29260 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
29261 been opened, the function should fail.
29262
29263 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
29264 name. Take this example:
29265
29266 @lisp
29267 (nntp "odd-one"
29268 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
29269 (nntp-port-number 4324))
29270 @end lisp
29271
29272 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
29273 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
29274
29275 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
29276 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
29277 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
29278
29279 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
29280 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
29281 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
29282
29283 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
29284 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
29285 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
29286 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
29287 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
29288 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
29289 return value.
29290
29291 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
29292 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
29293 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server'';
29294 they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
29295 more.
29296
29297 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
29298 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
29299 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
29300 possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
29301 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
29302 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
29303 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
29304 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
29305 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
29306 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
29307
29308 The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
29309 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
29310 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
29311 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
29312 the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
29313 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
29314 of numbers as long as possible.
29315
29316 Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
29317 Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
29318 @file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
29319
29320 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
29321 @code{nnchoke}.
29322
29323 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
29324
29325 @menu
29326 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
29327 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
29328 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
29329 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
29330 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
29331 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
29332 @end menu
29333
29334
29335 @node Required Back End Functions
29336 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
29337
29338 @table @code
29339
29340 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
29341
29342 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
29343 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
29344 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
29345 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
29346
29347 The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
29348 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
29349 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
29350 of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
29351
29352 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
29353 headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
29354 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
29355 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
29356 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
29357 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
29358 number, do maximum fetches.
29359
29360 Here's an example HEAD:
29361
29362 @example
29363 221 1056 Article retrieved.
29364 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
29365 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
29366 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
29367 Subject: Re: Something very droll
29368 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
29369 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
29370 Lines: 26
29371 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
29372 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
29373 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
29374 .
29375 @end example
29376
29377 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
29378 these in the data buffer.
29379
29380 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
29381
29382 @example
29383 headers = *head
29384 head = error / valid-head
29385 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
29386 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
29387 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
29388 header = <text> eol
29389 @end example
29390
29391 @cindex BNF
29392 (The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
29393
29394 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
29395 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
29396 separated by tabs.
29397
29398 @example
29399 nov-buffer = *nov-line
29400 nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
29401 field = <text except TAB>
29402 @end example
29403
29404 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
29405 @pxref{Headers}.
29406
29407
29408 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
29409
29410 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
29411 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
29412
29413 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
29414 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
29415 server. In fact, it should do so.
29416
29417 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
29418 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
29419
29420
29421 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
29422
29423 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
29424 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
29425 reason.
29426
29427 There should be no data returned.
29428
29429
29430 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
29431
29432 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
29433 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
29434 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
29435 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
29436
29437 There should be no data returned.
29438
29439
29440 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
29441
29442 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
29443 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
29444 non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
29445 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
29446
29447 There should be no data returned.
29448
29449
29450 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
29451
29452 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
29453
29454 There should be no data returned.
29455
29456
29457 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
29458
29459 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
29460 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
29461 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
29462 it would be nice if that were possible.
29463
29464 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
29465 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
29466 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
29467 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
29468 into its article buffer.
29469
29470 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
29471 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
29472 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
29473 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
29474 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
29475 on successful article retrieval.
29476
29477
29478 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST INFO)
29479
29480 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
29481 making @var{group} the current group.
29482
29483 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
29484 the current group.
29485
29486 If @var{info}, it allows the backend to update the group info
29487 structure.
29488
29489 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
29490
29491 @example
29492 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
29493 @end example
29494
29495 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
29496 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
29497 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
29498 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
29499 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
29500 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
29501 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
29502 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
29503 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
29504 highest as 0.
29505
29506 @example
29507 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
29508 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
29509 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
29510 @end example
29511
29512
29513 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29514
29515 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
29516 a no-op on most back ends.
29517
29518 There should be no data returned.
29519
29520
29521 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
29522
29523 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
29524 @emph{all}.
29525
29526 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
29527
29528 @example
29529 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
29530 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
29531 @end example
29532
29533 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
29534 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
29535 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
29536 and the highest as 0.
29537
29538 @example
29539 active-file = *active-line
29540 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
29541 name = <string>
29542 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
29543 @end example
29544
29545 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
29546 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
29547 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
29548
29549
29550 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
29551
29552 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
29553 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
29554 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
29555 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
29556 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
29557 clear if the posting could not be completed.
29558
29559 There should be no result data from this function.
29560
29561 @end table
29562
29563
29564 @node Optional Back End Functions
29565 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
29566
29567 @table @code
29568
29569 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
29570
29571 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
29572 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
29573 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
29574
29575 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
29576 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
29577 former is in the same format as the data from
29578 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
29579 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
29580
29581 @example
29582 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
29583 @end example
29584
29585
29586 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
29587
29588 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
29589 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
29590 the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
29591 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
29592 should return a non-@code{nil} value (exceptionally,
29593 @code{nntp-request-update-info} always returns @code{nil} not to waste
29594 the network resources).
29595
29596 There should be no result data from this function.
29597
29598
29599 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
29600
29601 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
29602 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
29603 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
29604 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
29605 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
29606 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
29607 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
29608 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
29609
29610 There should be no result data from this function.
29611
29612
29613 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
29614
29615 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
29616 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc.)@: internally, and store them in
29617 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
29618 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
29619 propagate the mark information to the server.
29620
29621 @var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
29622
29623 @example
29624 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
29625 @end example
29626
29627 @var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
29628 @var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
29629 marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
29630 marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
29631 @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
29632 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend}, and
29633 @code{forward}, but your back end should, if possible, not limit
29634 itself to these.
29635
29636 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
29637 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
29638 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
29639 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
29640
29641 An example action list:
29642
29643 @example
29644 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
29645 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
29646 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
29647 @end example
29648
29649 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
29650 mark on (currently not used for anything).
29651
29652 There should be no result data from this function.
29653
29654 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
29655
29656 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
29657 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
29658 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
29659 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
29660 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
29661
29662 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
29663 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
29664 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
29665 expirable.
29666
29667 There should be no result data from this function.
29668
29669
29670 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
29671
29672 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
29673 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
29674 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
29675 the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
29676 @var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
29677 it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
29678 total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
29679 local if that's practical.
29680
29681 There should be no result data from this function.
29682
29683
29684 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
29685
29686 The result data from this function should be a description of
29687 @var{group}.
29688
29689 @example
29690 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
29691 name = <string>
29692 description = <text>
29693 @end example
29694
29695 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
29696
29697 The result data from this function should be the description of all
29698 groups available on the server.
29699
29700 @example
29701 description-buffer = *description-line
29702 @end example
29703
29704
29705 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
29706
29707 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
29708 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
29709 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
29710 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
29711 in the active buffer format.
29712
29713 It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
29714 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
29715 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
29716 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
29717 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
29718 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
29719 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
29720
29721
29722 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29723
29724 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
29725
29726 There should be no return data.
29727
29728
29729 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
29730
29731 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
29732 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
29733 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
29734 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
29735 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
29736 they are.
29737
29738 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
29739 able to delete.
29740
29741 There should be no result data returned.
29742
29743
29744 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
29745
29746 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
29747 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
29748
29749 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
29750 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
29751 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
29752 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
29753 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
29754 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
29755
29756 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
29757 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
29758 optimizations.
29759
29760 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
29761 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
29762
29763 There should be no data returned.
29764
29765
29766 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
29767
29768 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
29769 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
29770 this function in short order.
29771
29772 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
29773 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
29774
29775 The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
29776 article for that group.
29777
29778 There should be no data returned.
29779
29780
29781 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
29782
29783 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
29784 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
29785
29786 There should be no data returned.
29787
29788
29789 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
29790
29791 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
29792 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
29793 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
29794
29795 There should be no data returned.
29796
29797
29798 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
29799
29800 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
29801 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
29802
29803 There should be no data returned.
29804
29805 @end table
29806
29807
29808 @node Error Messaging
29809 @subsubsection Error Messaging
29810
29811 @findex nnheader-report
29812 @findex nnheader-get-report
29813 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
29814 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
29815 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
29816 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
29817 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
29818 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
29819
29820 @lisp
29821 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
29822
29823 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
29824 @end lisp
29825
29826 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
29827 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
29828 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
29829 takes one argument---the server symbol.
29830
29831 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
29832 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
29833 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
29834
29835
29836 @node Writing New Back Ends
29837 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
29838
29839 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
29840 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
29841 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
29842 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
29843 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
29844 editing articles.
29845
29846 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
29847 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
29848 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
29849
29850 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
29851 package called @code{nnoo}.
29852
29853 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
29854 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
29855 following macros:
29856
29857 @table @code
29858
29859 @item nnoo-declare
29860 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
29861 parameters. For instance:
29862
29863 @lisp
29864 (nnoo-declare nndir
29865 nnml nnmh)
29866 @end lisp
29867
29868 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
29869 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
29870
29871 @item defvoo
29872 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
29873 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
29874 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
29875
29876 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
29877 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
29878 a function in those back ends.
29879
29880 @lisp
29881 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
29882 "Where nndir will look for groups."
29883 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
29884 @end lisp
29885
29886 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
29887 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
29888 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
29889
29890 @item nnoo-define-basics
29891 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
29892 have.
29893
29894 @lisp
29895 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
29896 @end lisp
29897
29898 @item deffoo
29899 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
29900 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
29901 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
29902
29903 @item nnoo-map-functions
29904 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
29905 functions from the parent back ends.
29906
29907 @lisp
29908 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
29909 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29910 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
29911 @end lisp
29912
29913 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
29914 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
29915 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
29916 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
29917
29918 @item nnoo-import
29919 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
29920 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
29921 haven't already been defined.
29922
29923 @lisp
29924 (nnoo-import nndir
29925 (nnmh
29926 nnmh-request-list
29927 nnmh-request-newgroups)
29928 (nnml))
29929 @end lisp
29930
29931 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
29932 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
29933 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
29934 defined now.
29935
29936 @end table
29937
29938 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
29939
29940 @lisp
29941 ;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
29942 ;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,1996 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
29943
29944 ;;; @r{Code:}
29945
29946 (require 'nnheader)
29947 (require 'nnmh)
29948 (require 'nnml)
29949 (require 'nnoo)
29950 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
29951
29952 (nnoo-declare nndir
29953 nnml nnmh)
29954
29955 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
29956 "Where nndir will look for groups."
29957 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
29958
29959 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
29960 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
29961 nnml-nov-is-evil)
29962
29963 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
29964 nil
29965 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
29966 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
29967 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
29968
29969 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
29970 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
29971
29972 ;;; @r{Interface functions.}
29973
29974 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
29975
29976 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
29977 (setq nndir-directory
29978 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
29979 server))
29980 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
29981 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
29982 (push `(nndir-current-group
29983 ,(file-name-nondirectory
29984 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
29985 defs)
29986 (push `(nndir-top-directory
29987 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
29988 defs)
29989 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
29990
29991 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
29992 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29993 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29994 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
29995 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
29996
29997 (nnoo-import nndir
29998 (nnmh
29999 nnmh-status-message
30000 nnmh-request-list
30001 nnmh-request-newgroups))
30002
30003 (provide 'nndir)
30004 @end lisp
30005
30006
30007 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
30008 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
30009
30010 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
30011 @findex gnus-declare-backend
30012 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
30013 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
30014 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
30015
30016 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
30017 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
30018
30019 Here's an example:
30020
30021 @lisp
30022 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
30023 @end lisp
30024
30025 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
30026
30027 The abilities can be:
30028
30029 @table @code
30030 @item mail
30031 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
30032 @item post
30033 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
30034 @item post-mail
30035 This back end supports both mail and news.
30036 @item none
30037 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
30038 different.
30039 @item respool
30040 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
30041 articles and groups.
30042 @item address
30043 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
30044 true for almost all back ends.
30045 @item prompt-address
30046 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
30047 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
30048 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
30049 @end table
30050
30051
30052 @node Mail-like Back Ends
30053 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
30054
30055 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
30056 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
30057 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
30058 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
30059
30060 @lisp
30061 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
30062 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
30063 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
30064 @end lisp
30065
30066 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
30067 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
30068 mail.
30069
30070 This function takes four parameters.
30071
30072 @table @var
30073 @item method
30074 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
30075 the call.
30076
30077 @item exit-function
30078 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
30079
30080 @item temp-directory
30081 Where the temporary files should be stored.
30082
30083 @item group
30084 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
30085 performed for one group only.
30086 @end table
30087
30088 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
30089 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
30090 find the article number assigned to this article.
30091
30092 The function also uses the following variables:
30093 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
30094 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
30095 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
30096 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
30097 this:
30098
30099 @example
30100 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
30101 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
30102 @end example
30103
30104
30105 @node Score File Syntax
30106 @subsection Score File Syntax
30107
30108 Score files are meant to be easily parsable, but yet extremely
30109 malleable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
30110 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
30111
30112 Here's a typical score file:
30113
30114 @lisp
30115 (("summary"
30116 ("Windows 95" -10000 nil s)
30117 ("Gnus"))
30118 ("from"
30119 ("Lars" -1000))
30120 (mark -100))
30121 @end lisp
30122
30123 BNF definition of a score file:
30124
30125 @example
30126 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
30127 element = rule / atom
30128 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
30129 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
30130 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
30131 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
30132 quote = <ascii 34>
30133 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
30134 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
30135 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
30136 date-header = "date"
30137 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30138 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30139 score = "nil" / <integer>
30140 date = "nil" / <natural number>
30141 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
30142 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
30143 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
30144 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
30145 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30146 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30147 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
30148 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30149 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
30150 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
30151 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
30152 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
30153 exclude-files / read-only / touched
30154 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
30155 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
30156 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
30157 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
30158 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
30159 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
30160 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
30161 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
30162 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
30163 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
30164 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
30165 eval = "eval" space <form>
30166 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
30167 @end example
30168
30169 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
30170 discarded.
30171
30172 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
30173 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
30174 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
30175 one looong line, then that's ok.
30176
30177 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
30178 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
30179
30180
30181 @node Headers
30182 @subsection Headers
30183
30184 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
30185 corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
30186 almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
30187 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
30188
30189 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
30190 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
30191 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
30192 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
30193 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
30194 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
30195 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
30196
30197 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
30198 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
30199 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
30200 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
30201 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
30202
30203 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
30204 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
30205
30206
30207 @node Ranges
30208 @subsection Ranges
30209
30210 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
30211 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
30212
30213 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
30214 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
30215 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
30216 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
30217
30218 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
30219 sequence.
30220
30221 @example
30222 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
30223 @end example
30224
30225 is transformed into
30226
30227 @example
30228 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
30229 @end example
30230
30231 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
30232 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
30233
30234 @example
30235 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
30236 @end example
30237
30238 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
30239 is slightly tricky:
30240
30241 @example
30242 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
30243 @end example
30244
30245 and
30246
30247 @example
30248 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
30249 @end example
30250
30251 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
30252
30253 @example
30254 (1 2 3 4 5)
30255 @end example
30256
30257 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
30258 also valid:
30259
30260 @example
30261 (1 . 5)
30262 @end example
30263
30264 and is equal to the previous range.
30265
30266 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
30267 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
30268 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
30269 range handling.)
30270
30271 @example
30272 range = simple-range / normal-range
30273 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
30274 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
30275 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
30276 number *[ " " contents ]
30277 @end example
30278
30279 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
30280 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
30281 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
30282 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
30283 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
30284 sequences.)
30285
30286
30287 @node Group Info
30288 @subsection Group Info
30289
30290 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
30291 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
30292 describes the group.
30293
30294 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
30295 second is a more complex one:
30296
30297 @example
30298 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
30299
30300 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
30301 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
30302 (nnml "")
30303 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
30304 @end example
30305
30306 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
30307 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
30308 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
30309 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
30310 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
30311 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
30312 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
30313 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
30314 this section is about.
30315
30316 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
30317 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
30318 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
30319
30320 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
30321
30322 @example
30323 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
30324 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
30325 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30326 group = quote <string> quote
30327 ralevel = rank / level
30328 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30329 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
30330 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30331 read = range
30332 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
30333 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
30334 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
30335 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
30336 @end example
30337
30338 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
30339 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
30340 in pseudo-BNF.
30341
30342 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
30343 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
30344
30345 @table @code
30346 @item gnus-info-group
30347 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
30348 @findex gnus-info-group
30349 @findex gnus-info-set-group
30350 Get/set the group name.
30351
30352 @item gnus-info-rank
30353 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
30354 @findex gnus-info-rank
30355 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
30356 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
30357
30358 @item gnus-info-level
30359 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
30360 @findex gnus-info-level
30361 @findex gnus-info-set-level
30362 Get/set the group level.
30363
30364 @item gnus-info-score
30365 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
30366 @findex gnus-info-score
30367 @findex gnus-info-set-score
30368 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
30369
30370 @item gnus-info-read
30371 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
30372 @findex gnus-info-read
30373 @findex gnus-info-set-read
30374 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
30375
30376 @item gnus-info-marks
30377 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
30378 @findex gnus-info-marks
30379 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
30380 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
30381
30382 @item gnus-info-method
30383 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
30384 @findex gnus-info-method
30385 @findex gnus-info-set-method
30386 Get/set the group select method.
30387
30388 @item gnus-info-params
30389 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
30390 @findex gnus-info-params
30391 @findex gnus-info-set-params
30392 Get/set the group parameters.
30393 @end table
30394
30395 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
30396 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
30397
30398 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
30399 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
30400 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
30401 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
30402
30403
30404 @node Extended Interactive
30405 @subsection Extended Interactive
30406 @cindex interactive
30407 @findex gnus-interactive
30408
30409 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
30410 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
30411 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
30412
30413 @lisp
30414 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
30415 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
30416 ...
30417 )
30418 @end lisp
30419
30420 The best thing to do would have been to implement
30421 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
30422 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
30423 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
30424 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
30425 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
30426 @code{interactive}.
30427
30428 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
30429 adds a few more.
30430
30431 @table @samp
30432 @item y
30433 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
30434 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
30435 variable.
30436
30437 @item Y
30438 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
30439 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
30440 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
30441
30442 @item A
30443 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
30444 function.
30445
30446 @item H
30447 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
30448 function.
30449
30450 @item g
30451 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
30452 function.
30453
30454 @end table
30455
30456
30457 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
30458 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
30459 @cindex XEmacs
30460 @cindex Emacsen
30461
30462 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
30463 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
30464 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
30465
30466 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
30467 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
30468 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
30469 Gnus, that's very useful.
30470
30471 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
30472 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
30473 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
30474 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
30475 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
30476 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
30477 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
30478 following function:
30479
30480 @lisp
30481 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
30482 (start-itimer
30483 "gnus-run-at-time"
30484 `(lambda ()
30485 (,function ,@@args))
30486 time repeat))
30487 @end lisp
30488
30489 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
30490 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
30491 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
30492 all over.
30493
30494 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
30495 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
30496 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
30497
30498 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
30499 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
30500 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
30501
30502
30503 @node Various File Formats
30504 @subsection Various File Formats
30505
30506 @menu
30507 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
30508 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
30509 @end menu
30510
30511
30512 @node Active File Format
30513 @subsubsection Active File Format
30514
30515 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
30516 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
30517 in each group.
30518
30519 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
30520
30521 @example
30522 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
30523 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
30524 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
30525 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
30526 no.general 1000 900 y
30527 @end example
30528
30529 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
30530
30531 @example
30532 active = *group-line
30533 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
30534 group = <non-white-space string>
30535 spc = " "
30536 high-number = <non-negative integer>
30537 low-number = <positive integer>
30538 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
30539 @end example
30540
30541 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
30542 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
30543
30544
30545 @node Newsgroups File Format
30546 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
30547
30548 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
30549 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
30550 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
30551 the user.
30552
30553 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
30554 Here's the definition:
30555
30556 @example
30557 newsgroups = *line
30558 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
30559 group = <non-white-space string>
30560 tab = <TAB>
30561 description = <string>
30562 @end example
30563
30564
30565 @page
30566 @node Emacs for Heathens
30567 @section Emacs for Heathens
30568
30569 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
30570 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
30571 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
30572 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
30573 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
30574 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
30575 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
30576 cat instead.
30577
30578 @menu
30579 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
30580 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
30581 @end menu
30582
30583
30584 @node Keystrokes
30585 @subsection Keystrokes
30586
30587 @itemize @bullet
30588 @item
30589 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
30590
30591 @item
30592 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
30593 @end itemize
30594
30595 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
30596 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
30597 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
30598 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
30599 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
30600 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
30601
30602 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
30603 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
30604 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
30605 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
30606 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
30607 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
30608 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
30609
30610 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
30611 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
30612 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
30613 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
30614 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
30615 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
30616 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
30617
30618 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
30619 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
30620 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
30621 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
30622 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
30623 it.
30624
30625
30626
30627 @node Emacs Lisp
30628 @subsection Emacs Lisp
30629
30630 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
30631 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
30632 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
30633 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
30634
30635 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
30636 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
30637 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
30638 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
30639 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
30640 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
30641 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{~/.gnus.el}
30642 file to customize Gnus. (You can also use the @file{~/.emacs} file, but
30643 in order to set things of Gnus up, it is much better to use the
30644 @file{~/.gnus.el} file, @xref{Startup Files}.)
30645
30646 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
30647 write the following:
30648
30649 @lisp
30650 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
30651 @end lisp
30652
30653 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
30654 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
30655 you can go and fill your @file{~/.gnus.el} file with lots of these to
30656 change how Gnus works.
30657
30658 If you have put that thing in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, it will be
30659 read and @code{eval}ed (which is Lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
30660 start Gnus. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
30661 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
30662 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
30663
30664 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
30665 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
30666 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
30667
30668 Some pitfalls:
30669
30670 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
30671 that means:
30672
30673 @lisp
30674 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
30675 @end lisp
30676
30677 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server-file} to
30678 @samp{/etc/nntpserver}'', that means:
30679
30680 @lisp
30681 (setq gnus-nntp-server-file "/etc/nntpserver")
30682 @end lisp
30683
30684 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
30685 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
30686
30687 @page
30688 @include gnus-faq.texi
30689
30690 @node GNU Free Documentation License
30691 @chapter GNU Free Documentation License
30692 @include doclicense.texi
30693
30694 @node Index
30695 @chapter Index
30696 @printindex cp
30697
30698 @node Key Index
30699 @chapter Key Index
30700 @printindex ky
30701
30702 @bye
30703
30704 @iftex
30705 @iflatex
30706 \end{document}
30707 @end iflatex
30708 @end iftex
30709
30710 @c Local Variables:
30711 @c mode: texinfo
30712 @c coding: utf-8
30713 @c End: